HP 8558 Spectrum Analyzer User Manual


Add to my manuals
343 Pages

advertisement

HP 8558 Spectrum Analyzer User Manual | Manualzz

TECHNICAL MANUAL

OPERATOR’S ORGANIZATIONAL,

DIRECT SUPPORT, AND

GENERAL SUPPORT

MAINTENANCE MANUAL

SPECTRUM ANALYZER

HEWLETT-PACKARD MODEL 85558B

TM 11-6625-3061-14

HEADQUARTERS, DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY

1 JANUARY 1986

A

TM 11-6625-3061-14

TM 11-6625-3061-14

SAFETY CONSIDERATIONS

Safety Symbols

The following safety symbols are used throughout this manual and in the instrument. Familiarize yourself with each of the symbols and its meaning before operating this instrument.

Instruction manual symbol: the apparatus will be marked with this symbol when it is necessary for the user to refer to the instruction manual in order to protect the apparatus against damage.

the equipment. Do not proceed beyond a

CAUTION sign until the indicated conditions are fully understood and met.

CAUTION

Indicates dangerous voltages.

The CAUTION sign denotes a hazard. It calls attention to an operation procedure, practice, or the like, which, if not correctly performed or adhered to, could result in damage to or destruction of part or all of

WARNING

The WARNING sign denotes a hazard. It calls attention to a procedure, practice, or the like, which, if not correctly performed or adhered to, could result in injury or loss of life. Do not proceed beyond a WARNING sign until the indicated conditions are fully understood and met.

Operation

WARNING

BEFORE THIS INSTRUMENT IS

SWITCHED ON, the oscilloscope mainframe protective earth terminal must be connected through the protective conductor of the ac power cable to a socket outlet provided with protective earth contact.

Failure to ground the instrument can result in personal injury.

WARNING

The 8558B Spectrum Analyzer should not be operated without protective covers (out of the mainframe). Adjustments,

Service and Adjustments performance tests, and service procedures which require operation of the 8558B out of the mainframe should be performed only by trained service personnel.

CAUTION

BEFORE THIS INSTRUMENT IS

SWITCHED ON, make sure that the oscilloscope mainframe is set to the voltage of the ac power source. Failure to set the ac power input to the correct voltage could cause damage to the instrument when the ac power cable is plugged in.

WARNING

There are voltages at many points in the instrument which can, if contacted, cause personal injury. Be extremely careful.

Service and adjustments should be performed only by trained service personnel.

WARNING

Any interruption of the protective

(grounding) conductor, inside or outside the instrument, or disconnection of the protective earth terminal may cause personal injury.

B

TM 11-6625-3061-14

This manual contains copyright material reproduced by permission of the Hewlett-Packard Company, Valley Forge, PA

19482.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Technical Manual )

)

No. 11-6625-3061-14)

OPERATOR'S ORGANIZATIONAL AND

DIRECT SUPPORT, AND GENERAL SUPPORT

MAINTENANCE MANUAL

SPECTRUM ANALYZER HEWLETT-PACKARD MODEL 8558B

(Includes Option 001 and Option 002)

HEADQUARTERS

DEPARTMENT OF THE ARMY

Washington, DC, 1 January 1986

SERIAL NUMBERS

This manual applies directly to instruments with serial numbers prefixed 2147A.

With modifications described in Section VII, this manual also applies to instruments with the serial prefixes 1914A through

2145A.

For additional important information about serial numbers, see

INSTRUMENTS COVERED BY MANUAL in Section I.

REPORTING ERRORS AND RECOMMENDING IMPROVEMENTS

You can help improve this manual. If you find any mistakes or if you know of a way to improve the procedures, please let us know. Mail your letter, DA Form

2028 (Recommended Changes to Publications and Blank Forms), or DA Form

2028-2 located in the back of this manual direct to Commander, US Army

Communications-Electronics Command and Fort Monmouth, ATTN: AMSEL-

ME-MP, Fort Monmouth, NJ 07703-5007.

In either case, a reply will be furnished direct to you.

i

Section

0

TM 11-6625-3061-14

TABLE OF CONTENTS

Page

INTRODUCTION

0-1

Scope......................................................................................................................

0-1

0-2

Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank Forms .....................................

0-1

0-3

0-4

0-5

0-6

Maintenance Forms, Records, and Reports .............................................................

Reporting Equipment Improvement Recommendations (EIR) ..................................

Administrative Storage ............................................................................................

Destruction of Army Electronics Materiel .................................................................

0-1

0-1

0-1

0-1

ii

TM 11-6625-3061-14

CONTENTS

Section

I

Page

GENERAL INFORMATION..................................1-1

Section Page

IV PERFORMANCE TESTS................................4-1

1-1.

Introduction ..........................................1-1

4-1.

Introduction ........................................4-1

1-20.

1-23.

1-24.

1-26.

1-28.

1-30.

1-32.

1-3.

1-6.

1-10.

1-12.

1-14.

1-15.

1-17.

Description ...........................................1-1

Manual Organization ............................1-1

Specifications.......................................1-2

Safety Considerations ..........................1-2

Instruments Covered by Manual...........1-2

Serial Numbers ....................................1-2

Manual Changes Supplement ..............1-2

Manual Backdating Changes ................1-2

Options ................................................1-9

Option 001 ...........................................1-9

Option 002 ...........................................1-9

Option 910 ...........................................1-9

Accessories Supplied ...........................1-9

Termination..........................................1-9

4-3.

4-5.

4-7.

Instruments Tested .............................4-1

Equipment Required...........................4-1

Test Record........................................4-1

4-9.

Calibration Cycle ................................4-1

4-11.

Frequency Span Accuracy..................4-2

4-12.

Tuning Accuracy.................................4-7

4-13.

Residual FM .......................................4-10

4-14.

Noise Sidebands ................................4-13

4-15.

Resolution Bandwidth

Accuracy ......................................4-15

4-16.

Resolution Bandwidth

Selectivity ....................................4-20

4-17.

Average Noise Level ..........................4-25

4-18.

Spurious Responses ...........................4-27

4-19.

Residual Responses ...........................4-34

4-20.

Frequency Response..........................4-37

4-21.

Bandwidth Switching

(Amplitude Variation)....................4-41

4-22.

Input Attenuator Accuracy ..................4-43

4-23.

Reference Level Accuracy..................4-46

4-24.

Display Fidelity ...................................4-51

4-25.

Calibrator Accuracy ............................4-55

1-34.

1-36.

1-38.

1-39.

Cable Adapter ......................................1-9

Side Stop Kit ........................................1-9

Graticule Overlays ...............................1-9

Equipment Required But .....................

Not Supplied ..................................1-10

Display Mainframe ...............................1-10

Extender Cable Assembly ....................1-10

1-40.

1-43.

1-45.

1-46.

1-48.

1-50.

1-52.

1-54.

Measurement Accessories ...................1-10

AC Probe .............................................1-10

Modification Kit ...................................

(Option 807 Connections) ..............1-10

Oscilloscope Camera ...........................1-10

Service Accessories .............................1-10

Recommended Test Equipment ...........1-11

......................................................

II INSTALLATION ...................................................2-1

2-1.

2-3.

Introduction ..........................................2-1

Initial Inspection ...................................2-1

2-5.

2-6.

2-9.

2-13.

2-15.

2-17.

2-21.

Preparation for Use ..............................2-1

Installation............................................2-1

Side Stop Kit ........................................2-1

Graticule Overlays ...............................2-2

Mainframe Interconnections .................2-2

Operating Environment ........................2-2

Modifications........................................2-2

2-23.

2-24.

2-26.

......................................................

III OPERATION ......................................................3-1

3-1.

3-3.

Introduction ..........................................3-1

Controls, Indicators, and Connectors ....3-1

3-5.

3-13.

3-15.

3-19.

Storage and Shipment..........................2-3

Environment ........................................2-3

Packaging ............................................2-3

Control Grouping..................................3-1

Variable Persistence and .....................

Storage Functions..........................3-2

Persistence and Intensity .....................3-2

Photographic Techniques .....................3-2

Operating Precautions..........................3-2

V ADJUSTMENTS .............................................5-1

5-1.

5-9.

5-19.

5-29.

Introduction ........................................5-1

5-4.

Equipment Required...........................5-1

5-7.

Adjustment Tools .........................5-1

Extender Cable Installation...........5-1

5-13.

Related Adjustments ..........................5-1

5-15.

Factory-Selected Components............5-2

5-17.

Second Converter LO and

Bandpass Adjustments .................5-12

5-18.

Third Converter LO and

CAL OUTPUT Adjustment............5-15

Slope Adjustment ...............................5-18

5-20.

Second IF Bandpass Amplifier and

Bandpass Filter Adjustment..........5-21

5-21.

Crystal and LC Bandwidth

Filter Adjustments ........................5-23

5-22.

3-dB Bandwidth Adjustment................5-29

5-23.

Step Gain Assembly RF

Gain Adjustment ..........................5-33

5-24.

Step Amplifier Gain

Adjustments .................................5-35

5-25.

+19.5V Adjustment .............................5-39

5-26.

Log Amplifier Log and

Linear Adjustment ........................5-40

5-27.

Sweep Time Per Division

Adjustment ...................................5-45

5-28.

Frequency Control and

DPM Adjustments ........................5-48

1-dB Offset Adjustment ......................5-51

iii

TM 11-6625-3061-14

CONTENTS

Section Page Section

VI REPLACEABLE PARTS ......................................6-1

8-5.

Schematic Symbols, Terminology,

6-1.

6-3.

6-6.

Introduction ..........................................6-1

Replaceable Parts List .........................6-1

Ordering Information ............................6-1

......................................................

VII MANUAL BACKDATING CHANGES ...................7-1

7-1.

7-5.

Introduction ..........................................7-1

Manual Change....................................

VII

SERVICE

8-1.

8-3.

Instructions ....................................7-2

......................................................8-1

Introduction ..........................................8-1

Service Information Index ....................8-1

8-7.

8-9.

8-10.

8-13.

Schematic, block and component location

diagrams are listed under ILLUSTRATIONS.

Page

and Voltage Levels.......................8-1

Test Equipment ..................................8-1

Troubleshooting..................................8-1

General ........................................8-1

Troubleshooting Hints...................8-1

8-18.

General Principles of Operation..........8-4

Front Switch Assembly A2,

Disassembly and Repair...............8-107

NOTE

LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS

Page Figure Figure

1-1.

HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer

with Accessories Supplied........................... 1-0

1-2.

Typical Serial Number Label............................ 1-2

1-3.

Service Accessories .......................................1-12

2-1.

Location of Side Stops..................................... 2-3

3-1.

HP 8558B Installed in HP 182T

Display Mainframe ...................................... 3-5

3-2.

Rear Panel Controls and Connectors ............... 3-7

4-1.

Frequency Span Accuracy Test Setup ............. 4-3

4-2.

Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for

Ninth Spectral Line...................................... 4-5

4-3.

Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for

Seventeenth Spectral Line .......................... 4-5

4-4.

Tuning Accuracy Test Setup ............................ 4-9

4-5.

Residual FM Test Setup .................................4-13

4-6.

Example of Residual FM ................................4-14

4-7.

Noise Sideband Test Setup ............................4-17

4-8.

Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup,

3 MHz to 100 kHz ......................................4-19

4-9.

Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup,

1 kHz to 30 kHz .........................................4-21

4-10.

Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup,

1 kHz to 30 kHz .........................................4-25

4-11.

Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup,

100 kHz to 3 MHz ......................................4-28

4-12.

Average Noise Level Measurement ................4-32

4-13.

Harmonic Distortion Test Setup ......................4-33

4-14.

Intermodulation Distortion Test Setup .............4-36

4-15.

Intermodulation Distortion Products ................4-37

4-16.

Residual Responses Test Setup .....................4-41

4-17.

Frequency Response Test Setup ....................4-45

4-18.

Input Attenuator Accuracy Test Setup.............4-51

4-19.

Reference Level Accuracy Test Setup ............4-55

4-20.

Amplitude Log Display Accuracy Test Setup...4-61

4-21.

Calibrator Accuracy Test Setup ......................4-65

5-1.

Second Converter LO and

Bandpass Adjustment Test Setup...............5-13

Page

5-2.

Special Adapter Used in Second Converter

LO and Bandpass Test Setup................5-14

5-3.

Third Converter LO and CAL OUTPUT

Adjustment Test Setup..........................5-17

5-4.

Slope Adjustment Test Setup.....................5-21

5-5.

Second IF Bandpass Amplifier and Bandpass

Filter Adjustment Test Setup .................5-25

5-6.

Crystal and LC Bandwidth Filter

Adjustment Test Setup..........................5-27

5-7.

Crystal Short Configuration........................5-28

5-8.

Adjusting Crystal Symmetry and

Crystal Centering ..................................5-29

5-9.

3- dB Bandwidth Adjustment Test Setup..........5-33

5-10.

Step Gain Assembly RF Gain

Adjustment Test Setup..........................5-37

5-11.

Step Amplifier Gain Adjustment

Test Setup ............................................5-39

5-12.

+19.5V Adjustment Test Setup ..................5-43

5-13.

Log Amplifier and Linear Adjustment

Test Setup ............................................5-45

5-14.

Sweep Time Per Division Adjustment

Test Setup ............................................5-51

5-15.

Frequency Control and DPM Adjustments

Test Setup ............................................5-55

5-16.

l-dB Offset Adjustment Test Setup.............5-59

6-1.

Cable Assembly W1 (08558-60038 or

08558-60031) Replaceable Parts ..........6-29

6-2.

Mechanical Chassis Parts ..........................6-31

6-3.

Front Switch Assembly ..............................6-33

7-1.

Mechanical Chassis Parts (CHANGE A) ......7-8

7-2.

Front Panel Assembly (CHANGE A) ..........7-11

7-3.

Front Switch Assembly A2,

Schematic (CHANGE A) .......................7-13

7-4.

Log Amplifier Log and Linear Adjustment

Test Setup (CHANGE B).......................7-15

7-5.

A14 Log Amplifier, Component and Test

Point Locations (CHANGE B)................7-24

iv

TM 11-6625-3061-14

LIST OF ILLUSTRATIONS

Page Figure Figure

7-6.

A14 Log Amplifier Assembly Schematic

(CHANGE B)..............................................7-25

7-7.

A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,

Component Locations (CHANGE C)...........7-27

7-8.

P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,

Schematic Diagram (CHANGE C)..............7-28

7-9.

A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,

Component Locations (CHANGE F) ...........7-29

7-10.

P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,

Schematic Diagram (CHANGE F) ..............7-30

8-1.

Symbols Used in Schematics and

Block Diagrams........................................... 8-5

8-2.

Conditions for Schematic Diagram

Measurements ............................................ 8-9

8-3.

CRT Displays for Residual FM

Troubleshooting .........................................8-13

8-4.

Baseline Step Caused by Failure of A7Q18 ....8-13

8-5.

Simplified Block Diagram ...............................8-15

8-6.

Troubleshooting Block Diagram ......................8-17

8-7.

A1A2U1 Clock ................................................8-20

8-8.

Integrator and EOC Waveforms for FRE-

QUENCY MHz Display of 1296 MHz..........8-20

8-9.

A1A2U1 Outputs for FREQUENCY MHz

Display of 1296 MHz ..................................8-21

8-10.

A1A2 DPM Driver Component Locations ........8-22

8-11.

A1A2 DPM Driver (and DPM Display),

Schematic..................................................8-23

8-12.

Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1,

Component Locations ................................8-26

8-13.

A2 Front Switch, Schematic Diagram .............8-27

8-14.

A3 Input Attenuator.........................................8-31

8-15.

A6 YIG Oscillator............................................8-31

8-16.

A4 First Converter, Component

Locations ...................................................8-32

8-17.

A5 Second Converter Assembly,

Component Locations ................................8-33

8-18.

A3 Input Attenuator, A4 First Converter,

A5 Second Converter, and A6 YIG

Oscillator, Schematic .................................8-35

8-19.

A7 Frequency Control Assembly,

Component and Test Point Locations.........8-42

8-20.

A7 Frequency Control, Schematic ..................8-43

Page

8-21.

Simplified Schematic of Sweep Generator

in AUTO Mode ......................................8-46

8-22.

A8 Sweep Generator Assembly,

Component and Test Point Locations....8-52

8-23.

A8 Sweep Generator, Schematic ...............8-53

8-24.

Bandpass Amplifier Tank Circuit,

Simplified Schematic ............................8-59

8-25.

A9 Third Converter Assembly, and

A10 Second IF Assembly, Component

Locations ..............................................8-60

8-26.

A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF,

Schematic.............................................8-61

8-27.

Crystal Pole, Simplified Schematic ............8-65

8-28.

LC Pole, Simplified Schematic ..................8-66

8-29.

A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly,

Component and Test Point Locations....8-68

8-30.

A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1, Schematic.....8-69

8-31.

Equivalent Circuit for

Step Gain Amplifiers .............................8-72

8-32.

A12 Step Gain Assembly, Component and

Test Point Locations..............................8-74

8-33.

A12 Step Gain, Schematic.........................8-75

8-34.

A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly,

Component and Test Point Locations....8-78

8-35.

A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2, Schematic.....8-79

8-36.

Simplified Log Amplifier Stage...................8-81

8-37.

A14 Log Amplifier Assembly,

Component Locations ...........................8-84

8-38.

A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Schematic ...8-85

8-39.

Simplified Vertical Driver Circuit ................8-91

8-40.

Simplified Blanking Circuit .........................8-92

8-41.

A15 Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly,

Component and Test Point Locations....8-94

8-42.

A15 Vertical Driver and Blanking,

Schematic.............................................8-95

8-43.

A16 Motherboard Assembly, Components

and Test Point Locations.......................8-97

8-44.

A16 Motherboard, Schematic Diagram ......8-97

8-45.

A17 Inverter Assembly, Component

Locations ............................................ 8-102

8-46.

A17 Inverter, Schematic .......................... 8-103

8-47.

Locations of Major Assemblies ................ 8-105

LIST OF TABLES

Page Table Table

1-1.

HP Model 8558B Specifications....................... 1-3

1-2.

Model 8558B/180-Series

Supplemental Characteristics...................... 1-6

1-3.

Parts Included in Modification

Kit 00180-69503.........................................1-10

1-4.

Page

Recommended Test Equipment.................1-14

2-1.

Side Stop Kit (08558-60131)........................2-1

2-2.

HP Model 8558B Mainframe

Interconnections......................................2-4

4-1.

Performance Tests ......................................4-1

V

C.

D.

E.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

LIST OF TABLES

Page Table Table

4-2.

Narrow Span Width Error Measurement .......... 4-7

4-3.

Tuning Accuracy Measurement.......................4-11

4-4.

Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity ....................4-29

4-5.

Frequency Response, 5 MHz to 1500 MHz. ...4-48

4-6.

Frequency Response, 100 kHz to 5 MHz ........4-48

4-7.

Amplitude Accuracy, Switching Between ..............

Bandwidths ................................................4-50

4-8.

Input Attenuator Accuracy...............................4-52

4-9.

IF Gain Accuracy in LOG Mode ......................4-57

4-10.

IF Gain Accuracy in Linear Mode....................4-58

4-11.

Conversion Table, Deviation in .............................

Linear Mode...............................................4-58

4-12.

Vernier Accuracy ............................................4-59

4-13.

Amplitude Log Display Accuracy.....................4-63

4-14.

Sample Computations of Amplitude......................

Log Display Accuracy.................................4-63

4-15.

Performance Test Record...............................4-69

5-1.

Adjustable Components ................................... 5-3

5-2.

Factory Selected Components in ..........................

Alpha-Numeric Order .................................. 5-7

5-3.

HP Part Numbers of Standard Value ....................

Replacement Components .......................... 5-8

Page

5-4.

Related Adjustments..................................5-11

5-5.

REF LEVEL FINE Control Check ...............5-41

5-6.

REFERENCE LEVEL Control Check .........5-42

5-7.

Log Fidelity Check .....................................5-47

5-8.

Linear Gain Adjustments............................5-48

5-9.

Log Gain Adjustment Limits .......................5-48

5-10.

Log Amplifier Output Limits .......................5-49

6-1.

Reference Designations and Abbreviations..6-2

6-2.

Manufacturers Code List ..............................6-4

6-3.

Replaceable Parts .......................................6-5

7-1.

Manual Change Requirement by

Serial Number.........................................7-1

7-2.

Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)..................7-6

7-3.

Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)..................7-7

7-4.

Linear Gain Adjustment Limits ...................7-17

7-5.

Log Fidelity Check .....................................7-18

7-6.

Log Gain Adjustment Limits .......................7-19

7-7.

Replaceable Parts (CHANGE B)................7-20

8-1.

Service Information .....................................8-2

8-2.

Residual FM Troubleshooting

Procedure .............................................8-11

8-3.

Truth Table for A2DSI Display ...................8-20

APPENDICES

APPENDIX

A.

REFERENCES ....................................................................... A-1

B.

COMPONENTS OF END ITEM LIST ...................................... B-1

ADDITIONAL AUTHORIZATION LIST(Not Applicable)

MAINTENANCE ALLOCATION............................................... D-1

EXPENDABLE SUPPLIES AND MATERIAL LIST(Not Applicable) vi

TM 11-6625-3061-14

SECTION 0.

INTRODUCTION

0-1. SCOPE

This manual describes Spectrum Analyzer, Hewlett-Packard Model 8558B and provides instructions for operation and maintenance.

0-2. CONSOLIDATED INDEX OF ARMY PUBLICATIONS AND BLANK FORMS

Refer to the latest issue of DA Pam 310-1 to determine whether there are new editions, changes or additional publications pertaining to the equipment.

0-3. MAINTENANCE FORMS, RECORDS, AND REPORTS a. Reports of Maintenance and Unsatisfactory Equipment. Department of the Army forms and procedures used for equipment maintenance will be those prescribed by DA Pam 738-750, as contained in Maintenance Management

Update.

b. Report of Packaging and Handling Deficiencies. Fill out and forward SF 364 (Report of Discrepancy (ROD)) as prescribed in AR 735-11-2/DLAR 4140.55/ NAVMATINST 4355.73A/AFR 400-54/MCO 4430.3F.

c. Discrepancy in Shipment Report (DISREP)(SF 361). Fill out and forward Discrepancy in Shipment Report

(DISREP)(SF 361) as prescribed in AR 55-38/ NAVSUPINST 4610.33C/AFR 75-18/MCO P4610.19D/DLAR 4500.15.

0-4. REPORTING EQUIPMENT IMPROVEMENT RECOMMENDATIONS (EIR)

If your equipment needs improvement, let us know. Send us an EIR. You, the user, are the only one who can tell us what you don't like about your equipment. Let us know why you don't like the design. Put it on an SF 368 (Quality

Deficiency Report). Mail it to Commander, US Army Communications-Electronics Command and Fort Monmouth,

ATTN: AMSEL-ME-MP, Fort Monmouth, NJ 07703-5007. We'll send you a reply.

0-5. ADMINISTRATIVE STORAGE

Administrative storage of equipment issued to and used by Army activities will have preventive maintenance performed in accordance with the PMCS charts before storing. When removing the equipment from administrative storage the

PMCS should be performed to assure operational readiness. Disassembly and repacking of equipment for shipment or limited storage is covered in paragraph 2-23.

0-6. DESTRUCTION OF ARMY ELECTRONICS MATERIEL

Destruction of Army electronics materiel to prevent enemy use shall be in accordance with TM 750-244-2.

0-1

Model 8558B

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 1-1. HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer with Accessories Supplied

1-0

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Model 8558B

1-1. INTRODUCTION

1-2. This Operation and Service manual contains information required to install, operate, test, adjust, and service the Hewlett-Packard Model 8558B Spectrum

Analyzer. Figure 1-1 shows the standard instrument and

accessories supplied. This section covers instrument identification, description, options, accessories, specifications, and other basic information.

1-3. DESCRIPTION

1-4. The HP 8558B displays the amplitude and frequency of each component of an input signal on a

CRT. This display gives quantitative information often not available from a conventional oscilloscope. The HP

8558B is capable of measuring signals from -117 dBm to +30 dBm over a frequency range of 100 kHz to 1500

MHz.

001: 110 dBm to + 30 dBm

002: 63 dBmV to + 80 dBmV

1-5. The complete measuring system includes the HP

8558B Spectrum Analyzer plugged into a compatible

Hewlett-Packard display mainframe.

1-6. MANUAL ORGANIZATION

1-7. This manual is divided into eight sections as follows:

SECTION I, GENERAL INFORMATION, contains the

instrument description and specifications, explains accessories and options, and lists recommended test equipment.

SECTION II, INSTALLATION AND OPERATION

VERIFICATION, contains information concerning initial mechanical inspection, preparation for use, operating environment, packaging and shipping, and operation verification.

SECTION I.

GENERAL INFORMATION

SECTION III, OPERATION, contains detailed

instructions for operation of the instrument.

SECTION IV, PERFORMANCE TESTS, contains the

necessary tests to verify that the electrical operation of the instrument is in accordance with published specifications.

SECTION V, ADJUSTMENTS, contains the necessary

adjustment procedures to properly adjust the instrument after repair.

SECTION VI, REPLACEABLE PARTS, contains the

information necessary to order parts and/or assemblies for the instrument.

SECTION VII, MANUAL BACKDATING CHANGES,

contains backdating information to make this manual compatible with earlier equipment configurations.

SECTION VIII, SERVICE, contains schematic diagrams,

block diagrams, component location illustrations, circuit descriptions, and troubleshooting information to aid in repair of the instrument.

1-8. On the title page of this manual, below the manual part number, is a microfiche part number. This number may be used to order 4-by 6-inch microfilm transparencies of the manual. Each microfiche contains up to 60 photo-duplicates of the manual pages. The microfiche package also includes the latest Manual

Changes supplement.

1-9. Where text changes are required to reflect Options

001 and 002, these changes are shown in bold type immediately following applicable text. Notes are also included in tables and illustrations where users of

Options 001 and 002 need to be informed of differences from the standard instrument. Users of the standard instrument should ignore references to Options 001 and

002.

1-1

Model 8558B

1-10. SPECIFICATIONS

1-11. Instrument specifications are listed in Table 1-1.

These specifications are the performance standards or

limits against which the instrument is tested. Table 1-2

lists supplemental characteristics. Supplemental characteristics are not specifications but are typical characteristics included as additional information for the user.

NOTE

To ensure that the HP Model 8558B meets the specifications listed in

Table 1-1, performance tests (Section

IV) should be performed every six

months.

1-12. SAFETY CONSIDERATIONS

1-13. Before operating this instrument, you should familiarize yourself with the safety markings on the instrument and safety instructions in this manual. This instrument has been manufactured and tested according to international safety standards. However, to ensure safe operation of the instrument and personal safety of the user and service personnel, the cautions and warnings in this manual must be followed. Refer to the

Safety Considerations at the front of the manual. Refer also to individual sections of this manual for detailed safety notation concerning the use of the instrument as described in those individual sections.

1-14. INSTRUMENTS COVERED BY MANUAL

1-15. Serial Numbers

1-16. Attached to the rear of your instrument is a mylar serial number label. The serial number is in two parts.

The first four digits and letter are the serial number

prefix; the last five digits are the suffix (see Figure 1-2).

The prefix is the same for all identical instruments; it changes only when a change is made to the instrument.

The suffix, however, is assigned sequentially and is different for each instrument. The contents of this manual apply to instruments with the serial number prefix(es) listed under SERIAL NUMBERS on the title page.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 1-2. Typical Serial Number Label

1-17. Manual Changes Supplement

1-18. An instrument manufactured after the printing of this manual might have a serial number prefix that is not listed on the title page. This unlisted serial number prefix indicates that the instrument is different from those described in this manual. The manual for this newer instrument is accompanied by a yellow Manual

Changes supplement. This supplement contains change information that explains how to adapt the manual to the newer instrument.

1-19. In addition to change information, the supplement may contain information for correcting errors in the manual. To keep this manual as current and accurate as possible, Hewlett-Packard recommends that you periodically request the latest Manual Changes supplement. The supplement carries a manual identification block that includes the model number, print date of the manual, and manual part number.

Complimentary copies of the supplement are available from Hewlett-Packard. Addresses of Hewlett-Packard offices are located at the back of this manual.

1-20. Manual Backdating Changes

1-21. Instruments manufactured before the printing of this manual have been assigned serial number prefixes other than those for which this manual was written directly. Manual backdating information is provided in

Section VII to adapt this manual to earlier serial number

prefixes. For instruments with serial number prefixes

1829A and earlier, refer to the HP 8558B Operating and

Service Manual dated October 1977, HP part number

08558-90043, and to the Manual Changes supplement supplied with that manual.

1-2

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

FREQUENCY SPECIFICATIONS

FREQUENCY RANGE

100 kHz to 1500 MHz

FREQUENCY SPANS

Per Division (MHz/Div, kHz/Div)

14 frequency scale calibrations in 1-2-5 sequence from 5 kHz/div to 100 MHz/div. Start or center frequency is set with the TUNING control and indicated by the FREQUENCY MHz readout.

Zero Span (0)

Analyzer functions as a manually tuned receiver, at the frequency indicated by the FREQUENCY MHz readout, for time-domain display of signal modulation.

FREQUENCY ACCURACY

Tuning Accuracy

Frequency MHz readout (start or center frequency), after zeroing on the LO feedthrough and operating the

FREQUENCY CAL control, +10°C to +40°C: 0-195

MHz:

±

(1 MHz+20% of frequency span per division)

195-1500 MHz:

±

(5 MHz + 20% of frequency span per division)

Frequency Readout Resolution

0-195 MHz: 100 kHz

195-1500 MHz: 1 MHz

Frequency Span Accuracy

±

5% of displayed frequency separation

SPECTRAL RESOLUTION AND STABILITY

Resolution Bandwidths

Eight selectable resolution (3-dB) bandwidths in 1-3 sequence from 1 kHz to 3 MHz. Bandwidth may be selected independently or coupled with frequency span. Optimum ratio of frequency span to resolution bandwidth is indicated by alignment of markers ( > < ) on the two controls.

Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy:

Individual resolution bandwidth 3-dB points:

±

20% (+10°C to +40

°

C)

Selectivity:

60-dB: 3-dB resolution bandwidth ratio: <15:1

Stability

Residual FM:

<1 kHz p-p in 0.1 second

Noise Sidebands:

>65 dB down, >50 kHz from center of CW signal with 1 kHz resolution bandwidth and full video filtering.

Table 1-1. HP Model 8558B Specifications (1 of 3)

Video Filter

Post-detection low-pass filter averages displayed noise for a smooth trace. The MAX (detent) position selects a video filter bandwidth of approximately 1.5 Hz for noise level measurement.

AMPLITUDE SPECIFICATIONS

AMPLITUDE RANGE

-117 dBm to +30 dBm

001: - 110 dBm to +30 dBm

002: -63 dBm V to +80 dBm V

Maximum Input (Damage) Levels

Total Power:

+30 dBm (1W, 7.1 Vrms)

001: +30 dBm (1W, 8.7 Vrms)

002: +80 dBm V (1.3W, 10 Vrms) dc or ac (<100 Hz):

±

50V

Peak Pulse Power:

+50 dBm (100W, <10 æsec pulse width, 0.01% duty cycle) with input attenuation >20 dB

002: + 100 dBm V (130W)

Average Noise Level

The displayed average noise level determines sensitivity (minimum discernible signal). Signals at this input level peak approximately 3 dB above the displayed noise.

Maximum average noise level with 10 kHz resolution bandwidth, 0 dB input attenuation, and maximum (MAX) video filtering:

<-107 dBm (1-1500 MHz)

001: <-100 dBm (1-1500 MHz)

002: <-53 dBmV (1-1500 MHz)

Calibrated Display Range

Log (from Reference Level):

70 dB with 10 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale

8 dB with 1 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale

Linear:

8 divisions with LIN Amplitude Scale

AMPLITUDE ACCURACY

With AUTO sweep time selected, amplitude accuracy is determined by one or more of the following factors, depending on the measurement technique.

Calibrator Output

-30 dBm +1 dB (into 50

)

280 MHz

±

300 kHz

001: -30 dBm + 1 dB (into 75

)

002: +20 dBm V + 1 dB (into 75

)

1-3

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 1-1. HP Model 8558B Specifications (2 of 3)

Reference Level

10-dB steps and a 12-dB vernier for calibrated

Reference Level adjustment from -112 dBm to +60 dBm.

(002: -62 dBm V to + 1 10 dBm V) 1

Step Accuracy:

Steps referenced with 0 dB input attenuation.

-10 dBm to -80 dBm:

±

0.5 dB

-10 dBm to -100 dBm:

±

1.0 dB

Vernier Accuracy

±

0.5 dB

Frequency Response

Frequency response includes input attenuator, limiter, and mixer flatness:

6<

±

1.0 dB with 10 dB input attenuation

Input Attenuator

0 dB to 70 dB of input attenuation selectable in 10-dB steps

Step Accuracy:

0 dB to 70 dB: <

±

0.5 dB per 10-dB step

Maximum Cumulative Error:

0 dB to 70 dB: <

±

1.0 dB

Bandwidth Switching (Amplitude Variation)

Bandwidths 3 MHz to 300 kHz: <

±

0.5 dB

Bandwidths 3 MHz to 1 kHz: <

±

1.0 dB2

Display Fidelity

CRT linearity and log or linear fidelity affect amplitude accuracy at levels other than Reference Level.

Log Incremental Accuracy:

±

0.1 dB per dB from Reference Level

Log Maximum Cumulative Error:

<

±

1.5 dB over entire 70-dB range

Linear Accuracy:

±

3% of Reference Level

SPURIOUS RESPONSES

Second Harmonic Distortion:

>70 dB3 below a -40 dBm input signal with 0 dB input attenuation.

001: -35 dBm input signal

002: + 15 dBm V input signal

Third Order Intermodulation Distortion:

>70 dB3 below two -30 dBm input signals, separated by >50 kHz, with 0 dB input attenuation.

001: two -25 dBm input signals

002: two +25 dBm V input signals

Image and Multiple Responses:

>70 dB3 below a -40 dBm input level with 0dB input attenuation.

001: -35 dBm input level

002: + 15 dBm V input level

RESIDUAL RESPONSES

<-100 dBm (1-1500 MHz) with 0 dB input attenuation and no signal present at input.

001: <-95 dBm (1--1500 MHz)

002: <-50 dBm V (1- 1500 MHz)

SWEEP SPECIFICATIONS

SWEEP TIME

Automatic (AUTO):

Sweep time adjusted automatically to maintain absolute amplitude calibration for any combination of frequency span, resolution bandwidth, and video filter bandwidth.

Calibrated Sweep Times (sec/Div, mSec/Div):

16 selectable sweep times in 1-2-5 sequence from

0.1 msec/div to 10 sec/div, provided primarily for time-domain calibration in zero span (0).

GENERAL SPECIFICATIONS

TEMPERATURE RANGE

Operating: 0°C to +55°C

Storage: -40°C to +75°C.

HUMIDITY RANGE

Type-tested from 50% to 95% relative humidity (-

<+40°C) per requirements of MIL-STD-810C, Method

507.1, Procedure IV.

EMI

Conducted and radiated interference is in compliance with MIL-STD 461A, Methods CE03 and RE02, CISPR

Publication 11 (1975) and Messempfaenger

Postverfuegung 526/527/79 (Kennzeichnung Mit F-

Nummer/Funkschutzzeichen).

1 Input level not to exceed +30 dBm (002: +80 dBm V) damage level.

2 100 kHz bandwidth limited to < 80% relative humidity. Amplitude variation is < +2.5 at 95% relative humidity, +40°C.

3 > 60 dB for 100 kHz to 5 MHz input signals. k,

1-4

Model 8558B

Table 1-1. HP Model 8558B Specifications (3 of 3)

POWER REQUIREMENTS

HP Model 182T/180TR Display with HP Model

8558B Spectrum Analyzer:

48440 Hz, 115 or 230 volts (

±

10%), 200VA maximum, convection cooled.

HP Model 181T/181TR Display with HP Model

8558B Spectrum Analyzer:

48440 Hz, 115 or 230 volts (

±

10%), 225 VA maximum, convection cooled.

WEIGHT

HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer:

Net: 5.5 kg (12 lbs)

Shipping: 10.5 kg (23 lbs)

HP Model 182T Display:

Net: 12.5 kg (27 lbs)

Shipping: 16.5 kg (36 lbs)

HP Model 181T Display:

Net: 11.0 kg (24 lbs)

Shipping: 15.5 kg (34 lbs)

HP Model 181TR Display:

Net: 12.0 kg (26 lbs)

Shipping: 17.5 kg (38 lbs)

HP Model 180TR Display:

Net: 12.0 kg (26 lbs)

Shipping: 17.5 kg (38 lbs)

DIMENSIONS

HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer:

TM 11-6625-3061-14

1-5

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 1-2. Model 8558B/180-Series Supplemental Characteristics (1 of 3)

SUPPLEMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS

NOTE:

Values in this table are not specifications. They are typical characteristics included for user information.

FREQUENCY CHARACTERISTICS

FREQUENCY ACCURACY

FREQUENCY ZERO

Adjusts digital FREQUENCY MHz readout. FRE-

QUENCY ZERO control may be used to calibrate the frequency readout on a known signal or on the

LO feedthrough.

FREQUENCY CAL

Removes tuning hysteresis from first LO (YIG oscillator). FREQUENCY CAL button should be pressed to maintain FREQUENCY MHz readout accuracy whenever TUNING is changed by more than 50 MHz.

FREQUENCY RANGE

OUT-OF-RANGE BLANKING

The CRT trace is automatically blanked whenever the spectrum analyzer is swept or tuned beyond its frequency range (approximately -50 MHz and 1600

MHz).

SPECTRAL RESOLUTION AND STABILITY

FREQUENCY DRIFT

At fixed start/center frequency, after 2-hour warmup:

<50 kHz in 10 minutes.

With temperature changes: <200 kHz/°C

RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SHAPE

Approximately gaussian (synchronously-tuned,

4-pole filter).

SPECTRAL RESOLUTION

The following graph shows typical spectrum analyzer resolution for different resolution bandwidths.

present at the input that may be measured within the limits of specified accuracy, sensitivity, and distortion

(i.e. spurious responses): >70 dB

FREQUENCY RESPONSE AND AVERAGE

NOISE LEVEL

The following graphs show typical frequency response and average noise level versus frequency.

Signal Resolution vs. Frequency Separation

AMPLITUDE CHARACTERISTICS

AMPLITUDE RANGE AND ACCURACY

DYNAMIC RANGE

Maximum power ratio of two signals simultaneously

1-6

(Option 002)

Average Noise Level and Frequency Response

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 1-2. Model 8558B/180-Series Supplemental Characteristics (2 of 3)

SUPPLEMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS

NOTE:

Values in this table are not specifications. They are typical characteristics included for user information.

GAIN COMPRESSION

Gain compression is typically less than 1 dB for a -

10 dBm input level with 0 dB input attenuation.

001: -5 dBm input level

002: +45 dBmV input level

AMPLITUDE SCALE SWITCHING

Reference Level variation is typically less than

±

1 dB for any change in Amplitude Scale.

SPURIOUS RESPONSES

SECOND HARMONIC AND THIRD ORDER

INTERMODULATION DISTORTION

The graphs below illustrate typical second harmonic and third order intermodulation distortion.

SWEEP CHARACTERISTICS

SWEEP TIME

CALIBRATED SWEEP TIME ACCURACY

(Sec/DIV, mSec/DIV)

Sweep times are typically

±

10% of indicated value.

MANUAL

Spectrum analyzer may be swept manually, in either direction, with front panel control.

SWEEP TRIGGER

FREE RUN

End of each sweep triggers new sweep.

LINE

Sweep triggered at ac line frequency.

VIDEO

Sweep triggered on post-detection video waveform.

One-half major division of vertical deflection required to trigger sweep.

SINGLE

Single sweep started or reset by turning SWEEP

TRIGGER clockwise momentarily.

FRONT PANEL INPUT AND OUTPUT

CHARACTERISTICS

SIGNAL INPUT

INPUT IMPEDANCE

50 ohms nominal; Precision Type N female connector.

001 and 002: 75 ohms nominal; 75-ohm BNC female connector.

INPUT SWR

<1.5 SWR with >10 dB input attenuation

001 and 002: <1.5 SWR

Distortion vs. Mixer Level

1-7

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 1-2. Model 8558B/180-Series Supplemental Characteristics (3 of 3)

SUPPLEMENTAL CHARACTERISTICS

NOTE:

Values in this table are not specifications. They are typical characteristics included for user information.

CAL OUTPUT

-30 dBm at 280 MHz with second through fourth harmonics greater than -70 dBm (into 50 ohms).

001:-30 dBm at 280 MHz (into 75 ohms)

002: +20 dBm V at 280 MHz (into 75 ohms)

1ST LO OUTPUT

+10 dBm nominal into 50 ohms, 2.05-3.55 GHz.

Terminate with a 50-ohm load when not in use.

PROBE POWER

+15V, -12.6V, and GND (150 mA maximum) for use with HP High-Impedance Probes (i.e. HP 1120A,

1121A, 1123A, 1124A). The HP 1121A is recommended for its low noise characteristics.1'

REAR PANEL OUTPUT CHARACTERISTICS2

VERTICAL, PENLIFT/BLANKING, AND HORIZONTAL

OUTPUTS (AUX A, B, D)

These outputs are compatible with and may be used to drive HP X-Y Recorders (using positive pencoils or TTL penlift input) and CRT monitors.

1See Section II for details regarding use with 001 and

002 75ohm inputs.

2Rear panel outputs refer to 180T-series display mainframes and other 180-series mainframes with

Option 807 installed. Horizontal, vertical, and blanking outputs, attenuated and shifted in dc level, are available on other 180-series mainframes at the MAIN SWEEP,

MAIN GATE, and DELAYED GATE outputs, respectively. DO NOT connect an X-Y recorder to the

DELAYED GATE OUTPUT, or damage will result.

AUX A VERTICAL OUTPUT

BNC output provides detected video signal from a

50-ohm output impedance. Typical 0-800 mV range corresponds to full 8-division CRT vertical deflection.

AUX B PENLI FT/BLANKING OUTPUT

BNC output provides a +15V penlift/blanking signal from a 10K-ohm output impedance when CRT trace is blanked. Otherwise, output is low at OV (low impedance, 150 mA max.) for an unblanked trace.

AUX C 21.4 MHz IF OUTPUT

BNC output provides 21.4 MHz IF signal (linearly related to spectrum analyzer RF input) from a 50ohm output impedance. Output bandwidth controlled by spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW setting; output amplitude controlled by INPUT

ATTEN, REFERENCE LEVEL FINE, and first six

REFERENCE LEVEL positions (i.e. -10 through -60 dBm with 0 dB input attenuation). Output level is approximately -10 dBm into 50 ohms with a signal displayed at Reference Level.

002: (i.e. +40 to -10 dBmV with 0 dB input attenuation).

AUX D HORIZONTAL OUTPUT

BNC output provides horizontal sweep voltage from a 5K-ohm output impedance. -5V to +5V range corresponds to full 10-division CRT horizontal deflection.

1-8

Model 8558B

1-22. This information should not be confused with information contained in the yellow Manual Changes supplement, which is intended to adapt this manual to instrument changes that are accomplished after its printing.

1-23. OPTIONS

CAUTION

The two 75-ohm BNC connectors on

Option 001 and Option 002 instruments are not compatible with

50ohm BNC connectors. Direct use of 50-ohm BNC connectors with these instruments might damage the

INPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors.

1-24. Option 001

1-25. Option 001 provides direct-measurement capability in a 75-ohm system. The BNC input and calibration-output connectors have 75

impedance

(nominal). Option 001 is calibrated in dBm, providing a measurement range from -110 dBm to +30 dBm.

Throughout the manual, differences between the standard instrument and Option 001 are given in boldface type following applicable text references and as necessary in tables and illustrations.

1-26. Option 002

1-27. Option 002 provides direct-measurement capability in a 75-ohm system. The BNC input and calibration-output connectors have 75Q impedance

(nominal). Option 002 is calibrated in dBmV, providing a measurement range from -63 dBmV to + 80 dBmV.

Throughout the manual, differences between the standard instrument and Option 002 are given in boldface type following applicable text references and as necessary in tables and illustrations.

1-28. Option 910

1-29. One additional Operation and Service manual is provided for each Option 910 ordered. To obtain additional manuals after initial shipment, order by the manual part number, which appears on the title page and on the back cover.

1-9

1-30. ACCESSORIES SUPPLIED

TM 11-6625-3061-14

1-31. The following accessories, supplied with the

instrument, are shown in Figure 1-1:

BNC termination

Cable adapter

Side stop kit

Graticule overlays

1-32. Termination

1-33. A BNC, 50-ohm termination, HP Model 11593A, is supplied for the front-panel 1ST LO OUTPUT.

1-34. Cable Adapter

1-35. A Type N male to BNC female adapter, HP part number 1250-0780, is supplied with the standard instrument for the use of lightweight cables with BNC connectors.

1-36. Side Stop Kit

1-37. A side stop kit, HP part number 08558-60131, is supplied to prevent the spectrum analyzer from sliding out of the mainframe. When the side stops are installed, the plug-in cannot be removed from the

mainframe. Refer to Section II for installation or

removal of the side stops.

1-38. Graticule Overlays

Three graticule overlays provide the operator with reference-level labels for the CRT. HP Part Number

5020-8565 is the overlay for 180-series display mainframes. HP Part Number 5020-8566 is the overlay for 181-series display mainframes. HP Part Number

5020-8567 is the overlay for 182- series display mainframes. For proper installation of the graticule

overlay, refer to Section II.

Model 8558B

1-39. EQUIPMENT REQUIRED BUT NOT

SUPPLIED

1-40. Display Mainframe

1-41. A 180T-series display mainframe (180TR, 181T,

181TR, or 182T) is recommended for use with the HP

Model 8558B. In the 180T-series mainframe, the rearpanel auxiliary output connectors (AUX A, AUX B, AUX

C, and AUX D) provide, respectively, Vertical Output,

Pen Lift Output, 21.4 MHz IF Output, and Horizontal

Output.

1-42. A standard 180-series Display mainframe

(180A/AR, 180C/D, 181A/AR, 182A/C, or 184A/B) provides only horizontal, vertical, and blanking rear panel outputs. Furthermore, these outputs are attenuated and shifted in dc level. Unbuffered rear panel outputs (similar to the 180T-series) are provided only if Option 807 is installed.

1-43. Extender Cable Assembly connector.

CAUTION

TM 11-6625-3061-14

The 75-ohm BNC input connector on

ANT Option 001 and 002 instruments is not compatible with 50-ohm BNC connectors. Direct connection of an

AC probe might damage the input

001 and 002: The AC probes have a 50-ohm output impedance. Use of a probe with the 75-ohm Option 001 or 002 without proper impedance matching causes a +

1.58 dB error in displayed signal levels.

1-48. Modification Kit (Option 807 Connections)

1-49. A modification kit, HP part number 00180-69503, provides the materials and information necessary to install unbuffered rear panel connections (formerly included in Option 807) in the following display mainframes: 180A/AR, 180C/D, 181A/AR, 182A/C, and

184A/B. Refer to Table 1-3 for a description of parts

included in the modification kit.

1-50. Oscilloscope Camera

1-44. An Extender Cable Assembly (Figure 1-3), HP

Part Number 5060-0303, allows operation of the HP

8558B outside the display mainframe. This provides access to the HP 8558B for necessary adjustments and some performance tests. This cable is also useful for troubleshooting.

1-45. MEASUREMENT ACCESSORIES

1-51. The HP Model 197B, Option 002, General

Purpose Camera can be used with 180- and 181-series display mainframes to make a permanent record of measurements. The HP 10367A adapter allows the camera to be used with 182-series mainframes.

1-46. AC Probe

1-47. The HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer has a front-panel PROBE POWER connector for the use of high-impedance active probes such as the HP 1120A,

HP 1121A, HP 1123A, and HP 1124A. High-impedance probes permit testing of high-frequency circuits without significant loading effects. The low-noise, AC-coupled

HP 1121A is preferred for use with the HP 8558B.

1-52. SERVICE ACCESSORIES

1-53. Service accessories are shown in Figure 1-3.

Table 1-3. Parts Included in Modification Kit 00180-69503

Quantity

1

1

2

1

Description

Output Amplifier Assembly (Auxiliary Output

Board)

Label

3/4 inch pieces of shrink tubing

Service Note

HP Part Number

00180-66551

7120-3116

0890-0720

180A/AR-10, 180C/D-2, 181A/AR8

182A/C-1, or 184/B-1 (modification is similar for all instruments listed)

1-10

Model 8558B

1-54. RECOMMENDED TEST EQUIPMENT

1-55. Equipment required for operation verification, performance tests, adjustments, and

TM 11-6625-3061-14

troubleshooting of the HP Model 8558B is listed in Table

1-4. Other equipment may be substituted if it meets or

exceeds the critical specifications listed in the table.

1-11

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 1-3. Service Accessories (1 of 2)

1-12

Model 8558B

(6)

(10)

(11)

(12)

(7)

(8)

(9)

Item

(1)

(2)

(3)

(4)

(5)

Description

Board Puller, 2 prongs to lift PC boards

Extender Board, 6 pin, 12 contacts

Extender Board, 10 pin, 20 contacts

Extender Board, 22 pin, 44 contacts

Extender Cable Assembly, for plug-in operation out of display mainframe

Tuning Tool, modified 5/16 inch nut driver with modified No. 10 Allen driver

Alignment tool, metal tip in plastic

Alignment tool, non-metallic

Wrench, No. 2 Bristol

Wrench, 15/64 inch, combination

Wrench, 1/4 inch, open end

Wrench, 5/16 inch, slotted box end/open end

Figure 1-3. Service Accessories (2 of 2)

1-13

9

8

2

9

4

0

6

7

CD

1

2

2

8

TM 11-6625-3061-14

HP Part Number

03950-4001

08559-60042

85680-60028

08565-60107

5060-0303

08555-60107

8710-0630

8710-0033

8710-0055

8710-0946

8720-0014

08555-20097

Model 8558B

Equipment

Display Mainframe

Oscilloscope

Frequency Counter

Timer/Counter

Digital Voltmeter

Power Meter

Power Sensor

Amplifier

Signal Generator

(2 required)

Tracking Generator

Sweep Oscillator

RF Plug-In

Spectrum Analyzer

Comb Generator

Function Generator

Crystal Detector

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (1 of 4)

Critical Specifications

Recommended

Model Use*

HP 180T Series with variable persistence

Time Base: 1 ms/cm to 10 ms/cm

Vertical Sensitivity: 1 mV/cm to 20 V/cm

Frequency Range: 150 MHz to 1.5 GHz

Sensitivity: -30 dBm

Time base: 10 us

Accuracy:

±

(.05% Rdg

±

digit)

Power Range: -20 dBm to +10 dBm

Frequency Range: 100 kHz to 1.5 GHz

Maximum SWR: 1.1,0.1 to 1 GHz

Frequency Range: 200 MHz to 300 MHz

Gain: > 20 dB

Impedance: 50

Frequency Range: 4 MHz to 305 MHz

Drift: Less than 50 ppm (or 5 Hz, whichever is greater)

Harmonic Distortion: > 30 dB below fundamental

Noise Sidebands: > 80 dB down, 50 kHz away, 1 kHz BW

Frequency Range: 5 MHz to 1500 MHz

Manual Sweep

Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 1.5 GHz

Flatness (external leveling): <

±

0.1 dB

Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 1.5 GHz

HP 181T/TR

HP 1741A

HP 5342A

HP 5308A

HP 3455A

HP 435A/B

HP 8482A

HP 8447D

HP 8640B

HP 8444A Opt. 059

HP 8350A

HP 83522A

Accuracy: 0.01%

Frequency Range: 5 kHz to 5 MHz

Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 1.5 GHz

Frequency Response:

±

0.2 dB/octave to 2 GHz;

±

0.5 dB overall

*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting

HP 141T/8552B/

8555A

HP 8406A

HP 3310A

HP 423B

P, A, T

A, T

P, A, T

A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, T

A

A

T

P, A, T

P, T

A, T

1-14

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Equipment

Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (2 of 4)

Critical Specifications

300 MHz LPF Rejection: > 50 dB for signals above

300 MHz

Power Splitter Frequency Range: 100 kHz to 1.5 GHz

Input SWR: <, 1.15

10 dB Attenuator

(2 required)

Step Attenuator

Frequency Range: 100 kHz to 1.5 GHz

Accuracy:

±

0.5 dB

Frequency Range: 20 MHz to 305 MHz

Attenuation: 12 dB in l-dB steps calibrated at 30 MHz by a standards lab

Accuracy:

±

0.25 dB

Step Attenuator

Termination

Type N Cable

Frequency Range: 20 MHz to 305 MHz

Attenuation: 80 dB in 10-dB steps calibrated at 30 MHz and 280 MHz by a standards lab

Accuracy:

±

0.01 dB

±

0.02/10 dB step at calibrated frequencies

Impedance: 50

50

coaxial cable with Type N (m) connectors on both ends

BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) 50

coaxial cable with BNC (m) connectors on both ends

BNC Cable, 120 cm

(48 in) (2 required)

50

coaxial cable with BNC (m) connectors on both ends

Cable BNC to Banana Plug

Cable

Cable

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

SMC (f) to BNC (m)

Banana Plug to Alligator Clips

Banana plugs to BNC (f)

N (m) to BNC (f) (3 required)

SMC (m) to BNC (m)

Adapter BNC (f) to BNC (f)

Adapter BNC Tee

*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting

1-15

Recommended

Model

Telonic

TPL 3004AB

HP 11667A

HP 8491A Opt. 010

HP 355C Opt. H80

HP 355D Opt. H82

HP 908A/11593A

HP 11500A

HP 10502A

HP 10503A

HP 11001A

HP 11592-60001

HP 11102A

HP 10111 A

HP 1250-0780

HP 1250-0831

HP 1250-0080

HP 1250-0781

Use*

P, A, T

P, A

P, A

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, A

P, A

P, A, T

P, A, T

P

A, T

A

P, T

P, A

P

P

A

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (3 of 4)

Critical Specifications

Recommended

Model Use* Equipment

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Adapter

Extender Board

N (m) to N (m)

BNC (m) to BNC (m)

N (f) to BNC (m)

SMC (m) to SMC (m)

Type N (m) to SMC (m)

BNC (f) to Alligator Clips

SMC (f) to SMC (f)

Type N (m) to SMA (f)

BNC (f) to SMA (m)

SMA (f) to SMA (f)

6 pin, 12 contacts with 51.1

resistor from pin 1 to pin 5

Termination

Power Sensor

NOTE

The following equipment is required for Option 001 and Option 002.

Impedance: 75

Frequency Range: 10 MHz to 2 GHz

Maximum SWR: 1.18, 10 MHz to 2 GHz

75

Ω BNC (m) to 75Ω Type N (f)

75

Ω BNC (f) to 50Ω SMA (m)

Adapter

Minimum Loss Adapter

5.72 dB attenuation

Adapter

Adapter

BNC (f) to SMA (m)

SMA (f) to SMA (f)

*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting

1-16

HP 1250-1475

HP 1250-0216

HP 1250-0077

HP 1250-0827

HP 1250-1023

HP 8120-1292

HP 1250-1113

HP 1250-1250

HP 1250-1200

HP 1250-1158

HP 08505-60109

HP 0757-0394

HP 11652-60010

HP 8483A

A, T

A, T

P, A

P

P

P

P

A, T

A, T

P

A, T

P

T

HP 1250-1534

HP 08558-60031

HP 1250-1200

HP 1250-1158

T

P, A, T

T

P, T

Model 8558B

Adapter

Cable

Cable

Cable

Adapter

Adapter

Equipment

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 1-4. Recommended Test Equipment (4 of 4)

Critical Specifications

Recommended

Model Use*

N (f) to N (f)

BNC, 30 cm (12 in), 75

BNC, 60 cm (24 in), 75

BNC, 90 cm (37 in), 75

BNC (m) to BNC (m)

Type N (m) to SMA (f)

HP 1250-0777

HP 11652-60012

HP 11652-60013

HP 11652-60014

HP 1250-1288

HP 1250-1250

A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

P, A, T

*P = Performance Test; A = Adjustment; T = Troubleshooting

1-17/1-18

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

SECTION II.

INSTALLATION

2-1. INTRODUCTION

2-2.

This section includes information on initial inspection, preparation for use, and storage and shipping requirements for the HP Model 8558B.

2-3. INITIAL INSPECTION

2-4.

Inspect the shipping container for damage. If the shipping container or cushioning material is damaged, it should be kept until the contents of the shipment have been checked for completeness and the instrument has been checked mechanically and electrically. The

contents of the shipment should be as shown in Figure

1-1. The electrical performance is checked with the

procedures in Section IV. If the contents are

incomplete, if there is mechanical damage or defect, or if the instrument does not pass the Performance Test procedures, notify the nearest Hewlett-Packard office. If the shipping container is damaged, or if the cushioning material shows signs of stress, notify the carrier as well as the Hewlett-Packard office. Keep the shipping materials for inspection by the carrier. The Hewlett-

Packard office will arrange for repair or replacement without waiting for a claim settlement.

2-5. PREPARATION FOR USE

2-6. Installation

2-7.

When properly installed, the spectrum analyzer obtains all necessary power from the display mainframe.

The rear panel connector provides the interface.

CAUTION

BEFORE SWITCHING ON THIS

INSTRUMENT, make sure it is adapted to the voltage of the ac power source to be used and the proper fuse is installed. Failure to set the ac power input of the instrument for the correct voltage level could cause damage to the instrument when plugged in. Refer to the display mainframe Operation and

Service Manual for line voltage and fuse selection.

2-8.

To install the spectrum analyzer in the mainframe:

1. Set display mainframe LINE switch to OFF.

2. Pull out lock knob and slide plug-in toward rear of compartment until it is seated firmly in place.

3. Push in lock knob to secure spectrum analyzer in mainframe.

2-9. Side Stop Kit

2-10. Installation of a Side Stop Kit, HP part number

08558-60131, prevents the removal of the analyzer from the 180-series mainframe without the use of hand tools.

This kit contains two side stops, mounting hardware,

label, and installation instructions. (Refer to Table 2-1

for part numbers of individual items.)

Table 2-1. Side Stop Kit (08558-60131)

HP Part C

Quantity Description Number D

2 SIDE STOP 08558-00094 7

4 MACHINE SCREW, 2200-0168 9

440 .438-IN-LG

82 DEG FLATHEAD

1 LABEL, FRONT-PANEL 7120-8131 7

1 LABEL, INSTRUCTIONS 7120-8215 8

2-1

Model 8558B

2-11. To install side stops:

WARNING

Before removing covers from the display mainframe, disconnect line power by removing the ac power cord.

1. Remove side covers from bottom section of mainframe. (Remove only right side cover if mainframe is a rack-mounted model.)

2. Use flathead machine screws to install side stops as

shown in Figure 2-1.0

3. Reinstall side covers on mainframe.

4. Place caution label on front panel of spectrum analyzer (upper right-hand corner) to indicate that plug-in is secured with side stops.

2-12. To remove side stops:

WARNING

Before removing covers from the display mainframe, disconnect line power by removing the ac power cord.

1. Remove side covers from bottom section of mainframe. (Remove only right side cover if mainframe is a rack-mounted model.)

2. Remove side stops. (See Figure 2-1.)

3. Reinstall side covers on display mainframe.

2-13. Graticule Overlays

2-14. To install a graticule overlay:

1. Select proper overlay. HP part number 5020-8565 is for 180TR display mainframes, HP part number

5020-8566, for 181T/TR display mainframes, and

HP part number 5020-8567, for 182T display mainframes.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

2. For 180TR and 181T/TR mainframes, remove

CRT bezel and metallic-mesh contrast filter. Insert proper overlay and replace contrast filter and CRT bezel.

3. For 182T mainframes, grasp top portion of CRT bezel and pull straight up. Remove metallic-mesh contrast filter and insert proper overlay and contrast filter. (Either the metallic-mesh contrast filter or a light blue contrast filter may be used.)

4. Slide bezel back into place to retain overlay and filter.

2-15. Mainframe Interconnections

2-16. When the HP 8558B is properly installed in the display mainframe, the interconnections are as listed in

Table 2-2.

2-17. Operating Environment

2-18. Temperature. The instrument may be operated in temperatures from 0°C to + 55 o

C.

2-19. Humidity. The instrument may be operated in environments with relative humidity from 5 percent to 95 percent, 0°C to +40 o

C. The recommended long-term operating environment is 5 percent to 80 percent relative humidity. The instrument should also be protected from abrupt temperature changes that cause internal condensation.

2-20. Altitude. The instrument may be operated in altitudes up to 4572 meters (15,000 feet).

2-21. Modifications

2-22. A Modification Kit, HP part number 00180-69503, provides materials and information necessary to add

Option 807 rear-panel connections to the standard HP

180-series display. Refer to Table 1-3 in Section I.

Option 807 is factory-installed in 180T, 181T, 181TR, and 182T mainframes. The modification kit is required for use with other mainframes if all four rear-panel outputs are needed.

2-2

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

* Only one side stop and two screws are used for rackmount models.

2-23. STORAGE AND SHIPMENT

2-24. Environment

Figure 2-1. Location of Side Stops

2-26. Packaging

2-25. The instrument may be stored or shipped in environments within the following limits:

Temperature: -40°Cto +75°C

Humidity: 5% to95o (0°Cto +400C)

Altitude: Up to 15240 meters (50,000 feet)

The instrument should also be protected from temperature extremes which cause condensation within the instrument.

2-27. Original Packaging. Containers and materials identical to those used in factory packaging are available through Hewlett-Packard offices. If the instrument is being returned to Hewlett-Packard for servicing, attach a tag indicating the type of service required, return address, model number, and full serial number. A supply of these tags is provided at the end of this section. Mark the container FRAGILE to assure careful handling. In any correspondence, refer to the instrument by model number and full serial number.

2-3

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Pin on P1 Signal or Voltage

2

5

6

7

3

4

8

9

10

11

12

1

13

14

CRT HORIZ (adjusted horizontal signal)

GROUND from mainframe

(jumpered to pin 8)

NC

L NORM

YNORM

NC

SING SWP

GROUND from mainframe

(jumpered to pin 2)

MAN SWP

NC

AUX D Horizontal Output

(to mainframe rear panel)

AUX C 21.4 MHz IF Output

(to mainframe rear panel)

AUX B Penlift/Blanking Output

(to mainframe rear panel)

AUX A Vertical Output

GROUND

NC

(to mainframe rear panel)

15

16

2-28. Other Packaging. The following general instructions should be used for repackaging with commercially available materials:

1. Wrap instrument in heavy paper or plastic. If shipment is to a Hewlett-Packard office or service center, attach a tag indicating type of service required, return address, model number, and full serial number. A supply of these tags is provided at end of this section.

2. Use a strong shipping container. A double-wall carton made of 350-pound test material is adequate.

Table 2-2. HP Model 8558B Mainframe Interconnections

Pin on P1 Signal or Voltage

17

18

19

20

21

22

23

24

25

26

27

28

29

30

31

32

W10P3

(2 contacts)

BLANKING

NC

GROUND from mainframe

(jumpered in pin 24)

AUTO SWP

BEAM FINDER

NC

NC

GROUND from mainframe

(jumpered to pin 19)

NC

NC

NC

-12.6 VDC from mainframe

+15 VDC from mainframe

+100 VDC from mainframe

30V p-p from mainframe

(for LINE TRIGGER)

NC

+VERT (top contact, yellow wire)

-VERT (bottom contact, orange wire)

3. Use enough shock-absorbing material (3- to 4-inch layer) around all sides of the instrument to provide firm cushion and prevent movement inside container. Protect control panel with cardboard.

4. Seal shipping container securely.

5. Mark shipping container FRAGILE to assure careful handling.

2-4

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

3-1. INTRODUCTION

3-2.

This section provides operating information for the

Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer. It also provides a brief description of display mainframe controls. For a detailed description of the display mainframe, refer to its manual.

3-3. CONTROLS, INDICATORS, AND CONNECTORS

3-4.

The spectrum analyzer is used with one of the

180-series display mainframes. The 180T-series display mainframes, or the 180-series mainframes with Option

807, have the correct rear-panel connections for spectrum analyzer horizontal, vertical, penlift, and IF

outputs. Figure 3-1 shows the front-panel features of

the HP 8558B Spectrum Analyzer and the display

mainframe. Figure 3-2 shows the rear-panel features of

the HP 8558B. The rear panels of all 180T-series mainframes, and 180-series mainframes with Option

807, are basically the same.

3-5. Control Grouping

3-6.

The spectrum analyzer and display mainframe front-panel controls fall into three general groups: those that deal with the display, those that deal with frequency, and those that deal with amplitude.

3-7. Display. The display group consists of:

SWEEP TIME/DIV

SWEEP TRIGGER

VERTICAL POSN

VERTICAL GAIN

MAN SWEEP

HORIZ GAIN (rear panel of 8558B)

VIDEO FILTER

BASELINE CLIPPER

HORIZONTAL POSITION

INTENSITY

FOCUS

TRACE ALIGN

ASTIG

SECTION III.

OPERATION

3-8.

The display group enables the operator to calibrate the display and to select a variety of scan and display conditions. The controls are explained in

Figures 3-1 and 3-2. However, when the SWEEP

TIME/DIV control is placed in the AUTO position, sweep time is controlled by the RESOLUTION BW, FREQ

SPAN/DIV, and VIDEO FILTER controls.

3-9. Frequency. The frequency group consists of:

TUNING

RESOLUTION BW

FREQ SPAN/DIV

3-10. The frequency group enables the operator to control how the spectrum analyzer displays the frequency domain. The RESOLUTION BW and FREQ

SPAN/DIV controls when pushed in are coupled together, and moving either control moves the other.

When the SWEEP TIME/DIV control is in the AUTO position varying the RESOLUTION BW or the FREQ

SPAN/DIV (coupled or uncoupled) will change the sweep time to maintain calibration. With the two controls coupled together in the OPTIMUM position,

RESOLUTION BW's of 3 MHz to 1 kHz will be automatically selected as the FREQ SPAN/DIV is narrowed from 100 MHz to 0. TUNING controls coarse and fine (coarse is larger knob) set the center frequency of the displayed spectrum. RESOLUTION BW control determines the resolution of the signals on the CRT.

3-11. Amplitude. The amplitude group consists of:

REFERENCE LEVEL

INPUT ATTEN

REF LEVEL FINE

REF LEVEL CAL

10 dB/DIV - 1 dB/DIV - LIN (Amplitude

Scale)

3-12. The amplitude group enables the operator to measure signal amplitude in units of either voltage or dBm.

3-1

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

3-13. Variable Persistence and Storage Functions

3-14. With the 181T/TR Display Mainframe, the operator can set trace persistence for a bright, steady trace that does not flicker, even on the slow sweeps required for narrow band analysis. The variable persistence also permits the display of low repetition rate pulses without flickering; and using the longest persistence, intermittent signals can be captured and displayed. The storage capability allows side-by-side comparison of changing signals.

3-15. Persistence and Intensity

CAUTION

Excessive INTENSITY may damage the CRT storage mesh.

3-16. These controls determine the appearance of the

CRT trace. Specifically, PERSISTENCE controls the rate at which a signal is erased and INTENSITY controls the trace brightness as the signal is written. With a given PERSISTENCE setting, the actual time of trace visibility can be increased by greater INTENSITY.

Since the PERSISTENCE control sets the rate of trace erasure, a brighter trace requires more time to be erased. Conversely, a display of low intensity disappears more rapidly. The same principle applies to a stored display of high or low intensity.

3-17. Storage. These controls select the storage mode in which the CRT functions. In ERASE mode,

STORE, WRITE, and MAX WRITE are disconnected and all written signals are removed from the CRT. The

STORE selector disconnects the WRITE, MAX WRITE, and ERASE functions and implements signal retention at reduced intensity. In the STORE mode,

PERSISTENCE and INTENSITY have no function.

3-18. Writing Speed. In the MAX WRITE mode, the

CRT storage surface is primed to allow much faster writing on the storage surface. Since the erasing rate is decreased, the entire screen becomes illuminated more rapidly and the display is obscured. The effective persistence and storage times are thus considerably reduced. For this reason, MAX WRITE is not normally used with a spectrum analyzer plug-in.

3-19. Photographic Techniques

3-20. The HP Model 197A Oscilloscope Camera attaches directly to the spectrum analyzer's CRT bezel without adapters. Flood guns in the CRT provide background lighting of the display. When photography of stored traces (181T/TR) is required, a double exposure is needed. (Flood guns are turned off when

STORE is pressed.) See Application Note AN 150-5 for full details.

OPERATING PRECAUTIONS

The spectrum analyzer is a sensitive measuring instrument. To avoid damage to the instrument, do not exceed the following Absolute Maximum Inputs:

Overloading the input with too much power, peak voltages, or dc voltages will damage the input circuit and require expensive repairs.

Total Power: + 30 dBm (1W, 7.1 Vrms)

Option 001: + 30dBm(1W, 8.7 Vrms)

Option 002: +80dBmV(1.3W, 9.9 Vrms) dc or ac (< 100 Hz):

±

50V

Peak Pulse Power:

+ 50 dB, (100W, < 10

µ s pulse width,

0.01% duty cycle) with ò20 dB INPUT ATTEN

Option 002: + 100 dBmV (130W), <10

µs

CAUTION

While the analyzer's reference level may be set for power levels up to +60 dBm, the total input power must not exceed the absolute maximum limits listed.

FRONT PANEL ADJUSTMENT PROCEDURE

Whenever an HP 8558B Spectrum Analyzer plug-in is reinstalled in a different mainframe, the spectrum

3-2

Model 8558B analyzer should be calibrated to ensure proper correlation between plug-in and display. It is good practice to execute this adjustment procedure periodically (recommended daily) to correct for changes in calibration which may occur over a period of time.

These adjustments are also an excellent way for the new user to become acquainted with the spectrum analyzer. For reference, a front panel view appears in

Figure 3-1.

If an HP 181 Variable Persistence Display is being used, begin by setting the PERSISTENCE maximum counterclockwise and pushing in the WRITE button.

Make the following spectrum analyzer settings.

Function Setting

10 dB INPUT ATTEN

(push knob to engage)

REFERENCE LEVEL

REF LEVEL FINE

Amplitude Scale

FREQ SPAN/DIV

(uncoupled)

RESOLUTION BW

(uncoupled)

SWEEP TIME/DIV

SWEEP TRIGGER

START - CENTER

TUNING

BASELINE CLIPPER

VIDEO FILTER

0 dBm

002: +50 dBmV

0

LIN

10 MHz

1 MHz

AUTO

FREE RUN

CENTER

> 60 MHz

OFF

OFF

180-series mainframes:

DISPLAY

MAGNIFIER

SCALE (180TR, 182T)

PERSISTENCE (181T/TR)

Display Mode (181T/TR)

INT (out)

X1 (out)

OFF

MIN (ccw)

WRITE

DISPLAY ADJUSTMENTS

1. With an adjustment tool, adjust VERTICAL POSN to place the CRT trace on a horizontal graticule line near center of CRT.

2. Reduce the INTENSITY and set the SWEEP

TIME/DIV control to MAN. Adjust the MAN SWEEP knob to bring dot to center of CRT.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

CAUTION

Leaving a dot on the CRT for prolonged periods at high intensity may burn the phosphor.

3. Adjust the FOCUS and ASTIG controls for the smallest round dot possible.

4. Reset the SWEEL TIME/DIV control to AUTO and increase the INTENSITY for an optimum CRT trace.

Center the trace horizontally with the HORIZONTAL

POSITION control. If the horizontal deflection is not exactly 10 divisions, adjust the HORIZ GAIN control

(located on the spectrum analyzer rear panel) for a

10 division (wide) horizontal deflection.

NOTE

The analyzer must be removed from the mainframe to adjust the HORIZ

GAIN control.

5. Adjust the TRACE ALIGN so that the CRT trace is parallel with the horizontal graticule lines.

6. Adjust the VERTICAL POSN until the trace aligns with the bottom graticule line.

FREQUENCY ADJUSTMENTS

7. Center the LO feedthrough - the 'signal' at 0 MHz on the CRT with the TUNING control, pressing the

FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton two or three times to remove tuning hysteresis in the first LO (YIG oscillator).

8. Narrow the FREQ SPAN/DIV to 200 kHz and press the FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton once more.

Adjust the REF LEVEL FINE control as necessary to position the signal peak near the top CRT graticule line.

9. Re-center the LO feedthrough, if necessary, and adjust FREQUENCY ZERO to calibrate the

FREQUENCY MHz readout at 00.0 MHz.

3-3

Model 8558B

AMPLITUDE ADJUSTMENTS

10. Set the FREQ SPAN/DIV control to 1 MHz and the

REF LEVEL FINE control to 0. Adjust the TUNING control for a FREQUENCY MHz readout of approximately 280 MHz.

11. Press the 10 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale pushbutton, and set the REFERENCE LEVEL control to - 20 dBm (+ 30 dBmV for Option 002).

CAUTION

The HP 8558B Options 001 and 002 feature 75-ohm (female) INPUT and

CAL OUTPUT connectors. Standard

50-ohm BNC cables and adapters should not be used with these connectors since damage might result.

12. Connect the 280 MHz CAL OUTPUT to the spectrum analyzer input and center the signal on the CRT with the TUNING control, pressing the

FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton two or three times.

The FREQUENCY MHz readout will indicate 280

MHz + 5 MHz.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

13. Press the LIN Amplitude Scale pushbutton. Adjust the REF LEVEL FINE control to place the signal peak at the top CRT graticule line.

14. Press the 10 dB/DIV Amplitude Scale pushbutton.

Adjust VERTICAL GAIN to place the signal peak at the top CRT graticule line.

15. Repeat steps 12 and 13 until the signal peak remains at the top CRT graticule line when the

Amplitude Scale is alternated between 10 dB/DIV and LIN.

16. Set the REF LEVEL FINE control to 0 and the

REFERENCE LEVEL control to -30 dBm (+ 20 dBmV for Option 002).

17. Press the LIN Amplitude Scale pushbutton and adjust REF LEVEL CAL to place the signal peak at the top CRT graticule line.

Once the Front Panel Adjustment Procedure is completed, the spectrum analyzer is calibrated for absolute amplitude and frequency measurements.

During normal operation, the FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton should be pressed whenever the tuning is changed by more than 50 MHz. This removes tuning hysteresis and ensures maximum frequency accuracy.

3-4

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 3-2. Rear Panel Controls and Connectors (2 of 2)

3-7/3-8 (blank)

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

SECTION IV.

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-3. INSTRUMENTS TESTED 4-1. INTRODUCTION

4-2.

The procedures in this section test the electrical performance of the instrument against the specifications

in Section I. The performance tests included in this

section are listed in Table 4-1. Most of the tests can be

performed without access to the interior of the instrument. If a test measurement is marginal, perform

the appropriate adjustment procedures in Section V.

4-4.

Since a 180-series Display mainframe is required for operation of the HP Model 8558B Spectrum Analyzer

plug-in, the specifications listed in Table 1-1 apply when

both instruments are functioning together.

Consequently, the performance tests in this section verify the proper operation of both the HP 8558B and the 180-series Display mainframe.

Table 4-1. Performance Tests

Paragraph Test

4-11 Frequency Span Accuracy

4-12 Tuning Accuracy

4-13 Residual FM

4-14 Noise Sidebands

4-15 Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy

4-16 Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity

4-17 Average Noise Level

4-18 Spurious Responses

4-19 Residual Responses

4-20 Frequency Response

4-21 Bandwidth Switching (Amplitude

Variation)

4-22 Input Attenuator Accuracy

4-23 Reference Level Accuracy

4-24 Display Fidelity

4-25 Calibrator Accuracy

4-5. EQUIPMENT REQUIRED

4-6.

The equipment required for the performance tests is listed under Recommended Test Equipment in

Section I. Any equipment that satisfies the critical

specifications given in the table may be substituted for the recommended model.

4-7. TEST RECORD

4-8.

Results of the performance tests may be tabulated in the Performance Test Record at the end of this section. The test record lists test specifications and acceptable limits.

4-9. CALIBRATION CYCLE

4-10. This instrument requires periodic calibration.

Calibration should be verified every six months by means of the performance tests.

4-1

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

NOTE

Perform the Front Panel Adjustment Procedure in Section III before proceeding

with the performance tests. Allow at least 30 minutes warmup time.

4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY

SPECIFICATION

Fourteen calibrated spans from 100 MHz/div to 5 kHz/div in a 1, 2, 5 sequence. Frequency error between any two points on the display is less than - 5 % of the indicated frequency separation.

DESCRIPTION

Wide span widths are checked by using the 100-, 10-, and 1-MHz outputs from a comb generator. Narrow span widths are checked by using the output from a comb generator modulated by a function generator. Since the comb generator produces frequency components separated by a precisely determined frequency interval, the resultant spectral lines displayed on the CRT are evenly spaced when no span error exists in the instrument. Thus, span error is the cumulative variance of distance among the spectral line intervals displayed across the CRT. The amount of span error is determined by comparing the distance of the first nine graticule divisions to the display distance of the corresponding spectral line intervals.

Figure 4-1. Frequency Span Accuracy Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Comb Generator.................................................................................................... HP 8406A

Timer/Counter ....................................................................................................... HP 5308A

Function Generator ............................................................................................... HP 3310A

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................. HP 10503A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780

BNC Tee ......................................................................................................... HP 1250-0781

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ............................................................. HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω .................................................................. HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f).............................................................................. HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ............................................................................ HP 1250-1200

4-2

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY(Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1. Set equipment controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer:

START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING .................................................................................................................. 800 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV .................................................................................................... 100 MHz

RESOLUTION BW ............................................................... OPTIMUM, coupled (pushed in)

INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................... 0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................... -20 dBm

002: + 30 dBmV

Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER..................................................................................................... OFF

VIDEO FILTER.............................................................................................................. OFF

Comb Generator:

COMB FREQUENCY- MHz........................................................................................ 100 MC

INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz ......................................................................... OFF

OUTPUT AMPLITUDE ............................................................................................ 10 o'clock

Function Generator:

FUNCTION ................................................................................................................... SINE

RANGE .......................................................................................................................... 10K

Frequency ................................................................................................................ 200 kHz

DC OFFSET LEVEL............................................................................................................ 0

2. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-1 but do not connect function generator to comb generator.

3. Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to position one spectral line (from comb generator) at first graticule line

(left-hand edge of display). Measure error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line as shown in Figure 4-2.

Error should be no greater than - 0.4 division.

__________ div

4. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between fifth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than i 0.4 division.

__________ div

4-3

Model 8558B

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY(Cont'd)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 4-2. Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for Ninth Spectral Line

Figure 4-3. Frequency Span Accuracy Measurement for Seventeenth Spectral Line

4-4

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY(Cont'd)

5.

Set comb generator COMB FREQUENCY-MHz for 10-MHz comb. Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20

MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between 17th

spectral line and ninth graticule line as shown in Figure 4-3. Error should be no greater than

±

0.4 division.

__________ div

6.

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 10 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line.

Measure error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than

±

0.4 division.

__________ div

7.

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between fifth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than

±

0.4 division.

__________ div

8.

Set comb generator COMB FREQUENCY-MHz for 1-MHz comb. Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 2

MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between 17th spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than

±

0.4 division.

__________ div

9.

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 1 MHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than

±

0.4 division.

__________ div

10. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line.

Measure error between fifth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than

±

0.4 division.

__________ div

11. Set comb generator COMB FREQUENCY-MHz for 10-MHz comb. Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to position a spectral line at center graticule line. Turn on comb generator INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz.

12. Set function generator frequency to 200 kHz (

±

0.5%) using frequency counter. Connect function generator output to comb generator MODULATION input. Set function generator OUTPUT LEVEL for a clean 200-kHz comb on the spectrum analyzer display.

4-5

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-11. FREQUENCY SPAN ACCURACY (Cont'd)

NOTE

To obtain a clean comb on the spectrum analyzer display, use the LOW or HIGH output of the function generator as necessary. Readjust the function generator

OUTPUT LEVEL and the comb generator INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE - 1 MHz as necessary.

13.Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 200 kHz. Adjust TUNING control to position one spectral line at first graticule line. Measure error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line. Error should be no greater than 4

0.4 division.

__________ div

14. Using procedure of NOTE in step 12, vary spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV and Function Generator Output

Frequency in accordance with Table 4-2. Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to position one spectral line at

first graticule line. Measure span error between ninth spectral line and ninth graticule line.

Table 4-2. Narrow Span Width Error Measurement

Spectrum Analyzer

FREQ SPAN/DIV RESOLUTION BW

Function Generator

Output Frequency*

Allowable Error

(Max.)

100 kHz

50 kHz

20 kHz

10 kHz

5 kHz

OPTIMUM

OPTIMUM

OPTIMUM

OPTIMUM

OPTIMUM

100 kHz

50 kHz

20 kHz

10 kHz

5 kHz

+0.4 Division

+0.4 Division

+0.4 Division

+0.4 Division

+0.4 Division

* Check function generator output frequency using a frequency counter. Frequency readout should be within +0.5% of desired audio frequency.

4-6

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-12. TUNING ACCURACY

SPECIFICATION

0 to 195 MHz:

±

(1 MHz

±

20% of FREQ SPAN/DIV setting), 10°C to 40°C

195 to 1500 MHz:

±

(5 MHz

±

20% of FREQ SPAN/DIV setting), 10°C to 40°C.

DESCRIPTION

A comb generator is used to provide 1-, 10-, or 100-MHz frequency components that produce spectral lines on the CRT at 1-, 10-, or 100-MHz intervals, respectively. The spectrum analyzer TUNING control is adjusted until the desired test frequency is shown on the FREQUENCY MHz readout of the Digital Panel Meter. The FREQUENCY CAL switch is pressed and the amount of readout (or tuning) error is found by measuring the distance of the spectral line offset from the center graticule line.

Figure 4-4. Tuning Accuracy Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Comb Generator.................................................................................................... HP 8406A

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200

4-7

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-12. TUNING ACCURACY (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER

FREQ SPAN/DIV ..................................................................................................... 200 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ................................................................................................ OPTIMUM

INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................... 0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................. - 20 dBm

002: +30dBmV

Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF

VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF

2.

Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to position LO feedthrough signal at center graticule line of display.

Press FREQUENCY CAL switch and reposition LO feedthrough signal at center graticule line, as required. Adjust

FREQ ZERO control for zero indication on FREQUENCY MHz readout. LO feedthrough signal should still be positioned at center graticule line of display.

3.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-4.

4.

Set comb generator controls as follows:

COMB FREQUENCY - MHz....................................................................................... 10 MC

INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz ......................................................................... OFF

OUTPUT AMPLITUDE .......................................................................................... 10 o'clock

5.

Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control until FREQUENCY MHz readout indicates 10.0 MHz. Press

FREQUENCY CAL switch. Comb generator spectral line, displayed on CRT, should be within 5.2 divisions ( - 1.04

MHz) of center graticule line.

__________ div

NOTE

If the spectral line is off screen, set FREQ SPANIDIV to 500 kHz and check that the spectral line is within 2.2 divisions of the center graticule line.

6.

Using procedure of step 5, adjust spectrum analyzer and comb generator controls as shown in Table 4-3 to measure

TUNING accuracy. After tuning to each FREQUENCY MHz readout, press FREQUENCY CAL switch before measuring TUNING accuracy.

4-8

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-12. TUNING ACCURACY (Cont'd)

Spectrum Analyzer

FREQUENCY

MHz

Readout

(MHz)

FREQ

SPAN/DIV.

Setting

20.0

40.0

60.0

80.0

100.0

120.0

140.0

160.0

180.0

200

400

600

800

1000

1200

1400

1500

200 kHz

200 kHz

200 kHz

200 kHz

200 kHz

200 kHz

200 kHz

200 kHz

200 kHz

1 MHz

1 MHz

1 MHz

1 MHz

1 MHz

1 MHz

1 MHz

1 MHz

Table 4-3. Tuning Accuracy Measurement

Comb Generator

COMB

FREQUENCY-MC

Setting

(MHz)

10

10

10

10

10

10

10

10

10

100

100

100

100

100

100

100

100

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

-5.2

Specification

(Spectral line limits referenced

Min.

to center graticule line)

(Divisions)

Max.

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

+5.2

4-9

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-13. RESIDUAL FM

SPECIFICATION

Less than 1 kHz peak-to-peak for time < 0.1 second

FM DESCRIPTION

This test measures the inherent short-term instability (residual FM) of the LO system in the spectrum analyzer. A stable signal applied to the input of the spectrum analyzer is slope-detected on the linear portion of the 10 kHz bandwidth filter

in zero span (fixed-tuned receiver). (See Figure 4-6a.) Instability in the LO system in transferred to the IF signal in the

mixing process. As the IF signal moves in relation to the center of the IF filter, the attenuation of the signal changes in accordance with the skirt characteristics of the filter. If the signal stays on the linear portion of the IF filter skirt, the amplitude of the IF signal applied to the final detector (and thus the level on the display) is linearly related to the

frequency of the IF signal. (See Figure 4-6b). Therefore, any variations in level seen on the display are linearly related

to variations in LO frequency.

Figure 4-5. Residual FM Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Comb Generator.................................................................................................... HP 8406A

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200

4-10

Model 8558B

4-13. RESIDUAL FM (Cont'd)

PERFORMANCE TESTS

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 4-6. Example of Residual FM

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer and comb generator controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer:

START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER

FREQUENCY SPAN/DIV ......................................................................................... 100 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ...................................................................................................... 10kHz

INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................... 0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................. - 20 dBm

002: +30dBmV

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................

LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF

VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF

Comb Generator:

COMB FREQUENCY - MHz....................................................................................... 100 MC

INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE- 1 MHz ......................................................................... OFF

OUTPUT AMPLITUDE .................................................................................. Fully clockwise

4-11

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-13. RESIDUAL FM (Cont'd)

2.

Connect OUTPUT of comb generator to spectrum analyzer INPUT connector as shown in Figure 4-5.

NOTE

The HP 8558B is sensitive to vibration. Be sure the instrument is in a vibrationfree environment.

3.

Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to display 500-MHz signal produced by comb generator. Adjust

REFERENCE LEVEL and REF LEVEL FINE controls to position peak of signal at top graticule line.

4.

Keep 500-MHz signal centered on CRT while reducing FREQ SPAN/DIV to zero.

5.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz and SWEEP TIME/DIV to .1 SEC.

6.

Slightly readjust fine TUNING control of spectrum analyzer until trace appears between fourth and seventh graticule lines. Peak-to-peak variation of trace should not exceed one major vertical division for each major horizontal

division. (See Figure 4-6a.)

__________ div

4-12

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-14. NOISE SIDEBANDS

SPECIFICATION

More than 65 dB below CW signal, 50 kHz or more away from signal with a 1-kHz resolution bandwidth and full video filtering.

DESCRIPTION

A stable 400-MHz CW signal is applied at a - 20 dBm level to the spectrum analyzer and is displayed on the CRT. The test is designed to measure the amplitude of noise-associated sidebands and unwanted responses.

Figure 4-7. Noise Sideband Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator ................................................................................................... HP 8640B

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200

4-13

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-14. NOISE SIDEBANDS(Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set equipment controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer:

START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ................................................................................................................... 400MHz

FREQUENCY SPAN/DIV .........................................................................................

1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW ..................................................................................................... 30 KHz

INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................

10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................. - 20 dBm

002: +30dBmV

Amplitude Scale ......................................................................................................10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................... AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF

VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF

Signal Generator

FREQUENCY.......................................................................................................... 400 MHz

RF OUTPUT ........................................................................................................... - 20 dBm

RF ..................................................................................................................................

ON

AM ................................................................................................................................. OFF

FM ................................................................................................................................. OFF

2.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-7.

3.

Adjust TUNING control to locate 400-MHz signal on CRT.

4.

Adjust REFERENCE LEVEL and REF LEVEL FINE controls to position peak of 400-MHz signal at top graticule line.

5.

Decrease FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz. Adjust TUNING to keep signal centered.

6.

Position signal at center of display. Turn VIDEO FILTER control fully clockwise (not in detent). Measure noise sidebands existing more than 2.5 division (50 kHz) from 400-MHz signal. Noise sidebands should be greater than

65 dB (6.5 divisions) down from top graticule line.

_________ div down

4-14

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY

SPECIFICATION

Individual resolution bandwidth 3-dB points calibrated to 20%o (10°C to 400C)

DESCRIPTION

Resolution bandwidth accuracy is measured in the linear mode to eliminate log amplifier errors. Since signal level at the

3-dB points (half-power points) is related to peak signal level by a voltage ratio of 0.707:1.0, a peak level of 7.1 vertical divisions on the spectrum analyzer display gives a half-power level of 5 vertical divisions:

0.707 (voltage ratio) = X div/7.1 div

X div = (7.1)(0.707)

5 div

In the 30-, 10-, and 1-kHz bandwidths, a 301.4-MHz signal (second IF) is injected into A9 Third Converter Assembly to provide the stability required for measurement of narrow resolution bandwidths.

Figure 4-8. Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup, 3 MHz to 100 kHz

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator ................................................................................................... HP 8640B

Extender Cable Assembly ............................................................................... HP 5060-0303

Adapter, SMC (m) to BNC (m)......................................................................... HP 1250-0831

Adapter, BNC (f) to BNC (f) ............................................................................. HP 1250-0080

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .................................................... HP 1250-0780

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)................................................................................... HP 10503A

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ........................................................... HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ................................................................. HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)............................................................................. HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ........................................................................... HP 1250-1200

4-15

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd) ,

PROCEDURE

WARNING

This test must be performed with power supplied to the instrument and with protective covers removed. The test should be performed only by service-trained personnel who are aware of the hazards involved.

1.

Set equipment controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer:

START-CENTER..................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ................................................................................................................... 10 MHz

FREQUENCY SPAN/DIV .................................................................................................... 0

RESOLUTION BW ...................................................................................................... 3 MHz

INPUT ATTEN............................................................................................................. 20 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................. 0 dBm

002: +30dBmV

Amplitude Scale ............................................................................................................... LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV .....................................................................................................5 mSEC

SWEEP TRIGGER............................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER...................................................................................................... OFF

VIDEO FILTER............................................................................................................... OFF

Signal Generator

COUNTER MODE................................................................................... INT, EXPAND X10

AM ................................................................................................................................ OFF

FM ................................................................................................................................ OFF

FREQUENCY TUNE .................................................................................................. 10 MHz

RF .................................................................................................................................... ON

OUTPUT LEVEL ........................................................................................................ 0 dBm

2.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-8.

3.

Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING control to locate peak of 10-MHz signal on CRT. Reduce signal generator output if necessary.

4.

Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at 7.1 divisions above graticule baseline.

5.

Tune signal generator frequency until trace drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

__________ MHz

4-16

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd)

6.

Tune signal generator frequency in direction opposite to that of step 5 until trace peaks (7.1 divisions above graticule baseline) and then drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

__________ MHz

7.

Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 3-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 5 and

6).

Min.

Actual Max.

2.40 MHz ________________ 3.60 MHz

8.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Set signal generator to 10 MHz and repeat steps 3 through 7.

Min.

Actual Max.

800 kHz _________________ 1200 kHz

9.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 300 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Set signal generator to 10 MHz and repeat steps 3 through 7.

Min.

Actual Max.

240 kHz _________________ 360 kHz

10. Set RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Set signal generator to 10 MHz and repeat steps 3 through 7.

Min.

Actual Max.

80 kHz __________________ 120 kHz

Figure 4-9. Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy Test Setup, 1 kHz to 30 kHz

4-17

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd)

WARNING

In the following procedure, the plug-in must be removed from the display mainframe and connected through the extender cable assembly. Be very careful; the energy at some points in the instrument might, if contacted, cause personal injury. This test should be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazard involved.

11. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to approximately -12 dBm and tune frequency to 301.4 MHz. Set COUNTER

MODE to EXPAND X100.

12. Set spectrum analyzer INPUT ATTEN to 0 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to -10 dBm. Set RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Leave FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0.

002: REFERENCE LEVEL, + 40 dBmV.

13. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-9. Remove W7P1 from A10OJ2. Connect signal generator through

adapters to W7P1.

14. Adjust signal generator frequency until spectrum analyzer trace is at peak. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at 7.1 divisions above graticule baseline.

15. Tune signal generator frequency until trace drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

__________ MHz

16. Tune signal generator frequency in direction opposite to that of step 15 until trace peaks and then drops to 5 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

__________ MHz

17. Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 3-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 15 and

16).

Min.

Actual Max.

24 kHz __________________ 36 kHz

18. Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 17.

Min.

Actual Max.

8 kHz ___________________ 12 kHz

4-18

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-15. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH ACCURACY(Cont'd) ,

19. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 17.

Min.

Actual Max.

2.4 kHz__________________ 3.6 kHz

20. Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 17.

Min.

Actual Max.

0.8 kHz__________________ 1.2 kHz

21. Reconnect W7P1 to A10J2 unless continuing on with next performance test.

4-19

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY '

SPECIFICATION

60-dB:3-dB resolution bandwidth ratio < 15:1.

DESCRIPTION

The 60-dB bandwidth is measured for all resolution bandwidths. The 60- to 3-dB resolution bandwidth ratio (shape factor) is then computed for each bandwidth by dividing the 3-dB value (from the Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy test) into the 60-dB value.

In the 30-, 10-, and 1-kHz bandwidths, a 301.4-MHz signal (second IF) is injected into A9 Third Converter assembly to provide the stability required for the measurement of narrow resolution bandwidths.

Figure 4-10. Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup, 1 kHz to 30 kHz

WARNING

In the following procedure, the plug-in must be removed from the display mainframe and connected through the extender cable assembly. Be very careful; the energy at some points in the instrument might, if contacted, cause personal injury. This test should be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazard involved.

4-20

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY(Cont'd)

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

Extender Cable Assembly...................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

Adapter, SMC (m) to BNC (m) ............................................................................................... HP 1250-0831

Adapter, BNC (f) to BNC (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-0080

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .......................................................................... HP 1250-0780

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

to 50

...................................................................................HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

....................................................................................... HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200

PROCEDURE

1.

Set equipment controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................50 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV........................................................................................................................................ 0

RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................. 1 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-10 dBm

002: + 40 dBm V

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV...........................................................................................................................5 mSEC

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................................OFF

Signal Generator

COUNTER MODE ...........................................................................................................INT, EXPAND X10

AM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF

FM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF

FREQUENCY TUNE ................................................................................................................... 301.4 MHz

RF ...........................................................................................................................................................ON

OUTPUT LEVEL..............................................................................................................................-20 dBm

2.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-10. Remove W7P1 from A10J2. Connect signal generator through

adapters to W7P1.

3.

Adjust signal generator frequency until spectrum analyzer trace is at peak. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at top graticule line.

4-21

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-16.

RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY(Cont'd)

4.

Tune signal generator until trace drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

MHz

5.

Tune signal generator in direction opposite to that of step 4 until trace peaks and then drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

MHz

6.

Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 60-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 4 and

5).

kHz

7 Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 3 through 6.

kHz

8.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 3 through 6.

kHz

9.

Set spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 3 through 6.

kHz

10. Reconnect W7P1 to A10J2. Set display LINE power to OFF and remove extender cable assembly. Install plug-in in mainframe and set LINE power to ON.

11. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to 0 dBm.

12. Set spectrum analyzer INPUT ATTEN to 20 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to 0 dBm. Set RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0.

002: REFERENCE LEVEL, +50 dBmV.

13. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-11.

14. Set signal generator frequency to 50 MHz. Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to locate peak of 50-MHz signal on

CRT.

15. Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to position trace at top graticule line.

4-22

Model 8558B

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY (Cont'd)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 4-11. Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity Test Setup, 100 kHz to 3 MHz

16. Tune signal generator frequency until trace drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

MHz

17. Tune signal generator frequency in direction opposite to that of step 16 until trace peaks and then drops to 2 divisions above graticule baseline. Record signal generator frequency.

MHz

18. Calculate and record resolution bandwidth at 60-dB points (difference between frequencies recorded in steps 16 and

17).

kHz

19. Set spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 300 kHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through

18.

kHz

20. Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 18.

MHz

21. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 MHz, leaving FREQ SPAN/DIV set to 0. Repeat steps 14 through 18.

MHz

22. In Table 4-4, record 3-dB bandwidths computed in Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy test.

23. In Table 4-4, record 60-dB bandwidths recorded in this procedure.

24. For each resolution bandwidth, divide 60-dB bandwidth by 3-dB bandwidth to obtain Resolution Bandwidth Ratio.

Each ratio should be less than 15:1.

4-23

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-16. RESOLUTION BANDWIDTH SELECTIVITY (Cont'd)

Table 4-4. Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity

RESOLUTION

BW Setting

3 MHz

1 MHz

300 kHz

100 kHz

30 kHz

10 kHz

3 kHz

1 kHz

MEASURED

3 db BW

MEASURED

60 db BW

Resolution Bandwidth

Ration (60 db BW):

(3 dB BW)

4-24

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-17. AVERAGE NOISE LEVEL

SPECIFICATION

Less than - 107 dBm with a 10-kHz resolution bandwidth (0 dB input attenuation), 1 MHz to 1500 MHz.

001: Less than - 100dBm

002: Less than - 53 dBm V

DESCRIPTION

The average noise level is checked by observing the average noise power level displayed on the CRT when no input signal is applied to the instrument. The test is performed with a 10-kHz resolution bandwidth.

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START-CENTER..................................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING .................................................................................................................................................. 500 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV..................................................................................................................................... 100 MHz

RESOLUTION BW ..................................................................................................................................... 10 kHz

INPUT ATTEN................................................................................................................................................. 0dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................................. - 60 dBm

002:-10 dBm V

Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.................................................................................................................................. 10 mSEC

SWEEP TRIGGER .............................................................................................................................. FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER....................................................................................................................................... OFF

VIDEO FILTER.......................................................................................................................................12 o'clock

2.

Adjust TUNING until LO feedthrough is not on screen. Set VIDEO FILTER to MAX (not in detent) and observe CRT

display of noise level from 1 MHz to 1000 MHz. Noise level, as shown in Figure 4-12, should be less than - 107.

001: Change '- 107 dBm' to '- 100 dBm' throughout procedure and in Figure 4-12.

002: Change '- 107 dBm' to '- 53 dBmV' throughout procedure and in Figure 4-12.

< - 107 dBm

3.

Set START-CENTER switch to START. Observe average noise level from 500 MHz to 1500 MHz. Noise level should be less than - 107 dBm.

< - 107 dBm

4-25

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-17. AVERAGE NOISE LEVEL(Cont'd)

4.

Set START-CENTER switch to CENTER and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 1 MHz. Adjust TUNING for a FREQUENCY MHz readout of 6 MHz and momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch.

5.

Observe average noise level from I MHz to 11 MHz. Noise level should be less than - 107 dBm.

< - 107 dBm

Figure 4-12. Average Noise Level Measurement

4-26

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES

SPECIFICATION

Image and multiple responses and second harmonic distortion products are > 70 dB* below a - 40 dBm in-put signal with

0 dB input attenuation.

001: - 35 dBm input signal

002: + 15dBmV input signal

Third order intermodulation distortion products are >70 dB* below two -30 dBm input signals, separated by

50 kHz, with

0 dB input attenuation.

001: two - 25 dBm input signals

002: two + 25 dBm V input signals

* > 60 dB for 100 kHz to 5 MHz input signals.

DESCRIPTION:

A signal source with a lowpass filter is used to measure harmonic distortion. The LPF is required to ensure that the signals displayed on the CRT are due to harmonic distortion in the spectrum analyzer rather than to the harmonic content of the signal generator.

In measuring spurious responses due to image frequencies, out-of-band responses, and intermodulation distortion, signals from two separate sources are applied to the spectrum analyzer.

Figure 4-13. Harmonic Distortion Test Setup

4-27

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES (Cont'd)

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator (2 required) ....................................................................................................... HP 8640B

10 dB Attenuator (2 required).........................................................................................HP 8491A Opt. 010

300 MHz LPF...............................................................................................................Telonic TLP 300-4AB

BNC Tee................................................................................................................................ HP 1250-0781

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (3 required) .......................................................................... HP 1250-0780

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) (2 required) ...................................................................................... HP 10503A

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

to 50

Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC(m), 75

Ω ......................................................................................... HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200

PROCEDURE

Harmonic Distortion

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ......................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 500 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-40 dBm

001: -30 dBm

002: + 20 dBm V

REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................... 0

001: -5

002: -5

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................. 12 o'clock

2.

Set signal generator frequency to 280 MHz and OUTPUT LEVEL to - 30 dBm.

3.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-13.

4.

Momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Tune signal generator to center signal on spectrum analyzer display.

4-28

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES (Cont'd)

5.

Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for -40 dBm displayed at top graticule line of spectrum analyzer CRT.

001: -35 dBm

002: + 15 dBm V

6.

Increase signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL by 20 dB.

7.

Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to approximately 560 MHz and identify second harmonic.

8.

Center signal on spectrum analyzer display and reduce signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL by 20 dB.

9.

Set spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz. Harmonics should be more than 70 dB below input signal

(below first graticule line from bottom).

2nd Harmonic: dB

3rd Harmonic: dB

10. Set RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Increase signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL by 20 dB.

11. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to approximately 840 MHz and identify third harmonic.

12. Repeat steps 8 and 9.

Intermodulation Distortion

13. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................30 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 500 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 30 dBm

001: -20dBm

002: +30dBm V

REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................... 0

001: -5

002: -5

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................. 12 o'clock

4-29

Model 8558B

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES(Cont'd)

14. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-14.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 4-14. Intermodulation Distortion Test Setup

15. Set both signal generators for approximately 30 MHz output at - 24 dBm.

16. Momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Tune signal generators until signals are 2 divisions apart and centered on display.

17. Adjust OUTPUT LEVEL controls of both signal generators for - 30 dBm displayed on spectrum analyzer.

001: -25 dBm

002: + 25 dBm V

18. Reduce spectrum analyzer RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and check for third order intermodulation distortion products at approximately 3 divisions to either side of center graticule line (see NOTE below). They should be more than 70

dB below input signals (-100 dBm on spectrum analyzer display). (See Figure 4-15.)

001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display

002: - 50 dBmV on spectrum analyzer display

dB

NOTE

If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.

4-30

Model 8558B

4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES(Cont'd)

PERFORMANCE TESTS

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 4-15. Intermodulation Distortion Products

19. Set INPUT ATTEN to 0 dB, REFERENCE LEVEL to -40 dBm, and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Adjust OUTPUT

LEVEL of each signal generator to - 43 dBm as displayed on CRT.

001: REFERENCE LEVEL - 35 dBm; output level of - 38 dBm displayed on CRT

002: REFERENCE LEVEL + 15 dBmV; output level of + 12 dBmV displayed on CRT

20. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 1 MHz and momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and adjust VIDEO FILTER as necessary for more than 70 dB display range. Check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f2 fl) near center of display (see NOTE below). Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than 60 dB below the total applied signal (- 100 dBm on spectrum analyzer

display). (See Figure 4-15.)

001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display

002: - 45 dBmV on spectrum analyzer display

dB

NOTE

If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.

4-31

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES (Cont'd)

21. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 60 MHz and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Momentarily press FREQUENCY

CAL switch.

22. Check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f

1

+ f

2

) between 2f

1 and 2f

2

signals (see NOTE below).

Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and adjust VIDEO FILTER as necessary for more than 70 dB display range.

Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than 70 dB below total applied signal (- 110 dBm on

spectrum analyzer display). (See Figure 4-15.)

001: - 105 dBm on spectrum analyzer display

002: - 60 dBm V on spectrum analyzer display

dB

NOTE

If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.

23. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING .............................................................................................................................................4 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 500 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 30 dBm

001: - 20 dBm

002: +30dBmV

REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................... 0

001: -5

002: -5

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................. 12 o'clock

24. Set both signal generators for approximately 4 MHz at - 24 dBm.

25. Momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Tune signal generators until signals are 2 divisions apart and centered on display.

26. Adjust OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator for - 30 dBm as displayed on CRT.

001: - 25 dBm

002: + 25 dBm V

4-32

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-18. SPURIOUS RESPONSES(Cont'd)

27. Check for third order intermodulation distortion products at approximately 3 divisions from either side of center graticule line. Third order intermodulation distortion products should be more than 60 dB below input signals (- 90 dBm on spectrum analyzer display).

001: - 85 dBm on spectrum analyzer display

002: - 35 dBm V on spectrum analyzer display

dB

NOTE

If signal generators other than HP 8640's are used, intermodulation distortion might be in the generators themselves because of crosstalk between the two sources.

28. Set INPUT ATTEN to 0 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to -40 dBm. Adjust OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator for - 43 dBm as displayed on CRT.

001: REFERENCE LEVEL, - 35 dBm; output level of - 38 dBm displayed on CRT

002: REFERENCE LEVEL, + 15 dBmV; + 12 dBmV as displayed on CRT

29. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 1 MHz and momentarily press FREQUENCY CAL switch. Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz and adjust VIDEO FILTER as necessary for more than 70 dB display range. Check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f

2

- f

1

) near center of display (see NOTE below). Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than 60 dB below total applied signal (-100 dBm on spectrum analyzer display).

(See Figure 4-15.)

001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display

002: - 45 dBm V on spectrum analyzer display

dB

NOTE

If the intermodulation distortion product cannot be located, increase output levels of both signal generators by 10 dB. Be sure to return the OUTPUT LEVEL of each signal generator to its previous setting before making the actual measurement.

30. Set spectrum analyzer TUNING to 8 MHz and check for second order intermodulation distortion product (f

1

+ f

2

) between 2f

1

and 2f

2

signals. (See figure 4-15.) Second order intermodulation distortion product should be more than

60 dB below total applied signal (- 100 dBm on spectrum analyzer display). (See NOTE above.)

001: - 95 dBm on spectrum analyzer display

002: - 45 dBmV on spectrum analyzer display

dB

4-33

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-19. RESIDUAL RESPONSES

SPECIFICATION

< - 100 dBm (1-1500 MHz) with 0 dB input attenuation and no signal present at input.

001: < - 95 dBm

002: < - 50 dBmV

DESCRIPTION

The spectrum analyzer is tested for residual responses with no signal applied to the INPUT 509 connector. The input attenuation is set to 0 dB.

001 and 002: INPUT 75

Figure 4-16. Residual Responses Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Variable Persistence/Storage Display ............................................................................................. HP 181T

50-Ohm Termination................................................................................................................... HP 11593A

001 and 002: 75-Ohm Termination, HP 11652-60010

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START-CENTER ........................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ......................................................................................................................................... 500 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................ 100 MHz

RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 60 dBm

002: - 10 dBm V

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................... Fully clockwise (not in detent)

4-34

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-19. RESIDUAL RESPONSES (Cont'd)

2.

Terminate INPUT 501 connector with 50-ohm coaxial termination (see Figure 4-16).

001 and 002: 75

Ω; 75-ohm

3.

With variable persistence display in NORM mode, set LO feedthrough to far left vertical graticule line. Set

BASELINE CLIPPER to 3 o'clock.

4.

Set HP 181T to WRITE mode. Set PERSISTENCE control to MAX and INTENSITY control to approximately 12 o'clock.

5.

Set spectrum analyzer SWEEP TRIGGER to SINGLE sweep mode and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz. Momentarily press ERASE pushbutton.

NOTE

When the ERASE pushbutton is pressed, the spectrum analyzer sweep might be triggered. To stop the sweep, turn SWEEP TRIGGER control clockwise.

6.

Turn SWEEP TRIGGER control clockwise to initiate sweep.

7.

Slowly turn BASELINE CLIPPER control until peaks of trace begin to appear on display. It might be necessary to increase baseline clipping slightly near end of sweep to reduce blooming.

8.

Trigger sweep at least one more time and check for residual responses from 1 to 1000 MHz. Record frequency at which residual response of greatest amplitude appears.

MHz

9.

Set display to NORM mode. Set spectrum analyzer BASELINE CLIPPER fully counterclockwise and SWEEP

TRIGGER to FREE RUN.

10. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and TUNING to center frequency of residual recorded in step 8.

11. Narrow FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW, using TUNING control to keep signal centered. Use SWEEP

TIME/DIV control to reduce sweep speed until signal level does not rise when sweep speed is further reduced.

Residual response must be less than - 100 dBm.

dBm

001: < - 95 dBm

002: < - 50 dBmV

12. Repeat steps 1 through 5.

13. Set START-CENTER switch to START and repeat steps 6 and 7.

4-35

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-19. RESIDUAL RESPONSES(Cont'd)

14. Trigger sweep at least one more time and check for residual responses from 500 MHz to 1500 MHz. Record frequency at which residual response of greatest amplitude appears.

MHz

15. Repeat step 9.

16. Set spectrum analyzer FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and TUNING to center frequency of residual recorded in step 14.

17. Narrow FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW, using TUNING control to keep signal centered. Use SWEEP

TIME/DIV control to reduce sweep speed until signal level does not rise when sweep speed is further reduced.

Residual response must be less than - 100 dBm.

dBm

001: < - 95 dBm

002: < - 50 dBm V

4-36

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE

SPECIFICATION

≤ ±

1.0 dB with 10 dB input attenuation

DESCRIPTION

Signals from 0.1 to 1500 MHz are applied to the input of the spectrum analyzer. The amplitude of each signal is adjusted to a reference set on the analyzer display. The power level, measured with a power meter, determines the frequency response of the spectrum analyzer.

Figure 4-17. Frequency Response Test Setup

4-37

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE(Cont'd)

EQUIPMENT

Tracking Generator........................................................................................................HP 8444A Opt. 059

Power Meter ................................................................................................................................... HP 435B

Power Sensor ............................................................................................................................... HP 8482A

Function Generator....................................................................................................................... HP 3310A

Power Splitter ............................................................................................................................. HP 11667A

BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ............................................................................................................. HP 10502A

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A

Type N cable, 180 cm (72 in) ...................................................................................................... HP 11500A

10 dB Attenuator............................................................................................................HP 8491B Opt. 010

Adapter, Type N (m) to Type N (m)........................................................................................ HP 1250-1475

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ............................................................................................. HP 1250-0780

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ....................................................................................... HP 1250-1288

Adapter, Type N (m) to SMA (f), 50

Ω ..................................................................................... HP 1250-1250

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031

PROCEDURE

1.

Set controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer:

START- CENTER .......................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ..................................................................................................................................................... 0

FREQ SPAN/DIV........................................................................................................................................ 0

RESOLUTION BW .......................................................................................................................... 100 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .....................................................................................................................................10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-10 dBm

002: + 40 dBmV

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................................OFF

2.

Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to peak LO feedthrough signal on display. Press FREQUENCY CAL and readjust

TUNING for peak. Repeat. Adjust TUNING for peak and adjust FREQUENCY ZERO for a FREQUENCY MHz reading of 00.0.

3.

Adjust TUNING for a FREQUENCY MHz reading of 5.0 MHz. Press FREQUENCY CAL. Set up equipment as

shown in Figure 4-17. Connect the tracking generator 500 MHz LO OUTPUT to the THIRD LO INPUT (rear panel).

4.

Set spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale to 1 dB/DIV and adjust REF LEVEL FINE to bring the trace on the display.

Peak the trace using tracking generator TRACK ADJ.

4-38

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE(Cont'd)

5.

Set power meter CAL FACTOR according to chart on power probe (5 MHz). Set RANGE to - 10 dBm.

6.

Adjust tracking generator LEVEL to set a reference of - 12 dBm on the power meter.

7.

Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL FINE to position trace to fourth graticule line.

8.

For each setting in Table 4-5:

a.

Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING and press FREQUENCY CAL.

b.

Set power meter CAL FACTOR.

c.

Adjust tracking generator TRACK ADJ to peak signal on display and adjust LEVEL to place signal on reference graticule.

d.

Record Power Meter Reading.

9.

Disconnect Type N cable from power splitter. Connect function generator LOW output to power splitter.

10. Set controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................... 50 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 10 kHz

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB/DIV

Function Generator:

RANGE ........................................................................................................................................... 100 kHz

Frequency ..........................................................................................................................................5 MHz

FUNCTION...........................................................................................................................................SINE

DC OFFSET ............................................................................................................................................... 0

11. Set power meter CAL FACTOR according to chart on power sensor (5 MHz). Adjust spectrum analyzer TUNING to center 5 MHz signal on display. Set amplitude scale to 1 dB/DIV.

12. Adjust function generator OUTPUT LEVEL to - 12 dB on power meter.

13. Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to bring the peak of the 5 MHz signal to fourth graticule from bottom.

14. For each frequency in Table 4-6, set function generator frequency and tune spectrum analyzer to bring signal to

center screen. Adjust function generator OUTPUT LEVEL to bring signal peak to reference graticule on the display.

Set the power meter CAL FACTOR and record the power indicated by the power meter.

15. Find the overall maximum power reading from both Table 4-5 and Table 4-6.

dBm

4-39

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-20. FREQUENCY RESPONSE (Cont'd)

16. Find the overall minimum power reading from both Table 4-5 and Table 4-6.

dBm

17. The difference between the overall maximum power in step 15 and the overall minimum power in step 16 should be less than 2 dB.

dB

Table 4-5. Frequency Response, 5 lMHz to 1500 MHz

Spectrum Analyzer TUNING

(MHz)

600

700

800

900

1000

1100

1200

5

100

200

300

400

500

1300

1400

1500

Power Meter Reading

(dBm)

-12(Ref.)

Table 4-6. Frequency Response, 100 kHz to 5 MHz

Spectrum Analyzer/Function Generator

Frequency

5 MHz

3 MHz

1 MHz

500 kHz

100 kHz

Power Meter Reading

(dBm)

-12 (Ref.)

4-40

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-21. BANDWIDTH SWITCHING (AMPLITUDE VARIATION)

SPECIFICATION

3 MHz to 300 kHz:

≤ ±

0.5 dB

3 MHz to I kHz:

≤ ±

1.0 dB (100 kHz bandwidth limited to < 80o R.H.)

DESCRIPTION

The spectrum analyzer 280 MHz CAL OUTPUT signal is applied to the INPUT connector and displayed on the CRT. The peak of the displayed 280 MHz signal is centered on the CRT and adjusted for a vertical deflection of seven divisions.

The amplitude variation of the 280 MHz signal is measured for each RESOLUTION BW control setting. The overall variation between RESOLUTION BW settings of 3 MHz to 300 kHz should be equal to or less than 1 dB (

±

0.5 dB). The overall variation between RESOLUTION BW settings of the 3 MHz to 1 kHz should be equal to or less than 2 dB (

±

1.0

dB).

EQUIPMENT

BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ............................................................................................................. HP 10502A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ............................................................................................. HP 1250-0780

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ....................................................................................HP08558-60031

Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC(m), 75

Ω ......................................................................................... HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START- CENTER .......................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ......................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV................................................................................................................................1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................3 MHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................................-20 dBm

002: + 30 dBm

REF LEVEL FINE ....................................................................................................................................-10

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................1 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................................OFF

2.

Connect spectrum analyzer CAL OUTPUT signal to INPUT 50

connector.

001 and 002: 75

4-41

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-21. BANDWIDTH SWITCHING (AMPLITUDE VARIATION) (Cont'd)

3.

Set TUNING control, as required, to center 280 MHz signal on CRT.

4.

Set REF LEVEL FINE control to position peak of 280 MHz signal seven divisions above graticule baseline.

5.

Vary the RESOLUTION BW and FREQ SPAN/DIV controls in accordance with Table 4-7. Record the change in

amplitude for each RESOLUTION BW setting. Changes in amplitude above reference level set in step 4 are positive

(+). Changes below reference level are negative (-).

Table 4-7. Amplitude Accuracy, Switching Between Bandwidths

RESOLUTION

BW

Setting

FREQ

SPAN/DIV

Setting

Change in

Amplitude

(dB)

Overall Variation Between

3 MHz and 300 kHz

RESOLUTION BW Settings (dB)

Overall Variation

Between 3 MHZ and

1 HZ RESOLUTION

BW Settings (dB)

3 MHz

1 MHz

300 kHz

1 MHz

500 kHz

100 KH

0 (Ref)

100 kHz

30 kHz

10 kHz

3 kHz

1 kHz

50 kHz

10 KHz

5 kHz

5 kHz

5 kHz

6.

To find the overall variation in Table 4-7, algebraically subtract the greatest negative change in amplitude from the

greatest positive change in amplitude. If all changes in amplitude are of the same sign, the overall variation is the largest positive or largest negative change in amplitude. The overall variation between 3 MHz and 300 kHz

RESOLUTION BW settings should be

1.0 dB (

±

5.0 dB). The overall variation between 3 MHz and 1 kHz

RESOLUTION BW settings should be

2.0 dB (

±

1.0 dB).

4-42

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-22. INPUT ATTENUATOR ACCURACY

SPECIFICATION

Accuracy

±

0.5 dB for each 10 dB step but not more than

±

1.0 dB over full 70 dB range.

DESCRIPTION

The input attenuator accuracy is tested over its full 70 dB range using an RF substitution method. A step attenuator that has been calibrated by a Standards Laboratory at 30 MHz is used for substitution. The known error of the calibrated attenuator is taken into account when computing the 8558B input attenuator accuracy.

Figure 4-18. Input Attenuator Accuracy Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

Step Attenuator................................................................................................................HP 355D Opt. H82

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .......................................................................... HP 1250-0780

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m) ............................................................................................... HP 1250-0216

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m)................................................................................................ HP 1250-0216

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158

BNC Cable, 30cm (12 in), 75

Ω............................................................................................HP 11652-60012

4-43

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-22 INPUT ATTENUATOR ACCURACY(Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

START - CENTER ......................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................30 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................. 200 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ............................................................................................................................ 30 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .....................................................................................................................................70 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL..........................................................................................................................0 dBm

001 -10dBm

002: +40dBmV

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................1 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................... 2 o'clock

Signal Generator

COUNTER MODE .................................................................................................................................. INT

AM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF

FM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF

FREQUENCY TUNE ..................................................................................................................... 30.0 MHz

OUTPUT LEVEL.................................................................................................................................0 dBm

RF ...........................................................................................................................................................ON

2.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4-18 with step attenuator set at 0 dB. Locate signal on CRT and adjust signal

generator OUTPUT LEVEL until signal peak is 6 divisions above graticule baseline.

3.

Set HP 8558B INPUT ATTEN control and step attenuator to settings indicated in Table 4-8. Record deviation from

sixth division reference set in step 2 for each setting.

Table 4-8. Input Attenuator Accuracy

INPUT ATTEN

Setting (dBm)

Step Attenuator

Setting (db)

Deviation from 6

Division (db) th

Step Attenuator Error

(Calibration)

Corrected Deviation

(db)

70

60

50

40

30

20

10

0

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

0 (Ref.) Ref.

0 (Ref.)

*Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-). For example, 9.99 dB calibration for a 10 dB attenuator setting represents an error of -0.01 dB.

4-44

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-22. INPUT ATTENUATOR ACCURACY(Cont'd)

4.

To compute Corrected Deviation, add Step Attenuator Error to Deviation from 6th Division for each setting.

Corrected Deviation should not differ more than 0.5 dB between any two adjacent settings of input attenuator.

Error Between Adjacent Settings

5.

Record maximum positive and maximum negative Corrected Deviation values. Difference between these two values (total deviation) should not exceed 2.0 dB (

±

1.0 dB).

dB Maximum Positive Corrected Deviation

dB Maximum Negative Corrected Deviation

dB Total Corrected Deviation

4-45

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY

SPECIFICATION

Step Accuracy:

Steps referenced with 0 dB input attenuation

-10 dBm to - 80 dBm:

±

0.5 dB

-10 dBm to - 100 dBm:

±

1.0 dB

Vernier Accuracy:

±

0.5 dB

DESCRIPTION

The reference level accuracy is tested over the range of - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm by checking the IF gain steps in 1 dB/DIV (Log) and in LIN. The resulting maximum deviation in each case must be less than 1.0 dB (

±

0.5 dB) from - 10 dBm to - 80 dBm and less than 2.0 dB (+ 1.0 dB) from - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm.

002: Change range to + 40 dBm V to - 50 dBm V.

Figure 4-19. Reference Level Accuracy Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

1 dB Step Attenuator ......................................................................................................HP 355C Opt. H80

10 dB Step Attenuator.....................................................................................................HP 355D Opt. H82

Adapter (2 required)............................................................................................................... HP 1250-0780

BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ............................................................................................................. HP 10502A

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................... HP 10503A

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ....................................................................................... HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-1200

4-46

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

Step Accuracy in Log Mode

1.

Set controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

START - CENTER ......................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...........................................................................................................................................30 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV................................................................................................................................. 5 kHz

RESOLUTION BW .............................................................................................................................. 3 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL dBm ..............................................................................................................-10 dBm

002: +40dBmV

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................1 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................................................................................................................. AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................... FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER .............................................................................................................................OFF

VIDEO FILTER ............................................................................................................................... 2 o'clock

Signal Generator

COUNTER MODE .................................................................................................................................. INT

AM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF

FM.........................................................................................................................................................OFF

FREQUENCY TUNE ........................................................................................................................30 MHz

OUTPUT LEVEL..............................................................................................................................-10 dBm

2.

Connect equipment in Figure 4-19 with step attenuator set at 0 dB. Locate signal on CRT.

NOTE

If signal is difficult to locate, press RESOLUTION BW control to couple with FREQ SPANIDIV control and turn the coupled controls clockwise until signal appears on display. Momentarily depress FREQ CAL switch and center the signal, using TUNING control. Return controls to positions called out in step 1, adjusting TUNING control as necessary to keep signal centered.

3.

Adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until trace is 6 divisions above graticule baseline. Set the 8558B

REFERENCE LEVEL control and step attenuator to settings indicated in Table 4-9. Record the Deviation from the

6th Division (reference set in step 2) for each setting.

4.

To compute the Corrected Deviation, add the Step Attenuator Error to the Deviation from 6th Division for each setting. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative Corrected Deviation values from -10 dBm to -80 dBm should not exceed 1.0 dB. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative Corrected Deviation values from - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm should not exceed 2.0 dB.

- 10 dBm to - 80 dBm dB

- 10 dBm to - 100 dBm dB

002: Change ranges to +40 dBm V to -30 dBm V and +40 dBm V to -50d BmV

4-47

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY (Cont'd)

Table 4-9. IF Gain Accuracy in LOG Mode

REFERENCE

LEVEL Setting

(dBm)

Step Attenuator

Setting

(db)

Deviation from

6 th

Division

(db)

Step Attenuator

Error (Calibration)*

(dB)

Corrected

Deviation

(db)

-10

-20

-30

-40

-50

-60

-70

-80

-90

-100

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

80

90

0 (Ref.) Ref.

0 (Ref.)

002: REFERENCE LEVEL (dBm V) from top to bottom: 40, 30, 20, 10, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40, -50.

*Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-). For example, 9.99 dB calibration for a 10 dB attenuator setting represents an error of -0.01 dB.

Step Accuracy in Linear Mode

5.

Set the spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale switch to LIN. Set REFERENCE LEVEL control to - 10 dBm and set step ttenuator to 0 dB. Readjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until trace is 6 divisions above graticule baseline.

6.

Set the 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL control and step attenuator to settings indicated in Table 4-10. Record the

Deviation from the 6th Division in Linear Mode (reference set in step 5) for each setting.

7.

Using Table 4-11, convert Deviation from 6th Division in Linear Mode to deviation in dB for each setting. Record dB values in Table 4-10.

8.

To compute the Corrected Deviation, add the Step Attenuator Error to the Deviation from the 6th Division in dB. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative Corrected Deviation values from - 10 dBm to -

80 dBm should not exceed 1.0 dB. The difference between the maximum positive and the maximum negative

Corrected Deviation values from - 10 dBm to - 100 dBm should not exceed 2.0 dB.

002: Change ranges to + 40 dBm V to -30 dBm V and +40 dBm V to -50 dBm V.

- 10 dBm to - 80 dBm dB

- 10 dBm to - 100 dBm _ dB

4-48

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY(Cont'd)

Table 4-10. IF Gain Accuracy in Linear Mode

REFERENCE

LEVEL

Setting (dBm)

Step Attenuator

Setting

(db)

Deviation from

6 th

Division in

Linear Mode (div.)

Deviation from

6 th

Division in db*

Step Attenuator

Error (Calibration)** (dB)

-60

-70

-80

-90

-100

-10

-20

-30

-40

-50

50

60

70

80

90

0

10

20

30

40

0 (Ref.) 0 (Ref.) Ref.

002: REFERENCE LEVEL (dBmV) from top to bottom: 40, 30, 20, 10, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40, -50.

*Use Table 4-11 to convert deviation in linear mode to deviation in dB.

**Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-).

Table 4-11. Conversion Table, Deviation in Linear Mode

Corrected

Deviation

(dB)

0 (Ref.)

POSTIVE DEVIATIONS (Above 6 th

division from graticule baseline)

Liner (Divisions)I dB

0

+.1

+.2

+.3

+.4

+.5

+.6

+.7

+.8

+.9

+1.0

+1.1

+1.2

+1.3

+1.4

+1.5

0

+0.14

+0.28

+0.42

+0.56

+0.70

+0.82

+0.96

+1.09

+1.21

+1.34

+1.46

+1.58

+1.70

+1.82

+1.94

NEGATIVE DEVIATIONS (Below 6 th

division from graticule baseline)

Linear (Divisions) dB

-.4

-.5

-.6

-.7

-.8

-.9

-1.0

-1.1

-1.2

0

-.1

-.2

-.3

0

-0.15

-0.29

-0.45

-0.60

-0.76

-0.92

-1.08

-1.24

-1.41

-1.58

-1.76

-1.94

4-49

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-23. REFERENCE LEVEL ACCURACY(Cont'd)

Vernier Accuracy

9.

Replace 10 dB step attenuator with 1 dB step attenuator. Set spectrum analyzer as follows:

REFERENCE LEVEL......................................................................................................................- 10 dBm

REFERENCE LEVEL FINE......................................................................................................................... 0

Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................dB/DIV

FREQ SPAN/DIV............................................................................................................................... 50 kHz

RESOLUTION BW .......................................................................................................................... 300 kHz

10. Center the signal on the CRT and adjust signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until trace is 6 divisions above graticule

baseline. Set step attenuator and spectrum analyzer REFERENCE LEVEL FINE to settings indicated in Table 4-12.

Record Deviation from 6th Division for each setting.

11. To compute Corrected Deviation, add Step Attenuator Error to Deviation from 6th Division for each setting.

Corrected Deviation should not exceed + 0.5 dB or -0.5 dB for each setting.

Table 4-12. Vernier Accuracy

Step Attenuator

Setting

(dB)

0

10

11

8

9

12

6

7

4

5

1

2

3

REFERENCE

LEVEL FINE

Setting

0

-1

-2

-3

-4

-5

-6

-7

-8

-9

-10

-11

-12

Deviation From

6 th

Division

(dB)

0 (Ref.)

Step Attenuator

Error (Calibration)*

(dB)

Ref.

* Attenuations > dial settings are positive (+). Attenuations < dial settings are negative (-).

Corrected

Deviation

(dB)

0 (Ref.)

4-50

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-24. DISPLAY FIDELITY

SPECIFICATION

Log Incremental Accuracy:

± 0.1 dB per dB from Reference Level

Log Maximum Cumulative Error:

< ± 1.5 dB over entire 70-dB range

Linear Accuracy:

± 3% of Reference Level

DESCRIPTION

The amplitude log display amplifier is tested by connecting a DVM to the rear panel AUX A connector (vertical output) of the mainframe. The widest analyzer bandwidth possible is selected so the signal appears as a straight horizontal line on the CRT display. The DVM is used to provide good resolution when checking for ±1 dB per 10 dB step (0.1 dB/dB).

Figure 4-20. Amplitude Log Display Accuracy Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator ............................................................................................................................. HP 8640B

Digital Voltmeter.............................................................................................................................. HP 3455A

10 dB Step Attenuator ....................................................................................................... HP 355D Opt. H82

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .............................................................................. HP 1250-0780

Cable, BNC to Banana Plug ...........................................................................................................HP 11001A

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω ...................................................................................... HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ...........................................................................................HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)....................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m) ..................................................................................................... HP 1250-1200

4-51

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-24.

DISPLAY FIDELI TY (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

Log Display Accuracy

1.

Set controls as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

START - CENTER............................................................................................................................. CENTER

TUNING .............................................................................................................................................. 30 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ................................................................................................................................500 kHz

RESOLUTION BW ..............................................................................................................................300 kHz

INPUT ATTEN........................................................................................................................................ 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................................ 0 dBm

002: + dBm V

REF LEVEL FINE.......................................................................................................................................... 0

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................. 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER........................................................................................................................ FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER................................................................................................................................ OFF

VIDEO FILTER......................................................................................................................................... OFF

Digital Voltmeter

RANGE ......................................................................................................................................................100

FUNCTION ...........................................................................................................................................V (DC)

AUTO CAL .............................................................................................................................................AUTO

TRIGGER....................................................................................................................................... INTERNAL

MATH....................................................................................................................................................... OFF

Signal Generator

FREQUENCY...................................................................................................................................... 30 MHz

COUNTERMODE.......................................................................................................................................INT

OUTPUT LEVEL ................................................................................................................................... 0 dBm

AM ........................................................................................................................................................... OFF

FM ........................................................................................................................................................... OFF

2.

3.

4.

5.

With no signal at INPUT, measure and record the vertical output (AUX A) offset of the spectrum analyzer.

_______ mV

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 4 20. Tune signal generator to 30 MHz and set power output for approximately 0 dBm. Set step attenuator to 0 dB.

Set spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale to 10 dB/DIV and adjust TUNING control to center the signal on CRT display.

Set the FREQ SPAN/DIV control to zero (0) and RESOLUTION BW control to 100 kHz. Tune the signal generator frequency for maximum reading on DVM.

4-52

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-24.

DISPLAY FIDELITY(Cont'd)

6.

Set the signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL so the DVM reads + 800 mV plus the offset (step 2) ± 0.5 mV. The trace should be approximately at the top graticule line.

Table 4-13. Amplitude Log Display Accuracy

AUX A

Theoretical

Reading

(mV)

AUX A Theoretical

Reading Subtracted

From Corrected

DMV Reading

(mV)

Difference

Between

Adjacent

Readings

(mV)

Attenuator

Setting

(dB)

DVM

Reading

(mV)

Corrected

DMV

Reading*

(mV)

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

*DVM Reading minus offset recorded in step 2.

+800 (Ref.)

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

+800

+700

+600

+500

+400

+300

+200

+100

0

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

-

Example (+ 5 mV offset):

Table 4-14. Sample Computations of Amplitude Log Display Accuracy

Attenuator

Setting

(dB)

DVM

Reading

(mV)

Corrected

DMV

Reading*

(mV)

AUX A

Theoretical

Reading

(mV)

AUX A Theoretical

Reading Subtracted

From Corrected

DMV Reading

(mV)

Difference

Between

Adjacent

Readings

(mV)

7.

8.

0

10

20

30

40

+805

+811

+599

+497

+406

*DVM Reading minus offset recorded in step 2.

+800

+703

+594

+492

+401

+800

+700

+600

+500

+400

0

+3

-6

-8

+1

-3

+9

+2

-9

Record the DVM Reading for each 10 dB step of the step attenuator, up to 70 dB, in Table 4-13.

Having recorded the DVM readings for all of the attenuator settings from 0 to 70 dB, subtract the AUX A

Theoretical Reading from the Corrected DVM Reading (DVM reading minus offset) in each case and record

results in Table 4-13. Theoretical Reading Subtracted From Corrected DVM Reading should not exceed ± 15

mV (± 1.5 dB).

4-53

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

11.

12.

13.

4.24.

DISPLAY FIDELITY (Cont'd)

9.

Subtract each converted reading (AUX A Theoretical Reading Subtracted From Corrected DVM Reading) from

the previous converted reading. This subtraction must be performed algebraically. Record results in Table 4-13

(see Example).

10.

The difference between adjacent readings (Table 4-13) should not exceed 10 mV (4 0.1 dB/dB).

Linear Display Accuracy

14.

15.

Replace 10 dB step attenuator with 1 dB step attenuator. Set step attenuator to 0 dB.

Set spectrum analyzer Amplitude Scale to LIN and RESOLUTION BW control to 1 MHz.

Peak the signal on the CRT display using the TUNING control. Set the signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to place the trace at the top graticule line.

Set the step attenuator to 6 dB. Trace should be at 4th division above graticule baseline (center horizontal graticule line) 1.2 minor divisions.

_______ div

Set the step attenuator to 12 dB. Trace should be at 2nd division above graticule baseline 1.2 minor divisions.

_______ div

4-54

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-25.

CALIBRATOR ACCURACY

SPECIFICATION

Amplitude: -30 dBm ± 1 dB.

002: +20dBmV ± 1 dB.

Frequency: 280 MHz ±300 MHz.

DESCRIPTION

The amplitude accuracy and frequency accuracy of the CAL OUTPUT signal are checked for -30 dBm ± 1 dB and 280

MHz ± 300 kHz, respectively.

002: +20dBmV ±1 dB.

Figure 4-21. Calibrator Accuracy Test Setup

4-55

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-25.

CALIBRATOR ACCURACY (Cont'd)

EQUIPMENT

Amplifier.......................................................................................................................................... HP 8447D

Signal Generator ............................................................................................................................. HP 8640B

10 dB Step Attenuator (Calibrated at 280 MHz) ................................................................. HP 355D Opt. H82

Power Meter ...................................................................................................................................... HP 435B

300 MHz LPF ............................................................................................................. TELONIC TLP 300-4AB

Power Sensor .................................................................................................................................. HP 8482A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) .............................................................................. HP 1250-6780

Adapter, Type N (f) to BNC (m) ................................................................................................. HP 1250-0077

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) (2 required)..........................................................................................HP 10503A

Additional Equipment for Options 001 and 002:

Power Sensor, 750 .......................................................................................................................... HP 8483A

Adapter, GR Type 874 to BNC (m), 75

Ω.................................................................. General Radio 0874-9754

Adapter, GR Type 874 to N (f), 75

Ω ........................................................................ General Radio 0874-9751

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75Q to 50

Ω ...................................................................................... HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m) ................................................................................................... HP 1250-0216

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f)....................................................................................................... HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC(f) to SMA (m) ...................................................................................................... HP 1250-1200

BNC Cable 30 cm (12 in), 75

Ω .............................................................................................. HP 11652-60012

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

2.

3.

START - CENTER............................................................................................................................. CENTER

TUNING ............................................................................................................................................ 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV .................................................................................................................................. 1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW ................................................................................................................................ 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN........................................................................................................................................ 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ......................................................................................................................... -20 dBm

002: +30dBmV

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................. 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER........................................................................................................................ FREE RUN

BASELINE CLIPPER................................................................................................................................ OFF

Set signal generator COUNTER MODE to EXT, 0-550, and EXPAND-X10. Connect spectrum analyzer CAL

OUTPUT to signal generator COUNTER INPUT connector through amplifier. Frequency counter should indicate

280 MHz ± 300 kHz.

__________ MHz

Set signal generator COUNTER MODE to INT and tune frequency to 280 MHz. Connect output of signal generator to calibrated step attenuator through 300 MHz low pass filter. Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to

0 dBm.

4-56

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4.

5.

6.

7.

4-25.

CALIBRATOR ACCURACY(Cont'd)

4.

5.

Set step attenuator to 10 dB and connect power sensor and power meter to attenuator as shown in Figure 4-21.

Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL power for a 10 dBm reading on power meter. Leave signal generator set at this level.

Set step attenuator to 30 dB and connect output of step attenuator to spectrum analyzer INPUT connector.

Set spectrum analyzer TUNING control to center signal on CRT display. Peak amplitude of reference signal should be one division down from top graticule line.

8.

9.

PROCEDURE FOR OPTIONS 001 and 002:

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as indicated above.

2.

Set Amplitude Scale switch to I dB/DIV and adjust REF LEVEL FINE control so peak amplitude of reference signal is one division down from top graticule line.

Disconnect reference signal and connect spectrum analyzer CAL OUTPUT to the INPUT connector. Signal peak amplitude should be one division down from top graticule line ±1 division.

- 31 dBm _______ 29 dBm

3.

Connect CAL OUTPUT to 8640B counter input connector through amplifier. Frequency counter should indicate

280 MHz ±300 kHz. (Use EXPAND X10 COUNTER MODE, EXT 0-550.)

Set signal generator frequency to 280 MHz. Connect output of signal generator to calibrated step attenuator and

75-ohm minimum loss adapter (approximately 5.7 dB attenuation). Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL to 5 dBm.

6.

7.

Set the step attenuator to 0 dB. Connect minimum loss adapter through power sensor to power meter.

Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for a 10 dBm (Option 001) or -8.75 dBm (Option 002) reading on power meter. Leave the signal generator set at this level.

Set step attenuator to 20 dB and connect -30 dBm (+20 dBm V) reference signal from signal generator through step attenuator, minimum loss adapter, and 75 ohm cable to HP 8558B INPUT 75

Ω connector.

With Amplitude Scale switch set to 10 dB/DIV, adjust TUNING control to center signal on CRT display. Peak amplitude of reference signal should be one division down from the top graticule line.

4-57

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PERFORMANCE TESTS

4-25.

CALIBRATOR ACCURACY (Cont'd)

8.

Set Amplitude Scale switch to 1 dB/DIV and adjust REF LEVEL FINE control so peak amplitude of reference signal is on seventh graticule line (one division down from top).

9.

Disconnect the reference signal and connect HP 8558B CAL OUTPUT through 75-ohm cable to INPUT 75g connector. Signal peak amplitude should be one division down from top, plus or minus one division.

002:

001: -31 dBm

+ 19 dBm V

_______ 29 dBm

______21 dBm V

4-58

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (1 of 4)

Hewlett-Packard Company Tested by: __________

Model 8558B

Spectrum Analyzer 0.1-1500 MHz

Serial No. _________________ Date: ______________

Paragraph Results

Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.

4-11 Frequency Span Accuracy

3.

100 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

4.

50 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

5.

20 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV .-0.4 div - +0.4 div

6.

10 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

7.

5 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

8.

2 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

9.

1 MHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

10. 500 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

13. 200 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

14. 100 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

50 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

20 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

10 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

5 kHz FREQ SPAN/DIV -0.4 div - +0.4 div

4-12 TUNING Accuracy

5.

10.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(8.96 MHz) (11.04 MHz)

6.

20.0MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(18.96 MHz) (21.04 MHz)

40.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(38.96 MHz) (41.04 MHz)

60.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(58.96 MHz) (61.04 MHz)

80.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(78.96 MHz) (81.04 MHz)

100.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(96.96 MHz) (101.04 MHz)

120.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(118.96 MHz) (121.04 MHz)

140.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(138.96 MHz) (141.04 MHz)

160.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(158.96 MHz) (161.04 MHz)

180.0 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(178.96 MHz) (181.04 MHz)

200 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(194.8 MHz) (205.2 MHz)

4-59

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (2 of 4)

Paragraph Results

Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.

4-12 TUNING Accuracy (Cont'd)

400 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(394.8 MHz) (405.2 MHz)

600 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(594.8 MHz) (605.2 MHz)

800 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(794.8 MHz) (805.2 MHz)

1000 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(994.8 MHz) (1005.2 MHz)

1200 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(1194.8 MHz) (1205.2 MHz)

1400 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(1394.8 MHz) (1405.2 MHz)

1500 MHz -5.2 div - +5.2 div

(1494.8 MHz) (1505.2 MHz)

4-13 Residual FM

6.

Peak-to-Peak Variation of Trace - 1.0 div

(1 kHz/0.1 sec)

4-14 Noise Sidebands

6.

Noise Sidebands - 6.5 div down

(-65 dB)

4-15 Resolution Bandwidth Accuracy

7.

3 MHz Resolution BW 2.40 MHz - 3.60 MHz

8.

1 MHz Resolution BW 800 kHz - 1.20 MHz

9.

300 kHz Resolution BW 240 kHz - 360 kHz

10. 100 kHz Resolution BW 80 kHz - 120 kHz

17. 30 kHz Resolution BW 24 kHz - 36 kHz

18. 10 kHz Resolution BW 8 kHz - 12 kHz

19. 3 kHz Resolution BW 2.4 kHz - 3.6 kHz

20. 1 kHz Resolution BW 0.8 kHz - 1.2 kHz

4-16 Resolution Bandwidth Selectivity

24. 3 MHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

1 MHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

300 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

100 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

30 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

10 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

3 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

1 kHz Resolution BW Selectivity - 15:1

4-60

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (3 of 4)

Paragraph Results

Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.

4-17 Average Noise Level

2 Average Noise Level 1 MHz to 1000 MHz - -107 dBm

3 Average Noise Level 500 MHz to 1500 MHz - -107 dBm

5 Average Noise Level 1 MHz to 11 MHz - -107 dBm

001: Max. is -100 dBm

002: Max. is -53 dBm V

4-18 Spurious Responses

9.

Harmonic Distortion

2nd Harmonic -70 dB -

3rd Harmonic -70 dB -

18. Third Order Intermodulation Distortion,

30 MHz input signals -70 dB -

20. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,

30 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -70 dB -

22. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,

30 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -70 dB -

27. Third Order Intermodulation Distortion,

4 MHz input signals -60 dB -

29. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,

4 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -60 dB -

30. Second Order Intermodulation Distortion,

4 MHz input signals (f1 + f2) -60 dB -

4-19 Residual Responses

11. Residual Responses 1 MHz to 1000 MHz - -100 dBm

17. Residual Responses 500 MHz to 1500 MHz - -100 dBm

001: Max. is <-95 dBm

002: Max. is <-45 dBm V

4-20 Frequency Response

17. Frequency Response - 2.0 dB

4-21 Bandwidth Switching (Amplitude Variation)

6.

3 MHz to 300 kHz (overall variation) -0.5 dB - +0.5 dB

3 MHz to 1 kHz (overall variation) -1.0 dB - +1.0 dB

4-22 Input Attenuator Accuracy

4.

Error Between Adjacent Settings - ±0.5 dB

(1.0 dB)

5.

Error Over Full 70 dB Range - ±1.0 dB

(2.0 dB)

4-61

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 4-15. Performance Test Record (4 of 4)

Paragraph Results

Number Test Description Min. Actual Max.

4-23 Reference Level Accuracy

4.

Step Accuracy in Log

-10 dBm to -80 dBm ±0.5 dB

(1.0 dB)

-10 dBm to -100 dBm ±1.0 dB

(2.0 dB)

002: +40 dBm V to -30 dBm V

+40 dBm V to -50 dBm V

8.

Step Accuracy in LIN

-10 dBm to 80 dBm ±0.5 dB

(1.0 dB)

-10 dBm to -100 dBm ±1.0 dB

(2.0 dB)

002: +40 dBm V to -30 dBm V

+40 dBm V to -50 dBm V

11. Vernier Accuracy

REF LEVEL FINE:

-1 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-2 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-3 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-4 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-5 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-6 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-7 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-8 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-9 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-10 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-11 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

-12 -0.5 dB +0.5 dB

4-24 Display Fidelity

Log Display Accuracy

8.

Maximum Error Over Full 70 dB Display Range ±1.5 dB

(±15 mV)

10. Error Between Adjacent Readings ±1.0 dB

(±10 mV)

Linear Display Accuracy

14. Error at 4th division 3.76 div 4.24 div

15. Error at 2nd division 1.76 div 2.24 div

4-25 Calibrator Accuracy

2.

CAL OUTPUT Frequency 279.7 MHz 280.3 MHz

9.

CAL OUTPUT Amplitude -31 dBm -29 dBm

002: Min. is + 19 dBm V, Max. is +21 dBm V

4-62

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

4-63 through 4-69

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

SECTION V.

ADJUSTMENTS

5-7. Adjustment Tools 5-1. INTRODUCTION

5-2. The adjustments in this section are required to optimize spectrum analyzer performance after repair.

Table 5-1 lists adjustable components by adjustment

name, reference designation, adjustment paragraph, and description.

5-3. Data taken during adjustment should be recorded in the spaces provided. Comparison of initial data with data taken during periodic adjustments is useful for preventive maintenance and troubleshooting.

WARNING

5-8. For adjustments requiring a non-metallic tuning tool, use fiber tuning tool, HP Part Number 8170-0033.

Never try to force an adjustment control in the analyzer.

This is especially critical when tuning slug-tuned inductors and variable capacitors.

5-9. Extender Cable Installation

WARNING

The adjustments in this section require the spectrum analyzer to be removed from the display mainframe and connected through an extender cable assembly. Be very careful; the energy at some points in the instrument might, if contacted, cause personal injury. The adjustments in this section should be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazard involved.

NOTE

Before performing any adjustments, allow 1 hour warmup time.

5-4. EQUIPMENT REQUIRED

5-5. The table of Recommended Test Equipment in

Section I lists the test equipment and test accessories

required in the adjustment procedures. In addition, the table lists the required minimum specifications and suggested manufacturers' model numbers.

5-6. Required service accessories, with part

numbers, are illustrated in Section I.

Disconnect mainframe line cord before installing extender cable assembly.

5-10. Pull out the lock knob and slide the spectrum analyzer out of the display mainframe. If side stops are

installed, refer to Section II for removal.

5-11. Carefully slide the extender cable assembly,

HP part number 5060-0303, into the display mainframe, aligning the metal guide plate with the slotted side rails of the mainframe. Firmly seat the extender cable assembly to ensure good contact.

5-12. Connect the opposite end of the cable to the spectrum analyzer. The plug is keyed so it will go on correctly and will not make contact upside down.

Remove the orange and the yellow leads from pins 3 and 4 on the A15 board at the rear of the spectrum analyzer. Connect the corresponding leads from the extender cable assembly to these pins by means of the insulated alligator clips.

5-13. RELATED ADJUSTMENTS

5-14. These adjustments should be performed

whenever troubleshooting information in Section VIII

indicates that an adjustable circuit is not operating properly. Perform the adjustments after repair or replacement of the circuit. The troubleshooting

procedures and Table 5-1 specify the required

adjustments.

5-1

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

5-15.

FACTORY-SELECTED COMPONENTS

5-16.

Table 5-2 provides a list of factory-selected

components by reference designation, selection procedure paragraph number, range of values, and basis

5-2 of selection. Factory-selected components are designated by an asterisk (*) on the schematic diagrams

in Section VIII and in the table of Replaceable Parts,

Section VI. Part numbers for standard-value

components can be found in Table 5-3.

Model 8558B

+14.5V

FM

GAIN

RNG

OFS

2 ms

1 ms

+10V

Adjustment

Name

REF

2nd MIXER MATCH

Z1, Z2, Z3

2nd LO FREQUENCY

3.55 GHZ

3.55 FINE

2.0 GHZ

REF V

XTL

LC

LO FREQ

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (1 of 4)

Reference

Designator

Adjustment

Paragraph

A1A2R3

5-28

A5L2

A5Z1 A5Z3

A5Z4

A7R1

A7R2

A7R3

A7R4

A7R5

A7R6

A7R7

A7R8

A7R72

A8R13

A8R10

A8R7

A8R72

A8R85

A9L4

5-17

5-17

5-17

5-28

5-28

5-28

5-28

5-28

5-28

5-28

5-28

5-28

5-27

5-27

5-27

5-21

5-22

5-21

5-18

Description

Adjusts DPM reference voltage and adjusts frequency for correct FREQUENCY MHz readout at 1500 MHz.

Adjust for optimum match between second converter output and second IF input.

Adjust the bandpass of the 2050 MHz bandpass filter.

Adjusts second LO frequency to 1748.60 MHz.

Coarse adjustment of YIG upper frequency limit, 3.55

GHz.

Fine adjustment of YIG upper frequency limit, 3.55

GHz.

Adjusts YIG lower frequency limit, 2.05 GHz

Adjusts reference voltage to 6.0 volts and is fine adjustment of YIG lower frequency limit, 2.05 GHz.

Adjusts 14.5 volt supply to +14.5 volts.

Adjusts frequency span accuracy for frequency spans

<1 MHz per division.

Adjusts frequency for correct DPM frequency readout at 190.0 MHz.

Adjusts frequency control circuit for proper DPM ranging.

Adjusts frequency for correct FREQUENCY MHZ readout at 200 MHz.

Adjusts sweep ramp to calibrate 2 ms per division sweep time.

Adjusts sweep ramp to calibrate 1 ms per division sweep time.

Adjusts +10 volt supply. This adjustment must be performed while spectrum analyzer is still cold, during first five minutes after turn on.

Adjusts IF bandwidth between 3 dB points for

RESOLUTION BW setting of 3 kHz.

Adjusts IF bandwidth between 3 dB points for

RESOLUTION BW setting of 1 MHz.

Adjusts third converter 280 MHz crystal-controlled LO for maximum output.

5-3

Model 8558B

Adjustment

Name

SLOPE COMP

3rd LO PWR

C 1, C2, C3

2nd IF TUNING

SYM

LC CTR

CTR

SYM

LC CTR

CTR

C73

C74

LC

XTL

40 dB

10 dB

GAIN

0 dB

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (2 of 4)

Reference

Designator

A9R1

Adjustment

Paragraph

5-19

A9R5

A10C1 A10C3

A10L2

A11C15

A11C23

A11C25

A11C38

A11C45

A11C54

A11C73

A11C74

A11R26

A11R31

A12R1

A12R3

A12R4

A12R5

5-18

5-20

5-20

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-24

5-24

5-23

5-24

Description

Compensates for frequency response of input mixer, allowing flatness of less than 2 dB.

Adjusts CAL OUTPUT signal for -30 dBm power level.

002: +20 dBm V.

Adjust the bandpass of the Second IF assembly

Bandpass Filter (301.4 MHz).

Peaks second IF bandpass amplifier. Has very little effect on signal.

Adjust symmetry of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of first stage of LC bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Adjusts symmetry of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of second stage of LC bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Compensates for capacitance of CR3.

Compensates for capacitance of CR11.

Adjusts feedback in LC circuit of bandpass filter.

Adjusts feedback in crystal circuit of bandpass filter.

Adjust 40 dB step gain.

Adjusts 10 dB step gain.

Adjusts overall gain of Step Gain assembly.

Adjusts to calibrate 0 dB position of REF LEVEL FINE control.

5-4

Model 8558B

Adjustment

Name

-12 dB

+19.5V

SYM

LC CTR

CTR

SYM

LC CTR

CTR

C73

C74

LC

XTL

OFFSET

TC

SLOPE

G6

G5

G4

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (3 of 4)

Reference

Designator

A12R6

Adjustment

Paragraph

5-24

A12R7

A13C15

A13C23

A13C25

A13C38

A13C45

A13C54

A13C73

A13C74

A13R26

A13R31

A14R10

A14R21

A14R23

A14R27

A14R30

A14R33

5-25

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-21

5-26

5-26

5-26

5-26

5-26

Description

Adjusts to calibrate -12 dB position of REF LEVEL

FINE control.

Adjusts +19.5 volt supply.

Adjusts symmetry of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of first stage of LC bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of first stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Adjusts symmetry of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of second stage of LC bandwidth filter.

Adjusts centering of second stage of crystal bandwidth filter.

Compensate for capacitance of CR3.

Compensates for capacitance of CR11 .

Adjusts feedback in LC circuit of bandpass filter.

Adjusts feedback in crystal circuit of bandpass filter.

Adjusts -8V temperature compensated supply.

Adjusts gain of +1V supply to provide temperature compensation for log mode temperature controlled variable gain amplifier. (Factory adjustable only.)

Adjusts gain of log mode temperature controlled gain amplifier.

Adjusts combined gain of 2nd and 3rd stages in linear mode.

Adjusts gain of 4th stage in linear mode.

Adjusts gain of 5th stage in linear mode.

5-5

Model 8558B

Adjustment

Name

LIN

-10 dB

-30 dB

1 VT

LOG GAIN

1 dB OFFSET

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-1. Adjustable Components (4 of 4)

Reference

Designator

A14R34

Adjustment

Paragraph

5-26

A14R39

A14R69

A14R88

A14R121

A15R1

5-26

5-26

5-26

5-29

Description

Adjusts combined gain of 6th and 7th stages in linear mode.

Adjusts shape of log fidelity curve at -10 dB.

Adjusts shape of log fidelity curve at -30 dB.

Adjusts voltage at A14TP1 for approximately +1V.

(Factory adjustable only.)

Adjusts dc offset circuitry at output of A14 Log

Amplifier Assembly for 10 dB steps in log mode.

Adjusts for equal amplitude displayed at full screen in

10 dB/DIV and 1 dB/DIV for a given input.

5-6

A8R30

A8R35

A8R74

A8R76

A8R78

A9R89

A8R92

A8R95

A8R105

A8R125

A9R4

A9R9

A9R12

A9R14

A11C20

A11C44

A11R23

A11R43

A11R48

A11R56

A13C20

A13C44

A13R19

A13R23

A13R43

A13R48

A13R56

A14R93

A14R101

A14R107

A15R26

A17R1

Model 8558B

Reference

Designator

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-2. Factory Selected Components in Alpha-Numerical Order

Selection

Procedure

Paragraph

Number

Basis of Selection

5-22

5-22

5-22

5-18

5-22

5-22

5-22

5-22

5-22

5-22

5-22

Selected to set start of sweep ramp to -5.OOOV ±30 mV.

Selected to set high end of sweep ramp to +5V.

Selected to optimize 1 kHz bandwidth.

Selected to optimize 3 kHz bandwidth.

Selected to optimize 10 kHz bandwidth.

Selected to optimize 300 kHz bandwidth.

Selected to optimize 1 MHz bandwidth.

Selected to optimize 3 MHz bandwidth.

Selected for OV at A8TP8 with START CENTER switch in START, 100 MHz/DIV, single scan mode (no sweep).

Selected for optimum automatic sweep time with VIDEO FILTER on (but not in detent).

Selected for proper Third Converter LO power.

Selected for proper CAL OUTPUT power.

Selected for proper gain of Third Converter.

Selected for proper REF LEVEL CAL range.

Selected to shift adjustment range of A11C23.

Selected to shift adjustment range of A11C45.

Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.

Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 100 kHz.

Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.

Selected to equalize feedback between LC stages (not field selectable).

Selected to shift adjustment range of A13C23.

Selected to shift adjustment range of A13C45.

Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 100 kHz.

Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.

Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 100 kHz.

Selected to give correct IF bandwidth for RESOLUTION BW of 30 kHz.

Selected to equalize feedback between LC stages (not field selectable).

Selected to shift adjustment range of A14R34.

Selected to shift adjustment range of A14R34.

Selected to shift adjustment range of A14R23.

Selected to provide increased range adjustment for 1 dB offset circuit.

Selected for proper voltage offset of A17Q1 and A17Q2 to ensure initial turn-on of oscillator.

5-7

Model 8558B

RANGE: 1 to 24 pF

TYPE: Tubular

TOLERANCE:

1 to 9.1 pF = ±.25 pF

10 to 24 pF = ±5%

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-3. HP Part Numbers of Standard Value Replacement Components (1 of 3)

CAPACITORS

RANGE: 27 to 680 pF

TYPE: Dipped Mica

TOLERANCE: ±5%

Value

(pF)

3.6

3.9

4.3

4.7

5.1

2.2

2.4

2.7

3.0

3.3

1.0

1.2

1.5

1.8

2.0

5.6

6.2

6.8

7.5

8.2

9.1

10.0

11.0

12.0

13.0

15.0

16.0

18.0

20.0

22.0

24.0

HP Part Number

0160-2236

0160-2237

0150-0091

0160-2239

0160-2240

0160-2241

0160-2242

0160-2243

0160-2244

0150-0059

0160-2246

0160-2247

0160-2248

0160-2249

0160-2250

0160-2251

0160-2252

0160-2253

0160-2254

0160-2255

OloO-2256

0160-2257

0160-2258

0160-2259

0160-2260

0160-2261

0160-2262

0160-2263

0160-2264

0160-2265

0160-2266

0

3

6

1

2

5

6

7

8

8

8

1

4

8

9

9

0

1

7

8

9

0

1

2

3

2

3

4

5

8

4

C

D

5-8

Value

(pF)

68

75

82

91

100

110

120

130

150

160

180

200

220

240

43

47

51

56

62

27

30

33

36

330

360

390

430

470

510

560

620

680

HP Part Number

0160-2306

0160-2199

0160-2150

0160-2308

0160-2200

0160-2307

0160-2201

0140-0191

0140-0205

0140-0192

0160-2202

0140-0193

0160-2203

0160-2204

0140-0194

0160-2205

0140-0195

0140-0196

0160-2206

0140-0197

0140-0198

0160-0134

0140-0199

0160-2208

0160-2209

0140-0200

0160-0939

0160-3533

0160-3534

0160-3535

0160-3536

0160-3537

1

2

3

2

0

1

0

9

9

8

1

6

4

5

6

4

7

8

5

5

5

3

2

C

D

0

3

4

1

2

4

5

0

4

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-3. HP Part Numbers of Standard Value Replacement Components (2 of 3)

RESISTORS

RANGE: 10 to 464 K Ohms

TYPE: Fixed-Film

WATTAGE: .125 at 125

°

C

TOLERANCE: ±1.0%

Value

(

Ω)

75.0

82.5

90.9

100

110

121

133

38.3

42.2

46.4

51.1

56.2

61.9

68.1

17.8

19.6

21.5

23.7

26.1

28.7

31.6

34.8

10.0

11.0

12.1

13.3

14.7

16.2

147

162

178

196

215

237

261

287

316

348

383

422

HP Part Number

0698-3435

0757-0316

0698-4037

0757-0394

0757-0395

0757-0276

0757-0397

0757-0398

0757-0399

0757-0400

0757-0401

0757-0402

0757-0403

0698-3437

0757-0346

0757-0378

0757-0379

0698-3427

0698-3428

0757-0382

0757-0294

0698-3429

0698-3430

0698-3431

0698-3432

0698-3433

0757-0180

0698-3434

0698-3438

0757-0405

0698-3439

0698-3440

0698-3441

0698-3442

0698-3132

0698-3443

0698-3444

0698-3445

0698-3446

0698-3447

C Value

D

2

2

0

1

4

5

9

7

3

0

1

0

6

0

2

9

7

8

5

6

9

2

0

1

6

2

0

1

2

3

0

1

4

9

4

7

8

3

4

4

(

Ω)

1.78K

1.96K

2.15K

2.37K

2.61K

2.87K

3.16K

3.48K

3.83K

4.22K

4.64K

5.11K

5.62K

6.19K

464

511

562

619

681

750

825

909

1.0K

1.1K

1.21K

1.33K

1.47K

1.62K

6.81K

7.50K

8.25K

9.09K

10.0K

11.0K

12.1K

13.3K

14.7K

16.2K

17.8K

19.6K

HP Part Number

0757-0278

0698-0083

0698-0084

0698-3150

0698-0085

0698-3151

0757-0279

0698-3152

0698-3153

0698-3154

0698-3155

0757-0438

0757-0200

0757-0290

0698-0082

0757-0416

0757-0417

0757-0418

0757-0419

0757-0420

0757-0421

0757-0422

0757-0280

0757-0424

0757-0274

0757-0317

0757-1094

0757-0428

0757-0439

0757-0440

0757-0441

0757-0288

0757-0442

0757-0443

0757-0444

0757-0289

0698-3156

0757-0447

0698-3136

0698-3157

5-9

C

D

4

8

2

2

3

7

5

1

3

8

9

0

7

0

6

0

9

8

9

9

1

5

7

3

7

4

5

9

0

3

7

7

8 o

1

1

9

4

7

8

Value

(

Ω)

21.5K

23.7K

26.1K

28.7K

31.6K

34.8K

38.3K

42.2K

46.4K

51.1K

56.2K

61.9K

68.1K

75.0K

162K

178K

196K

215K

237K

261K

287K

82.5K

90.9K

100K

110K

121K

133K

147K

316K

348K

383K

422K

464K

HP Part Number

0757-0463

0757-0464

0757-0465

0757-0466

0757-0467

0698-3451

0698-3452

0757-0470

0698-3243

0698-3453

0698-3454

0698-3266

0698-3455

0698-3456

0757-0199

0698-3158

0698-3159

0698-3449

0698-3160

0757-0123

0698-3161

0698-3450

0698-3162

0757-0458

0757-0459

0757-0460

0757-0461

0757-0462

0698-3457

0698-3458

0698-3459

0698-3460

0698-3260

4

5

3

5

3

8

2

0

1

7

8

4

5

6

6

7

8

1

9

2

3

8

1

0

7

9

9

6

8

3

3

4

5

C

D

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-3. HP Part Numbers of Standard Value Replacement Components (3 of 3)

RESISTORS

RANGE: 10 to 1.47M Ohms

TYPE: Fixed-Film

WATTAGE: .5 at 125°C

TOLERANCE:

±

1%

HP Part

Number

0757-0984

0575-0985

0757-0986

0757-0001

0698-3388

0757-0989

0698-3389

0698-3390

0698-3391

0698-3392

0757-0003

0698-3393

0698-3394

0698-3395

0698-3396

0698-3397

0698-3398

0757-1000

0757-1001

0757-1002

0757-0794

0757-0795

0757-0796

0757-0797

0757-0198

0757-0798

0757-0799

0698-3399

0698-3400

0757-0802

0698-3334

0757-1060

Value

(

Ω)

68.1

75.0

82.5

90.0

100

110

121

34.8

38.3

42.2

46.4

51.1

56.2

61.9

17.8

19.6

21.5

23.7

26.1

28.7

31.6

10.0

11.0

12.1

13.3

14.7

16.2

133

147

162

178

196

8

9

7

2

4

5

6

8

9

4

7

1

2

3

5

8

5

9

9

9

0

8

8

3

6

7

2

9

6

6

4

5

C

D

Value HP Part

(

Ω)

Number

215 0698-3401 0

237 0698-3102 8

261 0757-1090 5

287 0757-1092 7

316 0698-3402 1

348 0698-3403 2

383 0698-3404 3

422 0698-3405 4

464 0698-0090 7

511 0757-0814 9

562 0757-0815 0

619 0757-0158 4

681 0757-0816 1

750 0757-0817 2

825 0757-0818 3

909 0757-0819 4

1.00K

0757-0159 5

1.10K

0757-0820 7

1.21K

0757-0821 8

1.33K

0698-3406 5

1.47K

0757-1078 9

1.62K

0757-0873 0

1.78K

0698-0089 4

1.96K

0698-3407 6

2.15K

0698-3408 7

2.37K

0698-3409 8

2.61K

0698-0024 7

2.87K

0698-3101 7

3.16K

0698-3410 1

3.48K

0698-3411 2

3.83K

0698-3412 3

4.22K

0698-3346 2

C Value

D (

Ω)

HP Part

Number

C

D

4.64K

0698-3348 4

5.11K

0757-0833 2

5.62K

0757-0834 3

6.19K

0757-0196 0

6.81K

0757-0835 4

7.50K

0757-0836 5

8.25K

0757-0837 6

9.09K

0757-0838 7

10.0K

0757-0839 8

12.1K

0757-0841 2

13.3K

0698-3413 4

14.7K

0698-3414 5

16.2K

0757-0844 5

17.8K

0698-0025 8

19.6K

0698-3415 6

21.5K

0698-3416 7

23.7K

0698-3417 8

26.1K

0698-3418 9

28.7K

0698-3103 9

31.6K

0698-3419 0

34.8K

0698-3420 3

38.3K

0698-3421 4

42.2K

0698-3422 5

46.4K

0698-3423 6

51.1K

0757-0853 6

56.2K

0757-0854 7

61.9K

0757-0309 7

68.1K

0757-0855 8

75.0K

0757-0856 9

82.5K

0757-0857 0

90.9K

0757-0858 1

100K 0757-0367 7

Value HP Part C

(

Ω)

Number D

110K 0757-0859 2

121K 0757-0860 5

133K 0757-0310 0

147K 0698-3175 5

162K 0757-0130 2

178K 0757-0129 9

196K 0757-0063 0

215K 0757-0127 7

237K 0698-3424 7

261K 0757-0064 1

287K 0757-0154 0

316K 0698-3425 8

348K 0757-0195 9

383K 0757-0133 5

422K 0757-0134 6

464K 0698-3426 9

51IK 0757-0135 7

562K 0757-0868 3

619K 0757-0136 8

681K 0757-0869 4

750K 0757-0137 9

825K 0757-0870 7

909K 0757-0138 0

1M 0757-0059 4

1.M

0757-0139 1

1.21M

0757-0871 8

1.33M

0757-0194 8

1.47M

0698-3464 5

5-10

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 5-4. Related Adjustments

Assembly Charged or Repaired Perform the Following Related Adjustments

Paragraph

Number

A1

A2

A3

A4

AS

A6

A7

A8

A9

A10

A11,

A13*

A12

A14

A15

A16

A17

Digital Panel Meter A1A2R3

Front Switch A12RS, A12R6

Input Attenuator

First Converter

No related adjustments

A9R1

Second Converter A5Z1, A5Z2, A5Z3, A5Z4, A5L2

YIG Oscillator A1A2R3, A7R1, A7R2, A7R3, A7R4, A7R6, A7R7,

A7R8, A7R72

Frequency Control A5Z4

A1A2R3, A7R1, A7R2, A7R3, A7R4, A7R5, A7R6,

A7R7, A7R72

Sweep Generator A8R2, A8R10, A8R13, A8R72, A8R85

A9L4, A9R5, A9R1 Third Converter

Second IF

Bandwidth Filters

A10C1, A10C2, A10C3, A10L2

A11C15, A11C23, A11C25, A11C38, A11C45, A11C54, A11C73,

A11C74, A13C15, A13C23, A13C25, A13C38, A13C45, A13C54,

A13C73, A13C74, A8R72, A8R85

A12R1, A12R2, A12R3, A12R4, A12R5, A12R6, A12R7 Step Gain

Log Amplifier

Vertical Driver and Blanking

Motherboard

Inverter

A14R23, A14R27, A14R30, A14R33, A14R34, A14R39,

A14R69, A14R121

A15R1

No related adjustments

No related adjustments

5-28

5-24

5-19

5-17

5-28

5-17

5-28

5-22, 5-27

5-18, 5-19

5-20

5-21,5-22

5-23 - 5-25

5-26

5-29

5-29

*A11 and A13 bandwidth filter assemblies contain a matched set of crystals. These two assemblies must be treated as a matched pair when replacement is necessary.

5-11

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-17.

SECOND CONVERTER LO AND BANDPASS ADJUSTMENTS

REFERENCE

A5 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

The second converter is adjusted for 1748.60 MHz and the bandpass filter is adjusted for a 2050 MHz Bandpass.

Figure 5-1. Second Converter LO and Bandpass Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Frequency Counter.................................................................................................................... HP 5342A

Comb Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8406A

Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001

Adapter, SMC (m) to SMC (m) ............................................................................................ HP 1250-0827

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f). .......................................................................................... HP 1250-0780

Special Adapter.................................................................................................................. See Figure 5-2

BNC Cable 120 cm (48 in) .......................................................................................................HP 10503A

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω................................................................................ HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

Ω ....................................................................................HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ................................................................................................ HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC(f) to SMA (m)................................................................................................ HP 1250-1200

5-12

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-17.

SECOND CONVERTER LO AND BANDPASS ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

NOTE

The special adapter in Figure 5-1 is made from a SMC (f) to SMC (f) adapter, HP Part No. 1250-

1113. The nuts must be soldered to the body of the subminiature RF adapter so they will both

turn with the body. Be sure to space the nuts properly before soldering (see Figure 5-2).

MAXIMUM SPACE

(PULL NUT TO END

OF BODY, BOTH SIDES)

Figure 5-2. Special Adapter Used in Second Converter LO and Bandpass Test Setup

PROCEDURE

1.

Set equipment as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

START - CENTER ...................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 300 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ........................................................................................................................ 100 MHz

RESOLUTION BW......................................................................................................... 1 MHz (optimum)

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -30 dBm

002: +20dBmV

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................ 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN

Frequency Counter

10 Hz-500 MHz/500 MHz- 18 GHz ................................................................................ 500 MHz- 18 GHz

SAMPLE RATE........................................................................................................ Full counterclockwise

Comb Generator

COMB FREQUENCY ..................................................................................................................... 100MC

INTERPOLATION AMPLITUDE ......................................................................................................... OFF

5-13

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

11.

12.

13.

6.

7.

8.

5-17.

SECOND CONVERTER LO AND BANDPASS ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

2.

3.

4.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-1 and switch display mainframe power ON. Connect counter to A5J3

at the top of A5 Converter Assembly. Connect comb generator to HP 8558B INPUT.

Adjust second LO FREQUENCY adjustment A5Z4 for 1748.60 40.2 MHz. Use Allen wrench through center of drilled-out 5/16-inch nut driver to enable nut to be tightened without shifting frequency.

Set comb generator for 100 MHz comb.

5.

Center a 100 MHz comb tooth using 8558B TUNING control. Turn FREQ SPAN/DIV control to 2 MHz and uncoupled RESOLUTION BW control to 300 kHz, keeping comb tooth centered on display.

Loosen lock nut on A5Z1 and A5Z2. Carefully turn tuning screws clockwise until they bottom on cavity.

Turn A5Z1 and A5Z2 one turn counterclockwise and lightly tighten lock nuts.

Loosen lock nut on A5Z3, and adjust A5Z3 for peak signal on display. Make final adjustment with Amplitude

Scale switch in LIN position. It might be necessary to increase gain to see signal in linear mode. Leave in LIN position.

9.

10.

Adjust A5Z1 for peak signal on display. Reduce REFERENCE LEVEL as necessary to keep signal on display.

Repeat A5Z1 and A5Z3 adjustments for maximum signal on display.

Adjust A5Z2 for maximum signal on display. Reduce REFERENCE LEVEL as necessary to keep signal on display.

Carefully tighten lock nuts on A5Z1, A5Z2, and A5Z3 so that signal does not change on display.

Adjust A5L2 2nd MIXER MATCH adjustment for maximum signal.

Check second LO frequency. If frequency error is greater than 4i0.5 MHz, repeat step 3.

5-14

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-18.

THIRD CONVERTER LO AND CAL OUTPUT ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A9 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

The third converter LO frequency is adjusted for maximum output, and power is adjusted for -30 dBm

±

1.0 dB CAL

OUTPUT. The third LO frequency is checked for 280 MHz

±

300 kHz.

002: +20 dBmV

±1.0dB

Figure 5-3. Third Converter LO and CAL OUTPUT Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Amplifier ................................................................................................................................... HP 8447A

Power Meter................................................................................................................................ HP 435B

Power Sensor............................................................................................................................ HP 8482A

Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

10 dB Step Attenuator (calibrated at 280 MHz)........................................................... HP 355D, Opt. H82

300 MHz LPF ........................................................................................................... Telonic TLP 300-4AB

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) ........................................................................ HP 1250-0780

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Power Sensor, 75

Ω, HP 8483A

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

Ω to 50Ω................................................................................ HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC(m), 75

Ω ......................................................................................HP 1250-1288

BNC Cable, 30 cm (12 in), 75

Ω ....................................................................................... HP 11652-60012

5-15

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

3.

4.

5.

6.

7.

8.

5-18.

THIRD CONVERTER LO AND CAL OUTPUT ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set equipment as follows:

2.

9.

START- CENTER ....................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ..........................................................................................................................500 kHz

RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL dBm................................................................................................................... -20

002: + 30 dBm V

Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

Signal Generator:

OUTPUT LEVEL ........................................................................................................................ + 10 dBm

FREQUENCY ............................................................................................................................. 280 MHz

AM .................................................................................................................................................... OFF

FM .................................................................................................................................................... OFF

RF ...................................................................................................................................................... ON

COUNTER MODE................................................................................................................................INT

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-3. Connect CAL OUTPUT to INPUT 50( connector.

001 and 002: 75

Center the 280 MHz signal on the display.

Adjust A9L4 third converter LO FREQ adjustment for maximum signal amplitude.

Tune signal generator to frequency of third converter LO (280 MHz

±

300 kHz).

Connect signal generator through 300 MHz LPF to calibrated step attenuator. Set step attenuator to 10 dB.

Connect power sensor and power meter to step attenuator as shown in Figure 5-3.

Set signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for a 0 dBm full scale reading on power meter. Leave signal generator set at this level.

001: +5.7 dBm

002: + 7.0

Set step attenuator to 40 dB and connect the reference signal set in step 8 (from signal generator through step attenuator) to the 8558B INPUT 50

connector.

001 and 002: INPUT 75

Ω connector using Minimum Loss Adapter and 75Ω BNC Cable.

5-16

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-18.

THIRD CONVERTER LO AND CAL OUTPUT ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

10.

11.

12.

Set signal from signal generator to a convenient reference level on display with REFERENCE LEVEL and REF

LEVEL FINE controls.

Disconnect signal generator and connect spectrum analyzer CAL OUTPUT to the INPUT 500 connector.

001 and 002: 75

Adjust A9R5 3RD LO PWR adjustment, accessible from bottom of analyzer through motherboard, to the reference set in step 10. (If range is insufficient on A9R5, change value of factory-selected resistor A9R4*.)

13.

Connect CAL OUTPUT to amplifier input and connect amplifier output to COUNTER INPUT of 8640B. Set HP

8640B COUNTER MODE to EXT EXPAND X10. The third LO frequency should read 280 MHz

±

300 kHz.

5-17

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-19.

SLOPE ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A9 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

An externally leveled signal is applied to the INPUT of the spectrum analyzer. The signal is adjusted across the frequency range of the spectrum analyzer. A9R1 SLOPE COMP is adjusted for best flatness, compensating for first converter conversion loss over frequency.

Figure 5-4. Slope Adjustment Test Setup

5-18

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-19.

SLOPE ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

EQUIPMENT

Sweep Oscillator*...................................................................................................................... HP 8350A

RF Plug-In* ..............................................................................................................................HP 83522A

Power Splitter...........................................................................................................................HP 11667A

Crystal Detector .......................................................................................................................... HP 423B

10-dB Attenuator ........................................................................................................ HP 8491B Opt. 010

Adapter, Type N (m) to Type N (m) ..................................................................................... HP 1250-1475

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................HP 10503A

Type N Cable ...........................................................................................................................HP 11500A

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

*8620C/86222A may be substituted

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 752 to 50

................................................................................ HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC(m) to BNC (m), 75

..................................................................................... HP 1250-1288

Adapter, Type N (m) to SMA (f)........................................................................................... HP 1250-1250

PROCEDURE

1.

Set equipment as follows:

2.

Spectrum Analyzer

START - CENTER ...................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 500 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ........................................................................................................................ 100 MHz

RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -10 dBm

002: +40dBmV

REF LEVEL FINE ................................................................................................................................... 0

Amplitude Scale .......................................................................................................................... 1 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO

BASELINE CLIPPER ......................................................................................................................... OFF

VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF

Sweep Oscillator

START.......................................................................................................................................... 10 MHz

STOP........................................................................................................................................... 1.5 GHz

SWEEP .............................................................................................................................................MAN

POWER LEVEL .............................................................................................................................. 0 dBm

ALC MODE .........................................................................................................................................EXT

FREQUENCY/TIME .................................................................................................................... 500 MHz

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-4.

5-19

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

8.

9.

6.

7.

5-19.

SLOPE ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

3.

4.

5.

Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL FINE to bring signal peak on display.

Set spectrum analyzer START - CENTER to CENTER. Manually tune sweep oscillator for output frequencies from 10 MHz to 1.0 GHz. Set spectrum analyzer START - CENTER to START. Manually tune sweep oscillator for output frequencies from 1.0 GHz to 1.5 GHz.

Using procedure of step 4, locate highest displayed amplitude. Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL FINE to bring highest displayed amplitude to fifth CRT graticule line from bottom.

Using procedure of step 4, locate lowest displayed amplitude.

Adjust spectrum analyzer A9R1 SLOPE COMP for minimum difference between highest and lowest displayed amplitudes.

Repeat steps 5, 6, and 7 until no further adjustment is necessary.

With highest displayed amplitude set to fifth graticule line from bottom lowest displayed amplitude should be at or above third graticule line from bottom.

5-20

Model 8558B

ADJUSTMENTS

5-20.

SECOND IF BANDPASS AMPLIFIER AND BANDPASS FILTER ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A10 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

Tune bandpass amplifier output and bandpass filter.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 5-5. Second IF Bandpass Amplifier and Bandpass Filter Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ........................................................................................... HP 1250-0780

Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

PROCEDURE

1.

2.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

FREQ SPAN/DIV ........................................................................................................................ 100 MHz

RESOLUTION................................................................................................................................. 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .................................................................................................................. - 10 dBm

002: +40 dBmV

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................ 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN

Set signal generator frequency to 301.4 MHz and set output level to approximately - 35 dBm.

5-21

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

7.

8.

5-20.

SECOND IF BANDPASS AMPLIFIER AND BANDPASS FILTER ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

NOTE

3.

4.

5.

6.

9.

If 8640B is not used, adjust the signal generator for maximum signal on the display in step 3.

Remove W6P2 from Second IF A10J1. Connect signal generator through test cable to A10J1 as shown in

Figure 5-5.

Adjust bandpass filter capacitors A10C1, A10C2, and A10C3 on Second IF Assembly fully counterclockwise.

Adjust REFERENCE LEVEL if necessary for an on-screen display.

Adjust A10C1 for maximum signal amplitude. Make final adjustment with Amplitude Scale switch in LIN position.

Leave switch in LIN position. Use REFERENCE LEVEL and REF LEVEL FINE controls to keep signal on top half of display.

Adjust A10C3 for maximum signal amplitude. There may be a double peak; tune past first peak to second peak.

Signal on display will peak and fall off slightly and then peak again.

Repeat steps 5 and 6 adjusting A10C1 and A10C3 for maximum amplitude.

Adjust A10C2 for maximum signal amplitude. There may be a double peak; tune to second peak. Reduce input signal level to keep signal on display.

NOTE

The following adjustment of A10L2 has very little effect on the signal or performance of the spectrum analyzer. A10L2 need not be adjusted because the position of the core is not critical.

Adjust A10L2 2ND IF TUNING adjustment for maximum signal amplitude. L2 is adjusted through motherboard on bottom of analyzer. Reconnect W6P2 to A10J1.

5-22

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-21.

CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS

REFERENCE

A8, A11, and A13 Schematics

DESCRIPTION

The crystal and LC bandwidth filter circuits are adjusted for symmetry, center, and peak. Three-dB bandwidths are adjusted on the Sweep Generator Assembly A8 (paragraph 5-22).

Figure 5-6. Crystal and LC Bandwidth Filter Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ........................................................................................... HP 1250-0780

BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ..........................................................................................................HP 10502A

Crystal Short (3 Required)................................................................................................. See Figure 5-7.

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

BNC Cable, 30 cm (12 in), 75

Ω ................................................................................. HP 11652-60012

NOTE

A crystal short consists of a .01

µF capacitor (HP Part No. 0160-0161) and a 90.9 ohm resistor (HP

Part No. 0757-0400) connected in series. Two square-terminal connectors (HP Part No. 0362-

0265) are used to connect the crystal short across the test points.

5-23

Model 8558B

ADJUSTMENTS

5-21.

CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

3.

4.

Figure 5-7. Crystal Short Configuration

PROCEDURE

1.

NOTE

Allow 30 minutes warmup time before performing adjustments.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START- CENTER ....................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................. 5 kHz

RESOLUTION BW........................................................................................................................... 1 kHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -20 dBm

002: + 30 dBmV

Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV ..................................................................................................................... 10 mSEC

SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN

Crystal Alignment

2.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-6.

NOTE

If A8 Sweep Generator has been replaced or adjusted, perform steps 3 through 9. If not, proceed to step 10.

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz.

Center the signal with TUNING control. Using REF LEVEL FINE control, place signal at 7.1 divisions (0.9

division from top graticule line).

5-24

Model 8558B

ADJUSTMENTS

5-21.

CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

8.

9.

10.

5.

6.

7.

11.

12.

Figure 5-8. Adjusting Crystal Symmetry and Crystal Centering

Adjust A8R85 LC until signal is two divisions wide at the fifth graticule line (1 MH4z. wide at; 3-dB points).

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz.

Using REF LEVEL FINE control, place signal at 7.1 divisions.

Adjust A8R72 XTL until signal is two divisions wide- at the fifth graticule line (10 kHz wide at 3-dB points).

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz.

Center signal with TUNING control. (It might be necessary to increase FREQ SPAN/DIV temporarily to find the signal.) Set REF LEVEL FINE control to place signal at sixth graticule line.

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz.

NOTE

A non-metallic tuning tool is required for adjustments on the Al1 and A13 bandwidth filter assemblies.

Connect crystal shorts (through cover access holes) across A13TP1/TP2, A11TP1/TP2, and A11TP4/TP5.

5-25

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-21.

CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Co nt'd)

NOTE

Keep crystal spike centered during adjustments. The SYM and CTR adjustments for each crystal interact.

13.

14.

15.

16.

17.

18.

19.

20.

Adjust front-panel TUNING control to center bandpass spike (Figure 5-8) on the CRT display.

Adjust A13C38 SYM and A13C54 CTR for a centered and symmetrical bandpass as shown in Figure 5-8. Adjust

A13C54 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.

Remove crystal short from A13TP1/TP2 and connect it across A13TP4/TP5.

Adjust A13C15 SYM and A13C25 CTR for a centered and symmetrical bandpass. Adjust A13C25 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.

Remove crystal short from A11TP4/TP5 and connect it across A13TP1/TP2.

Adjust A11C38 SYM and A11C54 CTR for a centered and symmetrical bandpass. Adjust A11C54 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.

Remove crystal short from A11TP1/TP2 and connect it across A11TP4/TP5.

Adjust A11C15 SYM and A11C25 CTR for a centered and symmetrical bandpass. Adjust A11C25 CTR for minimum signal amplitude.

21.

Remove the crystal shorts.

LC Alignment

22.

Perform preliminary LC filter adjustments as follows: a. Install A13 on extender board. Set RESOLUTION BW control to 100 kHz.

b. Short to ground the following test points: A13TP6, A11TP3, and A11TP6. Jumper A8TP1 to A8TP2.

c. Adjust A13C73 for minimum signal amplitude.

d. Disconnect short from A13TP6 and short to ground A13TP3.

e. Adjust A13C74 for minimum signal amplitude.

f. Reinstall A13 and install A11 on extender board.

g. Disconnect short from A11TP3 and short to ground A13TP6.

h. Adjust A11C73 for minimum signal amplitude.

i. Disconnect short from A11TP6 and short to ground A11TP3.

5-26

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-21.

CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd) j. Adjust A11C74 for minimum signal amplitude.

k. Disconnect shorts from test points and reinstall A11. Replace covers on A11 and A13 assemblies. Remove jumper from A8TP1/A8TP2.

NOTE

23.

24.

25.

26.

27.

When A11 and A13 BW Filter Assemblies are installed with covers in place, midget copper alligator clips (HP Part No. 1400-0483) can be used to short test points to the cover.

Carefully center signal on CRT in 30 kHz RESOLUTION BW; then switch RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

Adjust A13C45 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

Switch RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz and center signal; then switch to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

Adjust A13C23 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

Switch RESOLUTION BW to 30 KHz and center signal; then switch to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

33.

34.

35.

28.

Adjust A11C45 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

29.

30.

31.

Switch RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz and center signal; then switch to 100 kHz. Note where signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

Adjust A11C23 LC CTR for maximum signal amplitude where the signal intersects the center vertical graticule line.

Switch RESOLUTION BW between 100 kHz and 30 kHz to be sure the signal is centered at both bandwidth settings.

Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz. Center signal with TUNING control.

32.

Bandwidth Amplitude

Set A11R31 XTL and A13R31 XTL fully counterclockwise.

Set Amplitude Scale switch to 1 dB/DIV.

Jumper A8TP1 to A8TP2. Short A11TP3, A11TP6, A13TP3, and A13TP6 to ground.

5-27

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

39.

40.

41.

5-21.

CRYSTAL AND LC BANDWIDTH FILTER ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

36.

37.

38.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 kHz.

Adjust fine TUNING and REF LEVEL FINE for a centered signal at 7 divisions.

Remove shorts from A13TP3 and A13TP6 and center signal with fine TUNING control. Adjust A13R26 LC for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.

Remove shorts from Al1TP3 and Al1TP6. Adjust A11R26 LC for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.

Repeat steps 35 through 39 until no further adjustment is necessary.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz. Center signal with fine TUNING control. Adjust

A11 R31 XTL and Al3R31 XTL equally for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.

NOTE

Each potentiometer should be adjusted to accomplish half the necessary increase in signal amplitude.

42. Remove jumper from A8TP1 and A8TP2.

43. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 100 MHz and RESOLUTION BW to 3 MHz and push in to couple the two controls.

44. Turn coupled controls to set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 MHz and RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz. Center signal with

TUNING control. Adjust REF LEVEL FINE for a signal amplitude of 7 divisions.

45. With controls coupled, step down RESOLUTION BW from 1 MHz to 300 kHz. Variation in signal amplitude should be less than

±

0.4 dB.

46. Step down RESOLUTION BW from 100 kHz to 1 kHz. Variation of signal amplitude should be less than

±

0.5 dB.

47. Repeat steps 35 through 46 until variation in signal amplitude is within limits.

5-28

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-22.

3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A8 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

The 3-dB bandwidths for the 3 MHz, 1 MHz and 300 kHz RESOLUTION BW settings are adjusted using the CAL

OUTPUT as the signal source. The 3-dB bandwidths for the 10 kHz, 3 kHz, and 1 kHz RESOLUTION BW settings are adjusted by injecting a stable 301.4 MHz signal into the third converter of the spectrum analyzer.

Figure 5-9. 3-dB Bandwidth Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

Frequency Counter.................................................................................................................... HP 5343A

10 dB Step Attenuator ................................................................................................................. HP 355D

BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in) ..........................................................................................................HP 10502A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (3 requird).......................................................................... HP 1250-0780

BNC Tee ............................................................................................................................. HP 1250-0781

Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

5-29

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-22.

3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

2.

3.

4.

5.

START - CENTER ...................................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ..........................................................................................................................200 kHz

RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................... 0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ................................................................................................................... -20 dBm

Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV ....................................................................................................................... 1 mSEC

SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN

VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-9 except for signal input to A9J1. Connect CAL OUTPUT to spectrum

analyzer INPUT 50(.

Set signal level of 7.1 divisions on display with REF LEVEL FINE control. (Signal should be 0.9 division from top graticule line.)

Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 200 kHz. Adjust A8R85 LC to set bandwidth of 5 divisions at the fifth graticule line.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz. The bandwidth at the fifth graticule line should be between 5.4 and 6.6 divisions.

NOTE

6.

7.

A8R85 LC may be further adjusted to bring the 3 MHz and 300 kHz bandwidths within limits; however, the final measurement of the 1 MHz bandwidth must be between 4.5 and 5.5 divisions at the fifth graticule line. (If the 3 MHz bandwidth cannot be brought within limits by adjustment of

A8R85 LC, change the value of factory-selected resistor A8R95*.)

Set RESOLUTION BW to 300 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 50 kHz. The bandwidth should be between 5.4 and

6.6 divisions at the fifth graticule line. (If the bandwidth cannot be adjusted within the specified limits, change the value of factory-selected resistor A8R89*.)

Set RESOLUTION BW to 100 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 20 kHz. The bandwidth should be between 4.3 and

5.7 divisions at the fifth graticule line.

NOTE

If the 100 kHz bandwidth is not within the specified limits, change the values of factory-selected resistors A13R19*, A13R43*, and A11R43*. If the bandwidth is too wide, increase the value of the resistors; if the bandwidth is too narrow, decrease the value of the resistors. The three factoryselected resistors need not be of equal value, but each must be within one standard value of the others.

5-30

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

18.

19.

20.

12.

13.

14.

5-22.

3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd )

8.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 30 kHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 5 kHz. The bandwidth should be between 5.2 and 6.8

divisions at the fifth graticule line.

9.

NOTE

If the 30 kHz bandwidth is not within the specified limits, change the values of factory-selected resistors A11R23*, A11R48*, A13R23*, and A13R48*. If the bandwidth is too wide, decrease the value of the factory selected resistors; if the bandwidth is too narrow, increase the value of the resistors. The four factory-selected resistors need not be of equal value, but each must be within one standard value of the others.

Connect signal generator through the BNC Tee connector to the step attenuator and to the frequency counter as

shown in Figure 5-9. Set the signal generator to approximately 0 dBm and the step attenuator to 30 dB. Set

COUNTER MODE to EXPAND X100.

Remove W7P2 from Third Converter A9J1. Connect step attenuator through test cable to A9J1.

10.

11.

Set HP 8558B RESOLUTION BW to 1 MHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display (near 301.4

MHz). Adjust the output level of signal generator to place the signal at 7.1 divisions.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 3 kHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display.

Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to place signal at 7.1 divisions.

15.

16.

17.

Note the counter frequency and tune the signal generator 1500 Hz below the center frequency noted. Record the new counter frequency.

Adjust A8R72 XTL to bring signal level to the fifth graticule line (three divisions from the top graticule line).

Increase signal generator frequency until signal on CRT display peaks and then decreases to the fifth graticule line. Record counter frequency.

Compare new frequency with frequency recorded in step 14. The difference between the two frequencies should be 2800 to 3200 Hz. If the bandwidth is not within limits, repeat steps 12 through 17, slightly readjusting A8R72

XTL, until the specified limits are achieved.

Set RESOLUTION BW to 10 kHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display.

21.

22.

Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to place signal at 7.1 divisions.

Note the counter frequency and tune the signal generator 5 kHz below the center frequency noted. Record the new counter frequency.

Increase the signal generator frequency until the signal on the CRT display peaks and then decreases to the fifth graticule line. Record counter frequency.

Compare new frequency with frequency recorded in step 20. The difference between the two frequencies should be 9.000 kHz to 11.000 kHz.

5-31

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

23.

24.

25.

5-22.

3-dB BANDWIDTH ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

26.

27.

NOTE

A8R72 XTL may be further adjusted to bring the 10 kHz and 1 kHz bandwidths within limits; however, the final measurement of the 3 kHz bandwidth must be between 2700 Hz and 3300 Hz.

(If the 10 kHz bandwidth cannot be brought within limits by adjustment of A8R72 XTL, change the value of factory-selected resistor A8R78*.)

Set RESOLUTION BW to 1 kHz. Tune signal generator to peak signal on CRT display.

Adjust REF LEVEL FINE to place signal at 7.1 divisions.

Note the counter frequency. Increase signal generator frequency until signal on CRT display peaks and then decreases to the fifth graticule line. Record new counter frequency.

Compare new frequency with frequency originally noted in step 25. The difference between the two frequencies should be 450 Hz to 550 Hz.

Reconnect W7P2 to A9J1.

5-32

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-23.

STEP GAIN ASSEMBLY RF GAIN ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A12 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

The RF gain (sensitivity) of the Step Gain assembly is adjusted by injecting a 21.4 MHz signal at A16XA9. The Third

Converter Assembly A9 is removed and replaced with a special extender board for applying the 21.4 MHz signal from the signal generator.

Figure 5-10. Step Gain Assembly RF Gain Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

Digital Voltmeter ....................................................................................................................... HP 3455A

Power Meter................................................................................................................................ HP 435B

Power Sensor............................................................................................................................ HP 8482A

Adapter, BNC (f) to alligator clips ........................................................................................ HP 8120-1292

Special Extender Board with 51.1-ohm resistor ..............................................HP 08505-60109/0757-0394

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ......................................................................................................HP 10503A

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

NOTE

To make special extender board, solder 51.1 ohm resistor from pin 1 to pin 5 of standard extender board, HP Part No. 5060-0257. Leave resistor leads long for easy connection of clip leads.

5-33

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

2.

3.

4.

5-23.

STEP GAIN ASSEMBLY RF GAIN ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set equipment as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................ 1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ...................................................................................................................... 0 dBm

002: + 50 dBmV

REF LEVEL FINE ................................................................................................................................... 0

Amplitude Scale ................................................................................................................................... LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN

VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF

Digital Voltmeter

RANGE ............................................................................................................................................AUTO

FUNCTION ..................................................................................................................................DC Volts

TRIGGER ................................................................................................................................ INTERNAL

MATH ................................................................................................................................................ OFF

AUTO CAL.:......................................................................................................................................... ON

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-10.

5.

6.

Set signal generator frequency to 21.4 MHz. Set OUTPUT LEVEL for approximately - 5 dBm.

Connect output of signal generator across 51.1 ohm resistor on special board using BNC to clip-lead adapter.

The red lead (center conductor) should be connected to pin 5 of extender board.

Set signal generator frequency for peak amplitude on CRT display. Connect output of signal generator to power meter through power sensor and set OUTPUT LEVEL to - 1 dBm. Reconnect signal generator output to clip-lead adapter.

001: -5 dBm

002: - 6 dBm

Adjust A12R4 GAIN adjustment for signal one division from top graticule line. DVM should indicate + 700 mV

±

30 mV. Remove special extender board and replace Third Converter Assembly A9.

NOTE

Front panel VERTICAL GAIN and VERTICAL POSN control settings can affect the voltage measured at A15TP1. Vertical calibration should be checked after adjusting A12R4 for 700 mV.

(Refer to Operator's Check, Section III).

5-34

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-24.

STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS

REFERENCE

A12 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

REF LEVEL FINE, 0 dB, and -12 dB adjustments are properly set and step gains of 10 dB, 20 dB, and 40 dB are adjusted.

Figure 5-11. Step Amplifier Gain Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator ....................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

1-dB Step Attenuator................................................................................................... HP 355C Opt. H80

10-dB Step Attenuator................................................................................................. HP 355D Opt. H82

Digital Voltmeter ....................................................................................................................... HP 3455A

Power Meter................................................................................................................................ HP 435B

Power Sensor............................................................................................................................ HP 8482A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) ........................................................................................... HP 1250-0780

Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m)...................................................................................... HP 11592-60001

Adapter, SMC (m) to SMC (m) ............................................................................................ HP 1250-0827

Extender Cable Assembly ................................................................................................... HP 5060-0303

5-35

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5.

6.

7.

5-24.

STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set equipment as follows:

2.

3.

4.

TUNING ...................................................................................................................................... 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................ 1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW.......................................................................................................................... 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................. 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL ...................................................................................................................... 0 dBm

002: + 50 dBm V

Amplitude Scale .......................................................................................................................... 1 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...........................................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ................................................................................................................. FREE RUN

VIDEO FILTER .................................................................................................................................. OFF

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-11. Connect signal generator tuned to 301.4 MHz with approximately -

13 dBm output to one side of a 1 dB/step attenuator. Connect attenuator output to A9J1 through test cable.

Tune signal generator frequency for peak amplitude on display.

Set step attenuator to 12 dB and REF LEVEL FINE to - 12. Set signal generator level for a signal one division down from top graticule line.

Adjust A12R6 - 12 dB until signal stops rising on display, then adjust A12R6 counterclockwise until signal drops approximately one third to one half of a division.

8.

9.

10.

Set signal generator level so signal is one division down from top graticule line on display.

Set step attenuator to 0 dB and REF LEVEL FINE to 0.

Adjust A12R5 0 dB adjustment for a signal level one division from top graticule line.

Set step attenuator to 12 dB and REF LEVEL FINE to -12. Signal level on display should be

±

0.1 division from the reference one division down from top graticule line. If signal level is out of limits, repeat steps 3 through 8 until the signal level is within limits.

Check REF LEVEL FINE control from 0 to - 12 dBm, as shown in Table 5-5. Verify correct operation on display,

or measure voltage at A15TP1 with digital voltmeter.

NOTE

Be sure all covers in the IF section are secured by at least six screws before proceeding. If covers are left off or not secured by at least six screws, leakage between assemblies may occur.

This leakage causes erroneous adjustment.

Replace 1 dB/step attenuator with 10 dB/step attenuator set to 0 dB. Set REF LEVEL FINE control to 0.

5-36

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-24.

STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

Table 5-5. REF LEVEL FINE Control Check

REF LEVEL

FINE Setting

0

-1

-2

-3

-4

-5

-6

-7

-8

-9

-10

-11

-12

Step Attenuator

Setting (dB

0

1

2

5

6

7

3

4

8

9

10

11

12

Deviation From

Reference

Ref. mV (Ref.)

±

0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

±0.3 Div ±30 mV

11.

12.

13.

14.

15.

16.

17.

18.

Connect power sensor and power meter to attenuator output and adjust signal generator output level for a power meter reading of - 13 dBm. Connect test cable from attenuator to A9J1.

Tune signal generator frequency for peak amplitude on the display (near 301.4 MHz).

Set step attenuator to 10 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to - 10 dBm.

002: +40dBmV

Adjust A12R3 10 dB adjustment for signal level one division from top graticule line.

Set step attenuator to 20 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to - 20 dBm.

002: + 30 dBmV

Adjust A12R2 20 dB adjustment for signal level one division from top graticule line.

Set attenuator to 40 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL to - 40 dBm.

002: +10dBmV

NOTE

Some video filtering might help reduce noise. Set VIDEO FILTER control so noise is reduced, but the signal amplitude remains unchanged.

Adjust A12R1 40 dB adjustment for signal level one division from top graticule line.

5-37

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-24.

STEP AMPLIFIER GAIN ADJUSTMENTS (Cont' d)

19.

Check REFERENCE LEVEL control from 0 to - 50 dBm as shown in Table 5-6.

002: + 50 dBmV to 0 dBm V. REFERENCE LEVEL dBmV settings in Table 5-6 are, from top to bottom, + 50,

+ 40, + 30, + 20, + 10, 0.

20.

Reconnect W7P2 to A9JI.

Table 5-6. REFERENCE LEVEL Control Check

REFERENCE LEVEL

(dBm)

0

-10

-20

-30

-40

-50

Attenuator

(dB)

0

10

20

30

40

50

Deviation From

Reference

Reference

±0.2 Div ±20 mV

±0.2 Div ±20 mV

±0.2 Div ±20 mV

±0.2 Div ±20 mV

±0.2 Div ±20 mV

5-38

Model 8558B

5-25. + 19.5V ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A12 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

+ 19.5V for YIG Oscillator is adjusted.

ADJUSTMENTS

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 5-12. +19.5VAdjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Digital Voltmeter........................................................................................................................... HP 3455A

Cable, Banana Plug to Alligator Clip ........................................................................................... HP 11102A

Extender Cable Assembly ......................................................................................................HP 5060-0303

PROCEDURE

1. Set Digital Voltmeter as follows:

RANGE .............................................................................................................................................. AUTO

FUCTION ............................................................................................................................................... dcV

AUTO CAL ..............................................................................................................................................ON

TRIGGER....................................................................................................................................INTERNAL

2. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-12. Connect digital voltmeter to A12TP8 (left side of A12R7 + 19.5V

adjustment).

3. Adjust A12R7 + 19.5V adjustment for + 19.5

±

0.1 V.

5-39

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE:

A9, A12, A14, and A15 Schematics

DESCRIPTION

Step attenuators are used to change, in calibrated steps, the input signal level of the spectrum analyzer. The output of

Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15 is monitored, and adjustments are performed to calibrate Log Amplifier

Assembly A14.

Figure 5-13. Log Amplifier and Linear Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator .......................................................................................................................... HP 8640B

Digital Voltmeter........................................................................................................................... HP 3455A

10-dB Step Attenuator ................................................................................................... HP 355D, Opt. H82

1-dB Step Attenuator ..................................................................................................... HP 355C, Opt. H80

Adapter, Type N (m) to SMC (m) ............................................................................................HP 1250-1023

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) ...........................................................................HP 1250-0780

BNC Cable, 20 cm (9 in)............................................................................................................. HP 18502A

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in)......................................................................................................... HP 18503A

Cable Assembly, Banana Plug to Alligator Clip........................................................................... HP 11102A

Test Cable, SMC (f) to BNC (m) ......................................................................................... HP 11592-60001

Extender Cable Assembly ......................................................................................................HP 5060-0303

5-40

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1. Set equipment as follows:

Spectrum Analyzer

FREQ SPAN/DIV .............................................................................................................................. 0

RESOLUTION BW................................................................................................................. 300 kHz

INPUT ATTEN ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................-50 dBm

002: 0 dBmV

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................... AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN

Digital Voltmeter

RANGE ........................................................................................................................................... 10

FUNCTION ................................................................................................................................... dcV

TRIGGER ..........................................................................................................................INTERNAL

MATH .......................................................................................................................................... OFF

AUTO CAL.....................................................................................................................................ON

2. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-13. Set 1-dB step attenuator to 10 dB. Set signal generator frequency

to 301.4 MHz and OUTPUT LEVEL to -13 dBm. Remove W7 from A9J1. Connect signal generator output through step attenuators and test cable to A9J 1.

NOTE

The HP 355C 10 dB attenuation is included to compensate for the 10 dB of gain on Step Gain

Assembly A12 the TEST-NORM switch is in TEST.

3. Set the TEST-NORM switch on Step Gain Assembly A12 to the TEST position. Tune signal generator frequency for maximum signal amplitude on display with 10 dB step attenuator set to 0 dB. (It may be necessary to reduce signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL slightly.)

4. Disconnect signal generator output from step attenuator. Measure offset at A15TP and record.

mV

5. Connect signal generator to step attenuator and adjust signal generator FINE TUNE control to peak signal on

CRT display.

6. Adjust spectrum analyzer REF LEVEL CAL and signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of

800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

7. Set Amplitude Scale to 10 dB/DIV.

8. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 0 dB and adjust A14R23 SLOPE for DVM reading (I 1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

5-41

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

9. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 60 dB and adjust A14R10 OFFSET for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of 200 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 until no further adjustment is necessary.

11. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 30 dB and adjust A14R23 SLOPE for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of 500 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

12. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 0 dB and adjust A14R69 - 30 dB for DVM (

±

1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

13. Repeat steps 11 and 12 until no further adjustment is necessary.

14. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 10 dB and adjust A14R23 SLOPE for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of 700 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

15. Set 10-dB step attenuator to O dB and adjust A14R39 - 10 dB for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

16. Repeat steps 14 and 15 until no further adjustment is necessary.

17. Repeat steps 8 through 16 until limits in Table 5-7 are met.

Table 5- 7. Log Fidelity Check

Step Attenuator Setting (dB)

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

DVM Reading*

Ref: 800

±

1 mV

700

±

3 mV

600

±

4 mV

500

±

4 mV

400

±

5 mV

300

±

6 mV

200

±

7 mV

100

±

8 mV

*Plus offset

Linear Output and Linear Step Gain

18. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................- 50 dBm

002: 0 dBmV

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................LIN

5-42

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

19. Set 10-dB step attenuator to O dB and adjust A14R34 LIN for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

20. Make adjustments indicated in Table 5-8 .

Table 5-8. Linear Gain Adjustments

Adjustment

A14R34

A14R33

A14R30

A14R27

No Adjustment

*Plus offset

Step Attenuator

0

10

20

30

40

Reference Level

-50 dBm

-60 dBm

-70 dBm

-80 dBm

-90 dBm

DVM Reading*

Ref: 800

±

1 mV

800

±

5 mV

800

±

5 mV

800

±

5 mV

800

±

10 mV

Log Gain

21. Set spectrum analyzer control as follows:

REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................- 50 dBm

002: 0 dBmV

Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................................... 1 dB/DIV

22. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 0 dB. Adjust signal generator for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

23. Set 10-dB step attenuator to 40 dB. Set REF LEVEL dBm to -90 and adjust A14R121 LOG GAIN for DVM reading (

±

3 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A15TP1.

002: - 40 dBmV

24. Check log gain steps according to Table 5-9.

Table 5-9. Log Gain Adjustment Limits

Step Attenuator

0

10

20

30

40

*Plus offset

Reference Level

-50 dBm

-60 dBm

-70 dBm

-80 dBm

-90 dBm

DVM Reading*

Ref: 800 +1 mV

800 +30 mV

800 +30 mV

800 +30 mV

800 +30 mV

5-43

Model 8558B

ADJUSTMENTS

5-26. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Error Check (1 dB/DIV)

25. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

REFERENCE LEVEL ............................................................................................................- 50 dBm

002: 0dBmV

Amplitude Scale ........................................................................................................................... 1 dB

26. Set both step attenuators to 0 dB. Reduce signal generator OUTPUT LEVEL until signal appears at top of display. Adjust signal generator FINE TUNE to peak trace on display and adjust OUTPUT LEVEL for DVM reading (

±

1 mV) of 800 mV plus offset recorded in step 4, as measured at A 5TP 1. Increase attenuation in 1-

dB steps and take DVM readings to check log amplifier output. (Refer to Table 5-10.)

27. Return A12S1 TEST-NORM switch to NORM. Remove test cable and reconnect W7 to A9J1.

Table 5-10. Log Amplifier Output Limits

Step Attenuator

1

2

3

4

5

6

7

DVM Reading*

700

±

10 mV

600

±

20 mV

500

±

30 mV

400

±

30 mV

300

±

30 mV

200

±

30 mV

100

±

30 mV

*Plus offset

5-44

Model 8558B

ADJUSTMENTS

5-27. SWEEP TIME PER DIVISION ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A8 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

Sweep time per division is adjusted for proper sweep time and 'dead time.'

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 5-14. Sweep Time Per Division Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Oscilloscope........................................................................................................................ HP 1741A

Digital Voltmeter ................................................................................................................. HP 3455A

Timer/Counter ..................................................................................................................... HP 5308A

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ............................................................................................... HP 18503A

Cable, Banana Plug to Alligator Clips 150 cm (60 in) ........................................................ HP 11002A

Extender Cable Assembly .............................................................................................HP 5060-0303

5-45

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-27. SWEEP TIME PER DIVISION ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1. Set equipment as follows:

Oscilloscope

DISPLAY...........................................................................................................................................A

TRIGGER .........................................................................................................................................A

CHAN A .........................................................................................................................2 VOLTS/DIV

AC-GND-DC .................................................................................................................................. DC

WRITE...........................................................................................................................................ON

TIME/DIV ............................................................................................................................... 2 mSEC

MAG X5 ....................................................................................................................................... OFF

EXT TRIGGER.............................................................................................................................. INT

MODE........................................................................................................................................ MAIN

Digital Voltmeter

RANGE ..................................................................................................................................... AUTO

FUNCTION ................................................................................................................................... dcV

AUTO CAL.....................................................................................................................................ON

TRIGGER ..........................................................................................................................INTERNAL

MATH .......................................................................................................................................... OFF

TIMER/COUNTER

TIME BASE.................................................................................................................................10 µs

FUNCTION ...............................................................................................................................PER B

2. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-14. Connect oscilloscope to AUX D, HORIZONTAL OUT- PUT, rear of

display mainframe, or to A8TP5 of HP 8558B. Connect digital voltmeter to A8TP6 (located to the left and below

A8TP4.)

3. Adjust A8R7 + 10lOV adjustment for 1OV 40.02 V.

NOTE

The + 10V must be adjusted while analyzer is still cold, during first five minutes after turn-on. If instrument has been operating, turn off mainframe and remove A8 Sweep Generator assembly.

Let A8 assembly cool on bench for 15 minutes. Replace A8 and proceed with adjustment of

A8R7 during the first five minutes after turn on.

4. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

SWEEP TIME/DIV ...................................................................................................................... 1 ms

SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN

5. Check oscilloscope trace for approximately a - 5V to + 5V ramp.

5-46

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-27. SWEEP TIME PER DIVISION ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

6. Adjust A8R10 1 ms adjustment for a 10 ms ramp time. Measure dead time of ramp.

MIN.

ACTUAL MAX.

0.25 ms 0.40 ms

7. Set spectrum analyzer SWEEP TIME/DIV to 2 mSEC. Adjust A8R13 2 ms adjustment for a 20 ms ramp time.

Measure dead time of ramp.

MIN.

ACTUAL MAX.

6.0 ms 9.0 ms

8. Set SWEEP TIME/DIV to 1 mSEC. Frequency counter should read sweep time plus dead time (10 ms + dead time 40.05 ms). Adjust A8R10 if necessary to obtain an indication of 10 ms + dead time

±

0.05 ms.

9. Set SWEEP TIME/DIV to 2 mSEC. Frequency counter should read sweep time plus dead time (20 ms + dead time -0.10 ms). Adjust A8R13 if necessary to obtain an indication of 20 ms + dead time

±

0.10 ms.

10. Repeat steps 8 and 9 until the sweep time plus dead time (dt) for the 1 ms and 2 ms sweeps are within limits.

ACTUAL MIN

10 ms + dt - 0.05 ms

20ms + dt- 0.10ms

MAX.

10 ms + dt + 0.05 ms

20ms + dt + 0.10ms

5-47

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-28. FREQUENCY CONTROL AND DPM ADJUSTMENTS

REFERENCE

A1 and A7 Schematics

DESCRIPTION

The + 14.5V and REF V voltages are adjusted and the - 10.0V voltage is checked. The frequency limits and linearity of the YIG oscillator are set. The FREQUENCY MHz readout is adjusted for proper voltage calibration and for correct ranging.

Figure 5-15. Frequency Control and DPM Adjustments Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

Digital Voltmeter ................................................................................................................. HP 3455A

Comb Generator ................................................................................................................. HP 8406A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) (2 required) ..................................................................HP 1250-0780

BNC Cable, 120 cm (48 in) ............................................................................................... HP 18503A

Cable, Banana Plug to Alligator Clips 150 cm (60 in) ........................................................ HP 11002A

Extender Cable Assembly .............................................................................................HP 5060-0303

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

Minimum Loss Adapter, 75

to 50

.......................................................................... HP 08558-60031

Adapter, BNC (m) to BNC (m), 75

..............................................................................HP 1250-1288

Adapter, SMA (f) to SMA (f) ..........................................................................................HP 1250-1158

Adapter, BNC (f) to SMA (m).........................................................................................HP 1250-1200

5-48

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-28. FREQUENCY CONTROL AND DPM ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

Voltage Adjustments

1. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-15. Connect digital voltmeter to A7TP7 (located between A7R4 REF V

and A7R5 + 14.5V adjustments).

2. Adjust A7R5 + 14.5V potentiometer for + 14.50

±

0.02 V.

3. Connect digital voltmeter to A7TP8 (located to the right of A7R5 + 14.5V adjustment) and check for -10.0

±

0.2

V.

4. Connect digital voltmeter to A7TP6 and adjust A7R4 REF V potentiometer for + 6.00

±

0.01 V.

YIG Oscillator Adjustment

NOTE

Check HORIZ GAIN and HORIZ POSN adjustments and perform voltage adjustments before continuing with the following procedure.

5. Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

START - CENTER ................................................................................................................CENTER

FREQ SPAN/DIV ...................................................................................................................... 5 MHz

RESOLUTION BW................................................................................................................. 100 kHz

INPUT ATTEN ................................................................................................................................dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................-10 dBm

002: +40dBmV

Amplitude Scale .................................................................................................................. 10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................... AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN

6. Turn FREQUENCY ZERO control fully counterclockwise.

7. Adjust TUNING for FREQUENCY MHz readout of approximately - 16.0.

NOTE

Press FREQUENCY CAL button to remove YIG oscillator hysteresis whenever the TUNING control is adjusted.

8. Adjust A7R3 2.0 GHZ to center LO feedthrough (within one division) on CRT.

NOTE

Disconnect comb generator whenever it is necessary to center the LO feedthrough.

5-49

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-28. FREQUENCY CONTROL AND DPM ADJUSTMENTS (Cont'd)

9. Couple FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW controls. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 100 MHz/DIV. Set comb generator frequency to 100 MHz. Adjust TUNING to approximately 500 MHz for full-screen display of comb teeth.

10. Adjust TUNING, A7R1 3.55 GHZ, and A7R2 3.55 FINE to align comb teeth on vertical graticule lines (one tooth per division).

11. Repeat steps 7 and 8. (A7R1 3.55 GHZ adjustment has a slight effect on A7R3 2.0 GHZ adjustment.)

12. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 1 MHz and comb generator frequency to 1 MHz.

13. Adjust TUNING to approximately 750 MHz. Adjust A7R6 FM to align comb teeth on vertical graticule lines (one tooth per division).

Digital Panel Meter Adjustment

14. Set FREQ SPAN/DIV to 500 kHz.

15. Center LO feedthrough. Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center LO feedthrough.

16. Adjust FREQUENCY ZERO control for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 00.0.

17. Set comb generator frequency to 100 MHz. Adjust TUNING to center 1500-MHz tooth (15th tooth from LO feedthrough). Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center comb tooth. Adjust A1A2R3 REF for

FREQUENCY MHz readout of 1500 + 1.

18. Adjust A7R8 RNG fully clockwise. Set comb generator frequency to 10 MHz. Adjust TUNING to center 190-MHz comb tooth (19th tooth from LO feedthrough). Adjust A7R7 GAIN for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 190.0.

NOTE

Press FREQUENCY CAL frequently while counting the comb teeth to avoid miscounting.

19. Adjust TUNING for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 198.5. Slowly adjust A7R8 RNG counterclockwise until range switches (no decimal on FREQUENCY MHz display).

20. Center LO feedthrough. Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center LO feedthrough. Set comb generator frequency to 100 MHz. Adjust TUNING to center 200-MHz comb tooth (second tooth from LO feedthrough).

Press FREQUENCY CAL button and re-center comb tooth. Adjust A7R72 OFS for FREQUENCY MHz readout of 200.

21. Repeat steps 15 through 21 until 190.0 MHz, 200 MHz, and 1500 MHz readouts on FREQUENCY MHz display are calibrated.

5-50

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-29. 1 dB OFFSET ADJUSTMENT

REFERENCE

A15 Schematic

DESCRIPTION

Reference is set in 10 dB/DIV and 1 dB offset is adjusted in 1 dB/DIV for the same full display reference in 10 dB/DIV.

Figure 5-16. 1-dB Offset Adjustment Test Setup

EQUIPMENT

BNC Cable, 120 cm (9 in) ................................................................................................. HP 18502A

Adapter, Type N (m) to BNC (f) .....................................................................................HP 1250-0780

Extender Cable Assembly .............................................................................................HP 5060-0303

Additional Equipment, Options 001 and 002:

BNC Cable, 30 cm (12 in).......................................................................................... HP 11652-60012

PROCEDURE

1. Set Spectrum Analyzer controls as follows:

START - CENTER ................................................................................................................CENTER

TUNING ................................................................................................................................ 280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ...................................................................................................................... 1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW.................................................................................................................... 1 MHz

INPUT ATTEN ........................................................................................................................... 10 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL .............................................................................................................-20 dBm

002: +30dBmV

REF LEVEL FINE ..................................................................................................Approximately - 10

Amplitude Scale .............................................................................................................................LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV .................................................................................................................... AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ........................................................................................................... FREE RUN

5-51

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

5-29. 1-dB OFFSET ADJUSTMENT (Cont'd)

2. Connect equipment as shown in Figure 5-16.

3. Set Amplitude Scale switch to LIN. Set TUNING control to center the trace on the display. Set REF LEVEL

FINE for a full-screen trace (signal at top graticule line).

4. Set Amplitude Scale switch to 10 dB/DIV. Adjust VERTICAL GAIN if necessary for full screen trace.

5. Repeat steps 3 and 4 until the trace is full screen in both LIN and 10 dB/DIV.

NOTE

1 dB/DIV will read approximately 0.5 dB (0.5 division) low when using extender cable assembly.

Adjusting A15Ri 1 dB OFFSET for a trace 0.5 division down from top graticule line should place signal at top graticule line when 8558B is properly installed in 180-series mainframe.

6. Amplitude Scale switch to 1 dB/DIV. Adjust A15R1 1 dB OFFSET for a trace 0.5 division down from top graticule line.

5-52

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

5-53 through 5-59

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

6-1. INTRODUCTION

SECTION VI.

REPLACEABLE PARTS

6-5.

The following information is listed for each part:

1. The Hewlett-Packard part number 6-2. This section contains information for ordering

replacement parts. Table 6-1 includes a list of reference

designations and a list of abbreviations used in the parts

list. Table 6-2 lists names and addresses that

correspond to the manufacturer code numbers in the

parts list. Table 6-3 lists all replaceable parts in alpha-

numerical order by reference designation.

2. The part number check digit (CD)

3. The total quantity (Qty) in the instrument. This quantity is given only once, at the first appearance of the part in the list.

4. The description of the part

6-3. REPLACEABLE PARTS LIST

6-4. Table 6-3, the list of replaceable parts, is organized

as follows:

5. A five-digit code indicating a typical manufacturer of the part

1. Electrical assemblies and their components in alpha-numerical order by reference designation

6. The manufacturer's part number

6-6. ORDERING INFORMATION

2. Miscellaneous parts, with appropriate electrical parts list assembly

3. Chassis-mounted electrical parts, in alphanumerical order by reference designation

4. Mechanical chassis parts, at end of

6-7. To order a part listed in the replaceable parts table, quote the Hewlett-Packard part number (with check digit), indicate the quantity required, and address the order to the nearest Hewlett-Packard office. The check digit will ensure accurate and timely processing of your order.

6-8. To order a part that is not listed in the replaceable parts table, include the instrument model number, instrument serial number, the description and function of the part, and the number of parts required.

Address the order to the nearest Hewlett-Packard office.

6-1

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-1. Reference Designations and Abbreviations (1 of 3)

A

REFERENCE DESIGNATIONS

A ........................................Assembly

F ............................................... Fuse

AT......... Attenuator, Isolator, Limiter, FL .............................................Filter

Termination H........................................Hardware

B ......................................Fan, Motor HY .....................................Circulator

BT..........................................Battery

J ..... Electrical Connector (Stationary

C........................................Capacitor

Portion), Jack

CP ....................................... Coupler K ..............................................Relay

CR ........Diode, Diode Thyristor, Step L .................................. Coil, Inductor

Recovery Diode (SCR), Varactor M .............................................Meter

DC ...................... Directional Coupler MP ....Miscellaneous Mechanical Part

DL .................................... Delay Line P ........ Electrical Connector (Movable

DS .............Annunciator, Lamp, Light Portion), Plug

Emitting Diode (LED), Signaling

Device (Audible or Visible

Q ............ Silicon Controlled Rectifier

(SCR), Transistor, Triode Thyristor

E .......... Miscellaneous Electrical Part R.......................................... Resistor

ABBREVIATIONS

D

A .................Across Flats, Acrylic, Air D................. Deep, Depletion, Depth,

(Dry Method), Ampere Diameter, Direct Current

ADJ..................... Adjust, Adjustment DA ....................................Darlington

ANSI .................... American National DAP-GL .........Diallyl Phthalate Glass

Standards Institute (formerly DBL .......................................Double

USASI-ASA) DCDR ..................................Decoder

ASSY .................................Assembly

DEG...................................... Degree

AWG................ American Wire Gage D-HOLE .................... D-Shaped Hole

DIA .................................... Diameter

B

DIP ................. Dual In-Line Package

DIP-SLDR ........................ Dip Solder

D-MODE .................. Depletion Mode

BCD ...............Binary Coded Decimal DO .......... Package Type Designation

BD ............... Deep, Depth, Diametric DP ............... Deep, Depth, Diametric

BE-CU ...................Beryllium Copper Pitch, Dip

BNC ..................... Type of Connector DP3TMINTR ........Double Pole Three

BRG..........................Bearing, Boring Throw, Miniature

BRS ......................................... Brass DPDTMINTR......Double Pole Double

BSC ......................................... Basic Throw, Miniature

BTN ........................................Button

DWL ....................................... Dowel

C E

E-R ........................................ E-Ring

C............... Capacitance, Capacitore, EXT .................Extended, Extension,

Center Tapped, Centistoke,

Cermet, Circular Mil Foot, Closed

External, Extinguish

Cup, Cold, Compression F

CCP .......Carbon Composition Plastic

CD .......................... Cadmium, Card, F ............ Fahrenheit, Farad, Female,

Cold-Drawn, Cord

CER .....................................Ceramic

Film (Resistor), Fixed, Flange,

Flint, Fluorine, Frequency

CHAM ................................. Chamfer FC.......... Carbon Film / Composition,

CHAR .............................. Character, Edge of Cutoff Frequency, Face

Characteristic, Charcoal FDTHRU ..................... Feed Through

CMOS............ Complementary Metal FEM...................................... Female

Oxide Semiconductor FIL-HD ......................... Fillister Head

CNDCT ...... Conducting, Conductive, FL ...........................Flash, Flat, Fluid

Conductivity, Conductor FLAT-PT ............................Flat Point

CONT .............. Contact, Continuous, FR.............................................Front

Control, Controller FREQ .............................. Frequency

CONV ............................... Converter FT ................Current Gain Bandwidth

CPRSN ........................ Compression Product (Transition Frequency);

CUP-PT ............................ Cup Point Feet, Foot

CW ..... Clockwise, Continuous Wave FXD ......................................... Fixed

RT .............................. Thermistor

S........................................ Switch

T ............................... Transformer

TB........................ Terminal Board

TC ......................... Thermocouple

TP................................ Test Point

U....Integrated Circuit, Microcircuit

V............................ Electron Tube

VR ....... Breakdown Diode(Zener),

Voltage Regulator

W. Cable, Transmission Path, wire

X........................................Socket

Y......... Crystal Unit (Piezoelectric,

Quartz)

Z .......Tuned Cavity, Tuned Circuit

GEN .............. General, Generator

GND .................................Ground

GP ......... General Purpose, Group

H............... Henry, Hermaphrodite,

High, Hole Diameter, Hot, Hub

Inside Diameter, Hydrogen

HDW........................... Hardware .

HEX ........ Hexadecimal, Hexagon,

Hexagonal

HLCL .................................Helical

HP .....Hewlett-Packard Company,

High Pass, Horsepower

I

H

IC......................Collector Current,

Integrated Circuit

ID... Identification, Inside Diameter

IF ....................... Forward Current,

Intermediate Frequency

IN.............................. Inch, indium

INCL .............................. Including

INT ...... Integral, Intensity, Internal

INTL ........... Internal, International

Transistor

Transistor

J

J-FET .......... Junction Field Effect

JFET............ Junction Field Effect

K

G

K...... Kelvin, Key, Kilo, Potassium

KNRLD ............................ Knurled

KVDC ...... Kilovolts Direct Current

6-2

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-1. Reference Designations and Abbreviations (2 of 3)

L PAN-HD ............................ Pan Head

PAR ........................... Parallel, Parity

LED................... Light Emitting Diode PB............ Lead (Metal), Push Button

LG................................ Length, Long PC .................... Picocoulomb, Piece,

LIN ..... Linear, Linear Taper, Linearity Printed Circuit ..............................

LK ..................................... Link, Lock PCB ................. Printed Circuit Board

LKG ...................... Leakage, Locking P-CHAN ........................... P-Channel

LOGO ................................ Logotype PD .................. Pad, Palladium, Pitch

LUM ...................................Luminous

Diameter, Power Dissipation

PF............... Picofarad; Pipe, Female

M Connection; Power Factor

PKG.................................... Package

M .......... Male, Maximum, Mega, Mil, PLSTC ................................... Plastic

Milli, Mode, Momentary, PNL .........................................Panel

Mounting Hole Centers, Mounting ..................................................PNP

Tapping

Hole Diameter Positive (Transistor)

MA ..................................Milliampere

POLYC ...................... Polycarbonate

MACH ................................Machined

POLYE............................... Polyester

MAX.................................. Maximum POT ............................ Potentiometer

MC ..................... Hot Molded Carbon POZI ........................Pozidriv Recess

Composition, Megacycle, PREC................................. Precision

PRP .........................Purple, Purpose Microcircuit, Molded Carbon

Composition PSTN ...................................... Piston

MET .......................... Metal, Metallic, PT..................... Part, Pint, Platinum,

Metallized, Metallurgical Point, Pulse Time

MHZ................................. Megahertz PW ..Power Wirewound, Pulse Width

MIT ...........................................Miter

MLD .............................Mold, Molded

Q

Q ............................... Figure of Merit

MM ................... Magnetized Material

(Restricted Articles Code);

Millimeter

MOM............................... Momentary

MTG .................................. Mounting

MTLC....................................Metallic

R

MUW .............................. Music Wire

MW ...................................... Milliwatt R................ Range, Red, Resistance,

N

Resistor, Right, Ring, Rosin,

Rubber-Resin, Run Torque

REF ..................................Reference

RES . Research, Resistance, Resistor

N..................Fan Out, Intrinsic Stand RF.......................... Radio Frequency

Off Ratio, Nano, Nanosecond,

Nitrogen, None

RGD .........................................Rigid

RND........................................Round

N-CHAN........................... N-Channel RR ............................................ Rear

NH ...................................Nanohenry

RVT ............................Rivet, Riveted

NMH ............ Nanometer Nonmetallic S

NO ..............Normally Open, Number

NOM ....................................Nominal

NPN ...................... Negative Positive

Negative (Transistor)

NS Nanosecond, Non-Shorting, Nose

SAWR.......... Surface Acoustic Wave

Resonator

NUM ..................Numeric, Numerical SEG....................................Segment

NYL...................... Nylon (Polyamide) SGL ........................................ Single

SI .......................Silicon, Square Inch

O SL ................................... Slide, Slow

SLT......................Slate, Slot, Slotted

OA .......................... Other Restricted SMA................ Subminiature, A Type

Articles, Group A (Restricted

Articles Code); Over-All

OD ......Olive Drab, Outside Diameter

(Threaded Connector)

SMC ...............Subminiature, C Type

(Threaded Connector)

OP AMP...........Operational Amplifier SPCG .................................. Spacing

OPT ........... Optical, Option, Optional SPDTSUBMIN .... Single Pole Double

Throw, Subminiature

P

PA...................... Picoampere, Power SST ...........................Stainless Steel

Amplifier, Pressure Angle,

Protactinium

SPST .........Single Pole Single Throw

SQ .........................................Square

STL...........................................Steel

SZ.............................................. Size

T

T ........... Tab Width, Taper, Teeth,

Temperature, Tera, Tesla,

Thermoplastic (Insulation),

Thickness, Time, Timed, Tooth,

Turns Ratio, Typical

TA............. Ambient Temperature,

Tantalum

TC ......................... Thermoplastic

THD ................. Thread, Threaded

THK .....................................Thick

TO .....Package Type Designation,

Troy Ounce

Positive Negative.................. TPG

TR-HD ....................... Truss Head

TRMR ............................. Trimmer

TRN ........................... Turn, Turns

TRSN................................Torsion

U

UCD........................ Microcandela

UF ...............................Microfarad

UH .............................. Microhenry

UL............Microliter, Underwriters'

Laboratories, Inc.

UNHDND .................. Unhardened

V

V........Vanadium, Variable, Violet,

Volt, Voltage

VAC ......................Vacuum; Volts,

Alternating Current

VAC/DC ...... Volts, Alternating and

Direct Current

VAR ................................ Variable

VDC..............Volts, Direct Current

W

W.............. Watt, Wattage, White,

Wide, Width, Wire

W/CP.... Wire / Conductive Plastic

W/SW........................With Switch

WW ..........................Wire Wound

X

X...... By (Used With Dimensions),

Reactance

XSTR............................Transistor

Y

YIG ................. Yttrium-ron-Garnet

Z

ZNR .................................... Zener

6-3

Model 8558B

Abbreviation f a n p c m

,U

T

G

M k da d

Table 6-1. Reference Designations and Abbreviations (3 of 3)

MULTIPLIERS

Prefix tera giga mega kilo deka deci centi milli micro nano pico femto atto

Table 6-2. Manufacturers Code List

Multiple

10

12

10

9

10

6

10

3

10

10

-1

10

-2

10

-3

10

-6

10

-9

10

-12

10

-15

10

-18

Mfr.

No.

24046

24546

28480

3L585

30983

33095

52763

56289

71041

72136

72982

74970

78707

9N171

92830

00000

01121

01295

02111

02660

03888

04713

06665

11236

13606

18736

19701

Manufacturer Name

ANY SATISFACTORY SUPPLIER

ALLEN-BRADLEY CO

TEXAS INSTR INC SEMICOND CMPNT DIV

SPECTROL ELECTRONICS CORP

BUNKER RAMO CORP AMPHENOL CONN DIV

K D I PYROFILM CORP

MOTOROLA SEMICONDUCTOR PRODUCTS

PRECISION MONOLITHICS INC

CTS OF BERNE INC

SPRAGUE ELECT CO SEMICONDUCTOR DIV

VOLTRONICS CORP

MEPCO/ELECTRA CORP

TRANSITRON ELECTRONIC CORP

CORNING GLASS WORKS (BRADFORD)

HEWLETT-PACKARD CO CORPORATE HQ

RCA CORP SOLID STATE DIV

MEPCO/ELECTRIC CORP

SPECTRUM CONTROL INC

STETTNER-TRUSH INC

SPRAGUE ELECTRIC CO

BOSTON GEAR WKS DIV OF NA ROCKWELL

ELECTRO MOTIVE CORP

ERIE TECHNOLOGICAL PRODUCTS INC

JOHNSON E F CO

TEK BEARING CO INC

UNITRODE COMPUTER PRODUCTS CORP

ASSOCIATED SPRING CORP

6-4

Address

MILWAUKEE, WI

DALLAS, TX

CITY OF IND, CA

BROADVILLE, IL

WHIPPANY, NJ

PHOENIX, AZ

SANTA CLARA, CA

BERNE, IN

CONCORD, NH

HANOVER, NJ

MINERAL WELLS; TX

WAKEFIELD, MA

BRADFORD, PA

PALO ALTO, CA

SOMERVILLE, NJ

SAN DIEGO, CA

FAIRVIEW, PA

CAZENOVIA, NY

NORTH ADAMS, MA

QUINCY, MA

FLORENCE, SC

ERIE, PA

WASECA, MN

NEW YORK, NY

METHUEN, MA

BRISTOL, CT

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Zip Codes

92121

16415

13035

01247

02171

06226

16512

56093

10013

06010

53204

75222

91745

60153

07981

85008

95050

46711

03301

07936

76067

01880

16701

94304

A2R1

A2R2

A2R3

A2R4

A2R5

A2R6

A2S1

A2S2

A1A2Q1

A1A2Q2

A1A2Q3

A1A2Q4

A1A2R1

A1A2R2

A1A2R3

A1A2R4

A1A2R5

A1A2R6

A1A2R7

A1A2R8

A1A2R9

A1A2R10

A1A2R11

A1A2R12

A1A2R13

A1A2R14

A1A2TP1

A1A2TP2

A1A2TP3

A1A2U1

A1A2U2

A1A2U3

A1A2U4

A1A2VR1

A1A2VR2

A1A2C1 THRU

A1A2C3

A1A2C4

A1A2C5 THRU

A1A2C9

A1A2C10

A1A2C11

A1A2CI2

A1A2C13

A1A2C14

A1A2C15

A1A2C16

A1A2CR1

A1A2CR2

A1A2CR3

A1A2J1

A1A2L1

A2

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A1

A1A1

A1A2

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number

08558-60125

0180-0197

0160-4084

0160-4084

0180-0197

0160-0168

0180-2207

0160-4084

1901-0040

1901-0050

1200-0508

9100-1644

1854-0404

1854-0404

0757-0465

0757-0420

2100-1702

0698-3446

0757-0442

0698-3260

0698-3457

0698-3439

0757-0442

0757-0416

0757-0442

0757-0458

0757-0458

0757-0317

0360-0535

0360-0535

0360-0535

1826-0431

1858-0047

1820-1413

1810-0346

1902-0064

08558-60100

2100-3593

2100-.3452

2100-3066

2100-0542

2100-3973

2100-3973

3101-0044

2100-3973

D

1

8

1

2

7

7

9

7

0

0

0

4

5

2

7

9

6

4

9

7

6

3

7

3

9

0

0

0

1

8

8

8

8

1

8

0

3

1

3

1

5

8

8

8

8

Qty

1

2

18

11

35

27

7

1

3

5

1

1

1

29

27

1

1

6

13

1

1

1 t

2

Description

DIGITAL PANEL METER ASSEMBLY

NOT ASSIGNED

DPM DRIVER ASSEMBLY

NOTE

SEE A2 FOR DPM DISPLAY

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD 2,2UF+-10X 20VDC TA

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-10% 200VODC POLYE

CAPACITOR-FXD 100UF +-10% 10VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD , 1UF +-20X 50VDC CER

NOT ASSIGNED

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

SOCKET-IC 14-CONT DIP-SLDR

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 330UH 5% .2DX.45L.G

NOT ASSIGNED

NOT ASSIGNED

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 100 10% WW SIDE-ADJ 20-TRN

RESISTOR 383 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1OO

RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 178 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10OK 1%X 125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-O00

RESISTOR 51.1K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

IC CONV 24-DIP- C PKG

TRANSISTOR ARRAY 16-PIN PLSTC DIP

IC DCDR CMOS BCD-TO-7-SEG 4-TO-7-LINE

NETWORK-RES 16-DIP080.0 OHM X S

NOT ASSIGNED

DIODE-ZNR 7.5V 5% DO-35 PD=,4W TC=+.05X

Mfr.

Code

28480

56289

1

1

3

1

1

1

1

FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY

(ELECTRICAL PARTS)

NOTE

SEE FIGURE 6-3 FOR COMPLETE IDENT-

IFICATION OF FRONT SW. ASSY PARTS.

RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 5K 10%

(COARSE TUNE)

RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-.TRN 10K 10%

(FINE TINE)

RESISTOR-VAR PREC WW 10-TRN 5K 5%

(FREQ. ZERO)

RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL WW 10K 5% LIN

(RF LVL FINE)

RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20%; 10CW

(VIDEO FILTER)

RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20%; 10CW

(VIDEO FILTER)

SWITCH-PB SPST-NO MOM .5A 115VAC RED-BTN

(FREQ. CAL)

RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20%; 10CW

P/O A2RS/R6/52(MAX VIDEO FILTER)

28480

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-5

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

24546

24546

02660

24546

24546

28480

28480

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

00000

00000

00000

04713

13606

3L585

11236

28480

28480

28480

56289

28480

56289

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

08558-60125

150D225X9020A2

0160-4084

0160-4084

150D225X9020A2

0160-0168

150D107X9010R2

0160-4084

1901-0040

1901-0050

1200-0508

9100-1644

1854-0404

1854-0404

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

3810P-101

C4-1/8-TO-383R-.F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

0698-3260

0698-3457

C4-1/8-TO-178R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/B-TO-5112-F

C4-1/8-TO-5112-F

C4--1/8-TO-1331-F

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

MC14433L

ULN-2003A

CD45118E

761-3-RI80

1902-0064

0855860100

2100-3593

2100-3452

2100-3066

2100-0542

2100-3973

2100-3973

3101-0044

2100-3973

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A2A1

A2A1CR1

A2A1CR2

A2A1DS1

A2A1DS2

A2A1DS3

A2A1DS4

A2A1D55

A2A1R1

A2A1R2

A2A1R3

A21AR4

A2A1R5

A2A1R6

A2A1R7

A2A1R8

A2A1S1

A2A1S2

A2A1S3

A2A1S4

A2A1S5

A2A1S6

A2A1S7

A21AW1

A2A1W2

A2A1XDS1

A2A1XDS2

A2A1XDS3

A2A1XDS4

A2A1XDS5

A3

A4

A4J1

A4J2

A4J3

A4J4

A4MP1

A4HP2

A4MP3

A4R0

A4R2

64R3

64R4

A4R5

A4U1

A5

A5C1

A5C2

A5C3

A5C4

A5CR1

A5J1

A5J2

A5J3

A5L1

A5L2

A5L3

A5L4

A5L5

A5MP1

A5MP2

A5MP3

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

08558-60160

1901-0025

1902-0064

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0485

0757-0447

2100-3340

2100-2681

2100-3332

0757-0444

2100-1412

2100-3331

0757-0317

6

2

7

3

1

3

3

5

4

1

7

4

2

7

7

7

1

1

8

0

17

1

1

1

1

2

6

3101-2213 0 1

3101-2124 2

018558-60168 2

08558-60037

1990-0619

4

7

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0485

5086-7363

08495-60004

7

5

7

7

9

9

08558-60004 5

1250-1020 8

1250-1020

1250--1020

8

8

1250-1020 8

0E8558-00052 7

08558--20042 7

08558-20043 8

0698-7212

0698-7221

0698-7216

0698-7202

0698-7216

08550-60152

3

4

08558-60097 6

0160-3036

0160-3036

8

8

3

7

9

0

0160-4959

0140-0075

1901-0950

1250-1157

1250-1435

1250-0829

9100-2255

08558-80009

08550-00034

08558-00033

08558-00033

08558-20122

9

3

4

2

2

2

6

7

4

4

5

4

08558-20121 3

1

1

6

1

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

2

0

3

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

4

1

1

1

Description

Mfr.

Code

SWITCH BOARD ASSEMBLY

DIODE-GEN PRP 1OOV 200MA DO-7

DIODE-ZNR 7.5V 5% 0DO-35 PD=.4W TC=+.05%

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

DISPLAY-.NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3--H

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

LED-LAMP LUM-INT=8OOUCD IF=3OMA-MAX

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL CCP 1K 20% LIN

RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% CCP TOP-ADJ I-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR o10K 20% CC TOP-ADS 1-TRN

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 20% CCP TOP-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 20% MC TOP-ADJ 1-TRN

28480

28480

20480

20480

28480

28480

28480

28480

24546

28480

28480

28480

24546

28480

28480

24546 RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

(REF LEVEL DOM) SEE FIGURE 6-3.

SWITCH-PB DPDT(AMPLITUDE SCALE)

(SWEEP TIME/DIV) SEE FIGURE 6-3.

(SWEEP TRIGGER) SEE FIGURE 6-3.

(RESOLUTION BW) SEE FIGURE 6-3.

(FREQ SPAN/DIV) SEE FIGURE 6-3.

SWITCH-PB DPDT (START/CENTER)

RIBBON CABLE ASSY-DPM

28480

RIBBON CABLE ASSY-INTERCONNECT

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG I-CHAR .3-H

DISPLAY-HUM-SEC i-CHAR .3--H

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

LED-LAMP LUM-INT=800UCD IF=30MA-MAX

INPUT ATTENUATOR

RESTORED 08558-60003,EXCHANGE REQUIRED

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

FIRST CONVERTER 28480

CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM SGL-HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480

CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM SGL-HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480

CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEN SGL-HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480

CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM SGL-'HOLE-RR 50-OHM 28480

GASKET, FIRST CONVERTER 28480

COVER, FIRST CONVERTER

MOUNT, FIRST CONVERTER

28480

28480

RESISTOR 100 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 147 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 38.3 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 147 1% .85W F TC=0+-100

FIRST MIXER DIODE ASSEMBLY

SECOND-CONVERTER

CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 5000PF +80 -20% 200V

CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 5000PF 0SO -20% 200V

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

28480

28480

28480

CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 10PF 5% 200V CER

CAPACITOR-FDTHRU 22PF 10% 500V MICA

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

CONNECTOR-RF SMA FEM THD-HOLE 50-OlIM

CONN: RF: 500 OHM: SMC

CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-HOLE-FR 50-OHM

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 47ONH 10% .185DX.26LC

COIL, SECOND CONVERTER

COUPLING LOOP, INPUT

COUPLING LOOP, FILTER

COUPLING LOOP, FILTER

OSCILLATOR HOUSING/SECOND CONV. COVER

MATCHED> TO ASFMP2NOT SEPARATELY REPLA

CAVITY BLOCK, SECOND CONVERTER

MATCHED TO A5MP1;NOT SEPARATELY REPLACE

NOT ASSIGNED

33095

72982

28410

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28400

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

08558-60160

1901-0025

1902-0064

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0485

C4-1/8-TO-1622-F

2100-3340

2100-2681

2100-3332

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

2100-1412

2100-3331

C4-1/8-TO-1331-F

3101-2213

3101-2124

08558-60168

08558-60037

1990-0819

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0485

5086-7363

08495-60004

08558-60004

1250-1020

1250-1020

1250-1020

1250-1020

08558-00052

08558-20042

08558-20043

C3-1/8-TO-100R-F

C3-1/8-TO-237R-F

C3-1/8-TO-147R-F

C3-1/8-TO-30R3-F

C3-1/8-TO-147R-F

08558-60152

0855800097

0160-3036

0160-3036

54-713-002-XSE-100J

666-053-0160-220K

1901-0950

1250-1157

1250-1435

1250-0829

9100-2255

08558-80009

08558-00034

08558-00033

08558-00033

08558-20122

08558-20121

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-6

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A7

A7C1

A7C2

A7C3

A7C4

A7C5

A7C6

A7C7

A7C8

A7C9

A7C10

A7C11

A7C12

A7C13

A7C14

A7CR1

A7CR2

A5MP4

A5MP5'

A5MP6

A5MP7 THRU

A5MP10

A5MP11

A5MP12THRU

A5MP17

A5MP18

A5MP19THRU

A5MP22

A5MP23

A5MP24

ASMP25

A5R1

A5A1

A5A1Q1

A5A1R1

A5A1R2

A6

A6MP1

A6MP2

A6MP3

A6MP4

A6MP5 THRU

A6MP7

A7CR3

A7CR4

A7CR5

A7CR6

A7CR7

A7CR8

A7CR9

A7L1

A7L2

A7MP1

A7MP2

A7MP3

A7MP4

A7MP5 THRU

A7MP8

A7MP9 THRU

A7MP12

A7MP13THRU

A7MP16

A7Q1

A7Q2

A7Q3

A7Q4

A7Q5

A7Q6

A7Q7

A7Q8

A7Q9

A7Q10

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

1901--0040

08558-80011

08558-80011

1205-0002

1205-0002

1205-0002

08558-00007

0520-0129

0610-0001

2190-0014

1854-0039

1853-0451

1854-0023

1855-0417

1854-0039

1854-0023

1854-0475

1853-0012

1854-0882

1853-0007

3030-0397

0380-0573

0516-0041

2200-0151

2740-0001

08565-20068

08565-20069

08565-20092

0757-0346

08558-60028

5086-4218

0683-4705

0683-2715

5086-7080

08558-00008

08558-00008

08558-00076

08558-20118

686558-20119 9

08558-60126 2

0180-1746

0180-1746

5

5

0160-3466

0180-0197

0160-3094

0160-3457

0160-3094

0180-0197

0180-1745

0160-3466

0160-2055

8

9

8

4

8

7

8

8

8

0160-2055

0180-1714

0180-1714

1901-0040

1901-0535

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

7

1

9

9

7

3

3

1

1

3

5

8

3

3

6

7

2

3

7

8

7

6

3

6

6

8

4

0

8

6

9

9

2

6

9

1

6

5

9

1

7

7

7

9

8

7

5

4

HP Part C

Number D Qty

08558-20074 5

085513-00032 3

08558-20120 2

1

1

1

1

1

3

1

2

30

1

2

1

1

1

4

1

1

1

2

4

1

6

1

3

4

4

12

2

3

3

1

4

26

1

4

4

3

2

4

6

4

1

98

3

Description

INSULATOR, COUPLING POST

MOUNTING, MIXER DIODE

COVER, OSCILLATOR

SCREW-SET 10-32 1-IN-LG FLAT-PT BRS

STANDOFF-HEX .625-IN-LG 10-32THD

SCREW-MACH 0-80 .125-IN-LG FIL-HD-SLT

SCREW-MACH 4-40 ,75-IN-LG PAN-ND-POZI

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 10-32-THD .109-IN-THK

CAPACITOR, INNER ELEMENT

CAPACITOR, OUTER ELEMENT

CAPACITOR, DIELECTRIC

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

SECOND CONVERTER OSCILLATOR

TRANSISTOR, NPN, MICROWAVE

RESISTOR 47 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+500

RESISTOR 270 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+600

OSCILLATOR, YIG (DOES NOT INCL MTG. HDW}

YIG BRACKET

YIG BRACKET

STRAP, YIG OSCILLATOR

STANDOFF, NOTCHED

STANDOFF, PLAIN

FREQUENCY CONTROL

CAPACITOR-FXD 15lF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 15UF+--10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR--FXD 2,216F+-10% 2OVDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-10% 10VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 200RPF +-10% 250VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-10% 1IRVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2,21UF+-1O% 2OVDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 1,SUF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 10VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD ,.01UF +80-20% 10VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 330UF+-10% 6VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 330UF+-10% 6VDC TA

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V SOMA 2NS 0D-35

DIODE-SM SIC SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 2ODMA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 8OV I00MA 2NS D0-35

NOT ASSIGNED

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

COIL, 100 UH

COIL, 100 UH

HEAT SINK TO-5/TO-39-CS

HEAT SINK TO-5/TO-39-CS

HEAT SINK TO-5/TO-39-CS

HEAT SINK, YIG DRIVE

SCREW-MACH 2-56 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 2-56-THD .062-IN-THK

WASHER-LK INTL T NO. 2 .089-IN-ID

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N30536 SI TO-39 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3799 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-8IS PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-.FET N--CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2904A SI TO-39 PD=600MW

TRANSISTOR NPN PD=300MW FT=20OMHZ

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

Mfr.

Code

28480

28480

20480

00000

00000

00000

00000

26480

56289

56289

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

56289

56289

28480

56289

28480

28480

28480

56289

56289

28480

20480

00000

28480

28480

28480

24546

28480

28480

01121

01121

28480

28480

28480

28480

28460

28480

26480

28460

28480

28480

28480

28430

00000

00000

20480

3L585

01295

28486

26480

3L585

28480

28480

01295

28480

04713

Mfr Part Number

08558-20074

08558-00032

08558-20120

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

08565-20068

08565-20069

08565-20092

C4-1/8-TR-10R0-F

08558-60028

5086-4218

CB4705

C82715

5086-7080

08558-00008

08558-00008

08558-00076

08558-20118

08558-20119

08558R0126

150D156X9020812

150D156X902082

0160-3466

150D225X9020A2

0160-3094

0160-3457

0160-3094

1500225X9020A2

150D155X9020A2

0160-3466

0160-2055

0160-2055

150D337X9006S2

156B337X9006S2

1901-0040

1901-0535

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0040

08558-80011

08558-80011

1205-0002

1205-0002

1205-0002

08558-00007

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

2190-0014

2N3053S

2N3799

1854-0023

1855-0417

2N3053S

1854-0023

1854-0475

2N2904A

1854-0882

2N3251

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-7

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A7R10

A7R11

A7R12

A7R13

A7R14

A7R15

A7R16

A7R17

A7R18

A7R19

A7R20

A7R21

A7R22

A7R23

A7R24

A7R25

47R26

A7R27

A7R28

A7R29

A7R30

A7R31

A7R32

A7R33

A7R34

A7R1

A7R2

A7R3

A7R4

A7R5

A7R6

A7R7

A7R8

A7R9

A7Q11

A7Q12

A7Q13

47Q14

A7Q15

A7Q16

A7Q17

A7Q18

A7Q19

A7Q20

A7Q21

A7Q22

A7Q23

A7Q24

A7Q25

A7R35

A7R36

A7R37

A7R38

A7R39

A7R40

A7R41

A7R42

A7R43

A7R44

A7R45

A7R46

A7R47

A7R48

A7R49

A7R50

A7R51

A7R52

A7R53

A7R54

A7R55

A7R56

A7R57

A7R58

A7R59

A7R60

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

0757-0317

0757-0465

0683-1555

0757-0280

0757-0465

0757-0465

0757-0424

0757-0274

069B-3151

0683-1555

0757-0438

0698-3458

0757-0465

0683-1555

0698-3458

0757-0465

0757-0438

0698-0083

0698-3153

0698-3151

06B3-1555

0683-1555

0757-0280

0698-3153

0757-0290

1854-0882

1854-0039

1853-0007

1853-0007

1855-0062

1855-0062

1854-0404

1853-0007

1855-0420

1855-0062

1B54-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1855-0062

1854-0404

2100-1754

2100-1760

2100-1754

2100-1757

2100-1757

2100-1756

2100-3123

2100-3123

0698-3458

0698-3154

0698-3458

0698-3156

0698-3453

0757-0401

0698-3458

0757-0470

0698-3160

0757-0470

0757-0401

0757-0401

0757-0290

0757-0199

0698-3151

0698-6271

0698-6315

0683-1555

0698-7799

0698-8323

0698-3458

0698-3438

0698-3162

0757-0317

0757-0290

0757-0279

0698-3153

6

0

7

6

3

7

7

0

6

6

7

5

0

3

7

6

3

9

5

0

0

9

7

3

8

0

0

5

0

8

0

7

2

7

7

8

7

8

8

0

0

0

7

2

1

9

2

9

7

3

7

8

1

0

5

3

0

0

7

3

8

2

2

0

7

7

5

0

9

3

0

5

7

0

7

HP Part C

Number D Qty Description

5

1

2

1

4

1

4

6

6

23

6

11

2

1

19

2

4

1

1

1

1

3

5

22

TRANSISTOR NPN PD=30OMNW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N30535 SI TO-39 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360NMW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET 2N4391 N-CHAN D-MODE

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360HW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360hW

RESISTOR-TRMR 50 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 50 5% WW SIDE-ADS 1-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 200 5% WW SIDE-ADJ I-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17--TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10OK 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.5N 5% .25W FC TC=.-900/+1100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.50 5% .25W FC TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 5.111K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F T 0=D+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.5M 5% .25W FC TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=+-100

RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10

RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.5N 5% .25W FC 'TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 1.5M 5% .25W FC TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=2+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=2+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.22K 1% .125W F TC=0+ -100

RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC=D+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=2+-100

RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100

RESISTOR 162K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 162K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1 00

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-800

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% 125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.B7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3K .1% .125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR 503.1 .12X .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.5M 5% .25W FC TC=-800/+1100

RESISTOR 2K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.76K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR 348K 1% .125W F TC= 0-1100

RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 46.4K 1% .12 5W F -TC=0+-10

RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .15W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-8

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Mfr.

Code

24546

24546

01121

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

01121

24546

28480

24546

01121

28480

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

01121

01121

24546

24546

19701

20480

3L585

04713

04713

28480

20480

28480

04713

01295

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

02111

02111

28480

24546

28480

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

28480

03888

01121

19701

19701

28480

84546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

Mfr Part Number

1854-0882

2N3053S

2N3251

2N3251

1855-0062

1855-0062

1854-0404

2N3251

2N4391

1855-0062

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1855-0062

1854-0404

2100-1754

2100-1760

2100-1754

2100-1757

2100-1757

2100-1756

43P501

43P501

0698-3450

C4-1/8-TO-1331-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

CS1555

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003--F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1101.-F

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

C4-1/8-TO-2871-F

C81555

C4-1/8-TO-5111-F

0698-3450

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C155

0698-5458

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-5111-F

C4-1/8-TO-1961-F

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

C4--1/8-TO-2871-F

CB1555

C81555

C4-1/S-TO-1001 -F

C4-.1/8-TO-3831-F

MF4CI/8-TO-6191 -F

C4-1/8-TO-4221-F

0698-3458

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-10-1963-F

C4-1/S-TO-101-F

06?98-2458

C4-1/8-TO-1623.-F

C4--1/8-TO-3162-F

C4- 1/8--1T623--F

84-1/8-TO-101 F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

1/8-0-191-F

C42/8-1-1--F

C4-01/8-0-2871-F

0698-6271

PME55-1/8-TO-503R1-C

C81555

NF4C1/8-10-2001-C

MF4C1/8-T2-2761-C

0698-345 8

C4-1/8-TO-147R-F

C4-1/8-TO-4642-F

C4-1/8-TO-1331-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A7VR1

A7VR2

A7VR3

A8

A8C1

A8C2

A8C3

A8C4

A8C5

A8C6

A8C7

A8C8

A8C9

A8C10

A8C11

A8C12

A8C13

A7R61

A7R62

A7R63

A7R64

A7R65

A7R66

A7R67

A7R68

A7R69

A7R70

A7R71

A7R72

A7R73

A7R74

A7R75

A7R76

A7R77

A7R78

A7R79

A7TP1 THRU

A7TP19**

A7U1

A7U2THRU

A7U4

A7U5

A7U6

A8C14

A8C15

A8C16

A8C17

A8C18

A8C19

A8C20

A8C21

A8C22

A8C23

A8C24

A8C25

A8C26

A8C27

A8CR1

A8CR2

A8CR3

A8CR4

A8CR5

A8CR6

A8CR7

A8CR8

A8CR9

A8CR10

A8CR11

A8CR12

A8CR13

A8CR14

A8CR15

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

1251-0600

1826-0261

0

8

0160-4297

0160-3456

0160-3094

0160-3449

0160-4297

0180-2205

0180-1743

0160-0163

0160-2055

0160-0155

0160-0153

0160-0134

0180-0197

0170-0066

1901-0040

1901-0040

1826-0229

1858-0032

1826-0092

1902-0033

1902-0680

4

7

1902-0202 9

08558-60123 9

8

8

3

0180-0197

0160-3456

0160-3402

0160-3009

0180-0197

0160-3094

0160-3456

0160-3466

0160-2257

0160-2150

0180-0197

0140-0192

0180-0197

8

9

8

3

5

6

8

0

8

8

6

2

5

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0376

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1

1

1

1

1

6

1

1

1

3

3

3

3

0

9

1

1

4

1

9

6

5

3

2

6

5

7

5

6

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0757-0401

0757-0416

0757-0199

0690-3450

0757-0441

0811-3247

0683-1065

0698-3156

0757-0199

0757-0401

0811-3246

2100-3094

0757-0462

0757-0459

0698-3428

0757-0199

0698-3132

0683-1065

0757-0422

7

2

3

8

4

3

9

0

7

4

3

0

3

3

4

7

5

8

1

1

1

1

1

2

4

1

1

2

1

60

2

12

1

1

3

1

2

1

3

2

5

2

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-9

Description

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-00

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1Dno

RESISTOR 41.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 150 1% 7.5W PW TC=0+-20

RESISTOR 10N 5% .25W CC TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1% 7.5W PW TC=0+-20

RESISTOR-TRMR 100K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TEN

RESISTOR 75K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 261 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10M 5% .25W CC TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 909 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 20480

IC OP AMP LOW-NOISE TO-99 PKG 28480

IC OP AMP LOW-DRIFT TO-99 PKG

TRANSISTOR ARRAY 14-PIN PLSTC DIP

IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG

DIODE--ZNR IN823 6.2V 5% 0DO-7 PD=.4W

DIODE-ZNR 1N827 6.2V 5% D00-7 PD=.4W

DIODE-ZNR 15V 5% PD=1W IR=5UA

SWEEP GENERATOR

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2LIF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1IF +-5% 50VDC MET-POLYC

CAPACITOR-FXD 982PF +-1% 1 100VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.21JF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-10% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 10PF +-5% 50FVDC CER 0+-60

CAPACITOR-FXD 33PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.21WF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 68PF +-5% 30OVDC MICA

CAPACITOR--FXD 2,21UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .022UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-10% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 200OPF +-10% 250VDC CER

56289

28480

24800

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD .022UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 33UF+-10% 35VDC TA

56289

56289

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF+-10% 35VDC TA 56289

CAPACITOR-FXD ,033UF +-10% 20OVDC POLYE 28480

CAPACITOR-FXD O01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 3300PF +-10% 200VDC POLYE

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 20OVDC POLYE

CAPACITOR-FXD 220PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .027UF +-10% 20OVDC POLYE

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50NA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50NA 2NS D0-35

28480

21480

28480

28480

56289

28480

28480

28480

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-GEN PRP 35V 50MA D00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35

DIODE--SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V SOMA 2NS D00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS D00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS D00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS 00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS 00-35

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

06665

3L585

28480

24046

24046

28480

28480

56289

28480

28480

28480

56289

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

56289

72136

56289

Mfr.

Code

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

21480

01121

24546

24546

24546

28480

02111

24546

24546

0388

24546

24546

01121

24546

**A7TP11 IS GND;A7TP12 NOT ASSIGNED.

Mfr Part Number

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-T0-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-4222-F

C4-1/8-TO-8251-F

0811-3247

C01065

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

0811-3246

43P104

C41/8-TO-7502-F

C4-1/8-TO-5622--F

PME55-1/8-TO-14R7-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2610-F

CB1065

C4-1/8-TO-909R-F

1251-0600

1826-0261

OP-05CJ

CA3146E

1826-0092

1N823

1N827

1902-0202

0855860123

150D225X9020A2

0160-3456

0160-3402

0160-3009

1500225X9020A2

0160-3094

0160-3456

0160-3466

0160-2257

0160-2150

150D225X9020A2

DM15E68OJO300WVICR

150D225X9020A2

C023F101H223ZS22-CDH

0160-3456

0160-3094

0160-3449

C023F101H223ZS22-CDH

150D334X9035A2

150D104X9035A2

0160-0163

0160--2055

0160-0155

0160-0153

0160-0134

1500225X902A2

0170-0066

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0376

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A8Q26

A8Q27

A8Q28

A8Q29

A8Q30

A8Q31

A8Q32

A8Q33

A8Q34

A8Q35

A8Q36

A8Q37

A8Q38

A8Q39

A8Q40

A8Q41

A8Q42

A8Q43

A8Q44

A8Q45

A8Q46

A8Q47

A8Q48

A8Q49

A8Q50

A8Q51

A8Q52

A8Q53

A8Q54

A8Q55

A8R1

A8R2

A8R3

A8R4

A8R5

A8R6

A8R7

A8R8

A8R9

A8R10

A8Q1

A8Q2

A8Q3

A8Q4

A8Q5

A8Q6

A8Q7

A8Q8

A8Q9

A8Q10

A8Q11

A8Q12

A8CR16

A8CR17

A8CR18

A8CR19

A8CR20

A8CR21

A8CR22

A8CR23

A8CR24

A8CR25

A8MP1

A8MP2

A8MP3

A8Q13

A8Q14

A8Q15

A8Q16

A8Q17

A8Q18

A8Q19

A8Q20

A8Q21

A8Q22

A8Q23

A8Q24

A8Q25

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

1855-0082

1855-0082

1855-0082

1855-0062

1855-0082

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1853-0020

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0404

1853-0020

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0040

1205-0202

0380-0198

2360-0055

1854-0071

1855-00B2

1855-0082

1853-0007

1853-0020

1854-0071

1853-0007

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0404

1855-0417

1853-0020

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0019

1855-0002

1854-0071

1855-0417

1854-0071

1853-0020

1854-0071

0698-3450

2100-3154

0757-0279

0757-0419

0757-0459

0698-3152

0757-0442

0757-0442

0757-0444

2100-3109

7

7

7

7

7

7

4

2

8

2

2

2

0

3

0

0

3

7

0

7

7

0

4

3

0

0

0

9

7

8

8

9

9

1

2

7

4

7

7

7

7

7

7

7

0

7

4

2

7

4

7

2

3

1

3

3

3

3

3

3

3

3

1

1

1

0

0

0

0

3

0

3

0

0

3

2

0

0

1

1

1

16

7

5

20

1

6

2

1

Description

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2HS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA INS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS 00-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

THERMAL LINK DUAL TO-18-CS

STANDOFF-RVT-ON .312-IN-LG 6-32THD

SCREW-MACH 6-32 .188-IN-LG BDG-HD-SLT

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=3OOMW FT=200MNHZ

TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-.MODE SI

TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N31251 SI T0-18 PD :360NW

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300MW FT=15SNHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=3OOnW FT=200NHZ

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360NW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=30OMW FT=200NHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=3SSNW FT=201HZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D0MODE TO-18 SI

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=30OMW FT=150MIIZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PS=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360NW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PS=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=36ONW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-B18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-S18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR J-FET P--CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR J-FET P--CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR J-FET P-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=20MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300MW FT=15MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN ST PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=3&0MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=3&0MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO--IS PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP SI, PD=300MW FT=150MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=20 0MHZ

TRANSISTOR J--FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=20PNDZ

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300MW FT=150MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

RESISTOR 42.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 1K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 11.1K 17 .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17--TRN

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-10

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Mfr.

Code

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

24546

02111

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

02111

28480

28480

28480

04713

28480

28480

04713

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

00000

00000

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

1855-0002

1855-0082

1855-0082

1855-0062

1855-0082

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1853-0020

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0404

1353-0020(

1901-0 050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0040

1205-0202

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

1854-0071

1855-0082

1855-0082

2N3251

1853-0020

1854-0071

2N3251

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0404

1855-0417

1853-0020

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0019

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0404

1854-0019

1855-0082

1854-0071

1855-0417

1854-0071

1853-0020

1854-0071

C4-1/8-TO-4222-F

43P102

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-681R-F

C4-1/8-TO-5622-F

C4-1/8-TO-3481-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

43P202

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A8R42

A8R43

A8R44

A8R45

A8R46

A8R47

A8R48

A8R49

AR850

A8R51

A8R52

A8R53

A8R54

A8R55

A8R56

A8R57

A8R58

A8R59

A8R60

A8R61

A8R62

A8R63

A8R64

A8R65

A8R66

A8R67

A8R68

A8R69

A8R70

A8R71

A8R72

A8R73

A8R74*

A8R75

A8R76

A8R77

A8R78*

A8R79

A8R80

A8R81

A8R82

A8R83

A8R84

A8R85

A8R29

A8R30*

A8R31

A8R32

A8R33

A8R34

A8R35*

A8R36

A8R37

A8R38

A8R39

A8R40

A8R41

A8R11

A8R12

A8R13

A8R14

A8R15

A8R16

A8R17

A8R18

A8R19

A8R20

A8R21

A8R22

A8R23

A8R24

A8R25

A8R26

A8R27

A8R28

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0698-7421

0698-3194

0698-7794

0698-3156

0757-0199

0757-0346

0757-0465

0757-0464

0757-0442

0757-0279

0757-0439

0757-0460

0757-0442

0757-0442

0757-0465

0757-0439

0757-0465

0757-0279

0698-3160

0757-0465

0757-0465

0757-0346

0757-0199

0757-0199

0757-0199

0757-0199

0698-7412

0757-1094

0757-0199

0757-0199

2100-2850

0757-0199

0698-3151

0757-0199

0757-0442

0757-0199

0757-0458

0757-0199

0757-0199

0757-0199

0698-0085

0698-3260

0757-0444

2100-2850

0698-3457

0698-3442

2100-3052

0698-3446

0757-0424

0698-7412

0757-0442

0757-0458

0757-0465

0757-0465

0757-0279

0757-0280

0698-3444

0698-7794

0698-0416

0698-7794

0683-3355

0683-3355

0698-7794

0698-7798

0757-0442

0698-3160

0698-3260

0698-3160

0757-0400

0757-0401

0683-6845

3498-3457

0757-0442

0698-3451

0757-0459

9

9

6

4

4

1

9

0

3

2

6

5

2

2

2

8

3

3

3

6

2

8

6

6

0

3

3

3

0

3

7

3

9

9

1

8

3

8

3

7

9

3

3

1

9

0

9

8

2

6

9

8

9

0

8

1

6

2

2

7

2

0

3

1

2

6

6

9

7

4

3

7

1

6

9

17

8

1

3

4

7

3

3

3

1

1

2

3

4

4

2

8

47

6

2

Description

Mfr.

Code

RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 50 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 383 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W - TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR -51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% 125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 44K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=:0-100

RESISTOR 3.3M 5%., .125W F TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 3.3M 5% .25W F TC=-900/+1100

RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=+100

RESISTOR 5.25K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 464k 1% .125W F TC=:+-100

RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 90.9 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC:TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 680K 5% .25W F TC=-800/+900

RESISTOR 316K 1% . 125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 133K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 40K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 20K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0·1-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC:0+-100

RESISTOR 90.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+ -100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC-TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W E TC=D+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 61.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+ -100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% ,125W F TC=0+ -100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21 .5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10S

RESISTOR 21.5K 17 .125W F TC=04-100

RESISTOR 3.3K 25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.47K 17 .125W F TC=0+-10

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

24546

19701

24546

24546

RESISTOR 21.5K 1-. 125W F TC=D+-100 24546

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% WW SIDE-ADJ 20-TRN 02660

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10 0

24546

24546

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 51.1K 1% ,125W F TC:0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% , 125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .1 -5W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-101

RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

28480

24546

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% WW SIDE-ADJ 20-TRN 02660

19701

19701

24546

24546

28480

24546

24546

24546

01121

28480

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

02111

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

19701

19701

01121

01121

19701

03888

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-11

Mfr Part Number

0698-3457

C4-1/8-TO-237R-F

43P500

C4-1/8-TO-383R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1101-F

MF4C1/8 -TO-1332-C

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-5112-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-T0-316R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

MF4C1/8-TO-4402-C

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

CB3355

CB3355

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

MF4C1/8-TO-5251-C

C4-1/8 TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-3162-F

0698-3260

C4-1/8-TO-3162-F

C4-1/8-TO -90R9-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

CB6845

0698-3457

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1333-F

C4-1/8-TO-5622-F

MF4C1/8-TO-4002-C

PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-9092-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-6192-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-3162-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-C

C4-1/8-TO-1471-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

3810P-103

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2071-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-5112-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2611-F

0698-3260

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

3810P-103

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A8R110

A8R111

A8R112

A8R113

A8R114

A8R115

A8R116

A8R117

A8R118

A8R119

A8R120

A8R121

A8R122

A8R123

A8R124

A8R125

A8R126

A8R127

A8R128

A8R129

A8R130

A8R131

A8R132

A8TP1 THRU

A8TP9

A8R86

A8R87

A8R88

A8R89*

A8R90

A8R91

A8R92

A8R93

A8R94

A8R95*

A8R96

A8R97

A8R98

A8RR99

A8R100

A8R101

A8R102

A8R103

A8R104

A8R105*

A8R106

A8R107

A8R108

A8R109

A8U1

A8U2

A8U3

A8VR1

A8VR2

A8VR3

A9

A9

A9C1

A9C2

A9C3

A9C4

A9C5

A9C6

A9C7

A9C8

A9C9

A9C10

A9C11

A9C12

A9C13

A9C14

A9C15

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

1251-0600

1820-0223

1826-0092

1826-0261

1902-0025

1902-3139

1902-0049

08558-60154

08558-60155

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-2249

0160-2264

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-2207

0140-0195

0140-0198

0180-0197

0180-0197

0160-3878

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0698-3451

0757-0442

0757-0442

0698-7794

0757-0459

0757-0442

0757-0442

0698-3238

0757-0465

0698-7794

0698-7086

0698-8322

0683-1055

0683-1055

0757-0465

0757-0461

0757-0442

0698-7421

0757-0442

0698-3194

0683-3355

0757-0442

0698-3194

0698-7794

0757-0199

0757-0199

0757-0460

0698-7421

0757-0199

0757-0289

0698-3194

0757-0199

0698-3153

0698-7412

0757-0199

0757-0442

0757-0199

0757-0465

0698-7794

0757-0459

0757-0442

0698-3154

0698-3457

0757-0440

0757-0442

0757-0442

0757-0442

5

5

6

2

5

4

6

2

B

9

9

1

9

2

0

9

2

9

8

9

8

9

2

3

9

3

6

9

1

0

3

3

1

2

3

2

3

2

9

9

9

6

7

9

0

2

8

3

7

10

5

10

1

1

3

1

3

8

6

2

5

6

3

2

6

6

6

6

3

6

6

2

6

7

4

7

3

8

0

0 1

5

2

1

1

1

2

1

I

1

1

12

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-12

Description

RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-1O0

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 61.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 40K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 20K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% ,125W F TC=0+ -100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K .25% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.22K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 133K 1% 3 125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.5K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.02K .25% -125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 111 .2% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1M 5% .25W FC TC=0+-800/+900

RESISTOR 1M 5% .25W FC TC=0+-800/+900

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 68.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 40K .25% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 20K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR 3.3M 5% .25W FC TC=0+-900/+1100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 20K .25% .125W F rC=0+-50

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-S7 SQ 28480

IC OP AMP GP TD-99 PKG 3L585

IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG

IC OP AMP LOW-NOISE TO-99 PKG

28480

28480

DIODE-ZNR 10V 5% DO-35 PD=4W TC=.06%

DIODE-ZNR 8.25V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W

DIODE-ZNR 6.19V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W

THIRD CONVERTER

THIRD CONVERTER, OPTION 001/002

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 10IVOC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 1009VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 4.7PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 20PF +-5% 500VDC CER 0+-30

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 130PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 200PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR--FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2U2F+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-20% 100VDC CER

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

72136

72136

56289

56289

28480

Mfr.

Code

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

19701

28480

19701

01121

01121

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

03888

01121

24546

03888

19701

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

19701

03888

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

24546

24546

24546

Mfr Part Number

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-6192-F

MF4C1/8-TO-4002-C

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-C

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-PF

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

C4-1/8-TO-5622-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-4221-F

0698-3457

C4-1/B-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1333-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

C4-1/8-TO-5622--F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

0698-3238

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1002-C

0690-7086

MF4C1/8-TO-111R-C

CB1055

CB1055

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-6812-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

MF4C1/8-TO-4002-C

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C

CB3355

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

PME55-1/8-T2-2002-C

1251-0600

CA301AT

1826-0092

1826-0261

1902-0025

1902-3139

1902-0049

08558-60154

08558-60155

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-2249

0160-2264

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-2207

DM15F131J0300WV1CR

DM15F201J0300WV1CR

150D225X9020A2

150D225X9020A2

0160-3878

Model 8558B

A9R10

A9R11

A9R12*

A9R12*

A9R13

A9R14*

A9R15

A9R16

A9R17

A9R18

A9R19

A9R20

A9R21

A9R22

A9R23

A9R24

A9R25

Reference

Designation

A9L7

A9L8

A9L9

A9L10

A9L11

A9L12

A9L13

A9L14

A9L15

A9L16

A9MP1

A9MP2

A91Q

A9Q2

A9Q3

A9Q4

A9Q5

A9R1

A9R2

A9R3

A9R4*

A9R5

A9R6

A9R7

A9R8

A9R9*

A9R10

A9R10

A9E3

A9J1

A9J2

A9L1

A9L2

A9L3

A9L4

A9L5

A9L6

A9C16

A9C17

A9C18

A9C19

A9C20

A9CR1

A9CR2

A9CR3

A9CR4

A9CR5

A9CR6

A9CR7

A9CR8

A9E1

A9E2

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

0698-7203

0698-7206

0757-0416

0757-0416

0698-3450

0757-0463

0698-3438

0683-0475

0757-0464

0698-3150

0698-3156

0757-0418

0698-3159

0757-0317

0698-3447

0757-0280

0757-0418

HP Part C

Number D Qty

9100-2255

9100-2255

9100-2249

9100-2249

9100-2276

9140-0178

9140-0178

9140-0143

9100-1623

9100-1623

08558-00014

08558-00079

1854-0345

1854-0247

1854-0247

1854-0019

1854-0404

2100-2522

0757-0280

0757-0346

0757-0424

2100-3123

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0799

0757-0274

0698-7188

0698-7196

0160-3456

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0070

1901-0070

9170-0029

1200-0173

1200-0173

1250-0830

1250-0830

9100-2255

9100-2255

08558-80002

08558-80012

9100-2255

9100-2250

8

9

9

3

1

8

8

8

9

0

0

9

6

6

4

4

2

2

9

7

0

3

2

0

1

5

8

8

7

7

3

5

1

1

9

9

7

7

6

7

7

1

1

7

4

9

4

5

6

4

5

6

10

23

2

21

3

4

1

1

1

8

6

2

1

1

1

2

1

4

1

1

1

2

4

8

1

1

7

7

8

1

5

7

2

9

3

1

5

6

9

4

4

3

9

12

1

2

5

4

0

0

Description

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-PWR RECT 600V 750MA DO-29

DIODE-PWR RECT 600V 750MA DO-29

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL

INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL

CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-HOLE-FR 50-OHM

CONNECTOR-RE SMC M SGL-HOLE-FR 50-OHM

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG

COIL, NEUTRALIZING

COIL., FREQUENCY ADJUST

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 180NH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 470NH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 150NH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 150NH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 100UH 10% .185Dx.26L.G

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10%.166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 3.3UH 10% .105DX,26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 27UH 5% .166DX,38SLG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 27UH 5% .166DX.385L.G

COVER, THIRD CONVERTER

RF SHIELD, MIXER

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI T0-72 PD=200MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-39 PD=1W FT=800MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-39 PD=1W FT=800MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=O+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 10 1X .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 121 1x .5W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .5OW F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

(OPTION 001/002)

RESISTOR 42.2 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

(OPTION 001/002)

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=1+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

(OPTION 001/002)

RESISTOR 42.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 02.5K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.7 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+500

RESISTOR 90,9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2,37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1Z .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 26.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.33K-1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 422 1% ,125W F T=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-13

Mfr Part Number

0160-3456

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0070

1901-0070

9170-0029

1200-0173

1200-0173

1250-0830

1250-0830

9100-2255

9100-2255

08558-80002

08558-80012

9100-2255

9100-2250

9100-2255

9100-2255

9100-2249

9100-2249

9100-2276

9140-0178

9140-0178

9140-0143

9100-1623

9100-1623

08558-00014

08558-00079

2N5179

1854-0247

1854-0247

1854-0019

1854-0404

ET50X103

C4-1/8-TO-001-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-1101-F

43P501

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

0757-0799

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

C3-1/8-TO-10R-F

C3-1/8-TO-21R5-F

C3-1/8-TO-42R2-F

C3-1/8-TO-56R2-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-4222-F

C4-1/8-TO-0252-F

C4-1/8-TO-147R-F

CB47G5

C4-1/8-TO-9092-F

C4-1/8-TO-2371-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-619R-F

C4-1/8-TO-2612-F

C4-1/8-TO-1331-F

C4-1/8-TO-422R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-619R-F

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

01121

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

Mfr.

Code

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

28480

28480

28480

28480

30983

24546

24546

24546

02111

24546

24546

28480

24546

24546

24546

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28400

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A9U1

A9VR1

A9VR2

A9Z1

A11C1

A11C12

A11C13

A11C14

A11C15

A11C16

A11C17

A11C18

A11C19

A11C20*

A11C21

A11C22

A11C23

A11C24

A11C25

A11C26

A11C27

A11C28

A11C29

A11C30

A11C31

A11C32

A11C33

A11C34

A11C35

A10L1

A10L2

A10L3

A10L4

A10L5

A10MP1

A10MP2

A10Q1

A10Q2

A10R1

A10R2

A10R3

A10R4

A10R5

A11

A11C1

A11C2

A11C3

A11C4

A11C5

A11C6

A11C7

A11C8

A11C9

A11C10

A10

A10C1

A10C2

A10C3

A10C4

A10C5

A10C6

A10C7

A10C8

A10C9

A10C10

A10C11

A10C12

A10C13

A10C14

A10C15

A10J1

A10J2

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0955-0076

1902-3104

1902-0025

1GA1-8001

4

3

5

6

1

1

1

1

3

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0140-0194

0160-3431

0160-4084

0121-0036

0121-0446

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-4084

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

08558-60010

0121-0457

0121-0457

0121-0457

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3877

0160-3878

0160-2236

0160-2250

0160-3878

0160-2250

0160-2250

0160-2252

0160-2250

0160-2250

1250-0830

1250-0830

9100-2247

08558-80005

08558-80003

08558-80003

08558-80003

08558-00015

1200-0172

1853-0007

5086-4218

0757-0442

0698-3136

0757-0438

0698-3442

0757-0280

9

3

08558-60128 4

0160-2055 9

8

3

7

9

6

2

4

7

6

6

4

8

0160-0127

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2250

0121-0059

3

9

9

9

9

9

9

2

8

6

6

9

9

7

6

6

6

6

6

8

6

6

5

6

8

6

6

6

9

9

3

9

6

8

6

9

3

9

9

9

9

6

9

7

8

0

9

1

9

9

1

3

9

1

1

2

2

1

3

1

1

3

4

4

4

5

4

Description

MIXER, D0UBLE BALANCED

DI0DE-ZNR 5.62V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W

DI0DE-ZNR 10V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W TC=+.06%

SURFACE ACOUSTICAL. WAVE RESONATOR

(SAWR)

SECOND IF

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-PSTN 8-8.5PF 750V

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-PSTN .8-8.5PF 750V

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-PSTN .8-8.5PF 750V

CAPACITOR-FXD 1D00PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-20% 200VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 100PF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500 VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-.20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500 VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 6.2PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-H0LE-FR 50-OHM

CONNECTOR-RF SMC M SGL-H0LE-FR 50-OHM

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 100NH 10% .105DX.26LG

COIL, PAR TANK

COIL, BANDPASS FILTER

COIL, BANDPASS FILTER

COIL, BANDPASS FILTER

C0VER, SECOND I. F

INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR, NPN MICROWAVE

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC:=0+-100

RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=00+-100

BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1

CAPACITOR-FXD ,01UF +80-20% 100VDC CE0R

CAPACITOR-FXD 11JF -20% 2SVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-.2PF 5S00VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .016F +80-20% 1100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-7FXD .0UF +00-20 1001VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 500PF 1-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 10VD0C CER

CAPACITOR --FXD .01UF +80--207 10lVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10%x 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25'SPF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-.20 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +0--20% 1D0VDC 10 ER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20X 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8 .+-.5PF 500VDC

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V

CAPACITOR FXD 01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 10UVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +10-20% 10VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF R80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% - 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% x100VDC CER

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-14

Mfr Part Number

0955-0076

1902-3104

1902-0025

1GA1-8001

08558-60010

TP9

TP9

TP9

0160-3878

0160-3878

0160-3877

0160-3878

0160-2236

0160-2250

0160-3878

0160-2250

0160-2250

0160-2252

0160-2250

0160-2250

1250-0830

1250-0830

9100-2247

08558-80005

08558-80003

08558-80003

08558-80003

08558-00015

1200-0172

2N3251

5086-4218

C4-1/8-T0-1002-F

C4-1/8-T0-1782-F

C4-1/8-T0-5111-F

C4--1/8-T0-237R-F

C4-1/8-T0-1001-F

08558-60128

0160-2055

0160-0127

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2250

304324 2/8PF NPO

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

DM15F111J0300D0WV1CR

0160-3431

0160-4084

304324 5.5/18PF NPO

0121-0446

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-4084

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

Mfr.

Code

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

72136

28480

28480

52763

28480

28480

28480

28400

28480

28400

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

28480

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

52763

28480

18736

18736

18736

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A11C36

A11C37

A11C38

A11C39

A11C40

A11C41

A11C42

A11C43

A11C44

A11C45

A11C46

A11C47

A11C48

A11C49

A11C50

A11C51

A11C52

A11C53

A11C54

A11C55

A11C56THRU

A11C59

A11C60

A11C61

A11C62

A11C63

A11C64

A11C65

A11C66

A11C67

A11C68THRU

A11C72

A11C73

A11C74

A11CR1

A11CR2

A11CR3

A11CR4

A11CR5

A11CR6

A11CR7

A11CR8

A11CR9

A11CR10

A11CR11

A11CR12

A11CR13

A11CR14

A11CR15

A11CR16

A11CR17

A11E1 THRU

A11E8

A11L1

A11L2

A11L3

A11L4

A11L5

A11L6

A11L7

A11L8

A11L9

A11L10

A11L11

A11L12

A11L13

A11L14

A11L15

A11L16

A11L17

A11MP1

A11Q1

A11Q2

A11Q3

A11Q4

A11Q5

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

0121-0452

0121-0452

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0047

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0535

9170-0029

9140-0112

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9100-3854

9140-0098

9140-0178

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9140-0098

9100-1620

9100-3854

9140-0144

9100-1624

08565-00024

1854-0345

1854-0404

1853-0007

1853-0007

1855-0267

8

9

9

9

9

8

9

9

8

8

9

9

8

9

9

4

4

8

1

3

5

4

9

0

0

1

3

9

2

1

0

7

7

5

8

0

3

2

0

4

9

1

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0160-2055

0160-2250

0121-0059

9

6

7

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3431

0140-0194

0121-0036

0160-4084

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0121-0446

0160-2055

9

9

9

9

9

9

6

9

9

6

9

7

8

9

1

0

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2208

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

9

9

9

9

9

9

4

9

4

13

3

4

7

6

14

4

4

2

3

2

1

1

Description

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC: CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01F +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8PF +-5PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF4-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-2.0% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-20% 10VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 330PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +50-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

NOT ASSIGNED

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE--PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE.-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75HA 10NS

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX,385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% 166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX .385LG

INDUCTOR 400NH 10% .3DX1 .016LG Q =150

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2.2UH 10

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX .385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX. 385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2,2UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .166DX385LG

INDUCTOR 400NH 10% .3DX1, .016LG Q=150

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10% .185 DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .1,6DX.385LG

BAFFLE, INDUCTOR

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD:=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN 0-MODE TO-92 SI 4

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-15

TM 11-6625-3061-14

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

74970

74970

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

28480

04713

04713

28480

Mfr.

Code

28480

28480

52763

28480

28480

28480

28480

72136

52763

28480

28480

284B0

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

0160-2055

0160-2250

304324 2/8PF NPO

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3431

DM15F111J0300WV1CR

304324 5.5/18PF NPO

0160-4084

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0121-0446(

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2208

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

187-0103-028

187-0103-028

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0047

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0535

9170-0029

9140-0112

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9100-3854

9140-0098

9140-0178

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9140-0098

9100-1620

9100-3854

9140-0144

9100-1624

08565-00024

2N5179

1854-0404

2N3251

2N3251

1855--0267

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A11R29

A11R30

A11R31

A11R32

A11R33

A11R34

A11R35

A11R36

A11R37

A11R38

A11R39

A11R40

A11R41

A11R42

A11R43*

A11R44

A11R45

A11R46

A11R47

A11R48*

A11R49

A11R50

A11R51

A11R52

A11R53

A11R54

A11R55

A11R56*

A11R57

A11R58

A11R59

A11R60

A11TP1

A11TP2

A11TP3

A11TP4

A11TP5

A11TP6

A11TP7

A11TP8

A11TP9

A11TP10

A11Q6

A11Q7

A1RQ8

A11Q9

A11Q10

A11R1

A11R2

A11R3

A11R4

A11R5

A11R6

A11R7

A11R8

A11R9

A11R10

A11R11

A11R12

A11R13

A11R14

A11R15

A11R16

A11R17

A11R18

A11R19

A11R20

A11R21

A11R22

A11R23*

A11R24

A11R25

A11R26

A11R27

A11R28

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

1853-0007

1854-0404

1853-0007

1855-0267

1853-0007

0757-0444

0698-3156

0757-0402

7

0

7

5

2

1

7

1

6

2

2

1

0757-0346

0757-0290

0698-3440

0757-0416

0757-0442

0757-0424

0757-0180

0698-3152

0757-0180

0698-3153

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

0757-0405

0698-3431

0698-8822

0757-0401

0757-0439

0757-1094

0757-0440

0757-0447

0698-0082

0757-0346

0698-3440

0757-0419

0698-3442

0757-0279

0757-0279

0757-0442

0757-0442

0757-0442

0757-0289

0757-0465

0757-0465

2100-3163

0757-0444

0757-0290

0757-1094

0757-0402

2100-3052

0757-0442

0757-0199

0757-0288

0698-0083

0757-0416

0698-3441

0757-0419

0698-3442

0757-0279

0757-0442

0757-0200

0757-0442

0757-0401

0757-0401

0757-0346

0698-3156

0757-0444

7

2

8

7

9

2

5

7

7

7

2

9

0

7

7

0

0

0

0

9

2

6

9

9

0

0

0

9

9

1

4

1

5

6

8

7

4

4

9

7

2

7

4

6

9

0

8

0

9

0

7

9

3

1

7

9

0

9

2

2

1

0

0

1

9

14

2

5

3

4

6

8

Description

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-M0DE TO-92 SI

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 162 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 23.7 1% .125W F TC=+-100

RESISTOR 6.81 1% .1251W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.47K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 464 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F 1C=D+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=D+-100

RESISTOR 11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1%.125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 1M 20% C SIDE-.ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-1R0

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.47K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0 +-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 50 10% C SIDE--ADJ 17-TRN

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1X .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESIST1)R 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 215 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESIST 0R 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-110

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-110

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-10

RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6 1x .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ S0

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ S

CONNECTOR-SGL- CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ

NOT ASSIGNED

C10NNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-16

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Mfr Part Number

2N3251

1854-0404

2N3251

1855-0267

2N3251

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-111-F

C4-1/8-TO-162R-F

PME55-1/8-TO-23R7-F

0698-8822

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TR-1471-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-'TO-1622-F

C4-1/8-TO-4640-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-681R-F

C4-1/8-TO-237R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161--F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

MS4C1/8-TO-1332F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

43P105

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-1471-F

C4-1/8-TO-111-F

43P500

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F

C4-1/8-TO-1961-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-215R-F

C4-1/8-TO-681R-F

C4-1/8-TO-237R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4. 1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-5621-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1 /8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8TO-1212-F

C4-1/8 -TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8STD-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R--F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1101-F

0757-0180

C4-1/8-TO-3481-F

0757-0180

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

28480

24546

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

02111

24546

19701

24546

24546

02111

24546

03888

28480

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

Mfr.

Code

04713

28480

04713

28480

04713

24546

24546

24546

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A11TP1

A11VR1

A11Y1/2

A12CR3

A12CR4

A12CR5

A12CR6

A12E1

A12E2

A12E3

A12L1

A12L2

A12L3

A12L4

A12L5

A12L6

A12L7

A12L8

A12L9

A12L10

A12L11

A12Q1

A12Q2

A12Q3

A12Q4

A12Q5

A12Q6

A12Q7

A12C17

A12C18

A12C19

A12C20

A12C21

A12C22

A12C23

A12C24

A12C25

A12C26

A12C27

A12CR1

A12CR2

A12

A12

A12C1

A12C2

A12C3

A12C4

A12C5

A12C6

A12C7

A12C8

A12C9

A12C10

A12C11

A12C12

A12C13

A12C14

A12C15

A12C16

A12Q8

A12Q9

A12Q10

A12Q11

A12Q12

A12Q13

A12R1

A12R2

A12R3

A12R4

A12R5

HP Part C

Number D Qty

1251-0600

1902-0048

0410-0450

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9100-2260

9140-0158

9100-2552

1853-0007

1854-0345

1853-0007

1854-0345

1853-0007

1854-0345

1853-0007

08558-60012

08558-60073

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2199

0160-2307

0140-0194

0180-0291

1901-0050

1901-0050

1853-0007

1853-0007

1854-0882

1854-0882

1853-0007

1853-0213

2100-3103

2100-3103

2100-3054

2100-3061

2100-3103

2

5

4

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

3

3

3

1

9

9

9

9

7

8

7

7

8

7

8

6

4

7

7

6

6

8

8

7

7

6

5

6

9

2

9

9

9

9

9

9

3

3

3

4

1

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

3

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

5

8

0

1

5

1

1

1

3

2

2

1

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

Description

Mfr.

Code

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1,14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

DIODE-ZNR 6.81V 5% DO-35 PD=.4W

28480

CRYSTAL, 21.4 MHZ (MATCHED SET OF FOUR;

INCLUDES A11Y1, A11Y2, A13Y1, & A13Y2)

28480

STEP GAIN

STEP GAIN, OPTION 001/002

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF+-10% 35VDC TA

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

56289

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2000PF +-10% 250VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2000PF +-10% 250VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2000PF +-10% 250VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 30PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 47PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF+-10% 35VDC TA

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

72136

56209

28480

28480

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1.8UH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX.385LG

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN PD=300MW FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N4236 SI TO-5 PD=1W

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 50K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 500K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

04713

04713

04713

04713

04713

04713

04713

04713

28480

28480

04713

04713

02111

02111

02111

02111

02111

Mfr Part Number

1251-0600

1902-0048

0410-0450

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9140-0179

9100-2260

9140-0158

9100-2552

2N3251

2N5179

2N3251

2N5179

2N3251

2N5179

2N3251

08558-60012

08558-60073

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

150D105X9035A2

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3457

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3457

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3457

0160-2055

0160-2199

0160-2307

DM15F111J0300WV1CR

150D105X9035A2

1901-0050

1901-0050

2N3251

2N3251

1854-0882

1854-0882

2N3251

2N4236

43P103

43P103

43P503

43P504

43P103

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-17

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A12R6

A12R7

A12R8

A12R9

A12R10

A12R11

A12812

A12R13

A12R14

A12R15

A12R16

A12R17

A12R18

A12R19

A12R20

A12R21

A12R22

A12R23

A12824

A12R25

A12R26

A12R26

A13C1

A13C2

A13C3

A13C4

A13C5

A13C6

A13C7

A13C8

A13C9

A13C10

A13C11

A13C12

A13C13

A13C14

A13C15

A13C16

A13C17

A13C18

A13C19

A13C20*

A12827

A12R28

A12R29

A12R30

A12R31

A12R32

A12R33

A12R34

A12R35

A12R36

A12R37

A12R38

A12R39

A12R40

A12R41

A12R42

A12R43

A12R44

A12R45

A12R46

A12R47

A12R48

A12R49

A12S1

A12TP1 THRU

A12TP9

A12VR1

A13

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0757-0280

0757-0279

0690-3444

0757-0395

0757-0280

0757-0420

0757-0280

0757-0279

0698-3444

0757-0395

0757-0280

0757-0420

0757-0280

0698-3440

0757-0274

0757-0274

0698-3151

0698-3151

0757-0290

0698-3151

0698-3162

0698-3162

0698-3162

3101-0973

2100-3056

2100-1757

0757-0288

0698-3457

0757-0346

0757-0279

0698-3444

0757-0208

0757-0395

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0290

0757-0346

0757-0290

0757-0279

0698-3162

0757-0279

0698-3444

0757-0395

0757-0280

0757-0417

0757-0419

1251-0600

1902-0033

08558-60129

0160-2055

0160-0127

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2250

0121-0059

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0140-0194

Description

Mfr.

Code

7

5

3

3

0

1

1

3

3

3

1

3

3

0

1

0

0

7

0

5

5

7

7

5

5

0

0

0

5

2

2

2

3

8

1

1

0

1

1

1

2

0

1

6

8

2

1

5

2

1

RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 9.09K 17 .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1x .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 46.4K 11 .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2 17 .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 11 .125W F TC=0+-108

RESISTOR 562 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

(OPTION 001/002)

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F C=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1X .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 46.4K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 46.4K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 46.4K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

SWITCH-SL DPDT MINTR .5A 125VAC/DC PC

9

1

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

3

6

6

7

8

9

9

2

0

4

5 1

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

DIODE-ZNR 1N823 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.4W

BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2

24046

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1UF +-20% 25VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

28480

28480

28480

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

28480

28480

52763

28480

28480

28480

72136

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

02111

28480

19701

213480

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

6-18

Mfr Part Number

43P502

2100-1757

MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F

0698-3457

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F

C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-4642-F

C4--1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-562R-F

C4-1/8-TO-681R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

C4-1/8-TO-2071-F

C4-1/8-TO-2871-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-2871-F

C4-1/8-TO-4642-F

C4-1/8-TO-4642-F

C4-1/8-TO-4642-F

3101-0973

1251-0600

1N823

08558-60129

0160-2055

0160-0127

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2250

304324 2/8PF NPO

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

DM15F111J0300WV1CR

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A13C21

A13C22

A13C23

A13C24

A13C25

A13C26

A13C27

A13C28

A13C29

A13C30

A13C31

A13C32

A13C33

A13C34

A13C35

A13C36

A13C37

A13C38

A13C39

A13C40

A13C41

A13C42

A13C43

A13C44*

A13C45

A13C46

A13C47

A13C48

A13C49

A13C50

A13C51

A13C52

A13C53

A13C54

A13C55

A13C56 THRU

A13C59

A13C60

A13C61

A13C62

A13C63

A13C64

A13C65

A13C66

A13C67

A13C68 THRU

A13C72

A13C73

A13C74

A13CR1

A13CR2

A13CR3

A13CR4

A13CR5

A13CR6

A13CR7

A13CR8

A13CR9

A13CR10

A13CR11

A13CR12

A13CR13

A13CR14

A13CR15

A13CR16

A13CR17

A13CR18

A13E1

A13E2

A13E3

A13E4

A13E5

A13E6

A13E7

A13E8

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

0121-0452

0121-0452

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0047

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0535

1901-0047

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0160-3431

0160-4084

0121-0036

0121-0446

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-4084

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2250

0121-0059

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3431

0140-0194

0121-0036

0160-4084

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0121-0446

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

Description

Mfr.

Code

9

9

6

6

9

8

3

9

6

9

6

7

9

9

7

8

0

9

6

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

7

9

6

1

0

8

CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8PF +-.5PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20x 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 300PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 5.1PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 2-8PF 350V PC-MTG

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1000PF +.-10% 1KVDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 6.8PF +-.5PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 110PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 5.5-18PF 350V

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR--FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF+80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-CER 4.5-20PF 160V

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

9

9

9

9

4

4

8

8

3

3

3

3

9

8

9

8

3

3

3

3

8

9

9

9

9

8

8

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V

CAPACITOR-V TRMR-AIR 1.3-5.4PF 175V

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 112V

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

NOT ASSIGNED

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA-10NS

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-19

74970

74970

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

52763

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

20480

28480

52763

28480

28480

20480

28480

72136

52763

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

187-0103-028

187-0103-028

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0047

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-0047

1901-0535

1901-0535

1901-0047

1901-0535

1901-0047

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

9170-0029

Mfr Part Number

0160-3431

0160-4084

304324 5.5/18PF NPO

0121-0446

0160--2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-4084

0160-2207

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2250

304324 2/8PF NPO

0160-2055

0160-3456

0160-2055

0160-3431

DM15F111J0300WV1CR

304324 5.5/18PF NPO

0160-4084

0160-2055

0160-20550

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0121-0446

0160-2055

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A13MP1

A13Q1

A15Q2

A13Q3

A13Q4

A13Q5

A13Q6

A13Q7

A13Q8

A13Q9

A13Q10

A13R1

A13R2

A13R3

A13R4

A13R5

A13R6

A13R7

A13R8

A13R9

A13R10

A13011

A13R12

A13R13

A13R14

A13R15

A13R16

A13R17

A13R18

A13019*

A13R20

A13R21

A13R22

A13R23*

A13L1

A13L2

A13L3

A13L4

A13L5

A13L6

A13L7

A13L8

A13L9

A13L10

A13L11

A13L12

A13L13

A13L14

A13L15

A13L16

A13L17

A13R24

A13R25

A13R26

A13R27

A13R28

A13R29

A13R30

A13R31

A13R32

A13R33

A13R34

A13R35

A13R36

A13R37

A13R38

A13R39

A13R40

A13R41

A13R42

A13043*

A13R44

A13R45

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

0757-0405

0698-3431

0698-3427

0757-0402

0757-0288

0698-0083

0757-0442

0757-0199

0757-0416

0757-0346

0698-3441

0757-0419

0698-3442

0757-0279

0757-0200

0757-0442

0757-0442

0757-0442

0698-3156

0757-0465

0757-0465

2100-3163

0757-0444

0757-0290

0757-1094

0757-0402

2100-3052

0757-0442

0757-0199

0757-0288

0698-0083

0757-0416

0698-3441

0757-0419

0698-3442

0757-0279

0757-0442

0757-0438

0757-0442

0757-0401

9140-0112

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9100-3854

9140-0098

9140-0178

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9140-0098

9100-1620

9100-3854

9140-0144

9100-1624

08565-00024

1854-0345

1854-0404

1853-0007

1053-0007

1855-0267

1853-0007

1854-0404

1853-0007

1855-0267

1853-0007

0757-0447

0698-3157

0757-0402

HP Part C

Number D Qty Description

Mfr.

Code Mfr Part Number

9

3

9

0

9

0

1

8

9

3

7

8

0

9

9

2

7

9

9

0

8

0

9

3

7

2

1

8

0

1

4

6

5

9

1

4

8

1

6

6

3

0

0

1

1

4

9

2

0

5

1

0

9

1

3

4

9

7

0

7

7

5

0

7

2

8

4

3

5

7

1

1

1

4

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR 400NH 10% .3DX1.016LG Q=150

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2.2UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 12UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 240UH 5% .166DX.305LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.38SLG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 2.2UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR 400NH 10% ,3DX1.016LG Q=150

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10% ,105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 30UH 5% .166DX.385LG

BAFFLE, INDUCTOR

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI TO-72 PD=200MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360NW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-92 SI

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-92 SI

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N5251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 19.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1X .125W F TC=0+-100

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 162 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 23,7 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 215 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 1M 20% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.47K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 50 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 215 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 681 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

28480

04713

04713

28480

04713

28480

04713

20480

04713

24546

24546

24546

9140-0112

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9100-3854

9140-0098

9140-0178

9100-1641

9140-0114

9100-1624

9140-0179

9140-0098

9100-1620

9100-3854

9140-0144

9100-1624

08565-00024

2N5179

1854-0404

2N3251

2N5251

1855-0267

2N3251

1854-0404

2N3251

1855-0267

2N3251

C4-1/8-TO-1622-F

C4-1/8-TO-1962-F

C4-1/8-TO-111-F

24546 C4-1/8-TO-162R-F

03888 PME55-1/8-TO-23R7-F

03888

24546

PME55-1/8-TO-13R3-F

C4-1/8-TO-111-F

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F

C4-2/8-TO-1961-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

02111

24546

19701

24546

24546

02111

C4-1/8-TO-215R-F

C4-1/8-TO-681R-F

C4-1/8-TO-237R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-5621-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

43P105

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

MF4C1/8-T0-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-1471-F

C4-1/8-TO-111-F

4AF500

C4-11/-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F

C4-1/8-TO-1961-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-215R-F

C4-1/8-TO-681R-F

C4-1/8-TO-237R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-5111-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-101 F

6-20

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A13R46

A13R47

A13R48*

A13R49

A13R50

A13R51

A13R52

A13R53

A13R54

A13R55

A13R56*

A13R57

A13R58

A13R59

A13R60

A13TP1

A13TP2

A13TP3

A13TP4

A13TP5

A13TP6

A13TP7

A13TP8

A13TP9

A13TP10

A13TP11

A13VR1

A13Y1/2

A14C72

A14C73

A14C74

A14C75

A14C76

A14C77

A14CR1

A14CR2

A14CR3

A14CR4

A14CR5

A14CR6

A14CR7

A14CR8

A14CR9

A14CR10

A14CR11

A14CR12

A14CR13

A14CR14

A14CR15

A14

A14C1

A14C2

A14C3

A14C4

A14C5

A14C6

A14C7

A14C8

A14C9

A14C10

A14C11

A14C12

A14C13

A14C14 THRU

A14C34

A14C35

A14C36 THRU

A14C69

A14C70

A14C71

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

0160-4554

0160-4519

0140-0195

0160-4386

0160-3872

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

1910-0016

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1070

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0757-0401

0757-0346

0698-3156

0757-0444

0757-0346

0757-0290

0698-3440

0757-0416

0757-0442

0757-0274

0757-0180

0698-3153

0757-0180

0698-3153

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1902-0048

0410-0450

5061-5411

0160-4554

0180-0197

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-3879

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

Description

Mfr.

Code

7

7

7

7

2

7

8

7

7

7

7

7

7

7

0

0

7

2

9

7

7

2

9

9

5

2

5

7

7

2

1

0

2

0

0

0

0

1

5

7

1

65

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

24546

24546

24546

24546

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=.+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1%X .125W F TC=0+-100

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

28480

28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN .045-IN-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

NOT ASSIGNED

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

DIODE-ZNR 6.81V 5%X DO-35 PD=.4W

CRYSTAL, 21.4 MHZ

(MATCHED SET OF 4;INCL.A13Y1,A13Y2,A11Y1

AND A11Y2)

28480

28480

LOG AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .1UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

NOT ASSIGNED

28480

28480

56289

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

NOT ASSIGNED

28480

7

7

3

0

7

4

2

7

7

0

3

3

1

1

1

1

6

9

6

6

9

6

6

6

6 16

6

1

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 9.1PF +-.5PF 200VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 130PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 33PF +-5% 200VDC CER 0+-30

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2PF +-.25PF 200VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 50VDC CER

DIODE-GE 60V 60MA 1US DO-7

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

NOT ASSIGNED

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

NOT ASSIGNED

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-PIN 110V

28480

28480

28480

28400

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

28480

28480

72136

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

0757-0180

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

0757-0180

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

0360-1788

0360-1788

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1251-0600

1902-0048

0410-0450

5061-5411

0160-4554

150D225X9020A2

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-3879

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4519

DM15F131J0300WV1CR

0160-4386

0160-3872

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

0160-4554

1910-0016

1901-0050

1901-0050

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1065

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1070

6-21

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A14CR33

A14E1

A14L1

A14L2

A14L3

A14L4

A14L5

A14L6

A14L7

A14L8

A14L9

A14L10

A14L11

A14L12

A14L13

A14L14

A14Q1

A14Q2

A14Q3

A14Q4

A14Q5

A14Q6

A14Q7

A14Q8

A14Q9

A14Q10

A14Q11

A14912

A14Q13

A14Q14

A14Q15

A14Q16

A14Q17

A14Q18

A14CR16

A14CR17

A14CR18

A14CR19

A14CR20

A14CR21

A14CR22

A14CR23

A14CR24

A14CR25

A14CR26

A14CR27

A14CR28

A14CR29

A14CR30

A14CR31

A14CR32

A14Q19

A14Q20

A14Q21

A14Q22

A14Q23

A14Q24

A14Q25

A14R1

A14R2

A14R3

A14R4

A14R5

A14R6

A14R7

A14R8

A14R9

A14R10

A14R11

A14R12

A14R13

A14R14

A14R15

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

1901-0050

9170-0029

9100-1618

9140-0144

9140-0105

9100-1619

9100-1619

9140-0114

9140--0114

9140-0114

9140-0112

9140-0105

9100-1627

9100-1629

9100-1622

9100-2257

1854-0637

1853-0281

1853-0281

1053-0015

1053-0015

1853-0007

1854-0019

1853-0015

1854-0019

1853-0015

1854-0019

1053-0015

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1005

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1005

1901-0050

1901-0050

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0475

1854-0404

1853-0181

1854-0404

1854-0019

0757-0117

0757-0280

0698-0084

0698-1430

0757-0443

0757-0442

0757-0465

0757-0442

0698-3450

2100-2633

0698-3155

0757-0458

0757-0401

0757-0460

0757-0458

Description

Mfr.

Code

7

3

7

1

7

7

9

9

4

7

6

1

3

2

4

2

2

4

4

3

2

1

0

3

3

3

3

3

3

3

7

3

7

3

1

6

6

6

6

6

9

9

6

9

6

3

3

6

9

9

6

9

6

9

9

5

0

3

9

9

0

3

7

5

0

3

3

1

7

7

0

5

1

2

1

1

1

3

1

1

2

1

1

2

4

2

2

4

1

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

CORE-SHIELDING BEAD

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 5.6UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10% .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 8.2UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 6.8UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 6.8UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 10UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 4.7UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 8.2UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 39UH 5% .166DX.385LG

28480

28480

28480

28480

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 47UH 5% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 24UH 5% .166DX.385LG

28480

28480

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 820NH 10%X ,105DX.26LG

28480

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N2219A SI TO-5 PD=800MW 01295

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2907A SI TO-18 PD=400MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2907A SI TO-18 PD=400MW

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI T0-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

04713

04713

28480

28480

04713

28480

28480

28480

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSTSTOR PNP SI PD=200MW FT=500MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28400

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28400

28480

28480

28480

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO -18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N2907A SI TO-18 PD=400MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

RESISTOR 1.33K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.15K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 42.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 1K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+--100

RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 61,9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

28480

28480

24546

24546

24546

03888

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

30983

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

Mfr Part Number

1901-0050

9170-0029

9100-1618

9140-0144

9140-0105

9100-1619

9100-1619

9140-0114

9140-0114

9140-0114

9140-0112

9140-0105

9100-1627

9100-1629

9100-1622

9100-2257

2N2219A

2N2907A

2N2907A

1853-0015

1853-0015

2N3251

1854-0019

1853-0015

1854-0019

1853-0015

1854-0019

1853-0015

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1901-1070

1901-1005

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0040

1901-1005

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-0050

1901-0050

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0475

1854-0404

2N2907A

1854-0404

1854-0019

C4-1/8-TO-1331-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-2151-F

PME55-1/8-TO-21R5-F

C4-1/8-TO-1102-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003--F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-4222-F

ET50X102

C4-1/8-TO-4641-F

C4-1/8-TO-5112-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-6192-F

C4-1/8-TO-5112-F

6-22

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A14R33

A14R34

A14R35

A14R36

A14R37

A14R38

A14R39

A14R40

A14R41

A14R42

A14R43

A14R44

A14R45

A14R46

A14R47

A14R48

A14R49

A14R50

A14R51

A14R52

A14R53

A14R54

A14R55

A14R56

A14R57

A14R58

A14R59

A14R60

A14R61

A14R62

A14R63

A14R64

A14R65

A14R66

A14R16

A14R17

A14R18

A14R19

A14R20

A14R21

A14R22

A14R23

A14R24

A14R25

A14R26

A14R27

A14R28

A14R29

A14R30

A14R31

A14R32

A14R67

A14R68

A14R69

A14R70

A14R71

A14R72

A14R73

A14R74

A14R75

A14R76

A14R77

A14R78

A14R79

A14R80

A14R81

A14R82

A14R83

A14R84

A14R85

A14R86

A14R87

A14R88

A14R89

A14R90

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

2100-2522

2100-2521

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0442

0698-3151

2100-2520

0757-0442

0757-0290

0757-0200

0757-0447

0757-0420

0698-3444

0698-3156

0757-0346

0698-3150

0698-3132

0757-0279

0757-0346

0698-3444

0757-0444

0757-0444

0757-0440

0757-0401

0757-0280

0757-0346

0698-3150

0698-3444

0757-0200

0757-0444

0757-0444

0757-0440

0757-0401

0757-0280

0757-0180

0757-0464

0698-3136

0757-0123

0698-0003

2100-2489

0698-3452

2100-2514

0757-0274

0757-0274

0757-0274

2100-2489

0757-0346

0757-0346

2100-2522

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0346

0698-8958

2100-2692

0698-3444

0757-0279

0707-0444

0757-0444

0757-0440

0757-0401

0757-0280

0757-0346

0698-3150

0690-3444

0757-0289

0757-0289

0757-0440

0757-0401

0757-0280

0757-0279

0757-0346

0698-3444

2100-2522

0757-0440

0757-0403

Description

Mfr.

Code Mfr Part Number

1

7

0

3

1

1

0

2

2

2

6

4

3

1

7

4

9

7

9

9

5

2

2

1

0

7

0

3

1

1

1

3

2

6

1

1

5

8

9

2

5

8

3

2

1

2

2

9

2

5

5

1

2

2

7

2

6

0

3

0

1

1

7

6

1

2

2

1

1

7

2

0

2

0

3

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 90.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 34.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 147K 1% .125W F TO=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 20K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.21K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 5K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-*100

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 50 20% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.371K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 261 1% ,125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0 +-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 1M 20% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC-=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 121 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-23

24546

28480

30983

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

30983

24546

24546

28480

24546

24546

28480

24546

30983

24546

30983

24546

24546

24546

30983

24546

24546

30983

24546

24546

0757-0180

C4-1/8-TO-9092-F

C4-1/8-TO-1782-F

0757-0123

C4-1/8-TO-1961-F

ET50X502

C4-1/8-TO-1473-F

ET50W203

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

C4-1/8-TO-1211-F

ET50X502

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

ET50X103

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

30983

30983

24546

24546

24546

24546

30983

24546

19701

ET50X103

ET50X202

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-2871-F

ET50X500

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

C4-1/8-TO-5621-F

C4-1/8-TO-1622-F

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-2371-F

C4-1/8-TO-2610-F

24546

24546

24546

24546

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

24546

24546

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

24546 C4-1/8-TO-101-F

24546 C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-2371-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

0698-0958

ET5X105

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-2371-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

ET50X103

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-121R-F

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A14R108

A14R109

A14R110

A14R111

A14R112

A14R113

A14R114

A14R115

A14R116

A14R117

A14R118

A14R119

A14R120

A14R121

A14R122

A14R123

A14R124

A14R125

A14R126

A14R127

A14R128

A14R129

A14R130

A14R131

A14R132

A14R133

A14R134

A14TP1

A14TP2

A14TP3

A14TP4

A14TP5

A14TP6

A14TP7

A14R91

A14R92

A14R93*

A14R94

A14R95

A14R96

A14R97

A14R98

A14R99

A14R100

A14R101*

A14R102

A14R103

A14R104

A14R105

A14R106

A14R107*

A14TP8

A14TP9

A14TP10

A14U1

A14U2

A14VR1

A15

A15C1

A15C2

A15C3

A15C4

A15C5

A15C6

A15CR1

A15CR2

A15CR3

A15CR4

A15CR5

A15CR6

A15CR7

A15CR8

A15CR9

A15CR10

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0698-3434

0757-0400

0757-0418

0698-3440

0757-0280

0757-0280

0698-3136

0757-0401

0757-0418

0757-0440

0698-0085

0698-3438

0757-0439

2100-2633

0757-0420

0757-0440

0757-0447

0757-0447

0757-0465

0757-0465

0757-0465

0698-0083

0757-0279

0757-0402

0757-1438

0698-7212

0698-7212

0360-0535

0360-0535

0360-0535

0360-0535

0360-0535

0360-0535

0360-0535

0757-0289

0757-0289

0698-3153

0698-3150

0757-0346

0698-3444

0757-0289

0757-0289

0757-0440

0757-0403

0698-3153

0757-0346

0757-0401

0757-0401

0698-3444

0757-0417

0757-0199

0360-0535

0360-0535

0360-0535

1826-0092

1826-0092

1902-0901

08558-60015

0180-0197

0180-0197

0180-0197

0160-2055

0180-0197

0160-2055

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0535

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0050

Description

Mfr.

Code

8

0

1

5

6

6

4

6

5

3

7

4

3

4

7

0

8

0

9

3

3

9

7

9

9

0

0

0

0

0

0

0

9

9

2

2

7

2

1

9

6

2

2

0

1

8

3

2

0

2

9

9

1

1

1

9

8

8

8

3

5

8

8

0

3

0

0

1

3

3

1

1

9

1

33

1

1

1

1

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.37K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 121 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC-0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 562 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 34.8 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 90.9 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+- 100

RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-TRMR 1K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR-5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100 1% .05W F TC=0+-100

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

TERMINAL TEST POINT PCB

IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG

IC OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG

DIODE-ZNR 5.4V 1% DO-35 PD=.4W TC=+.046%

VERTICAL DRIVE AND BLANKING

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

30983

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

24546

00000

00000

00000

00000

00000

00000

00000

19701

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

00000

00000

00000

28480

28480

28480

28480

56289

56289

56289

28480

56289

28400

28480

28400

28480

28450

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-24

Mfr Part Number

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

C4-1/8-TO-2371-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-121R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-562R-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-34R8-F

C4-1/8-TO-90R9-F

C4-1/8-TO-619R-F

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-1782-F

C4-1/8-TO-101-F

C4-1/8-TO-619R-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-2611-F

C4-1/8-TO-147R-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

ET50X102

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-1622-F

C4-1/8-TO-1622-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1961-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-111-F

0757-1438

C3-1/8-TO-101R-F

C3-1/8-TO-100R-F

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

1826-0092

1826-0092

1902-0901

08558-00015

150D225X9020A2

150D225X9020A2

150D225X9020A2

0160-2055

150D225X9020A2

0160-2055

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0535

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0050

1901-0050

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A15Q13

A15Q14

A15Q15

A15Q16

A15Q17

A15Q18

A15Q19

A15Q20

A15Q21

A15R1

A15R2

A15R3

A15R4

A15R5

A15R6

A15R7

A15R8

A15R9

A15R10

A15R11

A15R12

A15R13

A15R14

A15R15

A15R16

A15R17

A15R18

A15R19

A15R20

A15R21

A15R22

A15R23

A15R24

A15R25

A15CR11

A15CR12

A15L1

A15L2

A15MP1

A15Q1

A15Q2

A19Q3

A15Q4

A15Q5

A15Q6

A15Q7

A15Q8

A15Q9

A15Q10

A15Q11

A15Q12

A15R26*

A15R27

A15R28

A15R29

A15R30

A15R31

A15R32

A15R33

A15R34

A15R35

A15R36

A15R37

A15R38

A15R39

A15R40

A15R41

A15R42

A15R43

A15R44

A15R45

A15R46

A15R47

A15R48

A15R49

A15R50

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

1854-0404

1854-0475

1854-0404

1853-0007

1855-0049

1854-0404

1855-0417

1854-0404

1855-0020

2100-3123

0757-0199

0757-0420

0757-0280

0757-0279

0698-3156

0757-0444

0757-0424

0698-3156

8757-0199

0698-3155

0757-0416

0683-0475

0757-0424

0757-0199

0757-0199

0757-0280

0698-3155

0698-0084

0757-0416

0683-1055

0757-0442

0757-0465

0757-0442

0757-0199

1901-0050

1901-0518

9140-0179

9140-0179

1200-0173

1853-0007

1854-0234

1854-0234

1854-0009

1854-0404

1854-0234

1854-0234

1853-8007

1854-0019

1854-0039

1853-0451

1853-0451

0698-3153

0698-3440

0698-3440

0757-0279

0698-3156

0757-0444

0698-3444

0757-0424

0698-3156

0757-0279

0757-0200

0757-0465

0757-0199

0698-3444

0757-0394

0698-3155

0757-0416

0757-0442

0698-3444

0757-0837

0757-0844

0698-3440

0757-0420

0757-0844

0698-3440

Description

Mfr.

Code

1

7

3

3

1

7

2

3

0

2

1

7

3

3

0

3

1

0

7

0

8

0

7

0

5

6

9

3

5

9

9

7

3

1

5

7

4

4

1

1

I

3

8

3

7

5

5

4

7

0

4

3

1

0

1

7

6

2

0

2

1

1

7

7

0

9

7

3

5

7

5

7

1

6

7

9

1

4

1

1

1

1

2

2

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SM SIG SCHOTTKY

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 22UH 10% .166DX.385LG

INSULATOR-XSTR DAP-GL

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300MW FT=600MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3440 SI TO-5 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3799 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3799 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750MW

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR-JFET DUAL N-CHAN D-MODE SI

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR J-FET N-CHAN D-MODE TO-18 SI

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.7 5% .25W FC TC=-400/+500

RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2,15K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-10O

RESISTOR 1M 5% .25W FC TC=-800/+900

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.83K 1% .125WF TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 12.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1,1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 5.62K 1% .125W F T=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% 125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 51.1 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.64K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W FTC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 196 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

28480

28480

28480

04713

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

02111

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

01121

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

01121

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

3L585

3L585

04713

28480

3L585

3L585

04713

28480

3L585

01295

01295

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

28480

24546

24546

28480

24546

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-25

Mfr Part Number

1901-0050

1901-0518

9140-0179

9140-0179

1200-0173

2N3251

2N3440

2N3440

2N709

1854-0404

2N3440

2N3440

2N3251

1854-0019

2N30535

2N3799

2N3799

1854-0404

1854-0475

1854-0404

2N3251

1855-0049

1854-0404

1855--0417

1854-0404

1855-0020

43P501

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-1101-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-4641-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

CB47G5

C4-1/8-TO-1101-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-4641-F

C4-1/8-TO-2151-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

CB1055

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-3831-F

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-1212-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1101-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-5621-F

C4-1/8-TO-1013-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-51R1-F

C4-1/8-TO-4641-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

0757-0837

0757-0844

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

0757-0844

C4-1/8-TO-196R-F

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A16VR3

A16VR4

A16W1

A16W2

A16W3

A16W4

A16XA1 THRU

A16XA6

A16XA7

A16XA8

A16XA9

A16XA10

A16XA11

A16XA12

A16XA13

A16XA14

A16XA15

A17

A17C1

A17C2

A17C3

A17C4

A17C5

A15R51

A15R52

A15R53

A15R54

A15R55

A15R56

A15V1

A15V2

A15VR1

A15VR2

A15VR3

A15TP1 THRU

A15TP8

A16

A16C1

A16C2

A16C3

A16C4

A16C5

A16C6

A16C7

A16C8 THRU

A16C14

A16CR1

A16CR2

A16CR3

A16L1

A16L2

A16L3

A16L4

A16L5

A16MP1

A16MP2

A16R1

A16R2

A16R3

A16R4

A16R5

A16R6

A16R7

A16R8

A16TP1

A16TP2

A16VR1

A16VR2

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

0757-0837

0698-3444

0698-3260

0698-3446

0757-0280

0698-7284

1826-0092

1E58-0032

1902-0033

1902-0202

1902-0556

1251-0600

08558-65159

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

0180-0197

0180-0197

0160-3879

0160-2055

1901-0033

1901-0376

1901-0050

9140-0158

9140-0158

9140-0158

9140-0158

9100-2247

08558-20159

0380-0843

0757-0424

0757-0465

0698-5360

2100-1757

0757-0444

0698-3442

0757-0395

0698-3260

1251-0600

1251-0600

1902-0625

1902-0631

1902-0632

1902-3182

08558-60169

08558-60044

08558-60080

08558-60081

HP Part C

Number D Qty

5

3

3

3

6

1

9

8

4

9

6

8

8

7

7

7

7

7

0

1

1

1

1

1

1

0

0

0

9

0

9

1

2

1

5

7

4

7

6

2

6

6

6

6

3

3

0

0

7

8

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-0472

1251-0472

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-2034

08558-60035

11100-0228

0180-1747

0160-0128

0180-0229

0160-0128

3

7

3

6

6

8

2

6

6

6

6

6

6

4

4

6

2

1

1

1

1

2

1

Description

Mfr.

Code

RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .5W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 383 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

IC OF AMP GP DUAL TO-99 PKG

TRANSISTOR ARRAY 14-PIN PLSTC DIP

DIODE-ZNR 1N823 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.4W

DIODE-ZNR 15V 5% PD=1W 1R=5UA

DIODE-ZNR 20V 5% PD=1W 1R=5UA

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

MOTHERBOARD (INCL W12, W13 & P1) 28480

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CE.R

28480

2B480

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+-10% 20VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +-20% 100VDC CER

28480

28480

56289

56289

28480

28480

24546

28480

24546

24546

24546

28480

3L585

24046

28480

28480

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

DIODE-GEN PRP 180V 200MA DO-7

DIODE-GEN PRP 35V 50MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 80V 200MA 2NS DO-35

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10 .105DX.26LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 100NH 10% .105DX.26LG

BOARD-MOTHER

STANDOFF-RVT-ON .125-IN-LG 4-40THD

RESISTOR 1.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.74K .25% .125W F TC=0+-50

RESISTOR-TRMR 500 5% WW SIDE-ADJ 1-TRN

RESISTOR 12.1K 17 .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 237 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 56.2 1% .125W F TC= 0+-100

RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

CONNECTOR-SGL CONT PIN 1.14-MM-BSC-SZ SQ 28480

DIODE-ZNR 1N829 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W

DIODE-ZNR 1N5351B 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W

04713

04713

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

00000

24546

24546

28480

28480

24546

24546

24546

DIODE-ZNR 1N5354B 6.2V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W

DIODE-ZNR 1N829 12.1V 5% DO-7 PD=.25W

CABLE ASSY-.REAR PANEL INTERCONNECT

CABLE ASSY-YIG DRIVER

CABLE ASSY-SECOND CONVERTER

CABLE ASSY-DPM DRIVER

04713

04713

28480

28480

28480

28480

NOT ASSIGNED

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 6-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 6-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 22-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

CONNECTOR-PC EDGE 10-CONT/ROW 2-ROWS

INVERTER

CAPACITOR-FXD 22.UF+-10% 15VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 150UF+-20% 15VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF +-20% 50VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 33UF+-10% 10VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF +-20% 50VDC CER

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

56289

56289

28480

56289

28480

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-0472

1251-0472

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-1365

1251-2034

08558-60035

150D226X9015B2

150D157X0015

0160-0128

150D336X9010B2

0160-0128

Mfr Part Number

0757-0837

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

0698-3260

C4-1/8-TO-383R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C3-1/8-TO-1003-F

11326-0092

CA3146E

1N823

1902-0202

1902-0556

1251-0600

08558-65159

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

0160-3879

150D225X9020A2

150D225X9020A2

0160-3879

0160-2055

1901-0033

1901-0376

1901-0050

9140-0158

9140-0158

9140-0158

9140-0158

9100-2247

08558-20159

ORDER BY DESCRIPTION

C4-1/8-TO-1101-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

0698-5368

2100-1757

C4-1/8-TO-1212--F

C4-1/8-TO-237R-F

C4-1/8-TO-56R2-F

0698-3260

1251-0600

1251-0600

1N829

1N5351B

1N5354B

1902-3182

08558-60169

08558-60044

08558-60080

08558-60081

See introduction to this section for ordering information ,

*Indicates factory selected value

6-26

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A17C6

A17CR1

A17CR2

A17CR3

A17CR4

A17CR5

A17CR6

A17CR7

A17CR8

A17L1

A17L2

A17L3

A17L4

A17L5

A17L6

A17L7

A17L8

A17NP1

A17MP2

A17MP3

A17Q1

A17Q2

A17R1*

A17R2

A17T1

A17VR1

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0180-1714

1901-0620

1901-0620

1901--0620

1901-0620

1901-0620

1901-0620

1901-0620

1901-0620

9100-2552

08558-80010

9100-1618

9100-2552

9100-2552

9140-0096

08558-80007

08558-80007

7100-0529

7100-0530

08558-00049

1854-0039

1854-0039

0757-0459

0757-0180

08558-80006

1902-0551

8

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

6

7

3

3

3

3

3

1

4

4

5

4

3

3

3

7

7

8

2

9

2

2

1

0

0

9

1

Description

CAPACITOR-FXD 330UF+-10% 6VDC TA

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 60V 400MA DO-35

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX .385LG

COIL, FILTER, ORANGE, 500 UH

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 5.6UH 10%

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 15UH 10% .161DX.385LG

INDUCTOR RF-CH-MLD 1UH 10% .166DX.385LG

COIL, FILTER, GREEN, 150 UH

COIL, FILTER, GREEN, 150 UH

COVER

CAN

INSULATOR, INVERTER

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N3053S SI TO-39 PD=1W

RESISTOR 56.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

TRANSFORMER, INVERTER

DIODE-ZNR 6.2V 5% PD=1W 1R=10UA

Mfr.

Code

56289

9N171

9N171

9N171

9N171

9N171

9N171

9N171

9N171

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

3L585

3L585

24546

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

150D337X9006S2

NDP250

NDP250

NDP250

NDP250

NDP250

NDP250

NDP250

NDP250

9100-2552

08550-80010

9100-1618

9100-2552

9100-2552

9140-0096

08558-80007

08558-80007

7100-0529

7100-0530

0855EI-00049

2N3053S

2N3053S

C4-1/8-TO-5622-F

0757-0100

08558-80006

1902-0551

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

6-27

V1

W1

W1

W2

W3

W4

W5

W6

W7

W8

W8

W9

W10

W11

W12

W13

W14

W15

W16

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 6-3. Replaceable Parts

HP Part C

Number D

11593A

1250-0780

5020-8565

5020-8566

5020-8567

08558-60131

7

0

7

5

9

9

5086-7282

08558-60031

08558-60038

08558-20071

08558-20090

08558-20073

08558-60047

08558-60048

08558-60046

08558-60074

1

8

5

7

5

4

6

9

2

5

08557-60045 3

08558-20117

08558-20116

08558-60170

7

6

6

Qty

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

Description

Mfr.

Code

1

1

1

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

Mfr Part Number

ACCESSORIES SUPPLIED

TERMINATION-50 OHM

ADAPTER, TYPE N MALE TO BNC FEMAL.E

CRT-OVERLAY, 180-SERIES DISPLAYS

CRT-OVERLAY, 181-SERIES DISPLAYS

CRT-OVERLAY, 182-SERIES DISPLAYS

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480 SIDE STOP KIT

ELECTRICAL CHASSIS PARTS

LIMITER, RF INPUT,THRESH=1MW; MAX 10W,2WDC 28480

11593A

1250-0780

5020-8565

5020-8566

5020-8567

08558-60131

CABLE ASSY-750 OHM INPUT(OPT.001,002)

CABLE ASSY-50 OHM INPUT(STD. SEE FIG.6-1)

NOT ASSIGNED

CABLE ASSY-1ST LO OUTPUT

CABLE ASSY-YIG OSC TO FIRST CONVERTER

28480

28480

28480

28480

CABLE ASSY-FIRST CONVERTER TO SECOND CON 28480

CABLE ASSY-SECOND CONVERTER TO SECOND IF 28480

CABLE ASSY-SECOND IF TO THIRD CONVERTER

CABLE ASSY-50-OHM CAL OUTPUT (STD)

CABLE ASSY-75-OHM CAL OUTPUT(OPT.001/002

28480

28480

28480

5086-7282

08558-60031

08558-60038

08558-20071

08558-20090

08558-20073

08558-60047

08558-60048

08558-60046

08558-60074

NOT ASSIGNED

CABLE ASSY-VERT. OUTPUT(ON TOP GUIDE RAIL 28480 08557-60045

NOT ASSIGNED

NOT ASSIGNED

NOT ASSIGNED

CABLE ASSY-ATTEN TO LIMITER

CABLE ASSY-LIMITER TO FIRST CONVERTER

CABLE ASSY- PROBE POWER

28480

28480

28480

08558-20117

08558-20116

08558-60170

6-28

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Reference

Designation

7

8

9

10

3

4

5

6

1

2

11

12

13

HP Part C

Number D Qty

08558-20080

08558-20079

3050-0253

08558-60127

08558-20077

08558-20076

5040-0306

1250-0915

1250-0914

0160-3344

08558-20101

1250-0505

7

1

0

8

9

5

3

8

7

3

0

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

Description

Assy: Cable (Includes W1P1)

Shell: Type-N Capacitor

Washer: Spring

Blocking Capacitor Assy

Dielectric

Conductor: Inner Type-N

Capacitor Insulator

Contact: RF Connector

Body: RF Connector

Capacitor: 0.12

æF 50 Vdc

Dielectric

24 AWG Wire

RF Connector: 75 ohm

(separate white teflon dielectric supplied with connector and pin is not used)

Mfr.

Code Mfr Part Number

28480

28480

28480

28480

28280

28480

28480

02660

02660

28480

28480

08558-20080

08558-20079

3050-0253

08558-60127

08558-20077

08558-20076

5040-0306

131-149

131-150

0160-3344

08558-20101

28480 1250-0505

Figure 6-1. Cable Assembly W1 (08558-60038 or 08558-60031) Replaceable Parts

6-29/6-30(blank)

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

6-31 through 6-33

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

SECTION VII.

MANUAL BACKDATING CHANGES

7-1. INTRODUCTION

7-2. This section contains information for adapting this manual to earlier 8558B Spectrum Analyzers. If the serial number prefix of your spectrum analyzer appears on the title page of this manual, the contents of the manual are directly applicable to your instrument. If, however, your spectrum analyzer has a lower serial number prefix than what is shown on the title page, you must adapt this manual to your instrument by changing it as indicated in this section.

7-3. To adapt this manual to your instrument, refer to

Table 7-1 and make all the manual changes listed

opposite your instrument serial number. Make the changes in the sequence in which they are given.

7-4. If your instrument serial number is not listed on the

title page of this manual, or in Table 7-1 below, it may

be documented in a yellow MANUAL CHANGES supplement. For additional important information about serial number coverage, refer to INSTRUMENTS

COVERED BY MANUAL in Section I.

NOTE

In instruments with serial numbers

listed in Table 7-1, some parts have

part numbers that are different from those listed in the Replaceable Parts

list (Table 6-3) of this manual. Unless

otherwise indicated by the ‘change' instructions in this section, however, the listed parts are the recommended replacement parts.

Table 7-1. Manual Change Requirements by Serial Number

Serial Number, Prefix or Complete Number Make Manual Changes:

2145A A

2142A A, B

2118A A,B,C

2024A06643 thru -06691, and 2024A06731 to, but A, B, C, D not including, prefix 2118A

2024A prefix with suffixes thru 06642 A, B, C, D, E

1926A prefixes and 1914A with suffixes 04747,04918, A, B, C, D, E, F

04993,05158,05160, 05172, 05228,05229,05252,

05281,05297, 05300, thru 05307,05311,05312,

05313,05316,05318,05320

1914A with suffixes other than those listed above A, B, C, D, E, F, G

7-1

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS

CHANGE A

Page 6-5, Table 6-3:

Insert Table 7-2 (CHANGE A), A1 Digital Panel Meter parts list, of this section so it precedes the A1A2 list.

Page 6-28, Table 6-3:

Substitute Table 7-3 (CHANGE A) of this section for list of Accessories and Chassis Parts shown in Table 6-3.

Page 6-31, Figure 6-2, Mechanical Chassis Parts:

Substitute Figure 7-1 (CHANGE A) of this section for Figure 6-2.

Page 6-33, Figure 6-3, Front Panel Assembly:

Substitute Figure 7-2 (CHANGE A) in this section for Figure 6-3.

Page 8-26, Figure 8-12, Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 Component Locations:

Delete Figure 8-12.

Page 8-27, Figure 8-13, Front Switch Assembly A2 Schematic Diagram:

Substitute Figure 7-3 of this section for Figure 8-13.

General:

Change all references to front-panel control INPUT ATTEN (dB) to read 'OPTIMUM INPUT.' In Section III and in

the operation booklet, 8558B Spectrum Analyzer Operation, change front panel PUSH TO LOCK to LOCK (rotate clockwise to lock 8558B into mainframe).

Change description of OPTIMUM INPUT (changed from INPUT ATTEN) control function to read: 'The optimum and maximum input level selected is designated by the pointer behind the control. Push in control knob and turn it to select the required input level range.

Use table below to translate input attenuation levels given in manual to optimum input levels.

INPUT

ATTEN (dB)

OPTIMUM

INPUT

OPTION

001

OPTION

002

0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

-40 dBm

-30 dBm

-20 dBm

-10 dBm

0 dBm

10 dBm

20 dBm

30 dBm

-35 dBm

-25 dBm

-15 dBm

-5 dBm

5 dBm

15 dBm

25 dBm

30 dBm

15 dBmV

25 dBmV

35 dBmV

45 dBmV

55 dBmV

65 dBmV

75 dBmV

80 dBmV

CHANGE B

Page 5-6,Table 5-1:

Add adjustment LOG GAIN, A14R1, paragraph 7-6, adjusts dc offset circuitry at output of Log Amplifier for 10 dB

steps in Log mode.

Add adjustment LOG/LIN, A14R2, paragraph 7-6, adjusts for Log-to-linear full-screen display translations.

Add adjustment LIN GAIN, A14R3, paragraph 7-6, adjusts Log Amplifier for 10 dB gain steps in Linear mode.

Affects adjustment of LOG/LIN.

7-2

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS (Cont'd)

CHANGE B (Cont'd)

Page 5-45, Paragraph 5-26, Figure 5-13:

Substitute paragraph 7-6, LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE

B) in this section for paragraph 5-26, and Figure 7-4 (CHANGE B) for Figure 5-13.

Pages 6-21 through 6-24, Table 6-3:

of this section.

Page 6-31, Figure 6-2, Mechanical Chassis Parts:

Change item 30 to HP Part Number 08558-00086, Check Digit 7.

Page 8-84, Figure 8-37, A14 Log Amplifier Component and Test Point Locations:

Replace Figure 8-37 with Figure 7-5 (CHANGE B) of this section.

Pages 8-85/8-86 and 8-87/8-88, Figure 8-38, A14 Log Amplifier Schematic:

Replace Figure 8-38 with Figure 7-6 (2 sheets) (CHANGE B) of this section.

CHANGE C

Page 1-3,Table 1-1:

Under Calibrator Output, change '

±

300 kHz' to '

±

50 kHz.'

Page 1-8, Table 1-2:

Under Cal Output, change text to read as follows:

'-30 dBm, 280 MHz with 2nd through 5th harmonics greater than -60 dBm.

002: + 20 dBm V, 280 MHz with 2nd through 5th harmonics greater than - 10 dBm V.'

Page 6-12, Table 6-3:

Change A9C5 to HP Part Number 0150-2251, Check Digit 6, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD 5.6PF

±

.25PF.

Delete A9C20

Page 6-14, Table 6-3:

Add A9Y1, HP Part Number 0410-0447, Check Digit 0, Qty 1, CRYSTAL-QUARTZ

FREQ = 280 MHz 11th OVERTONE.

Delete A9Z 1.

Page 8-60, Figure 8-25:

Replace Figure 8-25 with Figure 7-7 (CHANGE C) of this section.

Page 8-61, Figure 8-26:

Replace function block A with function block A shown in Figure 7-8 (CHANGE C) of this section.

CHANGED

Page 6-14, Table 6-3:

Change A11C14 to HP Part Number 0160-2253, Check Digit 9, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD

6.8PF

±

.25PF 500VDC CER, 28480, 0160-2253.

Change A11C37 to HP Part Number 0160-2252, Check Digit 8, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD

6.2PF

±

.25PF 500VDC CER, 28480, 0160-2252.

7-3

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS (Cont'd)

CHANGE D (Cont'd)

Pages 6-18, and 6-19, Table 6-3:

Change A13C14 to HP Part Number 0160-2253, Check Digit 9, Qty 1, CAPACITOR- FXD 6.8PF .25PF

500VDC CER, 28480, 0160-2253.

Change A13C37 to HP Part Number 0160-2252, Check Digit 8, Qty 1, CAPACITOR-FXD 6.2PF .25PF 500VDC

CER, 28480, 0160-2252.

Page 8-69, Figure 8-30, A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Schematic:

Page 8-79, Figure 8-35, A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Schematic:

Change value of C14 to 6.8PF, and value of C37 to 6.2PF.

CHANGE E

Page 6-26, Table 6-3:

Delete A16C9 and A16C10.

Page 8-97, Figure 8-44:

Delete C9 and C10.

CHANGE F

Page 5-7,Table 5-2:

Change A9R14 to A9R25.

Pages 6-12 and 6-13, Table 6-3:

Delete A9C17, A9C18, A9C19, A9CR7, A9L15, and A9L16.

Change A9R12* (standard instrument) to HP Part Number 0698-3132, Check Digit 4, Qty 1, RESISTOR 261 1%

.125W F TC=0

±

100, 24546, C4-1/8-TO-2610-F.

Change A9R14* to A9R14, HP Part Number 0757-0462, Check Digit 3, Qty 1, RESISTOR 75K 1% .125W F TC

= 0

±

100, 24546, C4-1/8-TO-7502-F.

Change A9R25 to A9R25*.

Page 8-60, Figure 8-25:

Replace Figure 8-25 with Figure 7-9 of this section.

Pages 8-57, and 8-58:

Replace circuit descriptions for 21.4 MHz Amplifier (E) and PIN Driver (F) with the circuit descriptions provided below.

21.4 MHz Amplifier E

The 21.4 MHz Amplifier consists of A9Q3 in a common-emitter configuration and A9Q4 as an emitter follower.

Transistor A9Q3 employs resistor A9R12 and zener diode A9VR2 to furnish base bias and negative feedback for gain control and stabilization. Resistor A9R12 is factory selected to provide the proper gain of the third converter assembly. Capacitor A9C14 is connected across A9VR2 to reduce zener noise. The output of the 21.4 MHz

Amplifier looks into a voltage-controlled attenuator consisting of two PIN diodes, A9CR3 and CR4, resistor

A9R25, and the input impedance of the A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1.

7-4

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

7-5. MANUAL CHANGE INSTRUCTIONS (Cont'd)

CHANGE F (Cont'd)

PIN Driver (F)

The PIN diode resistance of A9CR3 and CR4 is controlled by the PIN driver A9Q5 and its associated circuitry.

The base of A9Q5 is the summing point for the frequency analog voltage from the A7 Frequency Control and a dc level set by the front-panel REF LEVEL CAL screwdriver adjustment A2R3. Setting the dc level by adjusting

A2R3 calibrates the 8558B display at a given frequency, usually performed at 280 MHz. The frequency analog voltage is a dc level varying from + 0.6 volts to + 6.7 volts as a function of frequency. This frequency analog voltage at the base of A9Q5 compensates for input mixer response. SLOPE COMP adjustment A9R1 sets the amount of compensation required for a flat frequency response. The total current through the PIN diodes A9CR3 and CR4 is shaped by the emitter network of A9Q5. This network provides a change in current through the PIN diodes to cause a change of PIN diode resistance. The change in resistance is required to provide the proper log curve within an 8 dB range for the voltage-controlled attenuator.

Page 8-61, Figure 8-26:

Replace function block E and F with function blocks E and F shown in Figure 7-10 (CHANGE F).

CHANGE G

Page 7-11, Figure 7-2:

Change item 53 HP Part Number to 08558-20052, Check Digit 9.

Change item 57 on HP Part Number 08552-20053, Check Digit 0.

7-5

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A1

A1MP1

A1MP2

A1MP3

A1MP4

A1MP5

A1MP6

A1MP7

A1IMP8

A1MP9 THRU

A1MP16

A1MP17 THRU

A1MP20

A1MP21 THRU

A1MP24

A1MP25 THRU

A1MP28

A1A1

A1A1DS1

A1A1DS2

A1A1DS3

A1A1DS4

A1A1W1

A1A1XDS1

A1A1XDS2

A1A1XDS3

A1A1XDS4

Table 7-2. Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)

HP Part C

Number D Qty

08558-00090

08558-00091

08558-20130

08558-20130

2200-0107

2200.0107

2200-0107

2200-0107

0520-0174 3

6

6

6

4

4

3

4

6

1

1

2

4

1

8

Description

DIGITAL PANEL METER ASSEMBLY

BRACKET, LEFT-HAND

BRACKET, RIGHT-HAND

DPM DISPLAY MOUNT

DPM DISPLAY MOUNT

SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 4-40.375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 2-56 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

0610-0001

2190-0890

3050-0098

08558-60124

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

1990-0619

08558-60130

1200-0693

1200-0693

1200-0693

1200-0693

6

7

7

7

0

7

6

1

8

4

4

4

4

1

4

4

1

4

4

4

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 2-56-THD.062-IN-THK

WASHER-LK MTCL NO. 2.088-IN-ID

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 2.094-IN-ID

DPM DISPLAY

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

DISPLAY-NUM-SEG 1-CHAR .3-H

CABLE ASSY RIBBON, DPM

SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR

SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR

SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR

SOCKET-IC 10-CONT DIP DIP-SLDR

Mfr.

Code

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Mfr Part Number

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

08558-00090

08558-00090

08558-20130

08558-20130

2200-0107

2200-0107

2200-0107

2200-0107

0520-0174

28480 0610-0001

28480 2190-0890

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

51167

51167

51167

51167

3050-0098

08558-60124

5082-7613

5082-7613

5082-7613

5082-7613

08558-60130

10-513-11

10-513-11

10-513-11

10-513-11

7-6

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

P1

R1

R2

R3

R4

R5

R6

S1

U1

W1

W1

W2

W3

W4

W5

W6

W7

W8

W8

W9

W10

W11

W12

W13

W14

W15

Reference

Designation

AT1

Table 7-3. Replaceable Parts (CHANGE A)

7

5

4

6

9

4

2

2

5

5

8

7

6

3

7

4

1

1

1

0

1

8

8

4

08558-60117

2100-3593

2100-3452

2100-3066

2100-0542

2100-3317

2100-3317

3101.0044

5086-7282

08558-60038

08558-60031

08558-20071

08558-20090

08558-20073

08558-20047

08558-20048

08558-20046

08558-20074

08558-60037

08558-60043

08558-60044

08558-60080

08558-20117

08558-20116

HP Part C

Number D Qty

11593A

1250-0780

5020-8565

5020-8566

5020-8567

08558-60131

7

5

7

8

9

9

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

Description

Mfr.

Code

ACCESSORIES SUPPLIED

TERMINATION, 50 OHM

ADAPTER, TYPE N MALE TO BNC FEMALE

OVERLAY, 180 SERIES SCOPES

OVERLAY, 181 SERIES SCOPES

OVERLAY, 182 SERIES SCOPES

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480 KIT, SIDE STOP

CHASSIS PARTS

REAR-PANEL INTERCONNECT (PREWIRED)

RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 5K 10%

RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 10K 10%

RESISTOR-VAR PREC WW 10-TRN 5K 5%

RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL WW 10K 5% LIN

RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20% 10CW

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

RESISTOR-VARIABLE W/SW 50K +-20% 10CW 28480

SWITCH-PB SPST-NO MOM .5A 115VAC RED-BTN 28480

28480 LIMITER, RF INPUT

CABLE ASSY, INPUT, RF(SEE FIG. 6-1)

CABLE ASSY, INPUT, RF (OPT. 001/002)

NOT ASSIGNED

CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, L.O.

CABLE ASSY, INPUT, 1ST L.O.

28480

28480

28480

28480

CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, 1ST I.F.

CABLE ASSY, INPUT, 2ND I.F.

CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, 2ND I.F.

CABLE ASSY, CAL OUTPUT

CABLE ASSY, CAL OUTPUT (OPT. 001/002)

CABLE ASSY, INTERCONNECT

CABLE ASSY, OUTPUT, VERTICAL

NOT ASSIGNED

CABLE ASSY, YIG DRIVER

CABLE ASSY, SECOND CONVERTER

CABLE ASSY, ATTENUATOR TO LIMITER

CABLE ASSY, LIMITER TO FIRST CONVERTER

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

11593A

1250-0780

5020-8565

5020-8565

5020-8567

08558-60131

08558-60117

2100-3593

2100-3452

2100-3066

2100-0542

2100-3317

2100-3317

3101-0044

5086-7282

08558-60038

08558-60031

08558-20071

08558-20090

08558-20073

08558-60047

08558-60048

08558-60046

08558-60074

08558-60037

08558-60043

08558-60044

08558-60080

08558-20117

08558-20116

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

7-7

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

29

30

31

32

33

24

25

26

27

28

19

20

21

22

23

34

35

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

8

9

6

7

10

11

3

4

5

1

2

Reference

Designation

08558-20092

08558-20030

08558-20041

08558-20027

0624-0203

2200-0055

2200-0104

2360-0210

0624-0268

0624-0206

2200-0103

2360-0115

2200-0170

0380-0006

2260-0003

2200-0107

2200-0164

2200-0168

08558-00086

08558-00089

08558-00088

08558-00087

08565-20096

08565-20093

HP Part C

Number

08558-00002

08558-00004

08558-00005

08558-00003

08558-20039

08558-20040

08558-20037

08558-20036

08558-20051

08558-20038

08558-40015

D

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

9

7

5

0

1

6

0

8

2

7

9

0

9

9

7

8

7

2

3

2

5

0

7

2

2

4

0

6

6

8

9

3

3

7

1

Qty

4

40

1

4

1

2

2

2

1

1

1

1

8

1

17

7

2

1

3

1

1

1

1

Description

MECHANICAL CHASSIS PARTS

PANEL, FRONT, SUP

GUSSET, LEFT

GUSSET, RIGHT

PANEL, REAR

GUIDE RAIL, LEFT

GUIDE RAIL, RIGHT

EXTRUSION, END PLATE ENCLOSURE

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED (4)

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE

EXTRUSION, ENCLOSURE DIVIDER

HOUSlNG, LATCH (FOR INSTRUMENTS WITH

SERIAL PREFIX 13344 & BELOW, SEE

SECTION VII

SHIFT, LATCH

INSULATOR, BOTTOM GUIDE RAIL

GUIDE RAIL, BOTTOM

BOARD, VERTICAL OUTPUT CONNECTOR

SCREW-TPG 4-40 .375-IN-LG 82 DEG

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .125-IN-LG 82 DEG

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG

SCREW-MACH 6-32 .625-IN-LG 82 DEG

SCREW-TPG 4-24 .375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-TPG 6-32 .25.-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI STL

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 6-32 .31 2-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .625.-IN-LG 82 DEG

SPACER-RND .375-IN-LG .18-IN-ID

NUT.HEX-PLSTC LKG 4-40-THD .141-IN.-THK

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .375IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .188-IN.LG UNCT 82 DEG

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .438-IN-LG 82 DEG

COVER, LOG AMPLIFIER

COVER, BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1

COVER, STEP GAIN

COVER, BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE,TAPPED (8)

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE,TAPPED (4)

Mfr.

Code

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28280

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Figure 7-1. Mechanical Chassis Parts (1 of 2) (CHANGE A)

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

08558-00002

08558-00004

08558-00005

08558-00003

08558-20039

08558-20040

08558-20037

08558-20036

08558-20051

08558-20038

08558-40015

08558-20092

08558-00030

08558-20041

08558-20027

0624-0203

2200-0055

2200-0104

2360-0210

0624-0268

0624-0206

2200-0103

2360-0115

2200-0170

0380-0006

2260-0003

2200-0107

2200-0164

2200-0168

08558-00086

08558-00089

08558-00088

08558-00087

08565-20096

08565-20093

7-8

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 7-1. Mechanical Chassis Parts (2 of 2) (CHANGE A)

7-9

66

67

68

69

35

36

37

38

32

32

33

34

28

29

30

31

24

25

26

27

43

44

45

46

47

39

40

41

42

60

61

62

63

56

57

58

59

52

53

54

55

48

49

50

51

11

12

13

14

7

8

9

10

4

5

6

6

3

4

1

2

19

20

21

22

23

15

16

17

18

64

65

70

71

72

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

TM 11-6625-3061-14

HP Part C

Number

0610-0002

08558-20002

08558-40005

3050-0017

1460-0532

2200-0165

08558-00020

08558-20061

08558-20062

08558-20052

2260-0002

0380-0413

08558-00022

08558-20053

1490-0841

2950-0006

2190-0027

08558-00021

2190-0019

08558-20054

1430-0036

08558-00036

3030-0007

0510-0089

08558-00017

08558-00055

3050-0032

08558-60050

08558-60072

3030-0022

08558-00043

08558-00018

08558-00038

08558-60051

00180-67402

08558-00043

08558-40003

2950-0043

2190-0016

1410-0721

08558-40001

2200-0781

08558-00019

0380-0411

08558-20047

08558-20051

1410-0006

1460-0578

08559-60060

1480-0367

1480-0059

08558-40011

08558-40008

0510-0015

08558-60046

08558-60074

2200-0509

2200-0125

08558-00024

08558-20050

08558-20066

08558-20089

1460-1376

08558-20088

0520-0139

0380-0487

08558-00081

3050-0105

08558-20030

2200-0143

08558-40004

08558-00025

D Qty Description

FRONT PANEL ASSEMBLY

Mfr.

Code

7

3

1

0

1

9

6

5

6

0

6

1

9

0

0

6

7

9

4

9

6

2

6

0

3

2

1

2

1

1

2

1

1

3

4

3

0

1

4

1

1

1

1

18

3

6

1

1

1

1

4

2

1

3

3

3

2

8

2

6

4

0

8

3

4

1

8

4

1

2

2

8

1

2

9

6

2

5

9

4

9

0

8

1

7

8

4

7

5

3

3

14

4

1

9

13

1

1

6

1

6

5

10

1

1

2

2

1

1

1

1

10

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

33

1

1

1

4

1

2

2

2

1

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

KNOB,REF LEVEL FINE

SCREW-SET 4-40 .125-IN-LG SMALL CUP-PT

RETAINER-RING BSC EXT .188-IN-DIA BE-CU

DISC, INDEX

DISC, INDEX (OPTION 002)

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 8 .189-IN-ID

KNOB, REF LEVEL

KNOB, REF LEVEL (OPTION 002)

SCREW-SET 6-32 .125-IN-LG SMALL CUP-PT

NUT

POINTER, ATTENUATOR

KNOB, DIAL, RESOLUTION

KNOB, FREQUENCY

KNOB, FINE TUNING

KNOB, COARSE TUNING

WINDOW, DBM

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK

WASHER-LK INTL T 3/8 IN .377-IN-ID

BUSHING PNL .265-ID .47-LG 3/8-32-THD

SLIDER, REF LEVEL

SCREW-MACH 4-40 2.75-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

DETENT, ATTENUATOR

SPACER-RND .5-IN-LG .114-IN-ID

BUSHING, PANEL

SHAFT, REF LEVEL

BALL-BRG TYPE .1875-DIA GRADE-50 SST

SPRING-CPRSN .18-IN-OD .312-IN-DA-LG MUW

HUB ASSEMBLY

PIN-DWL ANSI-UNHDND/GND .0625-IN-DIA

PIN-ROLL .062-IN-DIA .25-IN-LG STL

ROTOR, ATTENUATOR DRIVE

GEAR, 45 TEETH

RETAINER-RING E-R EXT .125-IN-DIA STL

CABLE, CAL OUTPUT

CABLE, CAL OUTPUT, 75 OHM (OPT. 001/002)

SCREW-MACH 4-40 1.625-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 4-40 1.5-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

DETENT, SWEEP TIME

SHAFT, SWEEP WIDTH

ROTOR, FREQUENCY SPAN

BUSHING, SLOTTED

SPRING-TRSN MUW

GEAR, 20 TEETH

SCREW-MACH 2-56 .875-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SPACER-RND .625-IN-LG .086-IN-ID

NOT ASSIGNED

NUT, HEX-BL-CHAM 2-56-THD .062-IN-LG

BOARD, FRONT SWITCH

ROTOR, DOUBLE CONTACT

WASHER-FL MTLC ¼ IN .26-IN-ID

SPRING-CPRSN .54-IN-OD .45-IN-DA-LG MUW

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG

DETENT, IF GAIN

LOCKOUT, ROTATING

LOCKOUT, FIXED

SHAFT, FIXED

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 4-40-THD .062-IN-THK

SPACER-RND 1.25-IN-LG .114-IN-ID

CRANK, SLOTTED

SHAFT, REF LEVEL FINE

COUPLER-RGD .375-LG BRS

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM ¼-32-THD .094-IN-THK

WASHER-LK INTL T ¼ IN .256-IN-ID

PLATE, LEVEL POT

WASHER-LK HLCL NO. 4 .115-IN-ID

SHAFT, ATTENUATOR DRIVE

GEAR-MIT 16-T 32-DP 20-DEG PA BRS

NOT ASSIGNED

BRACKET, ATTENUATOR

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 4 .125-IN-ID

NOT ASSIGNED

BOARD, REAR SWITCH

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

ROTOR, SINGLE CONTACT

DETENT, BANDWIDTH

Figure 7-2. Front Panel Assembly (1 of 3) (CHANGE A)

7-10

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

Mfr Part Number

08558-00036

3030-0007

0510-0089

08558-00017

08558-00055

3050-0032

08558-60050

08558-60072

3030-0022

08558-00043

08558-00018

08558-00038

08558-60051

00180-67402

08558-00043

08558-40003

2950-0043

2190-0016

1410-0721

08558-40001

2200-0781

08558-00019

0380-0411

08558-20047

08558-20051

1410-0006

1460-0578

08559-60060

1480-0367

1480-0059

08558-40011

08558-40008

0510-0015

08558-60046

08558-60074

2200-0509

2200-0125

08558-00024

08558-20050

08558-20066

08558-20089

1460-1376

08558-20088

0520-0139

0380-0487

0610-0002

08558-20002

08558-40005

3050-0017

1460-0532

2200-0165

08558-00020

08558-20061

08558-20062

08558-20052

2260-0002

0380-0413

08558-00022

08558-20053

1490-0841

2950-0006

2190-0027

08558-00021

2190-0019

08558-20054

G462Y (MOD)

08558-00081

3050-0105

08558-20030

2200-0143

08558-40004

08558-00025

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

7-11 through 7-14

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B

ADJUSTMENTS

7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B)

REFERENCE

A14 and A15 Schematics

DESCRIPTION

10 dB/DIV and LIN are adjusted for correct steps and full-screen display translations.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 7-4. Log Amplifier Log and Linear Adjustment Test Setup (CHANGE B)

EQUIPMENT

Signal Generator.......................................................................................................................HP 8640B

Digital Voltmeter......................................................................................................... HP 34740A/34702A

10 dB Attenuator.................................................................................................... HP 8491A, Option 010

Step Attenuator (10 dB/step).......................................................................................................HP 355D

Adapter, Type N Male on one end,

BNC Female on other end (2 required)..........................................................................HP 1250-0780

Adapter, Type N Female on both ends................................................................................HP 1250-0777

Adapter, Type N Male on one end,

SMC Male on other end................................................................................................HP 1250-1023

7-15

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)

PROCEDURE

1.

Set spectrum analyzer controls as follows:

FREQ SPAN/DIV ............................................................................................................................1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW .......................................................................................................................300 kHz

OPTIMUM INPUT .......................................................................................................................- 30 dBm

001: - 25 dBm

002: + 25 dBm V

REFERENCE LEVEL dBm..................................................................................................................- 50

002: 0 dBm V

10 dB/DIV - 1 dB/DIV - LIN...................................................................................................................LIN

SWEEP TIME/DIV ..........................................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ..................................................................................................................FREE RUN

2.

Connect equipment as shown in Figure 7-4. Set signal generator frequency to 301.4 MHz and output level to - 13

dBm. Remove W7P1 from Second IF assembly A10J2. Connect signal generator output through step attenuator, 0 dB attenuator, and adapters to W7P1.

NOTE

The 10 dB attenuator is included to compensate for the 10 dB of gain on A12 Step

Gain assembly when the TEST-NORM switch is in TEST.

3.

Set the TEST-NORM switch on A12 Step Gain assembly to the TEST position. Tune signal generator frequency for maximum signal amplitude on oscilloscope display with step attenuator set at 0 dB.

4.

Set output level of signal generator for

REFERENCE LEVEL control set to - 50 dBm.

002: 0 dBm V

5.

Set 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL to - 80 dBm and set step attenuator to 30 dB. Observe digital voltmeter reading.

002: - 30 dBm V

6.

Adjust A14R3 LIN GAIN for a digital voltmeter reading of 700 mV.

7.

Repeat steps 4, 5, and 6 until the DVM reading in step 5 is 700 +2 . mV.

8.

Set 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL to -50 dBm and set step attenuator to 0 dB. Change REFERENCE LEVEL and s

attenuator settings as shown in Table 7-4. If Deviation From Reference is not within the given limits, readjust

A14R3.

002: Set REFERENCE LEVEL dBm V to 0 and set attenuator to 0 dB. REFERENCE

LEVEL (dBmV) settings in Table 5-7 top to bottom are, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40.

7-16

Model 8558B

ADJUSTMENTS

7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)

Table 7-4. Linear Gain Adjustment Limits

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Reference Level

(dBm)

-50

-60

-70

-80

-90

Step Attenuator

Setting (dB)

0

10

20

30

40

Deviation From

Reference

Reference

±

0.2 DIV

±

20 mV

±

0.2 DIV

±

20 mV

±

0.2 DIV

±

20 mV

±

0.3 DIV

±

30 mV

9.

Set 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL to 0 dBm and disconnect signal generator from step attenuator. Record offset reading (DVM). The offset should be less than + 30 mV.

002: REFERENCE LEVEL, +50 dBm V

10. Reconnect signal generator as shown in Figure 7-3. Set 10 dB/DIV - 1 dB/DIV - LIN switch to 10 dB/DIV and set step

attenuator to 40 dB.

sum). (Example: If offset is - 23 mV, set output level of signal generator for a DVM reading of 377 mV.) reading is not within limits, adjust A14R2 LOG/LIN adjustment for a digital voltmeter reading of 800 mV, plus offset minus 50 percent of overshoot. Example: If DVM indicates 767 mV and should be indicating 777 mV (-10 mV overshoot), adjust A14R2 for a DVM reading of 777 mV minus - 5 mV, or 782 mV.

of A14R2 in step 12.

14. Set the step attenuator to the positions shown in Table 7-5 and record DVM reading for each setting. Correct the

DVM readings by algebraically adding the offset (recorded in step 9).

15. Readjust A14R2 if necessary to meet the limits in Table 7-5.

16. Set step attenuator to 0 dB and set output level of signal generator for a digital voltmeter reading of 800 mV plus offset (recorded in step 9)

±

1 mV.

mV. If it does, go to step 19. If it does not, or if log fidelity is not within limits, go to step 18 and select A14R16*.

7-17

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)

Table 7-5. Log Fidelity Check

DVM Reading Corrected For Offset

Step Attenuator

Setting (dB)

40

50

60

70

0

10

20

30

DVM Reading

(mV)

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

Min. (mV)

799

697

596

496

395

294

193

92

Actual (mV)

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

_______________

Max. (mV)

801

703

604

504

405

306

207

108

18. Select A14R16* to obtain an output in step 17 within 25 mV of the reading set in step 16. Decreasing A14R16* 10 percent will increase the DVM reading approximately 30 mV in step 17.

NOTE

Log fidelity must be considered when selecting A14R16*. That is, if the DVM

READING CORRECTED FOR OFFSET in Table 7-5 is greater than 100 mV for a

STEP ATTENUATOR SETTING of 70 dB, A14R16* should be selected for a DVM reading greater than the reading set in step 16. If the READING CORRECTED FOR

OFFSET is less than 100 mV, A14R16* should be selected for DVM reading less than the reading set in step 16.

20. Set 8558B 10 dB/DIV - 1 dB/DIV - LIN switch to 10 dB/DIV and adjust A14R2 LOG/LIN adjustment for a digital voltmeter reading of 800 mV plus offset.

21. Repeat step 14 to recheck the log fidelity.

002: 0 dBm V

23. Set the step attenuator to 0 dB and set output level of signal generator for a digital voltmeter reading of 700 mV (do not include offset).

24. Set the 8558B REFERENCE LEVEL dBm control to -90 and the step attenuator to 40 dB. Adjust A14RI LOG GAIN adjustment for a digital voltmeter reading of 700 mV.

002: - 40 dBm V

7-18

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ADJUSTMENTS

7-6. LOG AMPLIFIER LOG AND LINEAR ADJUSTMENT (CHANGE B) (Cont'd)

25. Change REFERENCE LEVEL and step attenuator settings as shown in Table 7-6. Deviation From Reference should

not exceed the given limits.

002: REFERENCE LEVEL (dBmV) settings, top to bottom are, 0, -10, -20, -30, -40.

26. Return the TEST-NORM switch on A12 assembly to the NORM position.

Table 7-6. Log Gain Adjustment Limits

Reference Level Step Attenuator Deviation From

(dBm) Setting (dB) Reference

-50 0 Reference

-60 10

±

0.3 DIV

±

30 mV

-70 20 ±

0.3 DIV

±

30 mV

-80 30 ±

0.3 DIV

±

30 mV

-90 40

±

0.3 DIV

±

30 mV

7-19

Reference

Designation

A14C17

A14C18*

A14C19

A14C20

A14C21

A14C22

A14C23

A14C24

A14C25

A14C26

A14C27

A14C28

A14C29

A14C30*

A14C31

A14C32

A14C33

A14C34

A14C35

A14C36

A14C37

A14C38

A14C39

A14C40*

A14C41

A14C42

A14C43

A14C44

A14C45

A14C46

A14C47

A14C48

A14C49

A14C50

A14C51

A14C52*

A14C53

A14C54

A14C55

A14C56

A14C57*

A14C58

A14C59

A14C60

A14C61

A14C62

A14C63

A14C64

A14C65

A14C66

A14C67

A14C68

A14C69

A14C70

A14

A14C1

A14C2

A14C3

A14C4

A14C5

A14C6

A14C7

A14C8

A14C9

A14C10

A14C11

A14C12

A14C13

A14C14

A14C15

A14C16

Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (1 of 4) (CHANGE B)

HP Part C

Number D Qty Description

Mfr.

Code Mfr Part Number

0160-2055

0160-2234

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-0228

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

08565-60111

0160-2055

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-2055

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3459

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2256

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-0195

0160-2055

0160-2308

0160-2240

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

9

9

8

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

8

9

9

9

6

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

8

9

6

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

4

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

9

5

4

9

9

2

9

9

9

9

8

9

9

9

2

9

9

9

9

8

9

9

9

9

9

1

59

7

1

1

5

1

1

1

LOG AMPLIFIER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .51PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 22UF +-10% 15VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

NOT ASSIGNED

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .02UF +-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +-25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 9.1PF +-.2PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 130PF +-5% 300VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 36PF +-5% 500VDC MICA

CAPACITOR-FXD 2PF +-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 1PF +0-.25PF 500VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-3459

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2256

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

DM15F131J0300WV1CR

0160-2055

0160-2308

0160-2240

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

7-20

08565-60111

0160-2055

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-2055

0160-3459

0160-3459

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

150D226X901582

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2236

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

Model 8558B

A14CR26

A14CR27

A14CR28

A14CR29

A14CR30

A14CR31

A14CR32

A14E1

A14L1

A14L2

A14L3

A14L4

A14L5

A14L6

A14L7

A14L8

A14L9

A14L10

A14L11

A14L12

A14L13

A14L14

A14Q1

A14Q2

A14Q3

A14Q4

A14Q5

A14Q6

A14Q7

A14Q8

A14Q9

A14Q10

A14Q11

A14Q12

A14Q13

A14Q14

A14Q15

A14Q16

A14Q17

A14Q18

A14Q19

A14Q20

Reference

Designation

A14C71

A14C72

A14C73

A14C74

A14C75

A14C76

A14C77

A14C78

A14CR1

A14CR2

A14CR3

A14CR4

A14CR5

A14CR6

A14CR7

A14CR8

A14CR9

A14CR10

A14CR11

A14CR12

A14CR13

A14CR14

A14CR15

A14CR16

A14CR17

A14CR18

A14CR19

A14CR20

A14CR21

A14CR22

A14CR23

A14CR24

A14CR25

TM 11-6625-3061-14

2

2

2

2

4

2

2

7

3

2

7

3

3

3

3

7

2

1

0

1

1

3

8

6

6

8

1

3

3

3

3

3

3

3

3

3

3

4

7

8

7

5

1901-0047

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0047

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

9170-0029

9100-1622

9100-0105

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-1627

9100-1629

9100-1622

9100-1619

9140-0145

9100-2269

1854-0071

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1853-0020

1853-0007

1853-0345

1853-0015

1854-0475

Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (2 of 4) (CHANGE B)

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0180-2206

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

0180-0197

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0040

1901-1085

6

6

1

1

6

6

6

6

6

1

1

1

9

9

9

4

9

8

9

9

1

6

6

6

9

6

9

6

8

1

6

6

6

1

5

17

17

3

2

Description

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20, 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD 60UF+ -10% 6VDC TA

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CER

CAPACITOR-FXD .01UF +80-20% 100VDC CE

CAPACITOR-FXD 2.2UF+ -10% 20VDC TA

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-PIN 110V

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

Mfr.

Code

28480

28480

28080

56289

28480

28480

28480

56280

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

284080

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

1

2

1

7

1

1

1

0

3

15

2

4

1

1

2

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SCHOTTKY

DIODE-SWITCHING 20V 75MA 10NS

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS D0-35

DIODE-SWITCHING 30V 50MA 2NS DO-35

CORE-SHIELDING READ

COIL-MLD 24AUH 5% Q=60 .155DX .375L-NOM

COIL-MLD 8.2UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 39UH 5% Q=60 .155DX.375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 47UH 5% Q=55 .155DX.375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 24UH 5% Q=60 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 6.8UH 10% Q=50 .155DX .375LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 8.2UH 10% Q=60 .095DX .25LG-NOM

COIL-MLD 27UH 10% Q=45 .095DX .25LG-NOM

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300mw FT=20OMHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO-18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300mw FT=150MHZ

TRANSISTOR PNP 2N3251 SI TO=18 PD=360mw

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N5179 SI T0=72 PD=I200mw

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=200mw FT=500MHZ

TRANSISTOR-DUAL NPN PD=750mw

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

04713

04713

28480

28480

See introduction to this section for ordering information

* Indicates factory selected value

7-21

1901-0047

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0047

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

9170-0029

9100-1622

9100-0105

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-1619

9100-1627

9100-1629

9100-1622

9100-1619

9140-0145

9100-2269

1854-0071

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1854-0019

1853-0020

2N3251

2N5179

1853-0015

185-0475

Mfr Part Number

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

150D606X9006B2

0160-2055

0160-2055

0160-2055

150D225X9020A2

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0047

1901-1085

1901-1010

1901-1085

1901-1070

1901-0040

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-1085

1901-0040

1901-1085

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A14R13

A14R14

A14R15

A14R16*

A14R17

A14R18

A14R19

A14R20

A14R21

A14R22

A14R23

A14R24

A14R25

A14R26

A14R27

A14R28

A14R29

A14R30

A14R31

A14R32

A14R33

A14R34

A14R35*

A14R36

A14R37

A14Q21

A14Q22

A14Q23

A14Q24

A14Q25

A14R1

A14R2

A14R3

A14R4

A14R5

A14R6*

A14R7

A14R8*

A14R9

A14R10

A14R11

A14R12

A14R38

A14R39

A14R40

A14R41

A14R42

A14R43

A14R44

A14R45

A14R46*

A14R47

A14R48

A14R49

A14R50

A14R51*

A14R52

A14R53

A14R54

A14R55

A14R56

A14R57

A14R58

A14R59

A14R60

A14R61

A14R62

A14R63

A14R64*

A14R65

A14R66

A14R67

A14R68

A14R69

A14R70

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (3 of 4) (CHANGE B)

HP Part C

Number D Qty

6

0698-0085

0757-0279

0757-0289

0757-0346

0698-3444

0757-0279

0698-3152

0757-0290

0757-0346

0698-3449

0757-0199

0698-3152

0757-0279

0757-0289

0757-0289

0698-3154

0757-0346

0698-3438

0757-0439

0757-0279

0698-3154

0757-0280

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0289

1854-0404

1853-0020

1854-0071

1854-0071

1854-0039

2100-3109

2100-3161

2100-3109

0757-0442

0757-0279

0757-0346

0757-0442

0757-0280

0757-0430

0757-0465

0757-0440

0698-3157

0698-3444

0757-0420

0698-3136

0698-3443

0698-3156

0757-0439

0698-0083

0757-0279

0757-0289

0757-0416

0698-3444

0757-0346

0757-0465

0698-0083

0757-0280

0698-3151

0757-0458

0757-0346

0757-0289

0757-0442

0698-3157

0757-0442

0698-3152

0698-3159

0757-0279

0757-0290

0757-0439

0757-0279

0757-0289

0757-0440

0757-0463

0

2

2

3

8

2

6

1

5

3

4

1

2

3

2

2

0

0

2

0

0

2

2

1

0

2

9

3

9

0

7

3

4

6

8

0

2

1

3

0

4

7

7

6

2

7

2

7

2

2

3

7

9

8

9

3

0

2

7

4

8

6

8

1

2

5

4

0

5

0

2

7

4

1

7

2

2

1

2

5

1

14

1

20

2

2

12

3

1

1

5

9

9

4

2

12

2

2

1

9

Description

TRANSISTOR NPN SI TO=18 PD=360MW

TRANSISTOR PNP SI PD=300mw FT=150MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300mw FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN SI PD=300mw FT=200MHZ

TRANSISTOR NPN 2N30538 SI TO=39 PD=1w

RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 20K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR-TRMR 2K 10% C SIDE-ADJ 17-TRN

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 19.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 750 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 17.8K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 287 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 14.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.9K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 28.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 21.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 4.22K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 100K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1.96K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 51.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10.1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 19.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.48K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 7.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 82.5K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

Mfr Part Number

1854-0404

1854-0020

1854-0071

1854-0071

2N30538

43P202

43P203

43P202

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1080-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-1962-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-751-F

C4-1/8-TO-1782-F

C4-1/8-TO-287R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1472-F

C4-1/8-TO-2611-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-2872-F

C4-1/8-TO-2152-F

C4-1/8-TO-3481-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-147R-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-4221-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-1961-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-1003-F

C4-1/8-TO-1961-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-2871-F

C4-1/8-TO-5112-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-1962-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-3481-F

C4-1/8-TO-2612-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-7501-F

C4-1/8-TO-8252-F

Mfr.

Code

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

28480

28480

28480

28480

01928

02111

02111

02111

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

7-22

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

A14R121

A14R122

A14R123

A14R124

A14R125

A14R126

A14R127

A14R128

A14R129

A14R130*

A14U1

A14VR1

A14VR2

A14VR3

A14R96

A14R97

A14R98

A14R99

A14R100

A14R101

A14R102*

A14R103

A14R104

A14R105

A14R106

A14R107

A14R108

A14R109

A14R110

A14R111

A14R112

A14R113

A14R114

A14R115

A14R116

A14R117

A14R118

A14R119*

A14R120

A14R71

A14R72

A14R73*

A14R74*

A14R75

A14R76

A14R77

A14R78

A14R79

A14R80

A14R81

A14R82*

A14R83

A14R84

A14R85

A14R86

A14R87

A14R88

A14R89

A14R90

A14R91

A14R92

A14R93

A14R94

A14R95

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 7-7. Replaceable Parts (4 of 4) (CHANGE B)

0757-0289

0757-0288

0698-3444

0757-0439

0757-0346

0698-3158

0698-3160

0698-3160

0698-3160

0757-0346

0757-0289

0698-0085

0757-0439

0757-0290

0757-0279

0757-0289

0757-0416

0757-0346

0698-3444

0757-0439

0757-0346

0757-0438

0757-0346

0757-0289

0757-0280

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0439

0757-0290

0757-0405

0757-0279

0757-0280

0698-0348

0757-0447

0757-0447

0757-0441

0698-3260

0757-0442

0757-0421

0757-0290

0757-0290

0757-0467

1826-0092

1902-0041

1902-0048

1902-0579

HP Part C

Number D Qty

0698-3444

0757-0290

0757-0346

0698-3151

0757-0442

0757-0289

0757-0280

0757-0346

0757-0346

0757-0439

0757-0403

0757-0290

0757-0418

0757-0402

0757-0279

5

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

5

1

1

5

5

1

5

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

5

5

1

5

1

1

5

1

1

1

1

1

5

1

1

5

1

1

5

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

5

5

1

1

1

1

1

9

3

4

1

3

2

2

1

1

1

Description

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.87K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 121 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 619 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 110 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

NOT ASSIGNED

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 511 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 5.11K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 162 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 1K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 9.09K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 316 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 23.7K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 31.6K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 13.3K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 2.61K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.81K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 3.16K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 147 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 16.2K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 8.25K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 464K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 10K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 825 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 6.19K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

RESISTOR 121K 1% .125W F TC=0+-100

OP AMP GP DUAL TO-99

DIODE-ZNR 5.11V 5% DO-7 PD=.4W TC=-.009%

DIODE-ZNR 6.81V 5% DO-7 PD=4W TC=+.043%

DIODE-ZNR 5.11V 5% DO-15 PD=1W TC=-.009%

See introduction to this section for ordering information

*Indicates factory selected value

Mfr Part Number

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-2871-F

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-121R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-619R-F

C4-1/8-TO-111-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-511R-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-5111-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-162R-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-1001-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

MF4C1/8-TO-9091-F

C4-1/8-TO-316R-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

C4-1/8-TO-2372-F

C4-1/8-TO-3162-F

C4-1/8-TO-3162-F

C4-1/8-TO-3162-F

C4-1/8-TO-10R0-F

MF4C1/8-TO-1332-F

C4-1/8-TO-2611-F

C4-1/8-TO-6811-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-3161-F

C4-1/8-TO-147R-F

C4-1/8-TO-1622-F

C4-1/8-TO-1622-F

C4-1/8-TO-8251-F

0698-3260

C4-1/8-TO-1002-F

C4-1/8-TO-825R-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

MF4C1/8-TO-6191-F

C4-1/8-TO-1213-F

1826-0092

1902-0041

1902-0048

1902-0579

Mfr.

Code

24546

19701

19701

24546

19701

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

19701

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

19701

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

19701

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

24546

28480

24546

24546

19701

19701

24546

28480

28480

28480

28480

7-23

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 7-5. A14 Log Amplifier, Component and Test Point Locations (CHANGE B)

7-24

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

7-25 through 7-26

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 7-7. A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF, Component Locations (CHANGE C)

7-27

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 7-8. P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF Schematic Diagram (CHANGE C)

7-28

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 7-9. A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF, Component Locations (CHANGE F)

7-29

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 7-10. P/O A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF Schematic Diagram (CHANGE F)

7-30

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

8-1. INTRODUCTION

8-2. This section prov ides instructions for troubleshooting and repairing the HP Model 8558B

Spectrum Analyzer. It includes general serv icing hints and information, block diagrams of the instrument, circuit descriptions, parts identification illustrations, and schematic diagrams.

WARNING

SECTION VIII.

SERVICE

Test conditions for the signal and dc voltage levels shown on the block and schematic diagrams are

prov ided in Figure 8-2.

8-7. TEST EQUIPMENT

8-8. Test instruments and accessories used to maintain

the spectrum analyzer are listed in Table 1-4. If the

listed instrument is not available, another instrument that meets the required minimums specifications may be substituted.

To troubleshoot and repair this instrument, you must remove it from the display mainframe and reconnect it to the mainframe through an extender cable. Operating the spectrum analyzer outside the mainframe in this manner exposes high voltage points in the instrument which might, if contacted, cause personal injury.

Maintenance and repair of this instrument should, therefore, be performed only by a skilled person who knows the hazards involved.

8-3. SERVICE INFORMATION INDEX

8-9. TROUBLESHOOTING

8-10. General

8-11. Troubleshooting to the assembly level is accomplished by referring to the overall and troubleshooting block diagrams, and by checking for the voltages given for the various system test points. Once the problem is isolated to a particular assembly, the circuit description and schematic diagram for the suspect assembly are used to locate the faulty component.

8-12. Before pursuing any troubleshooting in the spectrum analyzer, you should first make sure the problem is not in the display mainframe, or is not caused by a faulty connection between the spectrum analyzer and the display mainframe.

8-4. Table 8-1 lists specific kinds of information about

the spectrum analyzer main assemblies, and indicates where the information is located. The serv ice information for each assembly normally includes a description of the assembly circuits, a diagram showing the locations of the assembly components, and a schematic of the assembly circuits. These packages of assembly information are arranged in assembly number order with the circuit descriptions and component locations diagram preceding the assembly schematic.

The assembly numbers are printed in large, bold-faced, alpha-numeric characters (e.g., A4) in the lower righthand corner of each schematic diagram.

8-5. SCHEMATIC SYMBOLS, TERMINOLOGY, AND

VOLTAGE LEVELS

8-6. Symbols and terminology used on the schematic

diagrams are explained in Figure 8-1.

8-13. Troubleshooting Hints

NOTE

When a part is replaced, an adjustment of the affected circuitry is usually required. For adjustment

procedures, refer to Section V.

8-14. Residual FM. The troubleshooting procedure

prov ided in Table 8-2 can usually isolate the cause of

residual FM to a particular circuit or circuit component.

Figure 8-3 shows how certain components affect FM in

these procedures. Note that the zener diode causes peaks which are sharp and extreme compared to the IC peaks. A leaky

8-1

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 8-1. Service Information Index (1 of 2)

Subject Location

General Troubleshooting

Troubleshooting Hints

Paragraph 8-10

Residual FM Paragraph 8-14

Sideband Noise Paragraph 8-15

Spurious Responses Paragraph 8-16

Baseline Step Paragraph 8-17

Troubleshooting Block Diagram Figure 8-6

General Principles of Operation Paragraph 8-18

Simplified Block Diagram Figure 8-5

DPM Driver Assembly A1A2

Schematic (includes display) Figure 8-11

Component Locations Figure 8-10

Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-1

Front Switch Assembly A2

Schematic Figure 8-13

Board Assembly A2A1 Component Locations Figure 8-12

Disassembly and Repair Procedures Follows Figure 8-47

Input Attenuator Assembly A3 Figure 8-14

Schematic Figure 8-18

Description Precedes Figure 8-18

First Converter Assembly A4

Schematic Figure 8-18

Component Locations Figure 8-16

Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-18

Second Converter Assembly A5

Schematic Figure 8-18

Component Locations Figure 8-17

Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-18

Frequency Control Assembly A7

Schematic Figure 8-20

Component Locations Figure 8-19

Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-20

Sweep Generator Assembly A8

Schematic Figure 8-23

Component Locations Figure 8-22

Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-23

Third Converter Assembly A9

Schematic Figure 8-26

Component Locations Figure 8-25

Circuit Description Precedes Figure 8-26

8-2

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 8-1. Service Information Index (2 of 2)

Subject

Second IF Assembly A10

Schematic

Component Locations

Circuit Description

Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11

Schematic

Component Locations

Circuit Description

Step Gain Assembly A12

Schematic

Component Locations

Circuit Description

Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly A13

Schematic

Component Locations

Circuit Description

Log Amplifier Assembly A14

Schematic

Component Locations

Circuit Description

Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15

Schematic

Component Locations

Circuit Description

Motherboard Assembly A16

Schematic

Component Locations

Inverter Assembly A17

Schematic

Component Locations

Circuit Description

Major Assemblies, Location of

Location

Figure 8-26

Figure 8-25

Follows Figure 8-23

Figure 8-30

Figure 8-29

Precedes Figure 8-30

Figure 8-33

Figure 8-32

Precedes Figure 8-33

Figure 8-35

Figure 8-34

Precedes Figure 8-35

Figure 8-38

Figure 8-37

Precedes Figure 8-38

Figure 8-42

Figure 8-41

Precedes Figure 8-42

Figure 8-44

Figure 8-43

Figure 8-46

Figure 8-45

Precedes Figure 8-46

Figure 8-47

8-3

Model 8558B electrolytic capacitor (not shown) usually causes the displayed signal to step down and remain at the same level for several divisions before stepping up to a new level.

8-15. Sideband Noise. Sideband noise is usually caused by YIG Oscillator Assembly A6.

8-16. Spurious Responses. Spurious responses are usually caused by loose RF connections. Check all the

RF connections.

8-17. Baseline Step. If the left side of the baseline lifts to the signal peak level, the trouble is A7Q17; a lift of the right side of the baseline is caused by A7Q18 (see

Figure 8-4).

8-18. GENERAL PRINCIPLES OF OPERATION

8-19. A simplified block diagram of the HP 8558B

Spectrum Analyzer is shown in Figure 8-5. The HP

8558B is basically a superheterodyne receiver with a

YIG (Yttrium-Iron-Garnet) tuned oscillator for the first

LO (local oscillator). The first LO is the only LO that is swept. The sweep width is determined by the sweep attenuator (part of A8) which attenuates the ramp driv ing the LO. This ramp is produced by the sweep generator on A8. The ramp also drives the horizontal sweep of

TM 11-6625-3061-14 the CRT, and is available at a rear panel BNC connector to synchronize other instruments, such as X-Y recorders, with the analyzer.

8-20. The RF input to the spectrum analyzer passes through an attenuator network on assembly A3 which is controlled by the front panel INPUT ATTEN dB control.

This control is used to set the input signal level as required for a wide dynamic range. From the attenuator, the signal goes to first converter assembly

A4. Here it is mixed with a 2050 to 3550 MHz output from YIG oscillator assembly A6. The lower sideband,

2050 MHz, of the resulting signal is passed by a 2050

MHz IF amplifier immediately following the first converter circuit. It then enters second converter assembly A5 where it is mixed with a fixed 1748.6 MHz signal from a fixed-cav ity local oscillator. This produces a 301.4 MHz IF signal which is amplified and fed to third converter assembly A9. This time, the signal is mixed with a 280 MHz signal from a SAWR (surface acoustic wave resonator) oscillator, resulting in a 21.4 MHz IF signal. The final 21.4 MHz signal is amplified and detected, then filtered by low pass v ideo filter A2 before it is applied to the vertical deflection amplifier of the

CRT. The vertical deflection seen on the CRT corresponds to the RF input signal amplitude. The 280

MHz signal from the SAWR oscillator is fed out of the front panel for use as a -30 dBm calibration reference.

8-21. Circuit descriptions for each assembly precede the assembly schematic diagram.

8-4

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATICS AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS

BASIC COMPONENT SYMBOLS

Variable Resistor: Clockwise rotation of shaft moves wiper towards end of resistor marked CW.

Light-emitting diode

Transistor, PNP

Electrolytic capacitor

Variable capacitor

Slide, toggle, or rocker switch

Transistor, NPN

MOS-FET, N-Channel

Ferrite bead (prevents high frequency parasitic oscillations)

Pushbutton switch

Relay

Surface Acoustic Wave

Resonator (SAWR)

Indicates a factory-select component

Crystal

Speaker

Indicates shielding conductor for cables

Indicates a plug-in connection

Breakdown (zener) diode

Schottky diode

Indicates a soldered or mechanical connection

Indicates a single pin of a

PC board edge connector

Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (1 of 4)

8-5

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATICS AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS

BASIC COMPONENT SYMBOLS

Connection symbol indicating a Jack (except for

PC board edge connectors)

946

Indicates wire or cable color code. Color code same as resistor color code. First number indicates base color, second and third numbers indicate colored stripes.

Connection symbol indicating a Plug (except for

PC board edge connectors) Earth ground

Test Point: Terminal prov ided for test probe.

Instrument chassis ground.

May be accompanied by a number or letter to specify a particular ground.

Measurement Point: Used to indicate a convenient point for measurement. No terminal prov ided for test probe.

Screwdriver adjustment

Front-panel control

Oscillator

COMMONLY USED ASSEMBLY AND CIRCUIT SYMBOLS

Mixer

Operational amplifier Inverter, buffer

Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (2 of 4)

8-6

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Distinctive-Shape Symbols

SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATIC AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS

BASIC LOGIC SYMBOLS

AMPLIFIER/BUFFER Output is active when input is active.

AND FUNCTION

OR FUNCTION

Output is active only when all inputs are active.

Output is active when one or more inputs are active.

Output is active when only one input is active.

EXCLUSIVE-OR

FUNCTION

WIRED AND

FUNCTION

Two or more elements are joined together to achieve the effect of an AND function.

WIRED OR

FUNCTION

Two or more elements are joined together to achieve the effect of an OR function.

Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (3 of 4)

8-7

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

SYMBOLS USED IN SCHEMATIC AND BLOCK DIAGRAMS

BASIC LOGIC SYMBOLS

Indicator Symbols (positive logic assumed)

Input is active only on the negativegoing transition.

ACTIVE-HIGH inputs and outputs are indicated by the absence of the negation symbol, O.

ACTIVE-LOW inputs and outputs are indicated by the presence of the negation symbol, O.

EDGE-TRIGGERED (dynamic) inputs are indicated by the presence of the dynamic input symbol.

Input is active only on the positive-going transition.

Figure 8-1. Symbols Used in Schematics and Block Diagrams (4 of 4)

8-8

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Nominal power levels, voltages, and waveforms shown on schematic diagrams were measured using the test setup shown below. Note that signal characteristics shown on schematic diagrams are prov ided as a troubleshooting aid only. They should not be used for making instrument adjustments.

EQUIPMENT:

Oscilloscope(with 10:1 probe) .......................................................................................HP 1741A

Spectrum Analyzer....................................................................................HP 141T/8552B/8555A

Digital Voltmeter ...........................................................................................................HP 3455A

Signal Generator ...........................................................................................................HP 8640B

Extender Cable Assembly ......................................................................................HP 5060-0303

Adapter, Type N to BNC (2 required)...................................................................... HP 1250-0780

Figure 8-2. Conditions for Schematic Diagram Measurements (1 of 2)

8-9

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

PROCEDURE:

1. Set HP 8558B Spectrum Analyzer controls as follows:

START-CENTER ........................................................................................................... CENTER

TUNING ..........................................................................................................................280 MHz

FREQ SPAN/DIV ................................................................................................................1 MHz

RESOLUTION BW...........................................................................................................300 kHz

INPUT ATTEN .......................................................................................................................0 dB

REFERENCE LEVEL.......................................................................................................-10 dBm

Option 002: +40 dBm V

REFERENCE LEVEL FINE.........................................................................................................0

Amplitude Scale ............................................................................................................10 dB/DIV

SWEEP TIME/DIV..............................................................................................................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER .....................................................................................................FREE RUN

VIDEO FILTER ......................................................................................................................OFF

BASELINE CLIPPER.............................................................................................................OFF

BL CLIP .................................................................................................................................OFF

2.

3.

4.

Connect equipment as shown. Set signal genera tor for a 280 MHz, -10 dBm output signal. Center the signal on the display.

Using board extenders when necessary, check voltages and waveforms indicated on schematic diagrams.

Trigger oscilloscope on negative transition of AUX B PENLIFT/BLANKING signal from rear of display mainframe.

To measure RF power levels, set RESOLUTION BW control to 3 MHz and FREQ SPAN/DIV to 0 (zero span).

The first LO is not swept in zero span, allowing signal levels to be checked with a second spectrum analyzer (use adapter cables as necessary). DO NOT use a power meter (harmonics and LO signals will contribute to give erroneous levels).

Figure 8-2. Conditions for Schematic Diagram Measurements (2 of 2)

8-10

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 8-2. Residual FM Troubleshooting Procedure (1 of 2)

Probable FM Source Troubleshooting Step

1.

Set 8558B controls as follows:

INPUT ATTEN ......................................0 dB

REF LEVEL............................................-20

(Option 002: +30 dBm V)

FREQ SPAN/DIV...............................2 MHz

RESOLUTION BW ............................1 MHz

SWEEP TIME/DIV.............................AUTO

SWEEP TRIGGER ....................FREE RUN

AMPLITUDE SCALE ..............................LIN

VIDEO FILTER.....................................OFF

2.

Tune LO feedthrough to the left edge of CRT display

and make sure a double lobe (Figure 8-3d) does not

occur.

3.

Connect CAL OUTPUT to spectrum analyzer input.

Center 280 MHz signal on CRT and adjust REF

LEVEL FINE for a top-of-screen signal.

4.

Step FREQ SPAN/DIV from 2 MHz to 1 MHz.

Frequency shift should be less than one major div ision.

5.

Use FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton to remove YIG hysteresis, then center 280 MHz signal on CRT.

Repeated operations should shift signal less than one major div ision.

6.

Second LO frequency should be stable and not vary more than 200 kHz (check at A5J3).

7.

Check the voltages at A7TP6 and A7TP7 for correct level and stability.

A7TP6

+6V

A7TP7

+14.5V

8.

Select a 10 kHz RESOLUTION BW and tune the spectrum analyzer so the 280 MHz signal skirt crosses the center frequency graticule line between the fourth and seventh horizontal graticule lines. Switch to zero (0) span and select a .1 SEC/DIV sweep time. Peak-to-peak variations of the trace should not exceed one major vertical division for each major horizontal div ision.

9.

Try FM check (step 8) with TUNING potentiometer in several different positions. (Tune slightly off frequency with COARSE TUNING control and adjust FINE TUNING control for proper display.)

Main Coil Filter A7Q4 and associated circuitry.

Main Coil Filter A7Q4 and associa ted circuitry.

Calibrate single shot A7Q21-23. Proceed to step 11.

ASCR1 or A5Q1

A7VR2

A7VR1

TUNING potentiometer

8-11

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Table 8-2. Residual FM Troubleshooting Procedure (2 of 2)

Troubleshooting Step

10. Disconnect one end of A7C13 and repeat step 8.

Reconnect A7C13, disconnect one end of A7C4, and again repeat step 8.

11. Remove A7CR2 and A7Q22. If FM is still present, remove A7Q21 and A7Q23.

12. Remove A7R55 and repeat step 8.

Probable FM Source

A7C13 or A7C14

Calibrate single shot circuit on Frequency Control Assy A7.

YIG FM coil driver circuit on

Frequency Control Assy A7.

Probably A7U1.

13. Disconnect one end of A7VR3 or A7CR9 and repeat step 8.

14. Ground A7TP1 and repeat step 8.

A7VR3 or A7CR9

YIG main coil gate on Frequency

Control Assy A7.

15. If residual FM is still present, the problem is in the YIG main coil drivers on Frequency Control Assembly A7.

Refer to the Frequency Control Assembly schematic diagram for further troubleshooting.

8-12

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-3. CRT Displays for Residual FM Troubleshooting

Figure 8-4. Baseline Step Caused by Failure of A7Q18

8-13/8-14 (blank)

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-15 through 8-18

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A1A2 DPM DRIVER ASSEMBLY CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

The DPM circuit is a dc voltmeter that measures a tuning voltage from Frequency Control Assembly A7, and converts it to a front-panel frequency readout.

The DPM Driver is divided into three parts:

1.

The Analog-to-Digital Converter.

2.

The Segment Driver.

3.

The Digit Driver.

Analog-to-Digital Converter

The Analog-to-Digital converter comprises an MOS LSI dev ice, A1A2U1, and associated circuitry. A1A2U1 compares the input voltage (MTR V) on pin 3 with a reference voltage (V REF) on pin 2 and outputs the measured voltage in a binarycoded decimal (BCD) format. The BCD data is multiplexed out of A1A2U1, one decimal digit (four bits) at a time on pins

20 through 23. DS1 through DS4 (pins 16 through 19) are the enable lines for A2DS1 (MSD) through A2DS4 (LSD).

A1A2R2, A1A2R3, and A1A2R4 form an adjustable voltage divider which divides the 6.2 volts from A16VRI down to approximately 2.0V for the reference voltage (V REF) at pin 2 of A1A2U1.

Segment Drive

AIA2U3 converts the BCD data to seven-segment data for the displays and prov ides a test function which lights all the segments of all the displays when pin 3 (TP2) is jumpered to ground. A1A2Q3 switches the decimal point LED on for frequencies below 198.6 MHz. (The voltage, MTR V, is multiplied by 10 on the Frequency Control Assembly.) A1A2Q4 allows the 'g' segment line of A2DS1 to go high when the input voltage (MTR V) is less than zero. This causes a minus sign (-) to be displayed.

Digit Driver

The digits are enabled one at a time, sequentially through digit driver A1A2U2. Each digit display is in turn enabled for

300 microseconds until a 250 millisecond period has passed. This is the length of time A1A2U1 requires to make a new voltage measurement. After 250 milliseconds, the new data is put out on pins 20 through 23 of A1A2U1 and the cycle

repeats. (See Figures 8-8 and 8-9.)

Display

The digit displays, A2DS1 through A2DS4, are of the common-cathode type. When the digit enable line (cathode) is low and a segment line is high, that segment is turned on. Although only one digit display is enabled at a time, the enable rate is fast enough to prevent visible display flicker.

Troubleshooting

To check the digit displays, jumper A1A2TP2 (LT) to ground. All segments of all four numeric displays (A2DS1 through

A2DS4) should light. To troubleshoot DPM Driver A1A2, check for proper clock and outputs at A1A2U1 (see Figures 8-7,

8-8, and 8-9 and Table 8-3).

8-19

Model 8558B

Figure 8-7. A1A2U1 Clock

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-8. Integrator and EOC Waveforms for FREQUENCY MHz Display of 1296 MHz

Y3

1

1

0

0

0

0

1

1

0

0

1

1

0

0

1

1

1

1

0

1

0

1

1

1

Table 8-3. Truth Table for A2DS1 Display

A1A2U1 Data Output

Y2 Y1

Y0

0

1

0

1

0

1

0

1

Decimal

Equivalent

0

3

4

7

10

11

14

15

A1A1DS1

Display

-1

-1

1

1

-

-

Blank

Blank

8-20

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

NOTES

1. TRIGGER OSCILLOSCOPE EXTERNALLY USING EOC {(END OF

CONVERSION), A1A2U1 PIN 14.

2. DURING THE TIME INTERVA L THAT DS1 LINE IS HIGH,THE DATA ON

PINS 20 THROUGH 23 IS NOT STANDARD BCD CODE. SEE TABLE 8-2.

Figure 8-9. A1A2U1 Outputs for FREQUENCY MHz Display of 1296 MHz

8-21

Model 8558B

A1A2

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-10. A1A2 DPM Driver Component Locations

8-22

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-23 through 8-24

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A2 FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

Functions of the switches and potentiometers on Front Switch Assembly A2 and Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 are covered in the circuit descriptions for the electronic assemblies they control. Disassembly and repair procedures for the

Front Switch Assembly are at the back of this section (following Figure 8-47).

8-25

Model 8558B

A2A1

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-12. Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1, Component Locations

8-26

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-27 through 8-28

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A3, U1, A4, A5, A6 CIRCUIT DESCIPTIONS

A3 Input Attenuator Circuit Description

The 8558B input attenuator (Figure 8-14) is a 50-ohm, precision, coaxial step attenuator. Attenuation in 10 dB steps

from 0 dB to 70 dB is accomplished by switching the signal path through one or more of the three resistive pads in a predetermined sequence. (Note that the input attenuator is not field repairable.)

U1, RF Input Limiter Circuit Description

The RF input limiter contains Schottky diodes which clamp the input signal voltage, protecting the mixer diodes in the

First Converter Assembly A4. The typical limiting threshold is 1 mW (0 dBm). The limiter is not field serv iceable.

A4 First Converter Circuit Description

The RF signal input (0.1 1500 MHz) passes through a 1550 MHz low pass filter to the mixer diode assembly, U1. The output impedance of this low-pass filter seen from the mixer is effectively a short circuit at 2050 MHz, reflecting any IF power back to the mixer. The first LO input from YIG Oscillator Assembly A6 passes through a 3 dB power splitter consisting of two resistors, R1 and R2, and etched transmission lines. One of the power splitter outputs prov ides the front panel LO OUTPUT; the other output is through a balun (short piece of semi-rigid coaxial transmission line) to prov ide drive voltage to the mixer diodes. The LO signal is coupled to one mixer diode through the balun shield and to the other mixer diode through the balun center conductor. This arrangement splits the LO signal voltage evenly between the two mixer diodes. The 2050 MHz output signal from the mixer (first IF) is split-line coupled to a 6 dB 'pi' resistive matching pad (R3, R4, and R5). A small block of polyiron is placed over the split-output line. The polyiron helps balance the mixer and absorbs harmonics of the mixing signals. A 5000 MHz low-pass filter etched on the A4 printed circuit board prov ides additional filtering to the 2050 MHz IF signal after the 6 dB pad. The signal is then coupled to Second

Converter Assembly A5 through a semi-rigid coaxial cable.

A5 Second Converter Circuit Description

The IF signal from the First Converter is coupled into the Second Converter bandpass filter through coupling loop L3.

The bandpass filter consists of three circular, slug-tuned cav ity resonators operating as less than a quarter wavelength inductive transmission lines. The cav ities prov ide high 'Q' for good selectiv ity at 2050 MHz. Coupling loops L4 and L5 prov ide coupling between the cav ities. The 2050 MHz signal is loop coupled to the cathode end of second mixer diode

CR1. The second LO signal is loop coupled to the anode end of CR1. The second local oscillator is a Colpitts type circuit operating at 1748.6 MHz. The capacitive 'fingers' etched on the A5A1 printed circuit board and the internal transistor capacitances of A5A1Ql prov ide the positive feedback necessary to sustain oscillation. The oscillator tank circuit is a slug-tuned cav ity, Z4. The signal from the second LO is coupled into cav ity Z4 by a 4 - 40 machine screw extending down into the cav ity. The second LO output is also available at test jack A5J3. The 1748.6 MHz local oscillator prov ides the drive for mixer diode CR1. The difference frequency between the first IF, 2050 MHz, and the second LO frequency, 1748.6 MHz, is 301.4 MHz. This 301.4 MHz signal is coupled through the matching filter to the

A10 Second IF. The matching filter is a passive network designed to match the relatively high impedance of the second mixer, about 200 ohms, to the low input impedance of the second IF, about 50 ohms. The match may be optimized by adjusting A5L2, 2nd MIXER MATCH adjustment.

A6 YIG Oscillator Circuit Description

The YIG Oscillator is a transistorized thin-film microcircuit. It uses an yttrium-iron-garnet (YIG) sphere as the frequency determining structure. The YIG sphere is a ferromagnetic material whose resonant frequency is directly proportional to the applied magnetic field. The sphere is placed in the gap of an electromagnet to prov ide a magnetic tuning structure whose field (and thereby the oscillator's frequency) is linearly proportional to the drive current from Frequency Control

Assembly A7.

8-29

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

The main coil is used for wide range sweeping and tuning with the coil current varying from approximately 50 to 8 mA.

The FM coil is used only for narrow spans (1 MHz/DIV and less) with the coil current varying from approximately - 25 mA to + 25 mA.

The YIG Oscillator Assembly consists of three parts: a sealed magnet assembly which encloses the YIG sphere and oscillator; a bias board which uses discrete components to establish oscillator/amplifier bias and to protect against supply noise and voltage overloads; and a mu-metal magnetic shielding can.

8-30

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-14. A3 Input Attenuator

Figure 8-15. A 6 YIG Oscillator

8-31

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-16. A4 First Converter, Component Locations

8-32

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-17. A5 Second Converter Assembly, Component Locations

8-33/8-34(blank)

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-35 through 8-36

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A7 FREQUENCY CONTROL CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

General Description

Frequency Control Assembly A7 contains the circuitry to drive and control YIG Oscillator Assembly A6. The frequency is controlled by the sum of the sweep and tune voltages. The tune voltage is generated by the center frequency coarse and fine TUNING controls. The tune voltage is measured by the digital panel meter (DPM) voltmeter to provide the centerfrequency digital readout. The sweep voltage, controlled by the FREQ SPAN/DIV switch, is generated in Sweep

Generator Assembly A8. The YIG Oscillator has two driving coils: the main tuning coil and the FM coil. The tune voltage is applied to the main tuning coil driver. The sweep voltage is either summed with the tune voltage and applied to the main tuning coil driver or, in narrow frequency spans, it is applied to the FM coil driver. Gating circuits determine whether the sweep voltage is applied to the main or FM coil. The Frequency Control Assembly also contains separate low-noise voltage regulators to bias the YIG Oscillator and the 1748.6 MHz second local oscillator.

YIG Main Coil Fixed Driver

The YIG Main Coil Fixed Driver consists of differential amplifier A7Q7, a Darlington pair current source, A7Q5 and Q6, and a + 6V reference voltage from A7VR2 and R4. The fixed driver is used to tune the YIG oscillator to the minimum frequency of 2050 MHz.

The + 6V reference voltage is one input to A7Q7 and the other input, measured at TP3, is negative feedback that senses the voltage across A7R3 and R71. The operation of the fixed coil driver maintains a constant +6.OV across A7R3 and

R71. A11 current through R3/R71 comes from the YIG main coil through Darlington current source A7Q5 and Q6. A7R3 is the 2.05 GHz lower frequency adjustment and sets the emitter current of A7Q5 and Q6. The current source provides the fixed current to determine the zero CENTER FREQUENCY point set by A7R3.

YIG Main Coil Swept Driver

The YIG Main Coil Swept Driver consists of a swept driver, A7U4, and a Darlington pair current source, A7Q1 and Q3.

The swept driver tunes the YIG oscillator over the frequency range of 2050 MHz to 3550 MHz. The inputs to A7U4 are the Coarse and Fine TUNING voltage from the Tune Summing Amplifier, and the attenuated sweep ramp from the

Sweep Buffer. The output from A7U3 is the attenuated sweep only when 2 MHz/DIV or wider frequency spans have been selected. In narrower frequency spans, only the sum of the TUNING voltages is applied to the main coil swept driver. The attenuated sweep and TUNING voltages are summed across A7R49 and R52 and then applied to the noninverting input of A7U4. Diode A7CR3 prevents the input of the swept driver from going negative and driving it into cutoff. A7U4 drives the current source which converts the voltage at the emitter of Q1 into current to drive the YIG main tuning coil.

The current from A7Q1/Q3 is summed with the current from the fixed driver current source, A7Q5/Q6, to increase the main coil current synchronously with the TUNING and sweep voltages. The YIG upper frequency 3.55 GHz is set by

A7R1 (coarse adjust) and A7R2 (fine adjust). The emitter of A7Q1 is connected to the inverting input of A7U4 to provide a voltage proportional to the collector current of Q1/Q3 to be used as negative feedback.

Frequency AnA10g Output for Blanking. The emitter of A7Q1 also drives the base of A7Q2. A7Q2 is an emitter follower that provides the frequency anA10g output voltage to Third Converter Assembly A3 and to the Sweep Ramp High/Low

Limit Comparator (A15U1) of Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15. (See A15 Schematic.)

8-37

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Coarse and Fine TUNING . The Coarse and Fine tuning voltages from control potentiometers A2R1 and A2R2 (shown on A2 schematic) are applied to the noninverting and inverting inputs respectively of A7U2. A7U2 sums these voltages and applies the voltage sum to the junction of A7R52 and R53. It is in turn summed with the attenuated sweep signal from the output of the sweep buffer A7U3 if 2 MHz/DIV or wider frequency spans have been selected. In narrower frequency spans, the input of buffer A7U3 is grounded so only the summed tuning voltages are applied to A7U4.

YIG FM Coil Driver

The FM Coil Driver consists of A7U1, Q17, Q18, and FM adjust R6. Selecting 1 MHz/DIV and narrower frequency spans enables the YIG FM Coil Gate, allowing the attenuated sweep to be applied to the YIG FM Coil Driver. (A7Q15 is on and

Q16 is off.) A7U1 converts the sweep ramp voltage into current to drive the YIG FM coil. Transistors A7Q17/Q18 are biased at cutoff and provide additional current drive. The FM adjust, A7R6, sets the maximum FM coil current.

YIG Main and FM Coil Gates

The YIG Coil Gates determine which YIG coil is used to control the YIG oscillator frequency. The YIG Coil Gates are selected by the Scan Select which is controlled by FREQ SPAN/DIV control A2S6.

YIG Main Coil Gate . When 2 MHz/DIV and wider frequency spans are selected, the base of transistor A7U5C is returned to 12.6V through A7R11 and A8R131. A7U5C is turned off and the collector rises to about 5V while the emitter drops to near 12.6V. The collector of A7U5C turns on U5E and U5D, and these two transistors then turn off FETs Q15 and Q24 respectively. The emitter of A7U5C turns off U5A and U5B, which then turn on FETs Q16 and Q20. With

A7Q20 conducting and A7Q24 open, the attenuated sweep is applied to sweep buffer A7U3 and YIG main coil swept driver A7U4 to control the YIG oscillator frequency. FET A7Q15 is turned off preventing the attenuated sweep input from reaching the ./ YIG FM Coil Driver, and A7Q16 is turned on, grounding the input to the YIG FM coil driver.

YIG FM Coil Gate . The selection of 1 MHz/Div and narrower frequency spans with FREQ SPAN/DIV control A2S6 applies + 15V to the input of A7USC. The + 15V turns U5C on; FETs Q20 and Q16 are turned off, and FETs Q24 and

Q15 are turned on. This enables the YIG FM coil gate, allowing the sweep signal to be applied to the YIG FM Coil

Driver. A7Q20 prevents the Attenuated Sweep input from reaching the sweep buffer A7U3 and A7Q24 grounds the input of A7U3. However, the tuning voltage from the tune summing amplifier is still applied to the YIG main coil swept driver.

Main Coil Filter

When the narrower frequency spans are selected, the + 15V from FREQ SPAN/DIV switch A2S6 is also applied to A7Q4 in the main coil filter. The main coil filter consists of FET switch A7Q4, R75, and C13/C14. The filter provides noise filtering in the 1 MHz and narrower frequency spans. With the FET switch closed, the filter is connected in parallel with the YIG main tuning coil.

Meter Ranging

The DPM is a digital voltmeter which measures the TUNING voltage at the output of the tune summing amplifier. The output of the tune summing amplifier, approximately 0 to -10V, is divided down to 0 to 1.5V at pins 2 and 5 of A7U6 by

A7R53 and R50. This provides a 1 mV/MHz voltage to the DPM. The FREQ ZERO adjust R3 (shown on A2 schematic),

A7R43, and A7R54 enable this voltage to be offset 4 15 mV to zero the DPM. The FREQ ZERO adjustment compensates for the changes in the frequency of the YIG oscillator caused by temperature drift.

8-38

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A7U6A functions as a comparator and A7U6B as a switchable Xl/X10 gain stage. When the instrument is tuned to a frequency below 198.4 MHz, the voltage at A7U6 pin 2 is less than 198 mV. Since the voltage at A7U6 pin 3 is adjusted to be approximately 198 mV, the output at A7U6 pin 1 is positive. This turns on Q19, causing A7U6B to have a gain of approximately 10 and results in an output voltage at pin 7 of 10 mV/MHz.

When the instrument is tuned above 198.4 MHz, A7U6A pin 1 goes low, turning Q19 off, causing A7U6B to have a gain of 1. This results in an output voltage at pin 7 of 1 mV/MHz. The output of A7U6A pin 1 is also used to turn A7Q25 off to turn off the decimal point. The positive feedback from the emitter of A7Q25 to A7U6A pin 3 provides hysteresis for rapid switching of the X1/X10 crossover point. A7CR6 and CR7 provide proper biasing for FET Q19. OFS adjustment A7R72 compensates for input offset of A7U6B.

+ 14.5V Regulator The + 14.5V Regulator consists of series regulator A7Q8, driver Q10, and reference amplifier Q9 and

Q11. The +6.2V developed across zener diode A7VRI provides the base reference for A7Q9. This is compared to the voltage at the base of A7Q11 1 which senses the + 14.5V output across voltage divider A7R28, R29, and the + 14.5V

adjust R5. Should the output voltage increase, A7Q11 conducts more, decreasing the conduction of A7Q9 and driving the base of Q10 more positive. This decreases the drive current to A7Q8 and causes the output voltage to drop (return to + 14.5V). A7C4 provides stability compensation and some additional noise filtering at the output.

The + 14.5V supply is used for the positive supply on A7U2, U3, U4, and Q7. It is also used on Sweep Generator

Assembly A8 as the voltage reference that sets the 5V to + 5V ramp amplitude. The + 14.5V is also applied to Second

Converter A5 as the positive supply for the 1748.6 MHz second local oscillator.

+ 6.00V Reference Voltage Regulator

The + 14.5V at A7R32 and the +6.2V dropped across A7VR2, develop the +6.00V reference voltage. A7R4 REF V adjusts the voltage at TP6 to + 6.00V.

-10V Regulator

The regulated + 14.5V provides a reference voltage for voltage divider A7R34 and R35 for the -10V regulator. The -10V regulator consists of series regulator A7Q12 and reference amplifier A7Q13 and Q14. Should the -10V tend to become more positive (less negative), A7Q13 decreases its conduction and turns A7Q14 on harder. A7Q14 then increases the conduction of A7Q12, dropping the output voltage back to -10V.

The -10V supply is used for the negative supply on A7U2, U3, U4, and Q7. It is also used as the negative supply for the

A6 YIG Oscillator and the second local oscillator in A5.

Calibrate Single Shot

The calibrate single shot circuit consists of A7Q23, Q22, and Q21. The circuit is activated when the front panel FREQ

CAL button is pressed. With the FREQ CAL switch A2S1 (shown on A2 schematic) closed, the YIG Oscillator is tuned to its lowest frequency. Releasing the FREQ CAL button returns the YIG Oscillator to the previous operating frequency.

Pressing the FREQ CAL button shorts the + 6V line to ground, discharging A7C8 and turning A7Q23 off. The emitter of

A7Q22 is grounded, turning it on, and its collector goes low, turning off FET switch A7Q4. The main coil filter is now disabled and the charge held on A7C13/C14 remains the same during the calibration sequence. The charge voltage represents the previous operating frequency. The ground on the + 6V line is applied to the base of A7Q7, disabling the

YIG main coil fixed driver. When the + 6.OV line is grounded, the output of the coarse TUNING control is grounded; the

YIG main coil swept driver is disabled by the output from A7U2. With both YIG main coil drivers disabled, the magnetic current is removed and the magnet hysteresis is cancelled.

8-39

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

When the FREQ CAL button is released, the +6.0V reference line jumps to approximately + 1V. The charge on capacitor

A7C8 turns on A7Q23 which then turns on Q21. A7C8, Q21, and Q23 form a Miller Integrator and the +6.0V reference line slowly charges to +6.0V. This takes about 0.3 second and prevents the introduction of transients into the main coil.

However, as long as the + 6.0V reference line is charging; the conduction of A7Q23 keeps FET switch A7Q4 off, still disabling the main coil filter. The charge on A7C13/C14 has no path for discharge and remains the same. This allows the YIG Oscillator to return to the previous frequency faster since A7C13 and C14 do not have to be recharged.

8-40

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-19. A7 Frequency Control Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations

8-42

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-43 through 8-44

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A8 SWEEP GENERATOR CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

General Description

The Sweep Generator Assembly generates a -5 volt to + 5 volt linear sweep voltage. The sweep voltage controls the frequency of YIG oscillator Assembly A6, and also controls the horizontal deflection of the CRT beam. The SWEEP

TIME/DIV control varies from 0.1 mSEC/DIV to 10 SEC/DIV so the full scan sweep time varies from 1 ms to 100 sec.

The sweep may be synchronized with either the video input or the line voltage. Manual and free run modes are also provided. A single sweep may be started or stopped with the front panel TRIGGER switch. A retrace voltage is generated and applied to Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly A15.

Sheet 2 of the A8 schematic (Figure 8-23) shows the resolution bandwidth control circuit, the video filter, the sweep

attenuator circuit, and the + V sweep offset circuit. The resolution bandwidth control circuit has three purposes. First it provides the bandwidth filter control current to the PIN diodes on Bandwidth Filter Assemblies A11 and A13. Second, it provides current to the sweep generator current source (AST line) to control the AUTO sweep time circuit as a function of resolution bandwidth. Third, it switches in the proper capacitor for the RC lowpass video filter to provide video filtering as a constant percentage of resolution bandwidth. The sweep attenuator circuit attenuates the sweep ramp to Frequency

Control Assembly A7 in proportion to the FREQ SPAN/DIV selected. It also provides a current to the sweep generator current source (AST line) to control the automatic sweep time circuit as a function of frequency span per division. The +

V sweep offset circuit offsets the ramp voltage by 5 volts so the ramp voltage, when START frequency is selected, is from 0V to + 10V instead of 5V to + 5V.

Sweep Generator Circuit

The sweep ramp is generated in the following cycle. (See Figure 8-21.)

When transistor Q10 turns on, the sweep ramp is initiated. At the beginning of the sweep cycle, the voltage at TP3 is -4V and dead-time capacitor C15 is charging toward + 15V through R33. When the anode voltage on CR11 reaches + 1 .5V,

Q10 turns on and the TP5 voltage becomes + 3V.

Pin 2 of U1 is at -5V and comparator U1 toggles to its positive supply voltage of + 14.5V. CR5 is now reverse biased.

The current source can begin charging timing capacitors C3 and C4 positively, forming the positive slope of the sweep ramp.

As the sweep ramp level approaches + 5V at TP8, the U1 feedback circuit takes control, holding pin 2 of U1 at 2.68V and temporarily bringing pin 6 out of saturation. The anode voltage of zener diode VR1 equals the voltage at pin 6 minus

10V:

E

VR1

= E pin6

- 10V

8-45

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-21. Simplified Schematic of Sweep Generator in AUTO Mode

8-46

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

As the voltage at U1 pin 6 (TP3) decreases, the anode voltage of VR1 decreases. At some time (when the level of the sweep ramp at TP8 is + 5V), the anode voltage of VR1 will no longer forward bias CR7, and the zener feedback loop opens. At this point, the 3.3 megaohm feedback loop becomes active and U1 saturates again. The comparator toggles, this time toward the negative operational amplifier supply, and 4V appears at TP3.

The -4V at T3 forward biases CR5. Timing capacitors C3 and C4 discharge through CR5, forming the negative slope of the sweep ramp. Dead-time capacitor C15 discharges.

The endpoints of the sweep ramp at TP8, 5V and + 5V, are controlled by the voltage divider R21, R24, R29, and R30 or

R35, and by U1 and its feedback loops. U1 controls the ramp voltage as it maintains 2.68V at pin 2.

At the end of the ramp, when CR5 is forward biased, and the comparator output (pin 6 of U1) is approaching its negative supply, U1 uses Q1 and Q3 to maintain 2.68V at pin 2. Q10 is off, and the voltage divider R21, R24, R29, and R30 produces -5V at TP8.

At the beginning of the ramp, when CR5 is reverse biased, and the comparator output is approaching its positive supply,

U1 again maintains 2.68V at pin 2. This time, Q10 is on, and voltage divider R21, R24, R29, and R35 produces + 5V at

TP8.

Fast/Slow Sweep Time Operation . The ST6 control line from Front Switch Assembly A2A1, selects timing and deadtime capacitors C3, C4, C5, and C27, to control fast and slow sweep times. If the same amount of charging current is supplied to a larger capacitor, it charges at a slower rate.

Timing capacitors C3 and C4 are used to provide fast and slow sweep operation. When a fast sweep time (ms/div) is selected at TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3, the ST6 (FAST SWEEP) control line is grounded, turning off Q55 and Q53. With

Q53 off, C3 and C4 are in series and the timing capacitor becomes C4. With Q55 off, the + 15V at R57 back biases CR9 and CR6, so C27 is switched out of the dead-time circuit. the dead-time (about 0.4 ms) is set by C15. In sweep times greater than 1 ms/div (or in AUTO sweep times), the ST6 (FAST SWEEP) control line is open, Q55 and Q53 are both on.

With Q53 on, a ground is provided for C3 and it becomes the timing capacitor. CR6 and CR9 are on because of the conduction of Q55. C15 and C27 are in parallel, so the longer dead-time (about 7.5 ms) is set by C27.

When selecting FREE RUN mode (A2A1S4), + 15 volts is routed to the voltage divider, R59 and R60, via the TRIG control line. CR10 is reversed biased.

FREE RUN TRIGGER Operation. The circuit free runs and QI0 conducts when U1 switches on and off at a time determined by the RC time constants.

VIDEO TRIGGER OPERATION . When the video mode is selected (VIDEO position on A2A1S4 switch), CR10 is forward biased by R59, and Q10 is off. The sweep ramp is generated by turning on Q10 with a negative pulse from the pulse shaper circuitry. The negative pulse is applied to the emitter of Q10.

8-47

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

The pulse shape consists of a Schmitt trigger (Q39 and Q40), a differentiator (C12 and R55), and an emitter follower

(Q12). The Schmitt trigger produces a pulse which exists as long as the video trigger information on the SYNC line is above a certain dc level. When the TRIGGER switch is in VIDEO position, video information from Vertical Driver and

Blanking Assembly A15 is routed through the switch to the base of Q40. Q40 is normally off and Q39 is conducting.

During the positive portion of the SYNC signal, Q40 turns on, turning Q39 off. C7 accelerates the Q39 switching. When

Q40 switches on, the negative change at the collector is differentiated by C12 and R55, and coupled through Q12 to the

Q10 emitter. The negative pulse turns on Q10. CR8, R32, and VR1 keep Q10 on while the ramp is being generated.

After the ramp is completed, the circuit returns to its dead-time state and another trigger is required to generate another sweep. Trigger pulses from Q40, which may occur during the sweep, have no effect since Q10 is already on.

LINE TRIG Operation The sweep may be synchronized with the ac line voltage in the same manner as described in

VIDEO operation. With TRIGGER switch A2A1S4 in LINE position, the ac line from the mainframe power transformer is connected to the Schmitt trigger (Q40 and Q39) input. A16R2 and A16C2 on the motherboard attenuate the ac line signal to approximately 2 volts p-p and filter any line spikes.

SINGLE Sweep Trigger and Abort . Q10 is initially held off by R59 and CR10. Q9 is on, and voltage divider R37 and

R38 charges C16 to +2.8V. When the trigger switch A2A1R4 is set to SINGLE sweep (spring-loaded position), + 15V is applied to R62 turning on Q11. This shorts the positive end of C16 to ground and produces a negative pulse at the emitter of Q10. This turns Q10 on starting a sweep.

During the generation of a sweep, Q9 is off and the voltage divider R37 and R38 charges C16 to 4V. The sweep may be aborted (reset to 5V) by pressing the SINGLE switch to the spring-loaded position. This switches on Q11. The negative end of C16 is shorted to ground, a positive pulse is generated at the emitter of Q10, and Q10 is turned off aborting the sweep.

MANUAL Sweep Control

Manual control of the sweep is obtained with the TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3 in MAN position. A ground is applied to the base of Q38 and Q37 by the ST7 line from A2A1S3 in all sweep modes except manual; the ground holds Q38 and Q37 off. With A2A1S3 in MAN position, Q38 and Q37 are turned on. Q37 turns Q10 on and keeps it on. CR5 is on and the feedback loop to the timing capacitor is closed. Turning the MANUAL SWEEP control A2A1R4 changes the voltage at the collector of Q38 which changes the input current at U1 pin 2. Since the feedback current through R29 is constant, any change in manual sweep current must be compensated by a change in the current through R24, thereby varying the ramp output voltage.

Current Source

Current for the generation of the sweep is provided by the current source circuit. The temperature dependent power supply provides a nominal + 10V; Q6 is the temperature sensing element (diode). The following switches control current to operational amplifier U2A pin 2: RESOLUTION BW switch A2A1S5, FREQ SPAN/DIV switch A2A1S6, VIDEO FILTER potentiometer A2R5, and TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3. In the AUTO sweep time mode, the sweep time is controlled by the

RESOLUTION BW, FREQ SPAN/DIV, and VIDEO FILTER which set the currents to U2A. These currents are summed by U2A to produce a voltage proportional to the log of the sweep time. Q4 is the current driver and converts voltage variations into current variations proportional to sweep time. The current is applied to the timing capacitors C3 and C4, in the buffer amplifier circuit.

8-48

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Q7 provides temperature compensation for Q4. Q8 is a constant-current regulator for Q7. In AUTO, the sweep time is limited to 1 ms and longer because current is limited to 1 mA by Q5/R15.

In the calibrated sweep time/division mode, the gate of Q52 is grounded. This turns Q52 off and disconnects the currents proportional to RESOLUTION BW, FREQ SPAN/DIV, and VIDEO FILTER. Calibrated sweep times are now produced by the currents fed to U2A through R40 through R44. Those resistors are grounded in various combinations by

SWEEP TIME/DIV switch A2A1S3 resistor network. (See A2 Schematic.)

XTAL Resolution Bandwidth Control

When a XTAL bandwidth is selected (30 kHz, 10 kHz, 3 kHz, 1 kHz), control line BW5 is released from + 15V on the front panel and is pulled to -.5V by Q13. This has four effects.

1.

On the Bandwidth Filter boards CR2 and CR13 are turned off and Q3, Q6, CR8 and CR15 are turned on, allowing the XTAL filters to operate.

2.

Q21 is turned off allowing BW7 to be pulled up to more than + -10V by CR18 and R82. This turns off the LC filter sections on the Bandwidth Filter boards.

3.

4.

Q14 is turned off allowing the voltage on BW6 to be controlled by the current through A8Q 19.

Q22 is turned off having an effect on sweep time which is discussed in detail later.

The current through Q19 is a function of the states (off or on) of Q15, Q17, Q42, the values of factory select resistors

R74, R76, and R78, and the setting of. R72 XTL (3 kHz adjustment). The off/on states of Q15, Q17, and Q42 are controlled by BW1, BW2, and BW3 which are controlled by the front panel RESOLUTION BW switch and are at either +

15V or some negative voltage. The amount of current through Q19 controls the bandwidths of the XTAL filter sections on the Bandwidth Filter boards.

2.

3.

LC Resolution Bandwidth Control

When an LC bandwidth is selected, (3 MHz, 1 MHz, 300 kHz, 100 kHz), control line BW5 is pulled to + 15V at the front panel. This has four effects.

1.

On the Bandwidth Filter boards: Q3, Q6, CR8, and CR15 are turned off and CR2 and CR13 are turned on, thus blocking any signal from passing through the XTAL filer sections.

Q14 is turned on, pulling BW6 to -4V, which further defeats any possible action of the XTAL filter sections.

Q21 is turned on, allowing the voltage on BW7 to be controlled by the current through Q20.

8-49

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

The current through Q20 is a function of the states (off or on) of Q23, Q44, Q49, the values of factory select resistors

R89, R92, and R95, and the setting of R85 LC (1 MHz adjustment). The off/on states of Q23, Q44, Q49 are controlled by

BW2, BW3, and BW4 which are controlled by the front panel bandwidth switch and are either at + 15V or some negative voltage. The amount of current through Q20 controls the bandwidths of the LC filter sections on the Bandwidth Filter boards.

4.

Q22 is turned on having an effect on AUTO sweep time which is discussed later.

Video Filter

The video filter is composed of front panel control A2R6, switch A2S2, and 8 capacitors on Sweep Generator A8. The amount of filtering is controlled by the Resolution Bandwidth setting through Q16, Q18, Q43, Q41, Q46, Q24, and Q45.

These transistors switch in and out various combinations of filter capacitors to provide more video filtering when the resolution bandwidth is decreased. In LC mode, BW6 is low holding Q15, Q17, Q42, Q41 off and keeping C19, C20, C21 and C22 out of the circuit.

Switch A2S2 applies maximum video filtering for noise measure mode by switching in C26 through Q47.

Sweep Attenuator

The sweep attenuator circuit changes the amplitude of the sweep voltage applied to the Frequency Control A7 as a function of the FREQ SPAN/DIV selected. The attenuator attenuates the -5V to +5V ramp routed through XA8 pin 39 in a divide by 1, 2, 5, and 10 sequence from a divide-by-1 to a divide-by-200. The circuit also generates an auto-sweep control current used to control the AUTO sweep time circuit as a function of the frequency span.

The sweep attenuator has two voltage dividers buffered by the unity gain voltage follower U3. The divider at the input of

U3 provides either a divide-by-two or a divide-by-five; the divider at the output of the U3 provides a divide-by-one, a divide-by-ten, and a divide-by-one hundred.

Assuming that FS3 (divide-by-two) is selected, + 15V turns on Q31 and Q32 grounds a 10K ohm resistor R113. The -5V to +5V ramp is divided across the input resistor R101 (10K ohms) and R113 (10K ohms). The ramp is now divided in half and applied to sweep buffer U3 pin 3. The dividers at the output of U3 (controlled by FS4 and FS5) have reversed control logic; they are normally connected to + 15V by A2A1S5 and open when selected. Q50 is a gate to drive Q30.

When FS4 and FS5 are connected to + 15V, Q50 is off and Q30 is on, connecting the divide-by-one divider at the output of U3. If either FS4 or FS5 is open, Q30 is off and Q28 or Q26 is on, providing either a divide-by-10 or divide-by-100.

AUTO sweep control current is applied to Q52 as a function of frequency span by Q35, Q31, Q33, Q27, and Q25 and the appropriate resistors. For narrow spans (1 MHz/DIV or less), when the YIG FM coil is swept, FS6 is connected to + 15V by A2A1S5. Q29 is on and the additional current in the AUTO sweep control is used to reduce the sweep time.

8-50

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

+ V Sweep Offset

Normally, START-CENTER switch A2A1S7 is in the CENTER position. The + 15V back biases Q54 and holds it off.

Switching to START allows Q54 to conduct and adds 0.5 mA of current through R67 to offset the sweep ramp. When

START frequency is used, the ramp excursion is from 0V to a positive voltage.

8-51

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-22. A8 Sweep Generator Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations

8-52

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-53 through 8-56

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A9 THIRD CONVERTER CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

General Description

The Third Converter Assembly contains of a 280 MHz oscillator followed by a buffer amplifier, a balanced mixer, a matching filter, a 21.4 MHz amplifier,, and a PIN attenuator. The 301.4 MHz second IF signal from A10 is mixed with the

280 MHz oscillator (third LO) in balanced mixer A9U1. The output from the mixer is the difference frequency, 21.4 MHz, which is applied to the matching filter. This is a 21.4 MHz bandpass filter which also acts as an inter-stage impedance matching device. The signal is then amplified by the 21.4 MHz amplifier and coupled to a divider network consisting of two PIN diodes A9CR3 and CR4, resistor R25, and the input impedance of the Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11.

PIN driver A9Q5 changes the bias of the PIN diodes as a function of frequency, compensating for input mixer frequency response. The 21.4 MHz third IF output signal is coupled to the input of Bandwidth Filter No. 1. The 280 MHz Oscillator also provides the front panel CAL OUTPUT 280 MHz -30 dBm signal. It is sometimes necessary to select a different value for R9 to provide the 30 dBm CAL OUTPUT level while maintaining the proper input level to the balanced mixer.

280 MHz Oscillator (Third LO)

The third local oscillator is a modified Colpitts circuit with a 280 MHz surface acoustic wave resonator (SAWR) A9Z1 in the positive feedback path to provide increased frequency stability. Inductor A9L3, across the SAWR, tunes out the

SAWR shunt capacitance. The oscillator tuned circuit consists of capacitors A9C4, C5, and inductors L4 and L6. This tuned circuit ensures that the oscillator oscillates only on the proper overtone of the SAWR. A1though A9L4 is called the

LO FREQ adjustment, it is used to adjust for maximum LO output power and has only a slight effect on the output frequency. Inductor A9L5 provides a dc path for base bias of buffer amplifier A9Q2. Diodes A9CRI and CR2 provide temperature compensation for the 280 MHz oscillator and indirectly stabilize the CAL OUTPUT level. Power is taken out of the oscillator through L6, which transforms the output to approximately 50 ohms at a level of 0 dBm. The output level of the circuit is controlled by 3RD LO PWR adjustment A9RS, which sets the emitter current of A9Q1 and allows adjustment f6r a 30 dBm 280 MHz front-panel CAL OUTPUT level. It is sometimes necessary to select a different value for A9R4 to provide the proper third LO output level. Buffer amplifier A9Q2 provides isolation for the 280 MHz oscillator and provides about 10 dB of power gain to the L port of balanced mixer U1. The buffer amplifier also provides the proper output level to the front-panel CAL OUTPUT (by selecting A9R9) for a given balanced mixer input.

Balanced Mixer (Third Mixer)

The third LO 280 MHz input to the L port of the balanced mixer is approximately + 10 dBm. The level of the second IF

301.4 MHz input to the X port of the mixer is about 12 dBm or less. The third mixer output (Port R) is the 21.4 MHz difference frequency produced by heterodyning the 301.4 MHz IF and the 280 MHz LO. The third mixer has a conversion loss of about 7 dB.

Matching Filter

The output of the balanced mixer is applied to the matching filter which consists of A9L9, C10, C11, C12, and L10. The matching filter is a 21.4 MHz bandpass filter which also serves as an impedance matching network. The circuit raises the low input impedance of the 21.4 MHz amplifier (about 10 ohms) to match the higher output impedance of the balanced mixer (about 50 ohms).

21.4 MHz Amplifier

The 21.4 MHz amplifier consists of A9Q3 in a common-emitter configuration and A9Q4 as an emitter follower. Transistor

A9Q3 employs resistor A9R12 and zener diode A9VR2 to furnish base bias and negative feedback for gain control and stabilization. Resistor A9R12 is factory selected to provide the

8-57

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 proper gain of the Third Converter Assembly. Capacitor A9C14 is connected across A9VR2 to reduce zener noise. The output of the 21.4 MHz amplifier looks into a voltage-controlled attenuator consisting of two PIN diodes, A9CR3 and

CR4, resistor A9R25, and the input impedance of the Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11.

PIN Driver

The PIN diode resistance of A9CR3 and CR4 is controlled by the PIN driver A9Q5 and its associated circuitry. The base of A9Q5 is the summing point for the frequency anA10g voltage from the Frequency Control Assembly A7 and a dc level set by front-panel REF LEVEL CAL screwdriver adjustment A2R3. Setting the dc level by adjusting A2R3 calibrates the

8558B display at a given frequency, usually performed at 280 MHz. The frequency analog voltage is a dc level varying from + 0.6 volts to + 6.7 volts as a function of frequency. This frequency anA10g voltage at the base of A9Q5 compensates for input mixer response. SLOPE COMP adjustment A9R1 sets the amount of compensation required for a flat frequency response. The total current through the PIN diodes A9CR3 and CR4 is shaped by the emitter network of

A9Q5. This network provides a change in current through the PIN diodes to cause a change of PIN diode resistance.

The change in resistance is required to provide the proper log curve within an 8 dB range for the voltage-controlled attenuator.

8-58

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A10 SECOND IF CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

General Description

The Second IF Assembly contains a bandpass amplifier which provides a gain of approximately 16 dB at 301.4 MHz. It also contains a bandpass filter which provides further rejection of unwanted signals. The bandpass filter has a 3 dB loss, giving the Second IF Assembly a net gain of approximately 13 dB at 301.4 MHz. The 301.4 MHz IF output signal is coupled to Third Converter Assembly A9 by cable W7. This signal is the input to the X port of the balanced mixer on the

Third Converter Assembly.

Bandpass Amplifier

The bandpass amplifier consists of A10Q2 in a common-emitter configuration, and A10Q1 connected to control the base drive and bias current of A10Q2. Capacitors A10C4, C5, C7, and C10 serve as decoupling for high frequencies. The gain of the bandpass amplifier is set by the high frequency characteristics of A10Q2, R5, and the small amount of inductance on the emitter connection of Q2. The emitter inductance is used to establish a 50 ohm input impedance and to help stabilize the current gain of A10Q2. Resistor A10R5 in parallel with the output resistance of A10Q2 establishes an output impedance of about 500 ohms. Components A10L2, C8, C9 and the collector capacitance (Cc) of Q2 form the

collector tank circuit (see Figure 8-24). This tank circuit determines the center frequency of the bandpass amplifier and

transforms the 500 ohm output impedance at the collector of A10Q1 down to 50 ohms. The output of the bandpass amplifier flows from A10C9 through a 50 ohm microstrip transmission line (etched on the printed circuit board) to the bandpass filter. The bandpass amplifier has a gain of about 16 dB from the base of A10Q2 to the 50 ohm output of

A10C9.

Bandpass Filter

The output of the bandpass amplifier passes through a 301.4 MHz bandpass filter. The bandpass filter is made up of

A10L3, L4, L5, C11, C12, C13, C14, C15 and adjustable piston-type capacitors A10C1, C2, and C3. Capacitors A10C11 and C15 are used to transform the bandpass filter input and output impedance to 50 ohms. Inductors A10L3, L4, and L5 are wound on a common coil form which provides mutual inductance coupling between filter sections. The bandpass filter has an insertion loss of approximately 3 dB and 3 dB bandwidth of about 12 MHz.

Figure 8-24. Bandpass Amplifier Tank Circuit, Simplified Schematic

8-59

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-25. A9 Third Converter Assembly, and A10 Second IF Assembly, Component Locations

8-60

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-61 through 8-62

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14

A11 BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

General Description

Bandwidth Filter No. 1 operates at 21.4 MHz and is variable in bandwidth from 3 MHz to 1 kHz. The front-panel

RESOLUTION BW switch is used to select one of eight available bandwidth settings (3 MHz, 1 MHz, 300 kHz, 100 kHz,

30 kHz, 10 kHz, 3 kHz, or 1 kHz).

The narrower bandwidths (1 kHz through 30 kHz) are obtained from four synchronously tuned crystal filters; the four wider bandwidths (100 kHz through 3 MHz), from four synchronously tuned LC tank circuits. The four stages of bandwidth filters are on two similar printed-circuit boards, Bandwidth Filter No. 1 (A11) and Bandwidth Filter No. 2

(A13). Two LC tank circuits and two crystal filters are on each board. The four crystals in the two bandwidth assemblies

(A11Y1, A11Y2, A13Y1, and A13Y2) are a factory-selected matched set. If replacement of a Bandwidth Filter assembly is necessary, the new board is shipped with two crystals installed. The other two crystals (which must be used to replace the existing two crystals in the good Bandwidth Filter assembly) are packaged separately and shipped with the new

Bandwidth Filter board. In addition to the filter stages, each Bandwidth Filter provides 10 dB of gain in both LC and crystal filter operation. (There is some gain in the "unity" gain buffer amplifiers.)

10 dB Input Buffer Amplifier

The 10 dB input buffer amplifier functions as a non-inverting operational amplifier.

In the crystal mode (bandwidths <30 kHz), the amplifier includes Q3. The biasing of the amplifier is independent of its ac

(21.4 MHz) operation but is very critical for its proper functioning. If a malfunction occurs, the dc bias should be checked first.

In the LC mode (the four wider bandwidths), the BW5 line goes to + 14.8V and turns off current source Q3. The current supplied by Q3 in the crystal mode is then supplied through CR1 and R13 from the BW5 line.

Unity Gain Buffer Amplifier

The unity gain buffer amplifier is the same as the 10 dB input buffer amplifier, except that it has a FET input (Q5) and is connected for unity gain. The input is selected by the BW5 line from CR9 in the LC mode, or from CR8 in the crystal mode.

In the crystal mode, the current through Q5 is determined by the difference between the current sourced by Q6 and that sunk by Q7: about 4 mA. A significant deviation from this current should be reflected by the gate-to-source voltage of

Q5. The source should be at least 0.2V more positive than the gate, but not more than 1.5V more positive. If the difference is less than 0.2V, the FET current is too high; if the difference is greater than 1.5V, the FET current is too low.

In either case the FET could also be defective. To determine

8-63

Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14 precisely the current through Q5, the difference between the current through R38 and that through R60 should be subtracted from the current through R30. If the results are inconsistent, check the above mentioned resistors.

In LC mode of operation, current is supplied through R37 and CR19 from the BW5 line instead of through Q6. The difference between the current through R37 and that through R30 yields the FET current.

Output Buffer Amplifier The output buffer amplifier is a complementary pair of transistors in which Q9 acts as a source follower boosted by Q10. The current through FET Q9 is set by R53:

V be

(Q10) .7V

I

FET

= ÷ ÷

196

196

3 mA

The total current through Q9 and Q10 is set by R54. The input is selected by the BW5 line from either CR16 in the LC mode or CR15 in the crystal mode.

Crystal Filtering Circuits

The bandwidths 1 kHz, 3 kHz, 10 kHz, and 30 kHz are obtained by crystal filtering. The crystals are used in series resonant mode and can be modeled as a series resonant circuit with a parallel capacitance:

The parallel capacitance (Co) and series resistance (Rs) are not desired and are compensated for in the circuit, resulting in this simplified schematic of a single pole of crystal filtering:

PIN diode CR4 functions as a variable resistor at 21.4 MHz. As the resistance is lowered by increasing the current in the

BW6 line, the bandshape becomes narrower. The bandwidth of one pole widens to approximately 70 kHz when the PIN is turned off completely at the 30 kHz BW setting. (For a four-pole filter, the bandwidth of each pole is about 2.3 times the bandwidth of all four poles taken together. The bandwidth of two poles is about 1.5 times the bandwidth of all four poles taken together).

A simplified schematic of a crystal pole, including compensation for Rx and Co in the crystal and input capacitance of the

buffer amplifier, is shown in Figure 8-27.

8-64

Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-27. Crystal Pole, Simplified Schematic

The SYM adjustment, C15, compensates for Co by producing a current (-11) that is equal to the current (11) through Co of the crystal but opposite in phase. These currents cancel and nullify the effect of Co. The positive feedback from the collector of Q3 generates a negative output resistance that cancels Rs of the crystal. This is approximated by resistor R6 in the 10 dB input buffer amplifier and by potentiometer R31 in the unity gain buffer amplifier.

The input capacitance of the buffer amplifier, the printed circuit board capacitance, the PIN capacitance, and the centering (CTR) capacitor C25 are in parallel resonance with L7. These components have negligible effect on the band shape and as long as C25 has sufficient range to 'dip' the bandshape, they can be ignored in analyzing the remainder of the circuit.

PIN diode CR4 controls bandwidths from 1 kHz to 10 kHz. For the 30 kHz bandwidth, CR4 is back biased, and R23 sets the bandwidth. If the 30 kHz bandwidth is much too narrow, even with CR4 back biased, the circuit may be loaded by a bad buffer amplifier (Q5, Q7) or inverting amplifier (Q4). If the bandwidth is only slightly narrow, it may be widened by padding R23. If the narrowest bandwidths (1 kHz or 3 kHz) have too little gain, and it cannot be increased enough by

R31, either the crystals have too high a series resistance (defective crystal); or the output resistance is not negative enough (defective buffer amplifier or Q3).

Almost any defect in the Bandwidth Filter boards will result in a faulty dc bias condition in one of the three buffer amplifiers on each board. The dc bias of each stage is less straightforward than ac (21.4 MHz) operation and should be checked carefully.

8-65

Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14

LC Filtering Circuits

The two LC filtering circuits are used for the wider bandwidths (100 kHz through 3 MHz). They are similar in function; the first LC pole circuit is described. A schematic of the simplified equivalent circuit is shown below:

The LC filter uses a metallized inductor L6 in parallel with three capacitors: C23 (LC CTR) for centering, C21 for temperature compensation, and C20*. The parallel circuit is driven through PIN diode CR3, which functions as a variable resistor. The BW7 line sets the current through CR3. Higher resistance results in narrower bandwidth. A simplified

schematic of the first LC pole circuit is shown in Figure 8-28.

Figure 8-28. LC Pole, Simplified Schematic

8-66

Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14

C73 and L5 tune out the capacitance of CR3. R19 sets the 100 kHz bandwidth when CR3 is back biased (i.e., highest resistance). CR5 is controlled by the LC FEEDBACK pot R26 and compensates for losses in the parallel resonant circuit.

(In the second LC pole circuit, fixed resistor R56* replaces CR5.) Low gain in one of the poles in the 100 kHz bandwidth is caused by:

1.

The pole being centered at some frequency other than 21.4 MHz (a defective metallized inductor is most common).

2.

3.

4.

The Q of the pole being too low (not a common failure).

Insufficient feedback from the buffer amplifier.

Defective buffer amplifier is loading the circuit.

If the 100 kHz bandwidth amplitude is correct, but that of the 300 kHz bandwidth is too low, either C73 or C74 might not be properly adjusted. If the 300 kHz amplitude is too high, the four LC poles are not tuned close enough to the same

frequency. In either case, refer to Section V, Adjustments.

8-67

Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-29. A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations

8-68

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-69

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

A12 STEP GAIN CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

General Description

The Step Gain Assembly contains three amplifier stages to provide a 0 to 50 dB amplification of the 21.4 MHz third IF signal. The amplifier stages are selected by front panel REF LEVEL dBm switch A2S1. At the output of the final amplifier is a two-section bandpass filter. In conjunction with the front panel REF LEVEL FINE control, the step gain assembly also contains the circuitry for the 0 to 12 dB fine control for the reference level. A TEST/NORM switch is available; in TEST position, tests are made at a low gain level.

0 - 12 dB Control

A minimum current flow through PIN diode A12CR3 (maximum allowable diode resistance) is established by the 12 dB potentiometer, A12R6, so the diode is never completely cutoff. Adjustment of A12R6 sets the 0.3 dB point and is adjusted with the REF LEVEL FINE control fully clockwise (-12 position).

The maximum current flow through the PIN diode is set by the 0 dB potentiometer, A12R5. A12R5 is adjusted to the

12.3 dB attenuation point with the REF LEVEL FINE control fully counterclockwise (0 position).

Transistors A12Q8 and A12Q9 are identical current sources. The maximum current is set by 0 dB adjustment A12R5 in the common base circuit. Diode A12CR1 provides temperature compensation for the transistors.

A12Q8 provides current for a bias voltage applied to the anode of the PIN diode. The voltage source consists of A12R6,

A12R17, and A12CR2. Diode A12CR2 provides temperature compensation for the PIN diode. Inductance A12L5 isolates the current source from the RF signal.

A12Q9 provides current for a variable voltage source at the cathode of PIN diode A12CR3. A resistance is formed by

REF LEVEL FINE control R4 (shown on A2 schematic) and fixed resistor A12R9. The fixed 316K ohm resistor is used to shape the value of potentiometer R4 to match the PIN diode resistance changes. The REF LEVEL FINE control varies the voltage at the cathode of PIN diode A12CR3 and thus varies diode current flow. Regulating the current flow through the PIN diode controls the amount of signal attenuation. For example, if PIN diode current flow is increased, more RF signal is shunted or bypassed to ground. A12C12 provides the RF ground and also isolates from ground the variable dc from the REF LEVEL FINE control. When the REF LEVEL FINE control is fully clockwise, the PIN diode is at minimum conduction, and maximum signal is applied to the base of A12Q7. Conversely, when the REF LEVEL FINE control is fully counterclockwise, the PIN diode is at maximum conduction and minimum signal is applied to A12Q7.

Step Gain Amplifiers

Buffer amplifier A12Q7 operates in an emitter-follower configuration and provides isolation between the 0 12 dB control and the 10 dB amplifier.

The three step gain amplifiers can be considered as operational amplifiers. An equivalent circuit for the three stages is

shown in Figure 8-31. The gain for each amplifier is Av = Rf/Ri. The feedback resistance (Rf) for the 10 dB amplifier is

A12R26, 562 ohms; and for the 20 dB amplifiers it is A12R32 and A12R38, 750 ohms. The input resistance R i

is a combination of a fixed series resistance (56.2 ohms) and the controlled resistance of the PIN diodes. The resistance of the PIN diodes is approximatey 10 to 1000 ohms and increases as the forward bias current is decreased from 100 mA to

1 µA. R i

is approximately 260 ohms for the 10 dB amplifier and approximately 83 ohms for the 20 dB amplifiers.

8-71

Model 8558B TM11-6625-3061-14

Selection of the correct combination of step gain amplifiers is accomplished with front panel REF LEVEL dBm switch

A2S 1. Rotating the switch grounds the emitter circuit of the selected amplifier(s) allowing current to flow through the PIN diode(s). The possible switch combinations allow the gain to vary from unity (all switches open) to 50 dB maximum gain with all three emitter circuits grounded.

A TEST/NORM switch, A12S1, is included in the emitter paths of the 20 dB step gain amplifiers. In the TEST position, the switch defeats the two 20 dB amplifier stages, providing a fixed 10 dB of gain for use when making LOG amplifier adjustments.

Bandpass Filter

The output of the step-gain amplifiers is coupled through a two-section bandpass filter. The bandpass filter consists of

A12L9, A12L10, A12C24, and A12C25 and provides rejection of signals outside the region of 21.4 MHz.

+ 19.5V Regulator

The + 19.5V regulator consists of series regulator A12Q13, driver A12Q12, and reference amplifier A12Q10 and Q11.

Zener diode A12VR1 provides a +6.2V reference for the base of Q11. Q10 senses the + 19.5V output across resistors

A12R45, R46, and R7, the + 19.5V adjustment. Should the output voltage start to drop below + 19.5V, Q10 will start to turn off. This will turn on Q11 which turns on Q12 and Q13, raising the output back to + 19.5V. L11 and C27 filter the +

19.5V output. C26 between the collector and emitter of Q 12 is used to stabilize the feedback gain at high frequencies.

Figure 8-31. Equivalent Circuit for Step Gain Amplifiers

8-72

8-73

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-32. A12 Step Gain Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations

8-74

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-75 through 8-76

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B

A13 BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2 CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

TM 11-6625-3061-14

The Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly is very similar to the Bandwidth Filter No. 1 Assembly A11, and corresponding components have the same reference designators. The differences between the two board assemblies are as follows:

1.

2.

3.

A13 has a limiting diode, CR18, connected between the input (P1-23) and ground; A11 does not.

The values of some resistors and capacitors in A13 are different from their counterparts in A11.

A13 has about 0.5 dB less gain than A11.

8-77

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-34. A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2 Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations

8-78

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-79 through 8-80

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B

A14 LOG AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY, CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

TM 11-6625-3061-14

General Description

The Log Amplifier Assembly provides the ability to display signals in either a linear mode or 70 dB LOG mode. It also operates with the Step Gain Assembly A12 to provide the last 40 dB of step gain amplification of the 21.4 MHz IF signal.

The Log Amplifier Assembly has seven amplifier stages, with each stage capable of providing both linear and logarithmic amplification. Following the amplifier stages, the amplified IF signal is detected to produce the vertical signal for the display. An offset circuit, following the detector, is used-in the log mode to offset the vertical output in steps equivalent to

40 dB of IF gain.

Log Mode of Operation

The seven amplifier stages limit the gain in sequence to provide 70 dB of log amplification. Each stage consists of an emitter follower used as a voltage source to drive a common-base amplifier whose gain decreases with increasing signal level.

Log Amplifier Gain. The operation of the second stage is described. In the log mode of operation, Q24 (Gain Control

Lines circuit) is on, forward biasing the log diodes, CR10 and CR11, which are Schottky diodes with a forward bias voltage of approximately 0.4V. The gain of the amplifier is set by the ratio of R52 to the total resistance RT between the

emitters of Q13 and Q8. An example of gain computation is shown in Figure 8-36 RT is at a minimum (approximately

150 ohms) for small signals when the ac signal current in log diodes CR10 and CR11 is small compared to their dc bias current. As the ac signal level is increased, the ac signal current increases to the level of the dc bias current and RT increases because of current limiting in the diodes.

The initial (maximum) gain of the stage (approximately 10 dB) is set by the dc bias current through the log diodes. The bias current is controlled by the temperature variable -8VT supply at the emitter of Q24. The final (minimum) gain of the stage (0 dB) is set by the circuit configuration (RT becomes very large) and can be set further by the adjustment of R39 -

10 dB.

Figure 8-36. Simplified Log Amplifier Stage

8-81

Model 8558B

Linear Mode of Operation

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Linear Gain. In the linear mode, the limiting action of the log diodes is removed from the seven amplifier stages. The operation of the second stage is described. Q24 is turned off, and the dc bias current through log diodes CR10 and

CR11 is zero. With zero dc bias current the total resistance, RT, is maximum and the stage gain is approximately unity

(0 dB). (See Figure 8-26.)

In the sixth and seventh stages, an alternate signal path is used to set the gain at about 5 dB per stage. The purpose of this fixed gain is to scale properly between the log and linear modes. These stages are activated by the -8VT from the

AMPLITUDE SCALE switch through R34 (LIN), R93, and R101, and finally through the cathodes of CR25 and CR28.

The combined gain of the two stages is adjusted with R34 (LIN), which controls the dc bias current in the PIN diodes.

Step Gain Operation

The Log Amplifier Board Assembly provides 40 dB of step gain in 10 dB steps. This gain, combined with 50 dB of step gain from Step Gain Assembly A12, will produce up to 90 dB of total step gain. The amount of step gain is selected by the front panel REFERENCE LEVEL switch (A2A1S1). The control lines from A2AiS1, IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6, control the step gain on the Log Amplifier Board Assembly.

Step Gain When in Log Mode. When in log mode, control lines IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6 route + 15V to the Log Offset circuit through R24, R25, and R26. This forward biases diodes CR32, CR33, and CR31. The Log Offset circuit provide

10, 20, 30, or 40 dB of step gain, depending on the state of the control lines. (See Log Offset circuit description.)

Step Gain When in Linear Mode. In linear mode, amplifier stages 2, 3, 4, and 5, are used to provide 40 dB of step gain in 10 dB steps. In linear mode, the LOG/LIN line is at -8VT, Q24 is off, and the log diodes are normally off. Each amplifier stage has unity gain (0 dB). The control lines, IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6 are used to forward bias the log diodes, thus changing the gain of the amplifier stages from 0 dB to 10 dB. The state of the control lines determine which of stages 2, 3, 4, or 5 has a gain of 10 dB.

For example, with INPUT ATTEN at 0 dB and REFERENCE LEVEL dBm at -60, -8VT is routed through A2A1S2 and

A2A1S1 to the IFG4 control line to forward bias CR22. The fifth amplifier stage gain changes from 0 dB to 10 dB, providing 10 dB of step gain.

Resistors R33, R30, and R27 may be adjusted to set the step gains of stages 5, 4, and 3 and 2, respectively.

Log Mode Temperature Controlled Variable Gain Amplifier

LOG/LIN Relationship. In linear mode, when approximately 700 mVrms (+ 10 dBm) is applied to the input of the log amplifier, the voltage at the output of stage 7 (TP5) is about 1.5 Vrms. With the same input signal in log mode, the output at TP5 is about 2.0 Vrms. To maintain equal relationship with maximum input signal (trace at the top of the display) the output in log mode must be attenuated. This attenuation is achieved through the use of variable gain amplifier Q7, whose gain is determined by the ratio of its collector load to its emitter load.

Variable Gain Amplifier. In linear mode, the LOG/LIN control line is at -8VT. This forward biases CR4 and causes the output of U2B (TP1) to go to approximately + 15V. CR29 is reverse biased, and the gain of the variable gain amplifier is

R104/R105 (100/316), or approximately 0.3. In log mode, the LOG/LIN control line is at + 15V, which reverse biases

CR4. The output of U2B is now approximately + 0.45V. CR29 is forward biased and has an ac resistance of about 100 ohms, which is in parallel with the 100-ohm R104, so the collector load of Q7 is 50 ohms. The gain is 50/316, or 0.15.

This gain depends upon the resistance of CR29, which is set by SLOPE adjustment R23.

8-82

Model 8558B

Detector and Buffer Amplifier

TM 11-6625-3061-14

The signal output of Q7 is applied to the base of Q6, which converts voltage variations into current variations. Q5 is the current driver for the detector. Q4, a half-wave rectifier, is biased just below cutoff by CR1. When the input signal is positive, Q4 is in conduction but is cut off during the negative transistion. The detector output is routed to a low-pass filter and a X2 buffer amplifier, Q21 and Q22, to provide the video output.

Log Offset

The last 40 dB of log step gain is produced in this circuit. When this gain is used, there is already a full 50 dB of gain in the Step Gain Assembly, so the noise of the analyzer is amplified into the log range of the Log Amplifier Assembly. This makes further amplificiation unnecessary since any signal below the log range of the Log Amplifer Assembly would be buried in the noise. The output of the detector can then be offset in 100-mV steps corresponding to 10 dB of IF amplification. This offset is provided by Q23 operating as a stepped current source into R115. With the AMPLITUDE

SCALE switch in one of the LOG/DIV positions, + 15V is routed throuh the closed contacts of the REFERENCE LEVEL dBm switch to the IF gain control lines IFG4, IFG5, and IFG6. With an IF gain control line connected to + 15V, a log-shift diode (CR31, CR32, or CR33) is forward biased, and this bias current, determined by R123, R124, or R125, flows into the emitter of current source Q23. IFG4 and IFG5 each provides 10 dB (100 mV) of log offset gain and IFG6 provides 20 dB

(200 mV). The LOG GAIN adjustment R121 sets the operating point of Q23 for 100-mV steps.

Temperature Compensation Power Supply

Temperature compensation is provided for the - 8VT and + 1V regulators. CR2 and CR4 operate as the temperaturesensing element. Temperature variations cause diode voltage changes that are amplified by U1A for the - 8VT supply and by U2B for the + 1V supply. The - 8VT supply provides bias current for the Schottky diodes in the LOG mode. In the linear mode, the - 8VT supply provides bias current for CR12, CR15, CR19, CR22, CR25, and CR28. The + 1V supply provides bias current for CR29.

+11 V Regulated Power Supply

A precise 5.4V reference voltage VR1 is provided for the + 11V Regulator. This reference voltage is applied to the positive input of U1B. R5 and R6 set the gain of U1B to 2.1. The output at TP2 is 2.1 x 5.4, or 11.3V. Q1 acts as an emitter follower and provides the current drive for the + 11 V supply.

8-83

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-37. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Component Locations

8-84

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-85 through 8-88

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B

A15 VERTICAL DRIVER AND BLANKING CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

TM 11-6625-3061-14

General Description

The Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly provides a preamplifier circuit to amplify the detected and filtered video from the log amplifier. The video signal needed to trigger the sweep generator in INT mode is picked off at the preamplifier.

A vertical driver (differential amplifier) converts the signal to drive the vertical deflection plates (push-pull output).

The blanking and pen lift drive signals are also generated on assembly A15.

Preamplifier

The detected and filtered video input (0V to 0.8V) from the Log Amplifier Assembly A14 is applied to the gate of

A15Q17A. A15Q17, Q11, Q12, and Q18 make up a differential amplifier. The gate of Q17A is the noninverting input and the gate of Q17B is the inverting input. The output at the emitter of A15Q18 is feedback applied to the gate of Q17B through voltage divider A15R11, R12, and R13. The voltage gain of the preamplifier is 1 + R11/R12 + R13 = 10. With an input voltage range of 0V to 0.8V, the maximum signal measured at the output of A15Q18 (TP5) would be 8V. (This signal coupled through A15R17 is the trigger voltage for INT mode.) A buffer amplifier consisting of A15U2A, U2B, and

Q20 provides isolation between the preamplifier and vertical driver. A15U2D and Q13 are current sources to bias the differential amplifier.

The vertical deflection sensitivity of the following vertical driver is 0.8V for full-scale deflection. Since a maximum possible signal of 8V is available from the preamplifier, to obtain the correct signal amplitude, a divide-by-10 and an offset circuit are used.

10 dB/DIV and LIN. The preamplifier output is divided by 10 when LOG/LIN switch A2S2 is in either LIN or 10 dB/DIV.

With LIN or 10 dB/DIV selected, + 15V is applied to the Expand line, back biasing A15CR1, and turning A15Q19 on.

Also A15CR2 is on and CR3 is back biased. With A15Q19 on, a voltage divider consisting of A15R18, R20, and Q19 divides the preamplifier output by 10.

1 dB/DIV. With 1 dB/DIV selected, the Expand line is open and A15Q19 is held off by A15CR1 and R22. The divide-by-

10 circuit is disabled and the full 8-volt preamp voltage is available. Since only the 0.8V peak can be displayed, the signal to the buffer amplifier is offset by -7.2 volts as follows: A current source A15U2C is on, drawing current through

A15CR3 and R18. The voltage drop across R18 is set for 7.2V, so the 8V input is shifted -7.2V below ground. When the signal goes below ground (OV), A15CR4 conducts and clamps the signal at -0.6V. The 1 dB OFFSET adjustment,

A15R1, sets the current for the correct voltage shift.

-5.5V Temperature Compensated Supply

The -5.5V temperature-compensated supply controls four current sources: A15U2D, Q13, U2C, and Q15. The temperature-sensing element, A15U2E (connected as a diode), tracks the base-emitter temperature changes of the current-source transistors.

Vertical Driver

The vertical driver-is a differential amplifier that consists of A15Q2, Q3, Q6, Q7, and Q14 with Q15 as the current source.

(See Figure 8-39.) The 0V to 0.8V vertical signal from the output of the preamplifier is converted to a push-pull signal to

drive the CRT vertical deflection plates. A15Q14 is a dual transistor used as the input stage to the Vertical Driver circuit.

The reference input level at the base of A15Q14A is set by the VERT POSN control, A2R6. The gain of the vertical driver is set by the voltage divider consisting of A15R34, R42, and VERT GAIN control A2R7. The transistor pairs

A15Q2/Q6 and A15Q3/Q7 are current-to-voltage amplifiers and are driven by the current from the collectors of A15Q14A and B respectively. Diodes A15CR5 through CR8 protect the bases of A15Q2, Q3, Q6, and Q7 to prevent them from

8-89

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 being driven more negative than approximately 0.6V (the voltage drop across a diode). The resistors A15R44 and R52 decouple the capacitive load of the CRT plates from the emitters of A15Q2 and Q3, preventing overshoot and ringing in the vertical driver. A15Q21, CR11, and CR12 provide vertical driver input switching for normalizer compatibility. When the normalizer is not connected, pull-up resistor A15R56 places the cathode of A15CR11 at + 15V, preventing CR11 from conducting. A15Q21 is turned on so the input to the vertical driver is from the output of the preamplifier. When the normalizer is connected and in the BYPASS mode, the L NORM line at A15J3 is high (+ 12V) preventing A15CR11 from conducting. When the normalizer is operating, the L NORM line is pulled low (- 12V) causing A15CR11 to conduct.

A15Q21 is turned off by the negative voltage at the gate, switching the vertical driver input to the normalizer output (Y

NORM).

Blanking OR

Normally A15Q4 is off placing a low at the base of A15Q9 and turning it on. A15Q4 requires a positive voltage or about

1 mA to turn on and cut Q9 off. A high into the OR circuit provides a high blanking output (0V) to the mainframe. There

are four conditions that cause blanking of the sweep. (See Figure 8-40.) When the normalizer is not connected, pull-up

resistor A15R56 places the cathode of A15CR12 at + 15V, preventing CR12 from conducting. When the normalizer is connected and in the bypass mode, the L NORM line at A15J3 is high (+12V) keeping A15CR12 from conducting. When the normalizer is operating, the L NORM line is pulled low (-12V) causing A15CR12 to conduct. With A15CR12 conducting, the output of the blanking OR is held at a negative voltage level, inhibiting blanking from the 8558B.

Vertical/Baseline Comparator

The vertical/baseline comparator circuit consists of A15Q16 and Q8. The baseline clipping reference voltage is set by front panel BASELINE CLIPPER control A2R2 which varies the base voltage of A15Q16. The vertical preamplifier output signal is applied to the base of A15Q8. The signal voltage at the base of A15Q8 is compared to the dc reference on

Q16. When the signal voltage becomes more negative than the reference, Q8 turns on and the high input to its base turns A15Q4 on, blanking the display.

Sweep Ramp High/Low Limit Comparator

Operational amplifier A15Q1A and Q1B is connected to form a comparator circuit. A voltage divider made up of A15R6,

R7, and R8 establishes a high and low voltage reference at UIA pin 2 and U1B pin 5. The switching limits are approximately + 0.6V at U1B pin 5 (low frequency blanking) and +6.8V at U1A pin 2 (high frequency blanking). The signal to the other inputs of the comparator is the frequency analog voltage from the YIG main coil swept driver. The frequency analog input voltage is proportional to the instantaneous frequency to which the analyzer is tuned and sweeps from 0.7V to 6.7V as the analyzer tunes from 0 to 1500 MHz. If the YIG tuning voltage at U1B pin 6 goes below 0.6V, the output of U1B rises to about + 14V. This turns on A15Q4 and blanks the display. If the YIG tuning voltage at U1A pin 2 rises above 6.8V, the output of U1A rises to about + 14V turning on A15Q4. Blanking of the display occurs whenever the analyzer is swept below about - 30 MHz or above about 1600 MHz.

Pen Lift Driver

The display is blanked during retrace and the dead time of the sweep voltage. The Retrace Blanking input from A8Q9 in the sweep generator circuit is applied to the emitter of buffer amplifier A15Q1. When the sweep ramp is turned off (dead time), the Retrace Blanking signal rises to + 10V. The + 10V connected to the base of A15Q4 produces the blanking output. The same + 10V Retrace Blanking input is applied to the base of A15Q5, turning Q5 on and Q10 off. The collector of A15Q10 then rises to + 15V. A15Q10 provides a signal that can be used to drive the Pen Lift input on an X-Y recorder. This signal causes the pen to lift during the analyzer sweep retrace and dead time. Breakdown diodes A15VR2 and VR3 suppress the high positive and negative voltage transients that some X-Y recorder pen lift coils can generate.

8-90

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-39. Simplified Vertical Driver Circuit

8-91

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-40. Simplified Blanking Circuit

8-92

8-93

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-41. A15 Vertical Driver and Blanking Assembly, Component and Test Point Locations

8-94

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-95 through 8-100

TM 11-1247-B

Model 8558B

A17 INVERTER CIRCUIT DESCRIPTION

TM 11-6625-3061-14

+5V Power Supply

Inverter Assembly A17 is a single transformer inverter with A17Q1 and Q2 operating as a 22 kHz squarewave oscillator.

Diodes A17CR1 and CR2 prevent the transistors from base-emitter reverse breakdown. Positive feedback to sustain the oscillation is taken from the transistor base tickler winding of T1. A17R1* provides current to the base of Q2 to start oscillations when the -12.6V supply is first turned on. The voltage at the collectors of A17Q1 and Q2 is a -12V to +12V square wave. Diodes A17CR5, CR6, CR7, and CR8 are connected as a full-wave rectifier, receiving ac power from 6V taps on either side of the grounded center tap. The rectified dc is filtered by A17L6, L7, L8, C5, and C6. The filtered output voltage is +5V and powers DPM Driver Assembly A1A2. A17VR1, a 6.19V zener, provides protection for the DPM

Driver in case of excessive or reverse voltage.

+20.5V Power Supply

The oscillating current between the collectors of A17Q1 and Q2 through the primary winding of T1 induces a voltage in the secondary of T1. Diodes CR3 and CR4 full-wave rectify this voltage, which is then filtered by A17L3, L4, L5, C3, and

C4. The dc output voltage, approximately +5.5V, is added to the +15V supply to obtain a + 20.5V supply

8-101

Model 8558B

Figure 8-45. A17 Inverter Assembly, Component Locations

8-102

TM 11-6625-3061-14

THIS PAGE MISSING NOT AVAILABLE FOR DIGITIZATION.

PAGES

8-103 through 8-106

TM 11-1247-B

4.

5.

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY A2 DISASSEMBLY AND REPAIR

Tools and Materials Required

Description

No. 2 Spline (Bristol) Wrench

Long No.4 Hex (Allen) Wrench

Long No. 6 Hex (Allen) Wrench

13/64-inch Open-end Wrench

5/16-inch Open-end Wrench

3/8-inch Open-end Wrench

1/2-inch Open-end Wrench

5/8-inch Open-end Wrench

1/4-inch Nut Driver

5/16-inch Nut Driver

3/8-inch Nut Driver

1/2-inch Nut Driver (end covered with heatshrink tubing)

9/16-inch Nut Driver (drilled out, end covered with heatshrink tubing)

Pozi-driv Screwdriver

Long-nose Pliers

Wire Cutters

Instrument Grease

Tiewraps

Small Brush (for Grease Application)

Isoproply Alcohol/Distilled Water Mixture

(50%-50%, for use as cleaning solvent)

HP Part Number Check Digit

8710-0055

5020-0288

5020-0289

8710-0946

8720-0015

8720-0016

8720-0025

8720-0010

8720-0002

8720-0003

8720-0005

8720-0007

8

9

5

8

1

3

8

3

4

0

5

6

8720-0008

8710-0899

8710-0030

87100012

6040-0584

1400-0249

8520-0015

4

0

1

9

7

0

9

1.

2.

3.

REMOVAL OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY FROM HP 8558B CHASSIS

Turn HP 8558B upside down on a flat work surface.

NOTE

Numbers in parentheses match the numerical callouts on Figure 6-3, Front Switch

Assembly (exploded view), in Section VI. Unless otherwise indicated, all other

illustrations referenced in these procedures follow the last procedural step.

Use a 9/16-inch nut driver (drilled out, if necessary, to fit over front panel BNC connectors, and covered with heatshrink tubing or tape to avoid scratching enameled front panel) to remove two dress nuts holding 1 ST LO

OUTPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors to front panel.

Use a 5/16-inch open-end wrench to carefully disconnect semi-rigid Cable W14 from RF Input Limiter U1 (cable connects Limiter to Input Attenuator A3).

Cut plastic tiewrap holding brown CAL OUTPUT Cable W8 to Front Switch Standoff (69).

Disconnect 50-conductor Ribbon Cable A2A1W3 (53) from Motherboard Assembly A16.

8-107

8.

9.

Model 8558B

6.

Turn HP 8558B right-side up, with front panel facing you.

7.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Disconnect 14-conductor Ribbon Cable A2AlWl (52) from DPM Driver Assembly A1A2. Fold cable up away from board.

10.

Remove the four Screws (19) attaching DPM Driver Assembly A1A2 to DPM Mounting Brackets (20, 21).

Disconnect four wires (0, 916, 918, 923) from upper right corner of Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 (next to

FREQUENCY ZERO potentiometer).

Remove the four screws attaching Front Switch Diecast (1) to left and right side gussets. Remove Front Switch

Assembly A2, with Front Panel and RF Input Attenuator A3, from HP 8558B chassis and set chassis to one side.

DISASSEMBLY OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY

12.

13.

14.

11.

15.

16.

NOTE

It is not necessary to remove front panel, all connectors, and all knobs to service

Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 (steps 11-24).

Remove the following front panel knobs using a no. 4 hex (Allen) wrench: FINE TUNE, COARSE TUNE,

RESOLUTION BW, FREQ SPAN/DIV, REF LEVEL FINE, and REFERENCE LEVEL (including Index Disc,

Retaining Clip, Nylon Spacer Washer(s), Conical Spring, and Input Attenuator pointer).

Remove VIDEO FILTER and BASELINE CLIPPER knobs using a no. 2 spline (Bristol) wrench.

Remove dress nut on FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton using a 13/64-inch open-end wrench.

Remove front panel hex nut and lockwasher on Coarse Tune Bushing (42) using a 1/2-inch nut driver (covered with heatshrink tubing or tape to avoid scratching enameled front panel).

Remove Retaining Clip (25) from RESOLUTION BW Shaft (61).

Place Front Switch Assembly on flat working surface with remaining knobs face-down and lock mechanism facing you. Prop sides of switch assembly to allow knobs and shafts to clear working surface (be careful not to scratch front panel enamel).

17.

18.

19.

Loosen hex nut attaching RF Input Cable Assembly W1 to Front Switch Assembly using a 5/8-inch open-end wrench (Options 001 and 002: Loosen front panel dress nut with special 9/16-inch nut driver). Carefully disconnect input cable assembly from RF Input Attenuator A3 using a 5/16-inch open-end wrench. Remove input cable assembly from Front Switch Assembly.

Remove Screw (19) and Washer (56) attaching Attenuator Bracket (55) to Front Switch Diecast (1). Remove RF

Input Attenuator A3 from Front Switch Assembly.

Disassembly of REFERENCE LEVEL Switch: a. Cut tiewrap holding REF LEVEL FINE wires to Standoff (69).

b. Remove the three Screws (54) attaching Ref Level Fine Pot Plate (75) to Standoffs (69).

c. Remove Index Disc Locator and Ref Level Fine Assembly (35, 36, and 71 through 76) from Front Switch

Assembly (set to one side, without detaching wires).

8-108

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 d. Remove three Standoffs (69) used to support Ref Level Fine Pot Plate (75). Use a no. 6 hex wrench to loosen the two set screws on Miter Gear (57) attached to Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17); then remove Miter Gear from shaft.

e. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen Rotating Lockout (70) attached to Ref Level Shaft (6), and remove lockout from shaft. Remove Ref Level Detent (68) from Front Switch Assembly. Be careful to keep Ball Bearing (10) and Spring (11) with Ref Level Rotor (67).

f. Remove the three Studs (59) used to support Ref Level Detent (68).

g. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen the two set screws on front Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7) (between Front

Switch Board A2A1 and Front Switch Diecast (1) on Ref Level Shaft (6); accessible from side of Front Switch

Assembly). Remove Ref Level Rotor (67) and Ref Level Shaft (6) with rear Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7) still attached.

NOTE

Rear Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7) on Ref Level Shaft (6) is preset at 9.525

mm (03 in.) from end of shaft (see Figure 848A). Do not remove drive hub unless necessary for repair.

20.

Disassembly of RESOLUTION BW Switch.

a. Use a 1/4-inch Nut Driver to remove two Hex Nuts (22) attaching Bandwidth Switch Board (66) to Front Switch

Assembly, and set board to one side (without detaching wires).

b. Remove Rotor Spacer (64) and Bandwidth Rotor (63). Be careful to keep Ball Bearings (10) and Springs (62) with rotor.

c. Remove Bandwidth Shaft (61), with rear Drive Hub (14) still attached, from Front Switch Assembly.

NOTE

21.

d. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen the two screws on Coupling Hub (60) attached to Frequency Span Shaft (9), and remove hub from shaft.

e. Remove the two Studs (59) used to support Bandwidth Switch Board (66). Remove Bandwidth Detent (58) from

Front Switch Assembly.

Disconnect Probe Power wires (0, 92, 97) from Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1.

22.

Rear Drive Hub (14) on Bandwidth Shaft (61) is preset flush with collar on shaft

(see Figure 848B). Do not remove drive hub unless necessary for repair.

23.

Remove Screw (23) and Spacer (24) attaching Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 to Front Switch Diecast (1) above DPM Display.

Remove the three remaining Screws (54, not shown in Figure 6-3) attaching Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1

to Front Switch Diecast (1).

24.

Twist the left side of Front Switch Board Assembly A2Al down approximately 1/8-inch to provide clearance from

Front Switch Diecast support arm (upper left corner). Lift Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1 from Front Switch

Diecast (1) and set aside.

8-109

Model 8558B

25.

Removal of Rotor Assemblies:

TM 11-6625-3061-14 a. Remove Attenuator Drive Rotor (8), front Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7), and Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17) from Front Switch Diecast (1), and set these parts aside.

b. Remove Frequency Span Rotor (13) with associated parts (9-12, 14-16) from Front Switch Diecast (1), and set aside. Be careful to keep Ball Bearings (10) and Springs (11) with Frequency Span Rotor (13).

NOTE

Drive Hub (14) on Frequency Span Shaft (9) is preset at 12.954 mm (0.510 in.) from end of shaft (see Figure 848C). Do not remove drive hub from shaft unless necessary for repair.

c. Remove SWEEP TRIGGER, MANUAL SWEEP, and SWEEP TIME/DIV knobs using a no. 4 hex wrench.

26.

d. Remove both remaining rotor assemblies from Front Switch Diecast (1), and set aside. Be careful to keep Ball

Bearings (10) and Springs (27) with their respective rotors.

Use a no. 4 hex wrench to loosen the two set screws in Lock Knob. Remove Lock Knob.

27.

Use a 5/16-inch nut driver to remove the two nuts attaching front panel to Front Switch Diecast (1). Remove front panel from Front Switch Diecast.

28.

Disassembly of Lock: a. Press Locking Link (5) into Front Switch Diecast (1) to release pressure on Dowel Pin (4). Remove Dowel Pin

through cutout in Front Switch Diecast. (Individual parts are identified in Figure 8-50.)

b. Remove Locking Link (5), Locking Shaft (3), and Lock Spring (2) from Front Switch Diecast.

CLEANING AND INSPECTION OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY

1.

2.

3.

All switch contacts must be totally clean and grease-free for proper operation. Use a 50-50 mixture of isopropyl alcohol and distilled water to thoroughly clean switch rotor contacts and Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1.

Avoid touching contacts with fingers.

Inspect for bent or damaged shafts, worn or broken contacts, weak or broken springs, rough feeling potentiometers, cracked castings, and damaged PC boards. Check for signs of corrosion or rust. Replace any suspect parts.

A special Instrument Grease, (see list of Tools and Materials at beginning of these procedures) is recommended exclusively for use during switch reassembly. Lubrication is essential for proper operation of switches and lock.

A small brush is recommended for applying the Instrument Grease.

CAUTION

Misapplied grease might cause intermittent switch connections. Utmost care must be taken during reassembly to avoid excessive application of grease and contamination of switch contacts. Avoid getting grease on fingers.

8-110

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

ASSEMBLY OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY

1.

Assembly of Lock: a. Lightly grease Locking Shaft (3) and insert into Front Switch Diecast (1). Lightly grease bearing surfaces of

Locking Link (5).

b. Insert Lock Spring (2) into Front Switch Diecast (1). Press Locking Link (5) fully into Front Switch Diecast and insert Dowel Pin (4) through access cutout (left side of lock boss) to hold lock mechanism in place. Check for correct lock operation.

2.

3.

CAUTION

Pressed-in mounting studs on front panel will break if overtightened.

Use a 5/16-inch nut driver and two hex nuts to carefully install front panel (with pushbutton bezels and DPM window installed) on Front Switch Diecast (1).

Use a no. 4 hex (Allen) wrench to install lock knob on Locking Shaft (3). Base of Lock Knob should clear front panel when Locking Shaft is pushed in.

4.

Installation of Rotor Assemblies: a. Lightly grease all switch rotor detent holes on back of Front Switch Diecast (1).

b. Place Front Switch Assembly on flat working surface with front panel face-down and lock mechanism facing you.

Prop sides of switch assembly to provide clearance for knobs and shafts during assembly (be careful not to scratch front panel enamel).

c. Inspect SWEEP TRIGGER rotor assembly (10, 12, 27-31). Stop Arm (30) and Horseshoe Spring (31) are held in position by Push-on Retainer (29) and should move smoothly without binding (see Figure 849A). Roll Pins (12) should be positioned in hole 7 and hole 18 on SWEEP TRIGGER Rotor (28). Check that Spring (27) and Ball

Bearing (10) are in position.

d. Lightly grease long side of SWEEP TRIGGER Shaft (28) and insert SWEEP TRIGGER rotor assembly into leftmost bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1). Position rotor so that Ball Bearing (10) aligns with stop boss on left

side of Front Switch Diecast (see Figure 8-51).

e. Inspect SWEEP TIME/DIV rotor assembly (10, 25-28), Figure 8-49B. MANUAL SWEEP Shaft (26) should be

lightly greased and should turn freely inside SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft (28). Check that Spring (27) and Ball

Bearing (10) are in position. Note that there are no roll pins inserted in the SWEEP TIME/DIV Rotor (28).

f. Lightly grease long side of SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft (28) and insert SWEEP TIME/DIV rotor assembly into next

bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1) (see Figure 8-51).

g. Inspect FREQ SPAN/DIV rotor assembly (9-16). If Drive Hub (14) has been loosened or removed from

Frequency Span Shaft (9), refer to Figure 8-49C for correct dimensions for adjustment. Roll Pins (12) should be

positioned in hole 1 and hole 16 on Frequency Span Rotor (13), as shown in Figure 849C. Slotted Bushing (15),

Hairpin Spring (16), and Frequency Span Shaft must be lightly greased where they contact each other for proper operation of push-pull mechanism. Check that Springs (11), Ball Bearings (10), Slotted Bushing, and Hairpin

Spring are in correct position.

8-111

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 h. Lightly grease long side of Frequency Span Shaft (9) and insert FREQ SPAN/DIV rotor assembly (9-16) into next bushing in Front Switch Diecast (I). Position FREQ SPAN/DIV rotor assembly so that stop boss on Front Switch

Diecast does not fall within small span between Roll Pins (12), as shown in Figure 8-51.

i. Inspect Attenuator Drive Rotor (8). Roll Pins (12) should be positioned in hole 1 and hole 9, as shown in Figure

8-49D.

j. Inspect front Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7). Note that pin is offset to one side of drive hub; place drive hub over right-most bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1) with this side down (i.e., pin as close as possible to Front

Switch Diecast) for proper switch operation.

NOTE

Correct side of front Anticrush Drive Hub (7) must be oriented towards Front

Switch Diecast (1) for proper operation of Front Switch Assembly.

k. Set Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) over Anticrush Drive Hub (7) with Attenuator Drive Rotor gear facing up. Long pin on Attenuator Drive Rotor should protrude through curved slot in diecast.

l. Lightly grease gear end of Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17) and insert into Front Switch Diecast (1) as shown in

Figure 8-51 Place metal Washer (18) on shaft.

m. Clean contact fingers on all rotors using lint-free cloth and isopropyl alcohol/distilled water mixture. All rotors

should be in proper position as shown in Figure 8-51

5. Installation of Front Switch Board Assembly A2A1: a. Inspect Front Switch Board Assembly. Check switch traces for dirt, grease, or wear. Check interconnect wires, solder joints, pushbutton switches, and ribbon cables (52, 53).

b. Clean switch traces using lint-free cloth and isopropyl alcohol/distilled water mixture. No residue should be visible on traces.

c. Use a 1/4-inch nut driver to tighten Hex Nuts (22) and Screws (19) fastening DPM Mounting Brackets (20, 21) to

Front Switch Board Assembly.

d. Use a 3/8-inch open-end wrench to tighten Hex Nut (36) and Lockwasher (35) attaching FREQUENCY ZERO

Potentiometer (37) to Front Switch Board Assembly. Use a no. 2 spline (Bristol) wrench to install FREQUENCY

ZERO Knob (34).

e. Use a 3/8-inch open-end wrench to tighten Hex Nut (36) and Lockwasher (35) attaching VIDEO FILTER

Potentiometer (39) and metal Washer (38) to Front Switch Board Assembly.

f. Use a 1/2-inch open-end wrench to tighten inner Hex Nut (32) and Washer (33) attaching Dual Tune Pot assembly (25, 32, 33, 40-51, 77) to Front Switch Board Assembly. Note that Roll Pin (12) aligns with hole in switch board to locate Dual Pot Bracket (45); Washer (33) between bracket and switch board is critical to proper

switch operation. See Figure 8-52 for front view of assembled switch board.

g. Check Dual Tune Pot assembly for smooth operation and proper gear meshing; disassemble and lightly grease shafts if necessary. Install second Hex Nut (32) mid-way onto Coarse Tune Shaft Bushing (42).

h. Set Front Switch Board Assembly into place on partially-assembled Front Switch Assembly and use a Stud (59) on right-most side of switch assembly to loosely fasten switch board to Front Switch Diecast (1).

8-112

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 i. With one Stud (59) in place but not tight, twist left side of Front Switch Board Assembly up approximately 1/8inch to fasten switch board under Front Switch Diecast support arm (upper left corner) and align switch shafts.

j. Loosely install the three remaining Screws (54, not shown in Figure 6-3) used to fasten Front Switch Board

Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1).

k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to temporarily install SWEEP TRIGGER, SWEEP TIME/DIV, MANUAL SWEEP, and

FREQ SPAN/DIV knobs. Insert FREQUENCY CAL pushbutton through front panel and fasten with dress nut.

Use a 13/64-inch open-end wrench to tighten nut to front panel.

CAUTION

Do not overtighten screws and studs into Front Switch Diecast (1).

l. Tighten Stud (59) and left-most Screw (54) attaching Front Switch Board Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1).

Check all switch rotors for smooth, free switch action. Readjust position of Front Switch Board Assembly as necessary for proper switch action.

m. Install Screw (23) and Spacer (24) used to attach Front Switch Board Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1) above DPM Display.

n. Tighten the two remaining Screws (54) attaching Front Switch Board Assembly to Front Switch Diecast (1).

o. Recheck all switch rotors for smooth, free switch action and readjust Front Switch Assembly as necessary.

p. Connect PROBE POWER wires (0, 92, 97) to respective pins on Front Switch Board Assembly.

6. Assembly of RESOLUTION BW Switch: a. Place Coupler Hub (60) on Frequency Span Shaft (9) with pin facing up (away from Front Switch Assembly). Do not tighten Coupler Hub at this time.

b. Center Bandwidth Detent (58) over Coupler Hub (60) with stop tab towards top of Front Switch Assembly, and fasten to Front Switch Assembly using two Studs (59).

c. If Drive Hub (14) has been removed or loosened from Bandwidth Shaft (61), refer to Figure 8-48B for proper

adjustment. Lightly grease narrow end of Bandwidth Shaft (61) and detent holes on Bandwidth Detent (58).

Insert Bandwidth Shaft (61) through Frequency Span Shaft (9).

d. Inspect RESOLUTION BW Rotor (63). Roll Pins (12) should be positioned in hole 1 and hole 18 as shown in

Figure 8-49E. Check that Springs (62) and Ball Bearings (10) are in position.

e. Place RESOLUTION BW Rotor (63) onto Bandwidth Shaft (61). Position RESOLUTION BW Rotor assembly so that stop tab does not fall within small span between Roll Pins (12).

f. Place Rotor Spacer (64) onto RESOLUTION BW Rotor (63).

g. Clean contract fingers on RESOLUTION BW Rotor and switch traces on Bandwidth Switch Board (66) using lintfree cloth and isopropyl alcohol/distilled water mixture.

h. Use a 1/4-inch nut driver to fasten Bandwidth Switch Board (66) to Front Switch Assembly with two Hex Nuts

(22). End of Bandwidth Shaft (61) must not bind against hole in board. Align MANUAL SWEEP Shaft (26) with

MANUAL SWEEP Potentiometer (65) by turning MANUAL SWEEP knob clockwise until shaft engages with

MANUAL SWEEP Potentiometer.

8-113

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

NOTE

Depth of MANUAL SWEEP Shaft (26) can be adjusted if necessary by carefully tapping

SWEEPTIME/DIV Shaft (28) farther into the white plastic rotor.

i. Turn Front Switch Assembly over and remove FREQ SPAN/DIV knob using a no. 4 hex wrench.

7.

j. Install Retainer Clip (25) on Bandwidth Shaft (61).

k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to temporarily install FREQ SPAN/DIV and RESOLUTION BW knobs.

l. Pull and turn FREQ SPAN/DIV Knob until a set screw is visible on Coupling Hub (60). Push FREQ SPAN/DIV knob in and out to align pin on Coupling Hub with slots in Bandwidth Rotor (63). With FREQ SPAN/DIV knob pushed in and Coupling Hub flush against Bandwidth Rotor (pin aligned), tighten set screw using a no. 4 hex wrench. Turn FREQ SPAN/DIV knob until second set screw is visible, and tighten second set screw.

m. Push FREQ SPAN/DIV knob in and out while observing Bandwidth Rotor (63). Bandwidth Rotor will not move if

Coupling Hub (60) is properly aligned. Readjust Coupling Hub as necessary for proper operation.

Assembly of REFERENCE LEVEL Switch: a. Install remaining two Studs (59) on Front Switch Assembly. Check that all screws and studs have been tightened.

b. If rear Anticrush Drive Hub Assembly (7) has been loosened or removed from Ref Level Shaft (6), refer to Figure

8-48A for correct dimensions for adjustment.

c. Inspect Ref Level Rotor (67). Roll Pins (12) should be positioned in hole 1 and hole 9, as shown in Figure 849F.

Check that Spring (11) and Ball Bearing (10) are in position. Insert Ref Level Shaft (6) through Ref Level Rotor so that rear Anticrush Drive Hub (7) seats properly into rotor.

d. Lightly grease long end of Ref Level Shaft (6) and insert through Front Switch Board Assembly A2Al, Attenuator

Drive Rotor (8), front Anticrush Drive Hub (7), and bushing in Front Switch Diecast (1).

e. Lightly grease detent holes on flat side of Ref Level Detent (68). Mount detent on three Studs (59) and fasten tightly with three Standoffs (69).

CAUTION

Hollow Ref Level Shaft (6) might be damaged if set screws in Rotating Lockout

(70) are tightened excessively.

f. Place Rotating Lockout (70) on Ref Level Shaft (6) with teeth flat against Ref Level Detent (68). Lockout teeth should be aligned to miss pin on Ref Level Detent when Ref Level Shaft is pushed in (switch in any detent position). With Ref Level Shaft fully extended from front panel, use a no. 4 hex wrench to tighten Rotating

Lockout.

g. Push Ref Level Shaft (6) in and out and check for smooth mechanical feel and proper Rotating Lockout (70) alignment. Rotating Lockout should not bind against Ref Level Detent (68) and should allow Ref Level Shaft to turn smoothly between detent positions. Adjust Rotating Lockout as necessary for proper operation.

8-114

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 h. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to lightly tighten one set screw in front Anticrush Drive Hub (7) visible between

Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) and Front Switch Diecast (1).

i. Turn Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) so that long pin (for Input Attenuator pointer) is at bottom of Front Switch Diecast

(1). Hold Attenuator Drive Rotor in position and push in on Ref Level Shaft (6) to align front Anticrush Drive Hub

(7).

j. Push Ref Level Shaft (6) in and out while observing Ref Level Rotor (67) and Attenuator Drive Rotor (8). Rotors will not move when front Anticrush Drive Hub (7) is properly adjusted.

k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to firmly tighten both set screws in front Anticrush Drive Hub (7). Recheck Ref Level

Shaft (6) as in step j, and readjust front Anticrush Drive Hub as necessary.

l. Slip Miter Gear (57) over Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17). Do not tighten at this time.

8.

m. Inspect Ref Level Fine Assembly (35, 36, 72-76). Ref Level Fine Shaft (72) should turn smoothly. Check Ref

Level Fine Potentiometer (76) and connecting wires for good electrical connections. Lightly grease Ref Level

Fine Shaft and hollow Index Disc Locator (71) shaft.

n. Install Index Disc Locator (71) on Front Switch Assembly. Hole in locator bar rides over left-most Standoff (69) used to support Ref Leve Fine Pot Plate (75). Install Ref Level Fine Assembly (35, 36, 72-76) on Front Switch

Assembly with three Screws (54). Connecting wires should be routed as shown in Figure 8-53. Ref Level Fine

Shaft (72) should turn smoothly without binding over its full rotation. Adjust position of Ref Level Fine Pot Plate as necessary.

o. Use a new tiewrap to attach Ref Level Fine connecting wires to Standoff (69) as shown in Figure 8-53.

Installation of RF Input Attenuator A3: a. Mount RF Input Attenuator to Attenuator Bracket (55) using two Screws (53). Check all eight attenuator positions by hand for proper detent action and smooth operation. Leave attenuator in full counter-clockwise position.

b. Slide Miter Gear (57) to end of Attenuator Shaft Assembly (17) against Ref Level Fine Pot Plate (75). Set

Attenuator Assembly in place on Front Switch Assembly, with notch in Attenuator Bracket (55) lightly greased and aligned with Attenuator Shaft Assembly. Use Washer (56) and Screw (19) to fasten Attenuator Bracket to lower left corner of Front Switch Diecast (1). (Do not tighten Miter Gear at this time.) c. Insert RF Input Cable Assembly W1 through front panel and loosely attach with hex nut. Carefully connect cable assembly to RF Input Attenuator using a 5/16-inch open-end wrench. Tighten cable assembly to front panel using a 5/8-inch open-end wrench (Options 001 and 002: use special 9/16-inch nut driver to tighten front panel dress nut).

NOTE

Front-panel control knobs and their attaching parts are identified in Figure 6-2.

Numbers in parentheses match numerical callouts on Figure 6-3.

9.

Installation of Knobs: a. Turn SWEEP TRIGGER Shaft (28) fully clockwise (as seen from front of Front Switch Assembly) to spring4oaded SINGLE position and release. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to install SWEEP TRIGGER knob with

SINGLE line aligned with painted arrow on front panel. Check for proper switch operation and alignment.

8-115

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14 b. Turn SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft (28) to align Ball Bearing (10) on SWEEP TIME/DIV Rotor with left-most edge of stop boss on Front Switch Diecast (1). This positions SWEEP TIME/DIV Rotor with Ball Bearing slightly right of

12 o'clock position (as seen from front of Front Panel Assembly). Use a no. 4 hex wrench to lightly tighten

SWEEP TIME/DIV knob onto SWEEP TIME/DIV Shaft with approximate center of green AUTO position aligned with painted arrow on front panel. Turn SWEEP TIME/DIV knob to any calibrated sweep time position and align knob markings exactly with painted arrow on front panel. Tighten SWEEP TIME/DIV knob and check for proper switch operation and alignment.

c. Uncouple RESOLUTION BW Shaft (61) from FREQ SPAN/DIV Shaft (9) by pulling both shafts out. Turn each shaft fully clockwise. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to install FREQ SPAN/DIV knob with 100 MHz indicated, checking that the plastic indicator guide on back of knob does not completely bottom into hole in Front Switch Diecast (1).

Install RESOLUTION BW Knob with 3 MHz indicated. Check for proper operation and alignment of both switches. Push-pull action should be smooth and positive.

d. Set nylon shim washer(s) and Index Disc (see Figure 6-2) in place on REFERENCE LEVEL knob to check for

proper shim width. Nylon washers should shim Index Disc slightly away from labelled ring on REFERENCE

LEVEL knob to prevent rubbing against painted numbers. Add or remove shim washers as necessary to provide slight clearance.

e. Turn Attenuator Drive Rotor (8) fully counter-clockwise so that Input Attenuator Pointer guide pin (P/O 8) is at bottom of front panel. Turn Ref Level Shaft (6) fully clockwise. Place plastic Input Attenuator Pointer over guide pin (pointer should indicate 70 dB). Place large end of conical spring against Input Attenuator Pointer and slide

REFERENCE LEVEL knob, nylon washer(s), and Index Disc (from step d) onto Ref Level Shaft, securing with retainer clip.

f. Use a no. 6 hex wrench to adjust Miter Gears (57) for alignment of Input Attenuator Pointer with 70 dB front panel label and proper gear mesh (Input Attenuator A3 still in full counter-clockwise position).

g. Turn REFERENCE LEVEL knob to indicate level of CAL OUTPUT signal (i.e., -30 dB; Option 002: +20 dBm V) and tighten knob securely with a no. 4 hex wrench. Check for proper operation and alignment of REFERENCE

LEVEL and INPUT ATTEN controls, and readjust knob, gears, and Rotating Lockout (70) as necessary.

Reference Level should range from -10 dBm to -100 dBm with 0 dB INPUT ATTEN selected (Option 002: +40 dBm V to -50 dBm).

h. Turn REF LEVEL FINE Shaft (72) fully counter-clockwise and use a no. 4 hex wrench to install REF LEVEL

FINE knob with 0 dB indicated. Check for proper operation and alignment and readjust knob as necessary.

i. Turn BASELINE CLIPPER Shaft and VIDEO FILTER Shaft (39) fully counter-clockwise and use a no. 2 spline wrench to install BASELINE CLIPPER and VIDEO FILTER knobs in OFF position. Check for proper operation and alignment and readjust as necessary.

j. Loosely tighten second Hex Nut (32) on Coarse Tune Bushing (42) against Front Switch Diecast (1). Install front panel nut and washer on Coarse Tune Bushing and tighten with special 1/2-inch nut driver.

k. Use a no. 4 hex wrench to install COARSE TUNE and FINE TUNE knobs. Base of COARSE TUNE knob should clear front panel. Check for proper operation of TUNING control.

8-116

14.

15.

16.

Model 8558B

10.

11.

TM 11-6625-3061-14

INSTALLATION OF FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY INTO HP 8558B CHASSIS

Set Front Switch Assembly into place in chassis, being careful not to bend semi-rigid cables or pinch wires or ribbon cables. Attach Front Switch Diecast (1) to left and right side gussets with four screws.

Connect four wires (0, 916, 918, 923) to correspondingly4abelled pins in upper right corner of Front Switch Board

A2A1.

Attach DPM Driver Assembly A1A2 to DPM Mounting Brackets (20, 21) with four Screws (19).

12.

13.

Connect 14-conductor Ribbon Cable A2A1W1 (52) to DPM Driver Assembly A1A2.

Connect 50-conductor Ribbon Cable A2A1 W2 (53) to Motherboard Assembly A16.

Use a 5/16-inch open-end wrench to carefully connect Semi-rigid Cable W14 to RF Input Limiter U1.

Use special 9/16-inch nut driver to install CAL OUTPUT and 1ST LO OUTPUT connectors to front panel with two dress nuts.

17.

18.

Attach brown CAL OUTPUT Cable W8 to Front Switch Standoff (69) with tiewrap.

Slide HP 8558B into display mainframe, turn instrument ON, and verify proper operation of all controls.

8-117

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-48. Shaft Assemblies

8-118

Model 8558B TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-49. Rotor Assemblies

8-119

Model 8558B

Figure 8-50. Machined Parts

Figure 8-51. Proper Positioning of Rotors on Front Switch Diecast

8-120

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Model 8558B

Figure 8-52. Front View of Switchboard Assembly A2A1

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-53. Rear View of Front Switch Assembly A2

8-121/8-122(blank)

DA Pam 310-1

DA Pam 738-750

TM 750-244-2

TM 11-6625-3061-24P

TM 11-6625-3061-14

APPENDIX A

REFERENCES

Consolidated Index of Army Publications and Blank Forms.

The Army Maintenance Management System (TAMMS).

Procedures for Destruction of Electronics Materiel to Prevent Enemy Use (Electronics

Command).

Organizational, Direct Support, and General Support Maintenance, Repair Parts and Special

Tools List, and Maintenance Allocation Chart for Spectrum Analyzer Hewlett-Packard Model

8558B

A-1/(A-2 blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

APPENDIX B

COMPONENTS OF END ITEM LIST

Section I. INTRODUCTION

B-1. Scope

The appendix lists integral components of and basic issue items for Spectrum Analyzer, HP Model 8558B to help you inventory items required for safe and efficient operation.

B-2. General

This Components of End Item List is divided into the-following sections: a.

Section II. Integral Components of the End Item. These items, when assembled, comprise the Spectrum

Analyzer, HP Model 8558B and must accompany it whenever it is transferred or turned in. The illustrations referenced will help you in identify these items.

b.

Section III. Basic Issue Items. Not applicable.

B-3. Explanation of Columns a.

Illustration. This column is divided as follows:

(1) Figure number. Indicates the figure number of the illustration on which item is shown.

(2) Item number. The number used to identify item called out in the illustration.

b.

National Stock Number. Indicates the National Stock Number assigned to the item and which will be used for requisitioning.

c. Description. Indicated the Federal item name and, if required, a minimum description to identify the item. The part number indicated the primary number used by the manufacturer, which controls the design and characteristics of the item by means of its engineering drawings, specifications, standards, and inspection requirements to identify an item or range of items. Following the part number, the Federal Supply Code for Manufacturers (FSCM) is shown in parentheses.

d.

Location. The physical location of each item listed is given in the column. The lists are designed to inventory all items in one

B-1

TM 11-6625-3061-14 area of the major item before moving in to an adjacent area.

e.

Usable on Code. Not applicable.

f.

Quantity Required (Qty Reqd). This column lists the quantity of each item required for a complete major item.

g.

Quantity. This column is left blank for use during the inventory. Under the Rcvd column, list the quantity you actually receive on your major item. The Date columns are for your use when you inventory the major item.

B-2

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Section II. INTEGRAL COMPONENTS OF END ITEM

(1) (2) (3) (4) (5) (6) (7)

ILLUSTRATION QUANTITY

(A) (B) NATIONAL DESCRIPTION USUABLE

FIG. ITEM STOCK ON QTY

NO. NO. NUMBER PART NUMBER CAGE LOCATION CODE REQD RCVD DATE

SPECTRUM ANALYZER,

HP MODEL 8558B 28480

B-3

TM 11-6625-3061-14

APPENDIX D

MAINTENANCE ALLOCATION

Section I. INTRODUCTION

D-1. General

This appendix provides a summary of the maintenance operations for Spectrum Analyzer, HP Model 8558B. It authorizes categories of maintenance for specific maintenance function on repairable items and components and the tools and equipment required to perform each function. This appendix may be used as an aid in planning maintenance operations.

D-2. Maintenance Function

Maintenance functions will be limited to and defined as follows: a.

Inspect. To determine the serviceability of an item by comparing its physical, mechanical, and/or electrical characteristics with established standards through examination.

b.

Test. To verify serviceability and to detect incipient failure by measuring the mechanical or electrical characteristics of an item and comparing those characteristics with prescribed standards.

c.

Service. Operations required periodically to keep an item in proper operating condition; ie., to clean

(decontaminate), to preserve, to drain, to paint, or to replenish fuel, lubricants, hydraulic fluids, or compressed air supplies.

d.

Adjust. To maintain, within prescribed limits, by bringing into proper or exact position, or setting the operating characteristics to specified parameters.

e.

Aline. To adjust specified variable elements of an item to bring about optimum or desired performance.

f.

Calibrate. To determine and cause corrections to be made or to be adjusted in instruments or test measuring and diagnostics equip-

D-1

TM 11-6625-3061-14 ments use in precision measurement. Consists of comparison of two instruments, one in which is a certified standard of known accuracy of the instrument being compared.

g.

Install. The act of emplacing, seating, or fixing into position an item, part, module (component or assembly) in a manner to allow the proper functioning of the equipment or system.

h.

Replace. The act of substituting a serviceable like type part, subassembly, or module (component or assembly) for an unserviceable counterpart.

i.

Repair. The application of maintenance services (inspect, test, service, adjust, aline, calibrate, replace) or other maintenance actions (welding, grinding, riveting, staightening, facing, remachining, or resurfacing) to restore serviceability to an item by correcting specific damage, fault, malfunction, or failure in a part, subassembly, module

(component or assembly), end item, or system. This function does not include the trial and error replacement of running spare type items such as fuses, lamps, or electron tubes.

j.

Overhaul. That maintenance effort (service/action) necessary to restore an item to a completely serviceable/operational condition as prescribed by maintenance standards (.i..e., DMWR) in appropriate technical publications. Overhaul is normally the highest degree of maintenance performed by the Army. Overhaul does not normally return an item to like new condition.

k.

Rebuild. Consists of those services/actions necessary for the restoration of unserviceable equipment to a like new condition in accordance with original manufacturing standards. Rebuild is the highest degree of materiel maintenance applied to Army equipment.

The rebuild operation includes the act of returning to zero those age measurements (hours, miles, etc.) considered in classifying Army equipments/components.

D-3. Column Entries a.

Column 1, Group Number. Column 1 lists group numbers, the purpose of which is to indentify components, assemblies, subassemblies,

D-2

TM 11-6625-3061-14 and modules with the next higher assembly.

b.

Column 2, Component/Assembly. Column 2 contains the noun names of components, assemblies, subassemblies, and modules for which maintenance is authorized, c.

Column 3, Maintenance Functions. Column 3 lists the functions to be performed on the item listed column 2.

When items are listed without maintenance functions, it is solely for purpose of having the group numbers in the MAC and RPSTL coincide.

d.

Column 4, Maintenance Category. Column 4 specifies, by the listing of a "work time" figure in the appropriate subcolumn(s), the lowest level of maintenance authorized to perform the function listed in column 3. This figure represents the active time required to perform that maintenance function at the indicated category of maintenance. If the number or complexity of the tasks within the listed maintenance function vary at different maintenance categories, appropriate "work time" figures will be shown for each category. The number of task-hours specified by the "work time" figure represents the average time required to restore an item (assembly, subassembly, components, module, end item or system) to a serviceable condition under typical field operating conditions. This time includes preparation time, troubleshooting time, and quality assurance/quality control time in addition to the time required to perform the specific tasks indentified for the maintenance function authorized in the maintenance allocation chart. Subcolumns of column 4 are as follows:

C - Operator/Crew

O - Organizational

F - Direct Support

H - General Support

D - Depot e.

Columns 5, Tools and Equipment. Column 5 specifies by code, those common tools sets (not individual tools) and special tools, test, and support equipment required to perform the designated function.

f.

Column 6, Remarks. Column 6 contains as alphabetic code which leads to the remark in section IV, Remarks,

which is pertinent

D-3

TM 11-6625-3061-14 to the item opposite the particular code.

D-4. Tool and Test Equipment Requirements (Sec III)

a.

Tool and Test Equipment Reference Code. The numbers in this column coincide with the numbers used in the tools and equipment column of the MAC. The numbers indicate the applicable tool or test equipment for the maintenance functions.

b.

Maintenance Category. The codes in this column indicate the maintenance category allocated the tool or test equipment.

c.

Nomenclature. This column lists the noun name and nomenclature of the tools and test functions.

d.

National/NATO Stock Number. This column lists the National/NATO Stock Number of the specific tool or test equipment.

e.

Tool number. This column lists the manufacturer's part number of the tool followed by the Federal Supply Code for manufacturers (5 digit) in parentheses.

D-5. Remarks (Sec IV)

a.

Reference Code. This code refers to the appropriate item in section II, column 6.

b.

Remarks. This column provides the required explanatory information necessary to clarify items appearing in

section II.

D-4

TM 11-6625-3061-14

(1)

GROUP

NUMBER

00

01

0101

02

03

04

05

06

07

08

(2)

THIRD CONVERTER

08558-60154

A9

BW FILTER NO. 1

08559-60058

All

BW FILTER NO. 2

08558-6019

A13

LOG AMPLIFIER ASSY

5061-5411

A14

SECTION II MAINTENANCE ALLOCATION CHART

FOR

SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP8558B

COMPONENT ASSEMBLY

SPECTRUM ANALYZER

HP8558B

MTBF= 10,000 Hrs

FRONT SWITCH ASSY

08558-60100

A2

SWITCH BOARD ASSY

08558-60160

A2A1

FIRST CONVERTER

08558-60004

A4

SECOND CONVERTER

08558-60097

AS

MOTHERBOARD ASSY

08558-65159

A16

(3)

MAINTENANCE

FUNCTION

Inspect

Test

Test

Adjust

Calibrate

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

Inspect

Test

Replace

Repair

(4)

MAINTENANCE LEVEL

C O F H

0.1

3.0

0.3

0.1

9.2

10.

D

(5)

TOOLS AND

EQUIPMENT REMARKS

3.0

1-20

6

1,3-25

1,2,6-

20,22-

30

10.

B

A

B

(6)

B,C,E

D

0.1

0.3

1.0

4.0

6

0.1

03

1.0

4.0

6

0.1

0.3

1.0

4.0

6

0.1

0.3

1.0

4.0

6

0.1

0.3

1.0

4.0

6

0.1

0.3

1.0

4.0

6

0.1

0.3

1.0

4.0

6

0.1

0.3

1.0

4.0

6

6

0.1

0.5

2.0

6

4.0

6

DRSEL-MA Form 6031,(1 Jul 76) HISA-FM 2314-79

D-5

TM 11-6625-3061-14

SECTION III. TOOL AND TEST EQUIPMENT REQUIREMENTS

FOR

SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP8558B

TOOL OR TEST MAINTENANCE NATIONAL/NATO TOOL

EQUIPMENT CATEGORY NOMENCLATURE STOCK NUMBER NUMBER

REF CODE

1 H TRACKING GENERATOR HP8444A 6625-00-185-4802

2 H FUNCTION GENERATOR HP3310A 6625-01-028-4989

3 H POWER SPLITTER HP11667A 6625-01-017-2713

4 H 10 dB ATTENUATOR HP8491A 5985-00-128-0195

5 H 50 ohm TERMINATOR HP908A

6 F,H TOOL KIT, ELEC EQUIP TK-105/G 5180-00-610-8177

7 H TUNING TOOL 08555-60107

8 H ALINEMENT TOOL, MET TIP 8710-0630 5120-01-080-7650

9 H ALINEMENT TOOL, PLASTIC 8710-0033 1005-00-634-8012

10 H DISPLAY MAINFRAME HP181T

11 H FREQUENCY COUNTER HP5342A 6625-01-103-2958

12 H DIGITAL VOLTMETER HP3455A 6625-01-874-1000

13 H POWER METER HP435A 6625-00-449-9167

14 H POWER SENSOR HP8482A

15 H AMPLIFIER HP8447D 6625-01-065-0305

16 H SIGNAL GENERATOR HP8460 6625-00-318-6304

17 H COMB GENERATOR HP8406A 6625-00-937-3525

18 H 300 MHz LP FILTER TPL300-4AB

19 H STEP ATTENUATOR HP355C 5985-00-525-5074

20 H STEP ATTENUATOR HP355D 5985-00-957-1860

21 H SWEEP OSCILLATOR HP8350A

22 H RF PLUGIN HP83522A

23 H TIME COUNTER HP5308A 6625-01-022-6231

24 H OSCILLOSCOPE HP1741A 6625-01-058-0139

25 H CRYSTAL DETECTOR HP423B 6625-01-035-0626

26 H SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP141T 6625-00-424-4370

27 H BOARD PULLER 03950-4001

28 H EXTENDER BOARD, 6 PIN 08559-60042

29 H EXTENDER BOARD, 10 PIN 85680-60028 6625-01-137-2674

30 H EXTENDER BOARD, 22 PIN 08565-60107

31 H EXTENDER CABLE ASSY 5060-0303 5995-01-036-2960

D-6

TM 11-6625-3061-14

SECTION IV. REMARKS

SPECTRUM ANALYZER HP8558B

REMARKS REFERENCE

CODE

C

D

A

B

E

Adjustments made when combining units with other subassemblies in display frame.

Test, repair, and calibrate by USATSG at general support.

Subassemblies A3, A6, A7, A8, A10, A12, A15, A17 and W1 through W6 are throw-aways.

Repair consists of replacement of subassemblies and mainframe components as required.

A1is not a replaceable subassembly and has no part number.

D-7/(D-8 blank

By Order of the Secretary of the Army:

Official:

MILDRED E. HEDBERG

Brigadier General, United States Army

The Adjutant General

Distribution:

To be distributed in accordance with special list.

JOHN A. WICKHAM JR.

General, United States Army

Chief of Staff

*U.S. GOVERNMENT PRINTING OFFICE: 1986-612-069

Model 8558B

FRONT PANEL FEATURES

1.

VERTICAL POSN: Adjusts vertical position of CRT trace.

9.

1st LO OUTPUT: 50-ohm BNC output provides 2.05-3.55 GHz first LO signal at approximately + 10 dBm. Terminate with

50ohm load when not in use.

2.

3.

4.

VERTICAL GAIN: Adjusts deflection circuit gain for amplitude scale calibration of CRT display.

FREQUENCY CAL: Removes tuning hysteresis from first LO (YIG oscillator).

Should be pressed before calibration and whenever TUNING (22) is changed by more than 50 MHz.

FREQUENCY ZERO: Adjusts

FREQUENCY MHz (20) readout for calibration on LO feedthrough.

10. INPUT 50f: Precision type N (female) signal input connector with 50-ohm input impedance.

Options 001 and 002: INPUT 75f- 75-ohm

BNC (female) signal input connector.

CAUTION

50-ohm BNC connectors might cause damage if used directly with

Option 001 and 002 75-ohm BNC

INPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors.

0 (Zero Span): Spectrum analyzer operates as a manually-tuned receiver, at frequency indicated by FREQUENCY

MHz readout, for time-domain display of signal modulation. 16 calibrated sweep times selectable with SWEEP TIME/DIV control (11).

195 MHz for increased resolution at lower frequencies.

21. START-CENTER: Selects mode of

FREQUENCY MHz (20) readout.

14. REF LEVEL CAL: Adjusts spectrum analyzer RF gain to calibrate top CRT graticule line for absolute amplitude measurements.

22. TUNING: Adjusts spectrum analyzer start or center frequency. Coarse tuning is provided by large knob; smaller knob provides FINE tuning.

180-Series Display Mainframes

15. RESOLUTION BW: Selects spectrum analyzer 3-dB bandwidth. Alignment of

OPTIMUM markings ( > < ) automatically selects optimum resolution bandwidth for any frequency span. Control pushed in to couple mechanically with FREQ

SPAN/DIV.

23. CALIBRATOR (180TR, 182T): Provides 1 kHz square wave at two amplitudes: 250 mV and 10V p-p (not used with spectrum analyzer).

24. Ground Connection (180TR, 182T):

Provides chassis ground connection point.

5.

BASELINE CLIPPER: Blanks variable lower portion of CRT display. Prevents

CRT blooming with a variable persistence storage display mainframe (i.e.

181T/TR).

11. SWEEP TIME/DIV: Selects time required to sweep one major horizontal division on

CRT.

6.

VIDEO FILTER: Post-detection low-pass filter smooths CRT trace by averaging random noise. Filter bandwidth scaled by resolution bandwidth (15) setting. MAX

(detent) position selects 1.5 Hz bandwidth for maximum noise averaging and noise level measurements. MAX VIDEO

FILTER should not be used for CW signal analysis.

AUTO: Automatically selects fastest allowable sweep time as a function of

FREQ SPAN/DIV (13), RESOLUTION

BW (15), and VIDEO FILTER (6) settings to maintain display amplitude calibration. AUTO operation retained with FREQ SPAN/DIV and

RESOLUTION BW controls uncoupled.

7.

8.

SWEEP Indicator: Remains lit during each sweep.

SWEEP TRIGGER: Selects sweep trigger mode.

TIME/DIV: Selects calibrated sweep time; used primarily with 0 (Zero) frequency span for time-domain analysis of modulation waveforms.

Display amplitude calibration not automatically guaranteed for other frequency spans.

MAN: Enables manual frequency scan using MAN SWEEP knob.

VIDEO: Sweep triggered on internal post-detection video waveform. Onehalf major division of vertical deflection

(noise, AM signal, etc.) required to trigger sweep. Normally used with 0

(zero) frequency span for time-domain analysis.

LINE: Sweep triggered at ac line frequency.

12. PROBE POWER: Provides power for high-impedance active probes such as the

HP 1121A. (See Section I of HP 8558B

Operation and Service Manual for details regarding use with Options 001 and 002.)

13. FREQ SPAN/DIV: Selects CRT horizontal axis frequency calibration.

FREE RUN: End of each sweep triggers new sweep.

SINGLE: Single sweep triggered or reset by turning SWEEP TRIGGER clockwise momentarily.

MHz/DIV kHz/DIV: Selects desired frequency span. Alignment of OPTIMUM markings (><) selects optimum resolution bandwidth (15).

16. CAL OUTPUT: BNC output provides 280

MHz, -30 dBm calibration signal from 50f output impedance.

Option 001: 280 MHz, -30 dBm calibration signal from 759 output impedance.

Option 002: 280 MHz, + 20 dBmV calibration signal from 752 output impedance.

28. ASTIG: Adjusts CRT spot shape.

CAUTION

29. INTENSITY: Adjusts CRT trace intensity.

50-ohm BNC connectors might cause damage if used directly with

Option 001 and 002 75-ohm BNC

INPUT and CAL OUTPUT connectors.

30. FIND BEAM: Intensifies trace and forces on-screen display (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).

17. 10 dB/DIV - dB/DIV - LIN (Amplitude

Scale): Selects CRT vertical axis amplitude calibration (logarithmic or linear scale). Reference Level remains constant at top CRT graticule line.

31. HORIZONTAL POSITION: Single knob provides coarse and fine horizontal adjustment of CRT trace.

32. MAGNIFIER: Selects horizontal deflection factor (normally left in X1 position).

18. REFERENCE LEVEL: Adjusts' power level (in dBm or dBmV) represented |by top CRT graticule line. Large outer knob provides adjustment in calibrated 10-dB steps; FINE vernier provides 12 dB of continuous adjustment.

19. INPUT ATTEN: Selects desired RF input attenuation, indicated by blue numbers

(push and turn).

20. FREQUENCY MHz: Displays spectrum analyzer start or center frequency.

Automatically ranges at approximately

25. SCALE (180TR, 182T): Adjusts CRT graticule illumination.

26. TRACE ALIGN: Adjusts CRT trace alignment with horizontal graticule lines.

27. FOCUS: Adjusts CRT trace sharpness.

33. DISPLAY: Selects CRT sweep source

(normally left in INT position).

34. EXT VERNIER: Provides continuous deflection factor adjustment for external CRT sweep signals. In CAL detent position, deflection factor is selected by MAGNIFIER

(32) control (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).

(36) ac or dc coupling (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).

36. EXT INPUT: BNC input for external CRT sweep signal (normally not used with spectrum analyzer).

NOTE

HORIZONTAL EXT INPUT does not sweep the spectrum analyzer first

LO. Analyzer should be set to 0

(zero) FREQ SPANIDIV, AUTO

TIMEIDIV, and SINGLE SWEEP

TRIGGER- when operated with an external horizontal input.

37. Switch with indicator light for turning power ON and OFF.

NOTE

See Appendix A for details regarding HP 181TITR Variable

Persistence Storage Display

Mainframes.

HP 8558B Front Panel, Option 001

HP 8558B Front Panel, Option 002

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 3-1. HP 8558B Installed in HP 182T Display Mainframe

Model 8558B

REAR PANEL FEATURES

1.

P1 Connector: Connects spectrum analyzer plug-in to display mainframe.

output impedance. Output bandwidth controlled by spectrum analyzer

2.

HORIZ GAIN: Allows

±

1/2 major division of horizontal gain adjustment to calibrate spectrum analyzer plug-in with display mainframe.

RESOLUTION BW setting; output amplitude controlled by INPUT ATTEN,

REFERENCE LEVEL FINE, and first six REFERENCE LEVEL positions

(i.e., with 0 dB input attenuation, - 10 through -60 dBm; for Option 002, +

40 through - 10 dBmV).

3.

AUX A Vertical Output: BNC output provides detected video signal from a

50-ohm output impedance. Typical 0-800 mV range corresponds to full

8-division display deflection.

6.

AUX D Horizontal Output: BNC output provides horizontal sweep voltage from a 5Kohm output impedance. -5V to + 5V range corresponds to full

10-division display deflection.

4.

AUX B PENLIFT/BLANKING OUTPUT: BNC output provides a + 15V penlift/blanking signal from a 10K-ohm output impedance when CRT trace is blanked. Otherwise, output is low at 0V (low impedance, 150 mA max.) for an unblanked trace.

7.

Z-Axis Input: BNC input with a 5K-ohm impedance allows external modulation of CRT trace intensity. Approximately + 2V blanks normalintensity trace; negative voltage increases trace intensity. Maximum input voltage

±

20 Vdc.

5.

AUX C 21.4 MHz IF OUTPUT: BNC output provides 21.4 MHz IF signal

(linearly related to spectrum analyzer RF input) from a 50-ohm 8.

NORMALIZER INTER-CONN (180TR/182T): Provides connections for HP

8750A Storage Normalizer.

Figure 3-2. Rear Panel Controls and Connectors (1 of 2)

3-6

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Model 8558B

25

26

27

28

29

30

31

20

21

22

23

24

36

37

38

39

40

32

33

34

35

41

42

43

44

11

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

4

5

6

2

3

1

1

1

7

8

9

10

48

49

50

51

52

53

54

45

46

46

47

47

58

59

60

61

62

55

56

56

57

63*

64

65

66*

Reference

Designation

0624-0099

0624-0206

2200-0103

2360-0115

2200-0170

0380-0005

2260-0003

2200-0105

2200-0164

2200-0168

08558-00108

08558-00089

08558-00088

08558-00087

0380-0005

3050-0105

1400-0082

2420-0001

2190-0016

2950-0043

2190-0068

2950-0054

0370-0606

5040-8817

08565-40011

08558-60161

08558-60164

08558-60165

08558-00114

08558-00121

08558-00122

08558-00116

08558-00115

08558-00003

5061-5426

08565-20093

08558-20037

08558-20036

08565-20051

08558-2003 8

08565-20096

5021-3229

08558-00030

08558-20164

08557-60045

2200-0165

2360-0194

2200-0104

2360-0201

1460-0532

08558-60166

08558-60167

08558-0012 3

08565-00043

0510-0089

08565-60047

08558-20161

08558-20162

5040-8819

0590-1251

0370-1121

08558-60170

08558-60031

08558-60038

0370-3021

08558-20163

08559-20050

0370-3006

0370-3004

08565-60170

2190-0390

2950-0001

2200-0119

3050-0929

4

5

1

7

9

4

0

2

4

3

1

2

3

8

5

9

5

1

6

9

8

4

1

1

7

4

3

1

2

8

9

7

5

8

9

2

1

4

3

0

2

7

1

0

9

3

9

6

9

1

2

8

5

6

6

3

1

3

5

0

0

7

5

5

3

8

5

6

6

8

0

2

6

8

1

6

2

1

1

3

1

1

81

1

12

3

1

2

1

2

2

1

4

1

1

1

1

1

8

1

6

2

2

4

1

1

4

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

4

1

1

1

1

1

3

1

1

4

1

1

1

1

1

2

1

1

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

1

1

1

HP Part C

Number D Qty Description

MECHANICAL CHASSIS PARTS

NOTE

COMPLETE FRONT PANEL ASSEMBLIES (LISTED

BELOW) INCLUDE A2 FRONT SWITCH ASSY,

PANEL, ALL KNOBS, & PROBE POWER INPUT, CAL

OUTPUT, AND LO OUTPUT CABLES

FRONT PANEL ASSY (STD.)

FRONT PANEL ASSY (OPT. 001)

FRONT PANEL ASSY (OPT. 002)

PANEL-FRONT (STD.)

PANEL-FRONT (OPT.001)

PANEL-FRONT (OPT.002)

SIDE GUSSET (LEFT)

SIDE GUSSET (RIGHT)

PANEL (REAR)

GUIDE RAIL (TOP)

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED

EXTRUSION, END PLATE ENCLOSURE

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE

EXTRUSION, ENCLOSURE DIVIDER

EXTRUSION, CIRCUIT ENCLOSURE, TAPPED

WINDOW, FREQ. DISPLAY (GLUED TO 1)

INSULATOR-GUIDE RAIL (BOTTOM)

GUIDE RAIL (BOTTOM)

CABLE ASSY (W10) VERTICAL OUTPUT

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG

SCREW-MACH 6-32 .312-IN-LG 100 DEG

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG

SCREW-MACH 6-32 .5-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-TPG 4-40 .375-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-TPG 6-32 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 440 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 6-32 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 440 .625-IN-LG 82 DEG

SPACER-RND .312 IN-LG .18-IN-ID

NUT-HEX-PLSTC LKG 4-40-THD .141-IN-THK

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .188-IN-LG UNCT 82 DEG

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .438-IN-LG 82 DEG

COVER-LOG AMPLIFIER

COVER-BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 1

COVER-STEP GAIN

COVER-BANDWIDTH FILTER NO. 2

SPACER-RND .312 IN-LG .18-IN-ID

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 4 .125-IN-ID

CLAMP-CABLE .125-iDIA .375-WD NYL

NUT-HEX-W/LKWR 6-32-THD .109-IN-THK

WASHER-LK INTL T 3/8 IN .377-IN-ID

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK

1 WASHER-LK INTL T 1/2 IN .505-IN-ID

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 1/2-28-THD .125-IN-THK

BEZEL-PB .330-IN-SQ;JADE GRAY

PUSHBUTTON- SQUARE; JADE GRAY

POINTER-INPUT ATTENUATOR

SPRING-CONICAL

KNOB ASSY-REFERENCE LEVEL (OPT. 002)

KNOB ASSY-REFERENCE LEVEL (STD. OPT. 001)

INDEX DISK (OPT. 002) REFERENCE LEVEL

INDEX DISK (STD. OPT. 001) REFERENCE LEVEL

RETAINER-RING BSC EXT .188-IN-DIA BE-CU

KNOB ASSY, REF. LEVEL (FINE)

KNOB ASSY, RESOLUTION BW

KNOB ASSY, FREQ. SPAN/DIV

PUSHBUTTON-SQUARE, WILLOW GREEN

NUT-SPCLY 15/32-32-THD .1-IN-THK .562-WD

KNOB-LOCK

CABLE ASSY-PROBE POWER (W16)

CABLE ASSY-75 OHM INPUT (W1) OPT. 001, 002

CABLE ASSY-50 OHM INPUT (W1) STD. SEE FIG 6-1

KNOB ASSY-MANUAL SWEEP

KNOB ASSY-SWEEP TIME/DIV

KNOB ASSY-SWEEP TRIGGER

KNOB ASSY-FINE TUNE

KNOB ASSY-COARSE TUNE

KNOB-BASELINE CLIP/VIDEO FILTER

WASHER-FL NM 1/4 IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK

SCREW-MACH 440 1-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

WASHER-FL NM 1/4 IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD

(SHIM WASHER, NOT SHOWN, USED WITH 63 FOR

PROPER SPACING BETWEEN 46 AND 47.)

7-2. Front Panel Assembly (2 of 3) (CHANGE A)

Mfr.

Code Mfr Part Number

0624-0099

0624-0206

2200-0103

2360-0115

2200-0170

0380-0005

2260-0003

2200-0105

2200-0164

2200-0168

08558-00108

08558-00089

08558-0008 8

08558-00087

0380-0005

3050-0105

1400-0082

2420-0001

2190-0016

2950-0043

2190-0068

2950-0054

0370-0606

5040-8817

08565-40011

08558-60161

08558-60164

08558-60165

08558-00114

08558-00121

08558-00122

08558-00116

08558-00115

08558-00003

5061-5426

08565-20093

08558-20037

08558-20036

08565-20051

08558-20038

08565-20096

5021-3229

08558-00030

08558-20164

08557-60045

2200-0165

2360-0194

2200-0104

2360-0201

1460-0532

08558-60166

08558-60167

08558-00123

08565-00043

0510-0089

08565-60047

08558-20161

08558-20162

5040-8819

0590-1251

0370-1121

08558-60170

08558-60031

08558-60038

0370-3021

08558-20163

08559-20050

0370-3006

0370-3004

08565-60170

2190-0390

2950-0001

2200-0119

3050-0929

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

6-31/6-32 (blank)

Figure 6-2. Mechanical Chassis Parts

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Model 8558B

47

48

49

50

51

52

53

42

43

44

45

46

58

59

60

61

62

54

55

56

57

63

64

65

66

72

73

74

75

76

77

67

68

69

70

71

22

23

24

25

26

27

28

17

18

19

20

21

33

34

35

36

37

29

30

31

32

38

39

40

41

8

9

10

11

12

13

14

15

16

6

7

4

5

1

2

3

Reference

Designation

A2

08559-20040

1430-0568

1460-1542

5001-5825

2100-3452

2100-3593

1430-0567

2190-0390

3050-0086

1460-0019

08558-60168

08558-60171

2200-0103

5001-5817

3050-0105

1430-0036

5001-5816

5021-3220

08558-20058

5021-3225

1460-1860

08558-40004

08558-20139

2100-3332

08558-20030

08558-40005

5061-5423

5021-3221

08558-20061

5061-5422

5021-3217

1490-0841

3050-0080

08558-00021

2100-0542

3050-0017

5021-3213

1460-0012

5021-3227

1480-0017

5001-5818

5021-3218

08559-60060

08558-60098

5021-3224

1410-0006

1460-0623

1480-0059

08558-20066

08558-20059

08558-20089

1460-1376

5061-5424

3050-0032

2200-0105

5001-5813

5001-5814

2260-0009

2200-0111

0380-0034

0510-0015

5021-3226

1460-0578

5061-5425

0510-0027

08558-00053

1460-0537

2950-0001

2190-0016

08558-40007

2190-0067

2950-0006

2100-3066

3050-0028

2100-3973

08558-20114

08558-20113

6

2

8

8

8

2

7

4

6

8

6

9

5

8

9

5

3

6

6

2

6

3

3

3

3

6

0

8

7

1

9

4

0

5

4

6

6

0

3

2

9

4

8

4

2

3

7

8

4

3

0

3

6

5

8

4

8

4

3

2

8

8

0

8

7

7

2

2

5

6

9

4

8

7

4

1

0

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

I

5

1

2

8

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

3

1

1

1

1

1

5

4

1

1

2

2

7

1

1

1

1

3

3

1

4

1

1

4

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

7

3

11

1

1

1

2

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

HP Part C

Number D Qty

08558-60100 2 1

Description

FRONT SWITCH ASSEMBLY (MECH PARTS)

NOTE

SEE A2 FRONT SWITCH ASSY LISTING FOR

ELECTRICAL PARTS; SEE FIG 6-2 FOR FRONT

PANEL PARTS

DIECAST-FRONT SWITCH

SPRING-CPRSN .135-IN-OD .688-IN-OA-LG

SHAFT-LOCKING

PIN-DOWEL .125 OD

LINK-LOCKING

SHAFT-REF LEVEL

HUB ASSEMBLY-DRIVE, ANTI-CRUSH

ROTOR-ATTENUATOR DRIVE

SHAFT-FREQUENCY SPAN

BALL-BRG TYPE .1875-DIA GRADE-50 SST

SPRING-COMPRESSION .18-IN-OD .312-IN-OA-L

PIN-ROLL

ROTOR-FREQUENCY SPAN

HUB-DRIVE

BUSHING-SLOTTED

SPRING-HAIRPIN

SHAFT ASSEMBLY-ATTENUATOR

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 8 .189-IN-ID

SCREW-MACH 4 -40 .312-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

BRACKET-LEFT DPM MOUNTING

BRACKET-RIGHT DPM MOUNTING

NUT-HEX-W/LKWR 4-40-THD .094-IN-THK

SCREW-MACH 4-40.5-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

SPACER-RND .312-IN-LG .116-IN-ID

RETAINER-RING E-R EXT.125-IN-DIA STL

SHAFT-MANUAL SWEEP

SPRING-COMPRESSION

ROTOR/SHAFT ASSEMBLY, DOUBLE CONTACT

RETAINER-PUSH ON

STOP ARM

SPRING-HORSESHOE

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK

WASHER-LK INTL T 3/8 IN .377-IN-ID

KNOB-FREQ. ZERO

WASHER-LK INTL T 1/4 IN .256-IN-ID

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 1/4-32-THD .094-IN-THK

RESISTOR-VAR 5K 5% PREC WW (A2R3) FREQ.

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 12 .25-IN-ID

RESISTOR-VAR 50K 20% 5W(VIDEO FILTER)

SHAFT-FINE TUNE

SHAFT-COARSE TUNE

BUSHING-COARSE TUNE SHAFT

GEAR-SPUR, 40T

SPRING-UNIVERSAL COUPLER

BRACKET-DUAL POT

RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 10K 10%

RESISTOR-VAR PREC W/CP 10-TRN 5K 10%

GEAR-SPUR, 60T

WASHER-FL NM 1/4 IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD

WASHER-FL MTLC 3/8 IN .406-IN-ID

SPRING-COMPRESSION

CABLE ASSY, DPM RIBBON (A2A1W1) (P/O A2A1)

CABLE ASSY, INT RIBBON (A2A1W2) (P/O A2A1)

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

BRACKET-ATTENUATOR

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 4 .125-IN-ID

GEAR-MIT 16-T 32-DP 20-DG PA BRS

DETENT-BANDWIDTH

STUD-.500-IN-LG, 4-40 THD

HUB-COUPLING

SHAFT-BANDWIDTH

SPRING-CPRSN .18-IN-OD

ROTOR-SINGLE CONTACT

SPACER-ROTOR

RESISTOR-TRMR 10K 20% CC 1-TRN(A2A1R4)

BOARD-BANDWIDTH SWITCH (P/O A2A1)

ROTOR-DOUBLE CONTACT

DETENT-REF. LEVEL

STANDOFF-1 .438-1N-LG 4-40 THD

LOCKOUT-ROTATING

LOCATOR-INDEX DISC

SHAFT-REF. LEVEL (FINE)

COUPLING-RGD .375-LG BRS

WASHER-FL NM NO. 5 .13-IN-ID .25-IN-OD

PLATE-REF. LEVEL, FINE POT

RESISTOR-VAR CONTROL WW 10K 5% LIN

WASHER-FL MTLC .25-IN-ID

Mfr.

Code

28480

Mfr Part Number

08558-60100

08559-20040

1430-0568

1460-1542

5001-5825

2100-3452

2100-3593

1430-0567

2190-0390

3050-0086

1460-0019

08558-60168

08558-60171

2200-0103

5001-5817

3050-0105

G462Y(MOD)

5001-5816

5021-3220

08558-20058

5021-3225

C0180-014-0310-S

08558-40004

08558-20139

2100-3332

08558-20030

08558-40005

5061-5423

5021-3221

08558-20061

5061-5422

5021-3217

1490-0841

3050-0080

08558-00021

2100-0542

3050-0017

5021-3213

1460-0012

5021-3227

1480-0017

5001-5818

5021-3218

08559-60060

08558-60098

5021-3224

GRADE 50

1460-0623

1480-0059

08558-20066

08558-20059

08558-20089

1460-1376

5061-54240

3050-0032

2200-0105

5001-5813

5001-5814

2260-0009

2200-0111

0380-0034

0510-0015

5021-3226

1460-0578

5061-5425

0510-0027

08558-00053

1460-0537

2950-0001

2190-0016

08558-40007

2190-0067

2950-0006

2100-3066

3050-0028

2100-3973

08558-20114

08558-20113

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

71041

28480

28480

28480

28480

92830

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

78707

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

6-33/6-34 (blank)

Figure 6-3. Front Switch Assembly

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Model 8558B

Reference

Designation

110

111

112

113

114

105

106

107

108

109

101

102

103

104

104

96

97

98

99

100

115

116

117

118

119

120

121

122

123

83

84

85

86

87

78

79

80

81

82

73

74

75

76

77

93

94

94

94

95

88

89

90

91

92

HP Part C

Number D Qty

3101-0044

00183-67407

0510-0045

0590-0012

08558-20093

08558-00045

08558-00044

5060-0467

08558-60038

08558-60031

08558-00107

0380-0063

1430-0567

1430-0568

1460-1542

3050-0086

08558-00069

08558-00070

08558-20111

08558-20112

08558-20113

08558-20114

1460-0623

2200-0165

6960-0016

2200-0121

2190-0004

2950-0001

7120-7136

2260-0001

08558-20056

08558-20058

2190-0102

3050-0124

08558-20055

3030-0332

08558-40007

2950-0142

08558-20049

2200-0151

08558-20048

1460-0537

08558-00053

08558-00026

2200-0151

2950-0054

2190-0068

2200-0155

08558-20071

08558-20092

08558-00082

08558-00083

08558-00084

2950-0072

9

1

2

6

2

8

9

3

1

4

6

5

8

7

8

6

5

1

7

8

8

0

4

9

0

6

3

4

0

5

8

6

3

5

6

8

2

9

4

5

8

5

3

9

4

5

7

3

3

5

4

0

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

2

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

2

1

1

1

2

1

2

1

1

1

1

1

1

1

4

1

2

Description

Mfr.

Code Mfr Part Number

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 4-40

SHAFT, BANDWIDTH

HUB, COUPLING

WASHER-LK INTL T-15/32 IN .472-IN-ID

WASHER-FL MTLC NO. 5 .13-IN-ID

SHAFT, MANUAL SWEEP

SCREW-SET 2-56 .094-IN-LG CUP-PT SST

KNOB, KNURLED

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .635-IN-THX

SHAFT, SWEEP TIME

WASHER-FL NM ¼ IN .26-IN-ID .562-IN-OD

SHAFT, SWEEP TRIGGER

SPRING-TRSN MUW CD

STOP ARM

DETENT, SWEEP TRIGGER

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .75-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM ½-28-THD .125-IN-THX

WASHER-LK INTL T ½ IN .505-IN-ID

SCRE-MACH 4-40 1-IN1LG PAN-HD-POZI

CABLE, LO OUTPUT

SHAFT, LATCH

PANEL, FRONT (SEE FIG. 6-2 FOR SUB-PANEL)

PANEL, FRONT (OPTION 001)

PANEL, FRONT (OPTION 002)

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM ¼-32-THD .062-IN-THK

SWITCH-PB SPST-NO MOM .5A 115VAC RED-BTN 28480

KNOB 28480

RETAINER-RING F-R EXT .188-IN-DIA STL

NUT-KNRLD-R 15/32-32-THD .062-IN-THK

KNOB, LATCH

28480

28480

28480

KNOB, MANUAL SWEEP

KNOB, SWEEP TIME

CONNECTOR, MALE, PROBE POWER

CABLE ASSY, INPUT, RF

CABLE ASSY, 75 OHM INPUT, RF

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

KNOB, TRIGGER SWITCH

SPACER-RND .125-IN-LG .129-IN-ID

GEAR, SPUR, 60 T

GEAR, SPUR, 40 T

SPRING, UNIVERSAL COUPLER

WASHER-FL MTLC 3/8 IN .406-IN-ID

SPRING

BRACKET, DUAL POT

BUSHING, COARSE TUNE SHAFT

WASHER, THRUSH

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

SHAFT, COARSE TUNE

SHAFT, FINE TUNE

SPRING-CPRSN .18-INOD .312-IN-OA-LG MUW

SCREW-MACH 4-40 .25-IN-LG 82 DEG

PLUG-HOLE TR-HD FOR .125-D-HOLE NYL

SCREW-MACH 4-40 1.1258-IN-LG PAN-HD-POZI

WASHER-LK INTL T NO. 6 .115-IN-ID

NUT-HEX-DBL-CHAM 3/8-32-THD .094-IN-THK

LABEL, HP LOGO

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

28480

08558-20113

08558-20114

1460-0623

2200-0165

6960-0016

2200-0121

2190-0004

2950-0001

7120-7136

Figure 7-2. Front Panel Assembly (2 of 3) (CHANGE A)

2260-0001

08558-20056

08558-20058

2190-0102

3050-0124

08558-20055

3030-0332

08558-40007

2950-0142

08558-20049

2190-0390

08558-20048

1460-0537

08558-00053

08558-00026

2200-0151

2950-0054

2190-0068

2200-0155

08558-20071

08558-20092

08558-00082

08558-00083

08558-00084

2950-0072

3101-0044

00183-67407

0510-0045

0590-0012

08558-20093

08558-00045

08558-00044

5060-0467

08558-60038

08558-60031

08558-00107

0380-0063

1430-0567

1430-0568

1460-1542

3050-0086

08558-00069

08558-00070

08558-20111

08558-20112

7-11/7-12 (blank)

Figure 7-2. Front Panel Assembly (3 of 3) (CHANGE A)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Model 8558B

Figure 7-3. Front Switch Assembly A2, Schematic (CHANGE A)

7-13/7-14 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Model 8558B

Figure 7-6. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly Schematic (CHANGE B)

7-25/7-26 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-5. Simplified Block Diagram

8-15/8-16 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-6. Troubleshooting Block Diagram

8-17/8-18 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-11. A1A2 DPM Driver (and DPM Display), Schematic

8-23/8-24

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-13. A2 Front Switch, Schematic Diagram

8-27/8-28 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-18. A3 Input Attenuator, A4 First Converter, A5 Second Converter and A6 YIG Oscillator, Schematic

8-35/8-36 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-20. A7 Frequency Control, Schematic

8-43/8-44 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-23. A8 Sweep Generator, Schematic (1 of 2)

8-53/8-54 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-23. A8 Sweep Generator, Schematic (2 of 2)

8-55/8-56 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-26. A9 Third Converter and A10 Second IF, Schematic

8-61/8-62 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-30. A11 Bandwidth Filter No. 1, Schematic

8-69/8-70 (blank)

Figure 8-33. A12 Step Gain, Schematic

8-75/8-76 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-35. A13 Bandwidth Filter No. 2, Schematic

8-79/8-80 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

SERIAL PREFIX: 2147A

Figure 8-38. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Schematic (1 of 2)

8-85/8-86 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-38. A14 Log Amplifier Assembly, Schematic (2 of 2)

8-87/8-88 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-42. A15 Vertical driver and Blanking, Schematic

8-95/8-96 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-43. A16 Motherboard Assembly, Components and Test Point Locations Figure 8-44. A16 Motherboard, Schematic Diagram (1 of 2)

8-97/8-98

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-44. A16 Motherboard, Schematic Diagram (2 of 2)

8-99/8-100 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-46. A17 Inverter. Schematic

8-103/8-104 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

Figure 8-47. Location of Major Assemblies

8-105/8-106 (blank)

TM 11-6625-3061-14

PIN: 059359-000

advertisement

Was this manual useful for you? Yes No
Thank you for your participation!

* Your assessment is very important for improving the workof artificial intelligence, which forms the content of this project

Related manuals

advertisement

Table of contents